QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
FORM 20-F/A
Amendment No. 1

(Mark One)    
[    ] REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) or (g)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
 

 

OR

 

[ X ]

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 
  For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2004  

 

OR

 

[    ]

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

 

OR

 

[    ]

SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

Commission file number 1-6262
BP p.l.c.
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
ENGLAND and WALES
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
1 St James's Square
London
SW1Y 4PD
United Kingdom

(Address of principal executive offices)

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act.

Title of each class   Name of each exchange on which registered
Ordinary Shares of 25c each   Chicago Stock Exchange*
New York Stock Exchange*
Pacific Exchange, Inc.*

 

 

 

*Not for trading, but only in connection
with the registration of American Depositary
Shares, pursuant to the requirements of the
Securities and Exchange Commission

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.

None

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act.

None

        Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer's classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report.

 
   

Ordinary Shares of 25c each

 

21,525,977,902
Cumulative First Preference Shares of £1 each   7,232,838
Cumulative Second Preference Shares of £1 each   5,473,414

        Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.

Yes    X        No               

        If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

Yes                  No    X     

        Note — Checking the box above will not relieve any registrant required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 from their obligations under those Sections.

        Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.

Yes    X        No               

        Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of "accelerated filer and large accelerated filer" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act (Check one):

Large accelerated filer    X        Accelerated filer                  Non-accelerated filer           

        Indicate by check mark which financial statement item the Registrant has elected to follow.

Item 17                  Item 18    X     

        If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).

Yes                  No    X     


EXPLANATORY NOTE

Introduction

        This Amendment No. 1 (Amendment No. 1) to the Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2004, as filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the SEC) on June 30, 2005, (the Original Form 20-F), amends portions of the Original Form 20-F to give effect to the Revenues and Cost of Sales Restatement (as defined below) by the registrant as described in further detail below. Except as otherwise stated in this Amendment No. 1, and except as set forth in the Financial Statements with respect to information presented therein, all information presented in this Amendment No. 1, including forward looking statements, is as at June 30, 2005 and has not been updated for events subsequent to the date of the original filing. Certain disclosures are expressly presented as of an earlier date in accordance with disclosure requirements applicable to Form 20-F.

        This Amendment No.1 amends and restates in part Items 3, 4, 5, 15, 18 and 19 of the Original Form 20-F, and no other information included in the Original Form 20-F is amended hereby.

        This Amendment No. 1 does not amend the registrants' Annual Reports on Form 20-F filed with the SEC for the year ended December 31, 2003 or any prior period.

Revenues and Cost of Sales Restatement

        Previously, under US GAAP, revenues associated with over-the-counter forward contracts in oil, gas, NGLs and power were presented on a gross basis under the provisions of EITF 99-19. During 2005, a review was undertaken into the presentation of these transactions. It was concluded that the provisions of EITF 02-03 should have been applied rather than the provisions of EITF 99-19, and the transactions reported on a net basis. Under the provisions of APB 20, management concluded that this change represented an accounting error. Revenue and cost of sales on a US GAAP basis for all periods presented have been restated to adjust for transactions which should be reported net. This restatement, while reducing revenue and cost of sales did not impact the Group's profit for the year as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, profit per ordinary share, cash flow or financial condition.

        The following table sets forth the adjustments made to reported US GAAP revenues, cost of sales and profit for the year.

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

  2001

  2000

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Revenues   (81,756 ) (58,956 ) (32,730 ) (28,316 ) (16,395 )
Cost of sales   (81,756 ) (58,956 ) (32,730 ) (28,316 ) (16,395 )
Profit for the year            

        Refer to Note 50(s) on page F-120 for additional information on the Revenues and Cost of Sales Restatement.

2



TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
   
   
  Page
        Certain Definitions   5
Part I   Item 1   Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisors   8
    Item 2   Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable   8
    Item 3   Key Information   8
            Selected Financial Information   8
            Risk Factors   11
            Forward Looking Statements   13
            Statements Regarding Competitive Position   13
    Item 4   Information on the Company   14
            General   14
            Segmental Information   20
            Exploration and Production   22
            Refining and Marketing   44
            Petrochemicals   55
            Gas, Power and Renewables   62
            Other Businesses and Corporate   70
            Regulation of the Group's Business   72
            Environmental Protection   73
            Property, Plants and Equipment   80
            Organizational Structure   81
    Item 5   Operating and Financial Review   83
            Group Operating Results   83
            Liquidity and Capital Resources   99
            Outlook   105
            Critical Accounting Policies and New Accounting Standards   106
    Item 6   Directors, Senior Management and Employees   117
            Directors and Senior Management   117
            Compensation   121
            Board Practices   139
            Employees   151
            Share Ownership   152
    Item 7   Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions   155
            Major Shareholders   155
            Related Party Transactions   155
    Item 8   Financial Information   155
            Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information   155
            Significant Changes   156
    Item 9   The Offer and Listing   156
    Item 10   Additional Information   159
            Memorandum and Articles of Association   159
            Material Contracts   163
            Exchange Controls and Other Limitations Affecting Security
    Holders
  163
            Taxation   164
            Documents on Display   167
    Item 11   Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk   168
    Item 12   Description of Securities Other Than Equity Securities   177
             

3


Part II   Item 13   Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies   178
    Item 14   Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds   178
    Item 15   Controls and Procedures   178
    Item 16A   Audit Committee Financial Expert   179
    Item 16B   Code of Ethics   179
    Item 16C   Principal Accountant Fees and Services   180
    Item 16D   Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees   181
    Item 16E   Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers   182
Part III   Item 17   Financial Statements   184
    Item 18   Financial Statements   184
    Item 19   Exhibits   184

4



CERTAIN DEFINITIONS

        Unless the context indicates otherwise, the following terms have the meanings shown below:

Oil and natural gas reserves

        'Proved oil and gas reserves' — Proved reserves are defined by the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) in Rule 4-10(a) of Regulation S-X, paragraphs (2), (2i), (2ii) and (2iii). Proved oil and gas reserves are the estimated quantities of crude oil, natural gas, and natural gas liquids which geological and engineering data demonstrate with reasonable certainty to be recoverable in future years from known reservoirs under existing economic and operating conditions, i.e., prices and costs as of the date the estimate is made. Prices include consideration of changes in existing prices provided only by contractual arrangements, but not on escalations based upon future conditions.

(i)
Reservoirs are considered proved if economic producibility is supported by either actual production or conclusive formation test. The area of a reservoir considered proved includes: (A) that portion delineated by drilling and defined by gas-oil and/or oil-water contacts, if any; and (B) the immediately adjoining portions not yet drilled, but which can be reasonably judged as economically productive on the basis of available geological and engineering data. In the absence of information on fluid contacts, the lowest known structural occurrence of hydrocarbons controls the lower proved limit of the reservoir.

(ii)
Reserves which can be produced economically through application of improved recovery techniques (such as fluid injection) are included in the 'proved' classification when successful testing by a pilot project, or the operation of an installed programme in the reservoir, provides support for the engineering analysis on which the project or programme was based.

(iii)
Estimates of proved reserves do not include the following:

(a)
oil that may become available from known reservoirs but is classified separately as 'indicated additional reserves';

(b)
crude oil, natural gas, and natural gas liquids, the recovery of which is subject to reasonable doubt because of uncertainty as to geology, reservoir characteristics, or economic factors;

(c)
crude oil, natural gas, and natural gas liquids, that may occur in undrilled prospects; and

(d)
crude oil, natural gas, and natural gas liquids, that may be recovered from oil shales, coal, gilsonite and other such sources.

        'Proved developed reserves' — Proved reserves that can be expected to be recovered through existing wells with existing equipment and operating methods. Additional oil and natural gas expected to be obtained through the application of fluid injection or other improved recovery techniques for supplementing the natural forces and mechanisms of primary recovery are included as 'proved developed reserves' only after testing by a pilot project or after the operation of an installed programme has confirmed through production response that increased recovery will be achieved.

        'Proved undeveloped reserves' — Proved reserves that are expected to be recovered from new wells on undrilled acreage, or from existing wells where a relatively major expenditure is required for recompletion. Reserves on undrilled acreage are limited to those drilling units offsetting productive units that are reasonably certain of production when drilled. Proved reserves for other undrilled units are claimed only where it can be demonstrated with certainty that there is continuity of production from the existing productive formation. Under no circumstances are estimates of proved undeveloped reserves attributable to acreage for which an application of fluid injection or other improved recovery technique is contemplated, unless such techniques have been proved effective by actual tests in the area and in the same reservoir.

5



Miscellaneous terms

'ADR' — American Depositary Receipt.

'ADS' — American Depositary Share.

'Amoco' — The former Amoco Corporation and its subsidiaries.

'Atlantic Richfield' — Atlantic Richfield Company and its subsidiaries.

'Associated undertaking' — An undertaking in which the BP Group has a participating interest and over whose operating and financial policy the BP Group exercises a significant influence (presumed to be the case where 20% or more of the voting rights are held) and which is not a subsidiary undertaking.

'Barrel' — 42 US gallons.

'BP', 'BP Group' or the 'Group' — BP p.l.c. and its subsidiaries.

'Burmah Castrol' — Burmah Castrol plc and its subsidiaries.

'Cent' or 'c' — One hundredth of the US dollar.

The 'Company' — BP p.l.c.

'Liquids' — Crude oil, condensate and natural gas liquids.

'Dollar' or '$' — The US dollar.

'FSA' — Financial Services Authority.

'Gas' — Natural Gas.

'Hydrocarbons' — Crude oil and natural gas.

'IFRS' — International Financial Reporting Standards.

'Joint venture or JV' — an entity in which the Group has a long-term interest and shares control with one or more co-venturers.

'LNG' — Liquefied Natural Gas.

'London Stock Exchange' or 'LSE' — London Stock Exchange Limited.

'LPG' — Liquefied Petroleum Gas.

'mmbtu' — million British thermal units.

'MTBE' — Methyl Tertiary Butyl Ether.

'NGL' — Natural Gas Liquid.

'Noon Buying Rate' — The noon buying rate in New York City for cable transfers in pounds as certified for customs purposes by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York.

'OECD' — Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development.

'OPEC' — The Organization of Petroleum Exporting Countries.

'Ordinary Shares' — Ordinary fully paid shares in BP p.l.c. of 25c each.

'Pence' or 'p' — One hundredth of a pound sterling.

'Pound', 'sterling' or '£' — The pound sterling.

'Preference Shares' — Cumulative First Preference Shares and Cumulative Second Preference Shares in BP p.l.c. of £1 each.

6



'Subsidiary undertaking' — An undertaking in which the BP Group holds a majority of the voting rights.

'Tonne' — 2,204.6 pounds.

'UK' — United Kingdom of Great Britain and Northern Ireland.

'UK GAAP' — Generally Accepted Accounting Practice in the UK.

'Undertaking' — A body corporate, partnership or an unincorporated association, carrying on a trade or business.

'US' or 'USA' — United States of America.

'US GAAP' — Generally Accepted Accounting Principles in the USA.

7



PART I

ITEM 1 — IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISORS

        Not applicable.


ITEM 2 — OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE

        Not applicable.


ITEM 3 — KEY INFORMATION

SELECTED FINANCIAL INFORMATION

Summary

        This information has been extracted or derived from the audited financial statements of the BP Group presented elsewhere herein or otherwise included with BP p.l.c.'s Annual Reports on Form 20-F for the relevant years which have been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission, as reclassified to conform with the accounting presentation adopted in this annual report. The financial information for 2002 and 2003 has been restated to reflect the adoption by the Group of Financial Reporting Standard No. 17 'Retirement Benefits' (FRS 17) with effect from January 1, 2004. The financial information for 2000 and 2001 has not been restated for FRS 17. The financial information for 2000 to 2003 has been restated to reflect the adoption by the Group of Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract No. 38 'Accounting for Employee Share Ownership Plan (ESOP) Trusts with effect from January 1, 2004.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

  2001

  2000

 
  ($ million except per share amounts)

UK GAAP                    
Income statement data                    
Turnover   294,849   236,045   180,186   175,389   161,826
Less: joint ventures   9,790   3,474   1,465   1,171   13,764
   
 
 
 
 
Group turnover   285,059   232,571   178,721   174,218   148,062
Cost of sales   247,110   201,335   154,615   148,893   120,298

Profit for the year

 

15,731

 

10,482

 

6,795

 

6,556

 

10,120
Per ordinary share: (cents)                    
  Profit for the year:                    
  Basic   72.08   47.27   30.33   29.21   46.77
  Diluted   70.79   46.83   30.19   29.04   46.46
  Dividends per share (cents)   29.45   26.00   24.00   22.00   20.50
  Dividends per share (pence)   16.099   15.517   15.638   15.436   13.791
Ordinary Share data (a)                    
Average number outstanding of 25 cents ordinary shares (shares million undiluted)   21,821   22,171   22,397   22,436   21,638
Average number outstanding of 25 cents ordinary shares (shares million diluted)   22,310   22,429   22,504   22,574   21,783
Balance sheet data                    
Total assets   193,213   172,342   155,621   141,704   144,502
Net assets   77,999   71,720   64,472   65,741   66,010
Share capital   5,403   5,552   5,616   5,629   5,653
BP shareholders' interest   76,656   70,595   63,834   65,143   65,442
Finance debt due after more than one year   12,907   12,869   11,922   12,327   14,772
Debt to borrowed and invested capital (b)   14%   15%   16%   16%   18%

8


 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

  2001

  2000

 
  ($ million except per share amounts)

US GAAP                    
Income statement data                    
Revenues (restated) (c)   203,303   173,615   145,991   145,902   131,667
Cost of sales (restated) (c)   165,354   142,379   121,885   120,577   103,903
Profit for the year (c)   17,090   12,941   8,109   4,467   10,164
Comprehensive income   17,364   19,886   10,256   2,952   7,711
Profit per ordinary share: (cents)                    
  Basic   78.31   58.36   36.20   19.90   46.96
  Diluted   76.88   57.79   36.02   19.78   46.65
Profit per American Depositary Share: (cents)                    
  Basic   469.86   350.16   217.20   119.40   281.76
  Diluted   461.28   346.74   216.12   118.68   279.90
Balance sheet data                    
Total assets   205,648   186,576   164,103   145,990   151,966
Net assets   86,435   80,292   67,274   62,786   65,655
BP shareholders' interest   85,092   79,167   66,636   62,188   65,087

(a)
The number of ordinary shares shown have been used to calculate per share amounts for both UK and US GAAP.

(b)
Finance debt due after more than one year, as a percentage of such debt plus BP and minority shareholders' interests.

(c)
Previously, under US GAAP, revenues associated with over-the-counter forward contracts in oil, gas, NGLs and power were presented on a gross basis under the provisions of EITF 99-19. During 2005, a review was undertaken into the presentation of these transactions. It was concluded that the provisions of EITF 02-03 should have been applied rather than the provisions of EITF 99-19, and the transactions reported on a net basis. Under the provisions of APB 20, management concluded that this change represented an accounting error. Revenue and cost of sales on a US GAAP basis for all periods presented have been restated to adjust for transactions which should be reported net. While reducing the reported amount of revenues and cost of sales, the restating of these transactions on a net basis did not impact the Group's profit for the year as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, profit per ordinary share, cash flow or financial position.

Dividends

        BP has paid dividends on its ordinary shares in each year since 1917. In 2000 and thereafter, dividends were, and are expected to continue to be, paid quarterly in March, June, September and December. Until their shares have been exchanged for BP ADSs, Amoco and Atlantic Richfield shareholders do not have the right to receive dividends.

        BP currently announces dividends for ordinary shares in US dollars and states an equivalent pounds sterling dividend. Dividends on BP ordinary shares will be paid in pounds sterling and on BP ADSs in US dollars. The rate of exchange used to determine the sterling amount equivalent is the average of the forward exchange rate in London over the five business days prior to the announcement date. The directors may choose to declare dividends in any currency provided that a sterling equivalent is announced, but it is not the Company's intention to change its current policy of announcing dividends on ordinary shares in US dollars.

9


        The following table shows dividends announced by the Company per ADS for each of the past five years before the 'refund' and deduction of withholding taxes as described in Item 10 — Additional Information — Taxation on page 164. Refund means an amount equal to the tax credit available to individual shareholders resident in the UK in respect of such dividend, less a withholding tax equal to 15% (but limited to the amount of the tax credit) of the aggregate of such tax credit and such dividend.

        For dividends paid after April 30, 2004, there will be no refund available to shareholders resident in the US. Refer to Item 10 — Additional Information — Taxation for more information.

 
   
  Quarterly

Dividends per American Depositary Share

  First

  Second

  Third

  Fourth

  Total


 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
2000   UK pence   19.3   20.1   21.6   21.7   82.7
    US cents   30.0   30.0   31.5   31.5   123.0
    Can. cents   44.7   44.8   48.2   47.9   185.6
2001   UK pence   22.0   23.5   22.8   24.3   92.6
    US cents   31.5   33.0   33.0   34.5   132.0
    Can. cents   48.3   50.4   52.6   54.9   206.2
2002   UK pence   24.3   23.3   23.4   22.9   93.9
    US cents   34.5   36.0   36.0   37.5   144.0
    Can. cents   54.1   56.7   56.1   57.4   224.3
2003   UK pence   23.7   24.2   23.1   22.0   93.0
    US cents   37.5   39.0   39.0   40.5   156.0
    Can. cents   54.3   54.0   51.1   53.7   213.1
2004   UK pence   22.8   23.2   23.5   27.1   96.6
    US cents   40.5   42.6   42.6   51.0   176.7
    Can. cents   54.8   56.7   52.2   64.0   227.7

        A dividend reinvestment plan is in place whereby holders of BP ordinary shares can elect to reinvest the net cash dividend in shares purchased on the London Stock Exchange. This plan is not available to any person resident in the USA or Canada, or in any jurisdiction outside the UK where such an offer requires compliance by the Company with any governmental or regulatory procedures or any similar formalities.

        A dividend reinvestment plan is, however, available for holders of ADSs through JPMorgan Chase Bank.

        Future dividends will be dependent upon future earnings, the financial condition of the Group, the Risk Factors set out below, and other matters which may affect the business of the Group set out in Item 5 — Operating and Financial Review on page 83.

10



RISK FACTORS

        We urge you to carefully consider the risks described below. If any of these risks actually occur, our business, financial condition and results of operations could suffer, and the trading price and liquidity of our securities could decline, in which case you may lose all or part of your investment.

External Risks

        There are a number of risks that arise as a result of the business climate, which are not directly controllable.

        Competition Risk:    The oil, gas and petrochemicals industries are highly competitive. There is strong competition, both within the oil and gas industry and with other industries, in supplying the fuel needs of commerce, industry and the home. Competition puts pressure on product prices, affects oil products marketing and requires continuous management focus on reducing unit costs and improving efficiency.

        Price Risk:    Oil prices are subject to international supply and demand. Political developments (especially in the Middle East) and the outcome of meetings of OPEC can particularly affect world supply and oil prices. In addition to the adverse effect on revenues, margins and profitability from any future fall in oil and natural gas prices, a prolonged period of low prices or other indicators would lead to a review for impairment of the BP Group's oil and natural gas properties. This review would reflect management's view of long-term oil and natural gas prices. Such a review could result in a charge for impairment which could have a significant effect on the BP Group's results of operations in the period in which it occurs.

        Regulatory Risks:    The oil industry is subject to regulation and intervention by governments throughout the world in such matters as the award of exploration and production interests, the imposition of specific drilling obligations, environmental protection controls, controls over the development and decommissioning of a field (including restrictions on production) and, possibly, nationalization, expropriation, cancellation or non-renewal of contract rights. The oil industry is also subject to the payment of royalties and taxation, which tend to be high compared with those payable in respect of other commercial activities and operates in certain tax jurisdictions which have a degree of uncertainty relating to the interpretation of, and changes to, tax law. As a result of new laws and regulations or other factors, we could be required to curtail or cease certain operations, causing our production to decrease, or we could incur additional costs.

        Developing Country Risk:    We have operations in developing countries where political, economic and social transition is taking place. Some countries have experienced political instability, expropriation or nationalization of property, civil strife, strikes, acts of war and insurrections. Any of these conditions occurring could disrupt or terminate our operations, causing our development activities to be curtailed or terminated in these areas or our production to decline and could cause us to incur additional costs.

        Currency Risk:    Crude oil prices are generally set in US dollars while sales of refined products may be in a variety of currencies. Fluctuation in exchange rates can therefore give rise to foreign exchange exposures.

        Economic Risk - Refining and Petrochemicals Market:    Refining profitability can be volatile with both periodic oversupply and supply tightness in various regional markets. Sectors of the chemicals industry are also subject to fluctuations in supply and demand within the petrochemicals market, with consequent effect on prices and profitability.

11



Reputational Risks

        We set ourselves high standards of corporate citizenship and aspire to contribute to a better quality of life through the products and services we provide. This may create risks to our reputation if it is perceived that our actions are not aligned to these standards and aspirations.

        Social Responsibility Risk:    Risk could arise if it is perceived that we are not respecting or advancing the economic and social progress of the communities in which we operate.

        Environmental Risk:    We seek to conduct our activities in such a manner that there is no or minimum damage to the environment. Risk could arise if we do not apply our resources to overcome the perceived trade-off between global access to energy and the protection or improvement of the natural environment.

        Compliance Risk:    Incidents of non-compliance with applicable laws and regulation or ethical misconduct could be damaging to our reputation and shareholder value.

Operational Risks

        Inherent in our operations are hazards which require continual oversight and control. If operational risks materialized it could result in loss of life, damage to the environment or loss of production.

        Drilling and Production Risk:    Exploration and production require high levels of investment and have particular economic risks and opportunities. They are subject to natural hazards and other uncertainties, including those relating to the physical characteristics of an oil or natural gas field. The cost of drilling, completing or operating wells is often uncertain. We may be required to curtail, delay or cancel drilling operations because of a variety of factors including unexpected drilling conditions, pressure or irregularities in geological formations, equipment failures or accidents, adverse weather conditions and compliance with governmental requirements.

        Technical Integrity Risk:    There is a risk of loss of containment of hydrocarbons and other hazardous material at operating sites, pipelines or during transportation by road, rail or sea.

        Security Risk:    Acts of terrorism that threaten our plants and offices, pipelines, transportation or computer systems would severely disrupt business and operations.

12



FORWARD LOOKING STATEMENTS

        In order to utilize the 'Safe Harbor' provisions of the United States Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, BP is providing the following cautionary statement. This document contains certain forward-looking statements with respect to the financial condition, results of operations and businesses of BP and certain of the plans and objectives of BP with respect to these items. These statements may generally, but not always, be identified by the use of words such as 'will', 'expects', 'is expected to', 'should', 'may', 'is likely to', 'intends', 'believes', 'plans', 'we see' or similar expressions. In particular, among other statements, (i) certain statements in Item 4 — Information on the Company and Item 5 — Operating and Financial Review with regard to management aims and objectives, future capital expenditure, future hydrocarbon production volume, date or period(s) in which production is scheduled or expected to come on stream or a project or action is scheduled or expected to be completed, capacity of planned plants or facilities and impact of health, safety and environmental regulations; (ii) the statements in Item 4 — Information on the Company with regard to planned expansion, investment or other projects and future regulatory actions; and (iii) the statements in Item 5 — Operating and Financial Review with regard to the plans of the Group, cash flows, opportunities for material acquisitions, the cost of future remediation programmes, liquidity and costs for providing pension and other postretirement benefits; and including under 'Liquidity and Capital Resources' with regard to future cash flows, future levels of capital expenditure and divestments, working capital, the renewal of borrowing facilities, shareholder distributions and share buybacks and expected payments under contractual and commercial commitments; under 'Outlook' with regard to global and certain regional economies, oil and gas prices and realizations, expectations for supply and demand, refining and marketing margins; are all forward-looking in nature.

        By their nature, forward-looking statements involve risk and uncertainty because they relate to events and depend on circumstances that will or may occur in the future and are outside the control of BP. Actual results may differ materially from those expressed in such statements, depending on a variety of factors, including the specific factors identified in the discussions accompanying such forward-looking statements; the timing of bringing new fields on stream; future levels of industry product supply, demand and pricing; operational problems; general economic conditions; political stability and economic growth in relevant areas of the world; changes in laws and governmental regulations; exchange rate fluctuations; development and use of new technology; the success or otherwise of partnering; the actions of competitors; natural disasters and adverse weather conditions; changes in public expectations and other changes to business conditions; wars and acts of terrorism or sabotage; and other factors discussed elsewhere in this report including under 'Risk Factors' above. In addition to factors set forth elsewhere in this report, the factors set forth above are important factors, although not exhaustive, that may cause actual results and developments to differ materially from those expressed or implied by these forward-looking statements.


STATEMENTS REGARDING COMPETITIVE POSITION

        Statements made in Item 4 — Information on the Company, referring to BP's competitive position are based on the Company's belief, and in some cases rely on a range of sources, including investment analysts' reports, independent market studies and BP's internal assessments of market share based on publicly available information about the financial results and performance of market participants.

13




ITEM 4 — INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY


GENERAL

        Unless otherwise indicated, information in this Item reflects 100% of the assets and operations of the Company and its subsidiaries which were consolidated at the date or for the periods indicated, including minority interests. Also, unless otherwise indicated, figures for business turnover include sales between BP businesses.

        BP was created on December 31, 1998 by the merger of Amoco Corporation, incorporated in Indiana, USA, in 1889, and The British Petroleum Company p.l.c., registered in 1909 in England and Wales. The resulting company, BP p.l.c., is a public limited company, registered in England and Wales.

        BP is one of the world's leading oil companies on the basis of market capitalization and proved reserves. Our worldwide headquarters is located in London, UK. Our registered address is:

BP p.l.c.
1 St James's Square
London SW1Y 4PD
United Kingdom
Tel: +44(0)20 7496 4000
Internet address: www.bp.com

        Our agent in the USA is:

BP America Inc.
4101 Winfield Road
Warrenville, Illinois 60555
Tel: +1 630 821 2222

Overview of the Group

        For years to December 31, 2004, our operating business segments were Exploration and Production; Refining and Marketing; Petrochemicals; and Gas, Power and Renewables. Exploration and Production's activities include oil and natural gas exploration and field development and production (upstream activities), together with pipeline transportation and natural gas processing (midstream activities). The activities of Refining and Marketing include oil supply and trading as well as refining and marketing (downstream activities). Petrochemicals activities include manufacturing, marketing and distribution. The Petrochemicals segment ceased to report separately as from January 1, 2005 (see Resegmentation in 2005 in this Item on page 17). Gas, Power and Renewables activities include marketing and trading of natural gas, NGL, new market development and LNG, and solar and renewables. The Group provides high quality technological support for all its businesses through its research and engineering activities.

        These segments fall into two groupings: the Resources Business comprising Exploration and Production; and Customer Facing Businesses comprising Refining and Marketing, Petrochemicals and Gas, Power and Renewables.

        The Group's operating business segments are managed on a global basis and not on a regional basis. Geographical information for the Group and segments is given to provide additional information for investors, but does not reflect the way BP manages its activities. Information by geographical area is provided for production and reserves in response to the requirements of Appendix A to Item 4D of Form 20-F.

14



        We have well established operations in Europe, the USA, Canada, South America, Australasia and parts of Africa. Currently, more than 70% of the Group's capital is invested in Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development (OECD) countries with just under 40% of our fixed assets located in the USA, and around 30% located in the UK and the Rest of Europe.

        We believe that BP has a strong portfolio of assets in each of its main segments:

Acquisitions and Disposals

        With effect from February 1, 2002, BP acquired a majority stake in Veba from E.ON. Veba owned Aral, which was Germany's biggest fuels retailer. BP paid E.ON $1.1 billion in cash and assumed some $1.5 billion of debt in return for 51% and operational control of Veba. Under the terms of the agreement, E.ON had the option to require BP to buy the remaining 49% of Veba.

        On June 30, 2002, BP purchased the remaining 49% of Veba from E.ON for $2.4 billion. Separately, E.ON acquired BP's wholly-owned subsidiary Gelsenberg, which held a 25.5% stake in Germany's largest natural gas distributor, Ruhrgas, for $2.3 billion.

15



        As a condition of regulatory approval of the deal, BP was required to dispose of 4% of the combined 26.5% retail market share of BP and Aral in Germany, 45% of its stake in the Bayernoil refinery, two of its three shareholdings in the ARG ethylene pipeline, and to make it possible for a new entrant to supply aviation fuel on competitive terms at Frankfurt airport. During 2003, BP fully complied with the conditions imposed.

        Separately, BP and E.ON sold the bulk of Veba's oil and natural gas exploration and production business to Petro-Canada for $1.6 billion in the second quarter of 2002.

        In addition to the sale of Veba's exploration and production business, 2002 disposal proceeds of $6,782 million included $2,338 million from the sale of our investment in Ruhrgas, with the balance of the proceeds coming from a number of other transactions.

        In August 2003, BP and Alfa Group and Access-Renova (AAR) completed a transaction first announced in February 2003 to create the third largest oil company operating in Russia based on production volume. The company, TNK-BP, is a 50:50 joint venture between BP and AAR, and operates in Russia and the Ukraine. BP's share of the result of the TNK-BP joint venture has been included within the Exploration and Production segment from August 29, 2003.

        AAR contributed its holdings in TNK and Sidanco, its share of Rusia Petroleum, its stake in the Rospan gasfield in West Siberia and its interest in the Sakhalin IV and V exploration licence to the joint venture. BP contributed its holding in Sidanco, its stake in Rusia Petroleum and its holding in the BP Moscow retail network. Neither AAR's association with Slavneft, nor BP's interest in LukArco or the Russian elements of BP's international businesses such as lubricants, marine and aviation were included in this transaction.

        In addition, BP paid AAR $2.6 billion in cash upon completion of the transaction, which was subsequently reduced by receipt of pre-acquisition dividends net of transaction costs of $0.3 billion, and subject to the terms of its agreement with AAR, will pay three annual tranches of $1.25 billion in BP shares, valued at market prices prior to each annual payment. In September 2004, the first of the three annual tranches was paid to AAR in BP ordinary shares.

        In January 2004, BP and AAR completed a subsequent transaction to include AAR's 50% stake in Slavneft within TNK-BP, at which time BP paid $1.35 billion to AAR. Slavneft was previously held equally by AAR and Sibneft.

        The shareholder agreement between BP and AAR establishes TNK-BP in the British Virgin Islands with English law principles governing the legal system. The shareholder agreement establishes joint control between AAR and BP. BP holds 50% of the voting rights in TNK-BP. BP and AAR have equal representation on the TNK-BP Board, with AAR nominating the Chairman and Chairman of the Remuneration Committee, and with BP nominating the Vice Chairman and Chairman of the Audit Committee. BP appoints the Chief Executive Officer of TNK-BP and holds half of the senior management positions.

        Disposal proceeds in 2003 amounted to $6,432 million, and resulted primarily from the sale of various upstream interests and completion of divestments required as a condition of approval of the Veba acquisition.

        On November 2, 2004, Solvay exercised its option to sell its interests in BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe and BP Solvay Polyethylene North America to BP. Solvay held 50% of BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe and 51% of BP Solvay Polyethylene North America. On completion, the two entities, which manufacture and market high density polyethylene, became wholly owned subsidiaries of BP. The total consideration for the acquisition was $1,391 million.

        During 2004, BP China and Sinopec announced the establishment of the BP-Sinopec (Zhejiang) Petroleum Co. Ltd., a retail joint venture between BP and Sinopec. Based on the existing service station

16



network of Sinopec, the new 30-year dual branded joint venture has plans to build, operate and manage a network of 500 service stations in Hangzhou, Ningbo and Shaoxing. Also during the year, BP China and PetroChina announced the establishment of BP-PetroChina Petroleum Company Limited. Located in Guangdong, one of the most developed provinces in China, the 30 year dual branded joint venture is intended to acquire, build, operate and manage 500 service stations in the province within three years of establishment. The initial investment in both joint ventures amounted to $106 million.

        Disposal proceeds in 2004 were $5,048 million which included $2.3 billion from the sale of the Group's investments in PetroChina and Sinopec. Additionally, it includes proceeds from: the sale of various oil and gas properties, the sale of our interest in Singapore Refining Company Private Limited, the sale of our speciality intermediate chemicals and Fabrics and Fibres businesses and the sale of two natural gas liquids plants.

Resegmentation in 2005

        It is our intention to divest the O&D business, possibly starting with an Initial Public Offering in the second half of 2005, subject to market conditions and the receipt of necessary approvals. Additionally, in November 2004, we announced our intention to include the Grangemouth and Lavéra refineries in the new O&D business. In March 2005, we announced the new O&D entity would be called Innovene and would be formed as a separate entity within the Group in April 2005. We intend to retain and grow the A&A businesses.

        As a result, with effect from January 1, 2005:

        In addition to these changes related to the divestment of the O&D business, the Mardi Gras pipeline system in the Gulf of Mexico has been transferred from Exploration and Production to Refining and Marketing with effect from January 1, 2005.

17


Financial and Operating Information

        The following table summarizes the Group's turnover, profit and capital expenditure for the last five years and total assets at the end of each of those years. The financial information for 2002 and 2003 has been restated to reflect the adoption by the Group of Financial Reporting Standard No. 17 'Retirement Benefits' (FRS 17) with effect from January 1, 2004. The financial information for 2000 and 2001 has not been restated for FRS 17. The financial information for 2000 to 2003 has been restated to reflect the adoption by the Group of Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract No. 38 'Accounting for Employee Share Ownership Plan (ESOP) Trusts with effect from January 1, 2004.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

  2001

  2000

Turnover   294,849   236,045   180,186   175,389   161,826
Less: joint ventures   9,790   3,474   1,465   1,171   13,764
   
 
 
 
 
Group turnover (sales to third parties)   285,059   232,571   178,721   174,218   148,062

Total operating profit (a)

 

24,427

 

17,123

 

11,161

 

14,127

 

18,407
Profit for the year*   15,731   10,482   6,795   6,556   10,120
Capital expenditure and acquisitions (b)   17,249   20,012   19,093   14,091   47,549
Total assets   193,213   172,342   155,621   141,704   144,502

*
After minority shareholders' interest

(a)
Operating profit is a UK GAAP measure of trading performance. It excludes profits and losses on the sale of fixed assets and businesses or termination of operations and fundamental restructuring costs, interest expense, other finance expense and taxation.

(b)
Capital expenditure and acquisitions for 2004 includes $1,354 million for including TNK's interest in Slavneft within TNK-BP and $1,355 million for the acquisition of Solvay's interests in BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe and BP Solvay Polyethylene North America; for 2003 includes $5,794 million for the acquisition of our interest in TNK-BP; for 2002 includes $5,038 million for the acquisition of Veba; and for 2000 includes $27,506 million for the acquisition of Atlantic Richfield and $8,936 million for other significant one-off cash investments.

        With the exception of the Atlantic Richfield acquisition, which was a share transaction, and the shares issued to AAR in connection with TNK-BP (see Acquisitions and Disposals in this Item on page 16) all capital expenditure and acquisitions during the last five years have been financed from cash flow from operations, disposal proceeds and external financing.

        Information for 2004, 2003 and 2002 concerning the profits and assets attributable to the businesses and to the geographical areas in which the Group operates is set forth in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 49 on page F-99.

18



        The following table shows our production for the last five years and the estimated net proved oil and natural gas reserves at the end of each of those years.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

  2001

  2000

Crude oil production for subsidiaries (thousand barrels per day)   1,480   1,615   1,766   1,723   1,743
Crude oil production for equity-accounted entities (thousand barrels per day)   1,051   506   252   208   185
Natural gas production for subsidiaries (million cubic feet per day)   7,624   8,092   8,324   8,287   7,346
Natural gas production for equity-accounted entities (million cubic feet per day)   879   521   383   345   263
Estimated net proved crude oil reserves for subsidiaries (million barrels) (a)(b)   6,755   7,214   7,762   7,217   6,508
Estimated net proved crude oil reserves for equity-accounted entities (million barrels) (a)(c)   3,179   2,867   1,403   1,159   1,135
Estimated net proved natural gas reserves for subsidiaries (billion cubic feet) (a)(d)   45,650   45,155   45,844   42,959   41,100
Estimated net proved natural gas reserves for equity-accounted entities (billion cubic feet) (a)(e)   2,857   2,869   2,945   3,216   2,818

(a)
Net proved reserves of crude oil and natural gas exclude production royalties due to others, whether royalty is payable in cash or in kind.

(b)
Includes 40 million barrels (55 million barrels at December 31, 2003 and 17 million barrels at December 31, 2002) in respect of the 30% minority interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.

(c)
Includes 127 million barrels (97 million barrels at December 31, 2003) in respect of the 5.9% minority interest in TNK-BP.

(d)
Includes 4,064 billion cubic feet of natural gas (4,505 billion cubic feet at December 31, 2003 and 1,185 billion cubic feet at December 31, 2002) in respect of the 30% minority interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.

(e)
Includes 13 billion cubic feet (December 31, 2003 nil) in respect of the 5.9% minority interest in TNK-BP.

        During 2004, 796 million barrels of oil and natural gas, on an oil equivalent* basis (mmboe), were added to BP's proved reserves for subsidiaries (excluding purchases and sales). After allowing for production, which amounted to 1,026 mmboe, BP's proved reserves for subsidiaries, were 14,626 mmboe at December 31, 2004. These proved reserves are mainly located in the USA (39%), Rest of Americas (22%) and the UK (10%).


*
Natural gas is converted to oil equivalent at 5.8 billion cubic feet (bcf) = 1 million barrels.

        For equity-accounted entities, 506 mmboe were added to proved reserves, (excluding purchases and sales), production was 444 mmboe and proved reserves were 3,672 mmboe at December 31, 2004.

19



SEGMENTAL INFORMATION

        The following tables show turnover and profit before interest expense, other finance expense and tax by business and by geographical area, for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

Turnover (a)

  Total
sales

  Sales
between
businesses

  Sales
to
third
parties

  Total
sales

  Sales
between
businesses

  Sales
to
third
parties

  Total
sales

  Sales
between
businesses

  Sales
to
third
parties

 
  ($ million)

  ($ million)

  ($ million)

By business                                    
Exploration and Production   34,914   24,756   10,158   30,753   22,885   7,868   25,083   18,109   6,974
Refining and Marketing   179,587   6,539   173,048   149,477   4,448   145,029   125,836   3,366   122,470
Petrochemicals   21,209   780   20,429   16,075   592   15,483   13,064   557   12,507
Gas, Power and Renewables   83,320   2,442   80,878   65,639   1,963   63,676   37,580   1,320   36,260
Other businesses and corporate   546     546   515     515   510     510
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Group turnover   319,576   34,517   285,059   262,459   29,888   232,571   202,073   23,352   178,721
   
 
     
 
     
 
   
Share of joint venture sales           9,790           3,474           1,465
           
         
         
            294,849           236,045           180,186
           
         
         
 
  Total
sales

 

Sales
between
areas

  Sales
to
third
parties

  Total
sales

  Sales
between
areas

  Sales
to
third
parties

  Total
sales

  Sales
between
areas

  Sales
to
third
parties

 
  ($ million)

  ($ million)

  ($ million)

By geographical area                                    
UK (b)   81,155   28,484   52,671   54,971   15,275   39,696   48,748   14,673   34,075
Rest of Europe   54,422   6,928   47,494   50,582   8,672   41,910   46,518   7,980   38,538
USA   130,652   3,603   127,049   108,910   2,169   106,741   80,381   2,099   78,282
Rest of World   68,052   10,207   57,845   52,498   8,274   44,224   34,401   6,575   27,826
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    334,281   49,222   285,059   266,961   34,390   232,571   210,048   31,327   178,721
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Share of joint venture sales                                    
UK           155           144           129
Rest of Europe           296           290           298
USA           212           177           236
Rest of World           9,127           2,863           802
           
         
         
            9,790           3,474           1,465
           
         
         

(a)
Turnover to third parties is stated by origin, which is not materially different from turnover by destination. Transfers between Group companies are made at market prices, taking into account the volumes involved.

(b)
UK area includes the UK-based international activities of Refining and Marketing.

20


Analysis of profit

  Group
operating
profit (a)

  Joint
ventures

  Associated
undertakings

  Total
operating
profit (a)

  Exceptional
items (b)

  Profit
before
interest
and tax

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Year ended December 31, 2004                          
By business                          
Exploration and Production   15,195   2,948   235   18,378   152   18,530  
Refining and Marketing   5,921   31   132   6,084   (117 ) 5,967  
Petrochemicals   (204 ) (36 ) 252   12   (563 ) (551 )
Gas, Power & Renewables   911     15   926   56   982  
Other businesses and corporate   (973 )     (973 ) 1,287   314  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    20,850   2,943   634   24,427   815   25,242  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
By geographical area                          
UK (c)   2,402   (3 ) 9   2,408   (343 ) 2,065  
Rest of Europe   3,130   (7 ) 34   3,157   (87 ) 3,070  
USA   9,039   29   70   9,138   (205 ) 8,933  
Rest of World   6,279   2,924   521   9,724   1,450   11,174  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    20,850   2,943   634   24,427   815   25,242  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31, 2003                          
By business                          
Exploration and Production   12,570   914   272   13,756   913   14,669  
Refining and Marketing   2,319   29   135   2,483   (213 ) 2,270  
Petrochemicals   512   (19 ) 92   585   38   623  
Gas, Power & Renewables   585     (3 ) 582   (6 ) 576  
Other businesses and corporate   (301 )   18   (283 ) 99   (184 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    15,685   924   514   17,123   831   17,954  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
By geographical area                          
UK (c)   1,929   (19 ) 14   1,924   717   2,641  
Rest of Europe   2,259     12   2,271   (151 ) 2,120  
USA   6,566   27   79   6,672   (347 ) 6,325  
Rest of World   4,931   916   409   6,256   612   6,868  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    15,685   924   514   17,123   831   17,954  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31, 2002                          
By business                          
Exploration and Production   8,395   343   268   9,006   (726 ) 8,280  
Refining and Marketing   1,765   24   180   1,969   613   2,582  
Petrochemicals   457   (20 ) 10   447   (256 ) 191  
Gas, Power & Renewables   362     107   469   1,551   2,020  
Other businesses and corporate   (782 )   52   (730 ) (14 ) (744 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    10,197   347   617   11,161   1,168   12,329  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
By geographical area                          
UK (c)   1,211   (14 ) 10   1,207   (88 ) 1,119  
Rest of Europe   2,065   (2 ) 132   2,195   1,817   4,012  
USA   3,493   17   136   3,646   (242 ) 3,404  
Rest of World   3,428   346   339   4,113   (319 ) 3,794  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    10,197   347   617   11,161   1,168   12,329  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 

(a)
Group operating profit and total operating profit are before interest expense and other finance expense, which is attributable to the corporate function. Transfers between Group companies are made at market prices taking into account the volumes involved.

(b)
Exceptional items comprise profit or loss on the sale of fixed assets and businesses or termination of operations.

(c)
UK area includes the UK-based international activities of Refining and Marketing.

21



EXPLORATION AND PRODUCTION

        The activities of our Exploration and Production business include oil and natural gas exploration and field development and production — the upstream activities — as well as the management of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, processing and export terminals and LNG processing facilities — the midstream activities. We have Exploration and Production interests in 26 countries. Areas of activity include the USA, UK, Norway, Canada, South America, the Caribbean, Africa, the Middle East and Asia Pacific. Production during 2004 came from 22 countries. Our most significant midstream activities are in three major pipelines — the Trans Alaska Pipeline System (TAPS, BP 46.9%); the Forties Pipeline System (FPS, BP 100%) and the Central Area Transmission System pipeline (CATS, BP 29.5%) both in the UK sector of the North Sea; and four major LNG plants — the Atlantic LNG plant in Trinidad (BP 34% in Train 1, 42% in Trains 2 and 3, and 37.8% in Train 4); in Indonesia through our interests in Sanga-Sanga Production Sharing Agreement (PSA) (BP 38%), which supplies natural gas to the Bontang LNG plant, and Tangguh (PSA, BP 37%), which is under construction; and in Australia through our share of LNG from the North West Shelf natural gas development (BP 16.7%).

        With effect from January 1, 2004, we transferred certain of our Natural Gas Liquid processing plants to the Gas, Power and Renewables segment in order to consolidate the management of our global NGL activity. The 2003 and 2002 data below has been restated to reflect this transfer.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)


Turnover (a)

 

34,914

 

30,753

 

25,083
Total operating profit   18,378   13,756   9,006
Total assets   83,048   77,703   71,423
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   11,193   15,370   9,659

 

 

($ per barrel)

Average BP crude oil realizations (b)

 

36.45

 

28.23

 

24.06
Average BP NGL realizations (b)   26.75   19.26   12.85
Average BP liquids realizations (b) (c)   35.39   27.25   22.69
Average West Texas Intermediate oil price   41.49   31.06   26.14
Average Brent oil price   38.27   28.83   25.03

 

 

($ per thousand cubic feet)

Average BP natural gas realizations (b)

 

3.86

 

3.39

 

2.46
Average BP US natural gas realizations (b)   5.11   4.47   2.63

 

 

($ per mmbtu)

Average Henry Hub gas price (d)

 

6.13

 

5.37

 

3.22

(a)
Excludes BP's share of joint venture turnover of $8,734 million in 2004, $2,587 million in 2003 and $539 million in 2002.

(b)
The Exploration and Production business does not undertake any hedging activity. Consequently, realizations reflect the market price achieved.

(c)
Crude oil and natural gas liquids.

(d)
Henry Hub First of Month Index.

        Our upstream activities are divided between existing profit centres — that is our operations in Alaska, Egypt, Latin America (including Argentina, Bolivia, Brazil, Colombia, Mexico and Venezuela),

22



Middle East (including Abu Dhabi, Sharjah and Pakistan), North America Gas (Onshore US, the Gulf of Mexico Shelf and Canada) and the North Sea (UK, Netherlands and Norway); and new profit centres — that is our operations in Asia Pacific (Australia, Vietnam, Indonesia and China), Azerbaijan, North Africa (Algeria), Angola, Trinidad, Deepwater Gulf of Mexico and Russia.

        Operations in Argentina, Bolivia, Abu Dhabi and the TNK-BP operations in Russia are conducted through equity-accounted entities.

        The Exploration and Production strategy is to:

        This strategy is underpinned by a focus on investing in a portfolio of large, lower-cost oil and natural gas fields chosen for their potentially strong return on capital employed. We seek to manage those assets safely with maximum capital and operating efficiency. We continue to develop new profit centres in which we have a distinctive position. These new profit centres augment the production assets in our existing profit centres, providing greater reach, investment choice and opportunity for growth.

        In support of growth, 2004 capital expenditure was $9.8 billion, excluding the $1.4 billion payment to AAR to incorporate its 50% interest in Slavneft into TNK-BP. Excluding $5.8 billion for the purchase of our interest in TNK-BP, 2003 capital expenditure was $9.6 billion versus the 2002 level of $9.2 billion. Including acquisitions, capital expenditure and acquisitions in 2004 was $11.2 billion compared with $15.4 billion in 2003 and $9.7 billion in 2002. Development expenditure incurred in 2004, excluding midstream activities, was $7,271 million compared with $7,535 million in 2003 and $7,224 million in 2002. This reflects the investment we have been making in our new profit centres and the development phase on many of our major projects. Capital expenditure excluding acquisitions for 2005 is planned to be between $9.5 billion and $10 billion.

Upstream Activities

Exploration

        The Group explores for oil and natural gas under a wide range of licensing, joint venture and other contractual agreements. We may do this alone or, more frequently, with partners. BP acts as operator for many of these ventures.

        Our exploration and appraisal costs in 2004 were $1,038 million compared to $826 million in 2003 and $1,108 million in 2002. About 22% of 2004 exploration and appraisal costs were directed towards appraisal activity. In 2004, we participated in 118 gross (56.6 net) exploration and appraisal wells in 13 countries. The principal areas of activity were Angola, Egypt, Russia (outside TNK-BP), Trinidad and the USA.

        Total exploration expense in 2004 of $637 million (2003 $542 million, 2002 $644 million) includes the write-off of unsuccessful drilling activity in the Gulf of Mexico ($135 million), in Brazil ($32 million) and in the UK ($13 million).

        In 2004, we obtained upstream rights in several new tracts, which include the following:

23


        In 2004, we were involved in discoveries in Angola, Egypt, Trinidad, Russia and the USA. In most cases, reserve bookings from these fields will depend on the results of ongoing technical and commercial evaluations, including appraisal drilling. Our 2004 discoveries included the following:

Reserves and Production

        BP manages its hydrocarbon resources in three major categories: prospect inventory; non-proved resources and proved reserves. When a discovery is made, volumes transfer from the prospect inventory to the non-proved resource category. The reserves move through various non-proved resource subcategories as their technical and commercial maturity increases through appraisal activity. Reserves in a field will only be categorized as proved when all the criteria for attribution of proved status have been met including an internally imposed requirement for project sanction, or for sanction expected within six months and, for additional reserves in existing fields, the requirement that the reserves be included in the business plan and scheduled for development within three years. Internal approval and final investment decision are what we refer to as project sanction.

        At the point of sanction, all booked reserves will be categorized as proved undeveloped (PUD). Volumes will subsequently be recategorized from PUD to proved developed (PD) as a consequence of development activity. When part of a well's reserves depends on a later phase of activity, only that portion of reserves associated with existing, available facilities and infrastructure moves to PD. The first PD bookings will occur at the point of first oil or gas production. Major development projects typically take one to four years from the time of initial booking to the start of production. Changes to reserves bookings may be made due to analysis of new or existing data concerning production, reservoir performance, commercial factors, acquisition and divestment activity and additional reservoir development activity.

        BP has an internal process to control the quality of reserve bookings which forms part of an integrated system of internal control. BP's process to manage reserve bookings has been centrally controlled for over 15 years and it currently has several key elements.

        The first element is the accountabilities of certain officers of the Company to ensure that there are effective controls in the proved reserve verification and approval process of the Group's reserve estimates and the timely reporting of the related financial impacts of proved reserve changes. These officers of the Company are responsible for carrying out verification of proved reserve estimates and are independent of the operating business unit to ensure integrity and accuracy of reporting.

        The second element is the capital allocation processes whereby delegated authority is exercised to commit to capital projects that are consistent with the delivery of the Group's business plan. A formal

24



review process exists to ensure that both technical and commercial criteria are met prior to the commitment of capital to projects.

        The third element is Internal Audit, whose role includes systematically examining the effectiveness of the Group's financial controls designed to assure the reliability of reporting and safeguarding of assets and examining the Group's compliance with laws, regulations and internal standards.

        The fourth element is a quarterly due diligence review, which is separate and independent from the operating business units, of proved reserves associated with properties where technical, operational or commercial issues have arisen.

        The fifth element is the established criteria whereby proved reserve changes above certain thresholds require central authorization. Furthermore, the volumes booked under these authorization levels are reviewed on a periodic basis. The frequency of review is determined according to field size and ensures that more than 80% of the BP reserves base undergoes central review every two years and more than 90% is reviewed every four years.

        There is no direct link between compensation for executive directors and reserves replacement. Below the level of the executive director in the Exploration and Production segment, no specific portion of compensation bonuses has been directly related to oil and gas reserves targets. Additions to proved reserves was one of several indicators by which the performance of a business unit in the Exploration and Production business segment was assessed for purposes of determining compensation bonuses. Other indicators included production costs, changes in working capital, drilling days, operating efficiency and greenhouse gas emissions.

        For 2005, BP's variable pay programme for the senior managers in the Exploration and Production business segment will be based on Individual Performance Contracts. Individual Performance Contracts are made up of two elements, one of which is based on certain elements of financial performance (cash from operations, capital expenditure, divestments) of the Group as a whole. The other is based on agreed items from the business performance plan, one of which, if they choose, could relate to oil and gas reserves.

        Details of our net proved reserves of crude oil, condensate, natural gas liquids and natural gas at December 31, 2004, 2003, and 2002 and reserves changes for each of the three years then ended are set out in the Supplementary Oil and Gas Information section in Item 18 — Supplementary Oil and Gas Information beginning on page S-1. We separately disclose our share of reserves held in equity-accounted companies (joint ventures and associated companies) although we do not control these entities or the assets held by such entities.

        All of the Group's oil and gas reserves held in consolidated companies have been estimated by the Group's petroleum engineers. Of the oil and gas reserves held in equity-accounted companies, approximately 17% have been estimated by the Group's petroleum engineers. The majority of the rest consists of reserves in TNK-BP which have been estimated by independent engineering consultants. For significant properties where BP has adopted the proved reserve estimates of others, BP's petroleum engineers reviewed such estimates before making their assessment of volumes to be booked by BP.

        Our proved reserves are associated with both concessions (tax and royalty arrangements) and production sharing agreements (PSAs). In a concession, the consortium of which we are a part is entitled to the reserves that can be produced over the licence period, which may be the life of the field. In a PSA, we are entitled to recover volumes that equate to costs incurred to develop and produce the reserves and an agreed share of the remaining volumes or the economic equivalent. As part of our entitlement is driven by the monetary amount of costs to be recovered, price fluctuations will have an impact on both production volumes and reserves. Twenty one per cent of our proved reserves are associated with PSAs. The main countries in which we operate under PSA arrangements are Algeria, Angola, Azerbaijan, Egypt, Indonesia and Vietnam.

25



        The Company's proved reserves estimates for the year ended December 31, 2004 reported in this Form 20-F reflect year-end prices and some adjustments which have been made vis-à-vis individual asset reserve estimates based on different applications of certain SEC interpretations of SEC regulations relating to the use of technology (mainly seismic) to estimate reserves in the reservoir away from wellbores and the reporting of fuel gas (i.e., gas used for fuel in operations on the lease) within proved reserves. The 2004 year-end marker prices used were Brent $40.24/bbl and Henry Hub $6.01/mmbtu. The other 2004 movements in proved reserves, are reflected in the tables showing movements in oil and gas reserves by region in Item 18—Financial Statements—Supplementary Oil and Gas Information on pages S-1 to S-8.

        Total hydrocarbon proved reserves, on an oil equivalent basis and excluding equity-accounted entities, comprised 14,626 mmboe at December 31, 2004, a decrease of 2.5% compared with December 31, 2003. Natural gas represents about 54% of these reserves. This reduction includes net sales of 144 mmboe comprising a number of assets in Egypt, Indonesia and the United States, and dilution of our interest in the reserves of the North West Shelf (NWS) in Australia. The proved reserve replacement ratio was 78% (2003 119%, 2002 175%). The proved reserve replacement ratio (also known as the production replacement ratio) is the extent to which production is replaced by proved reserve additions. This ratio is expressed in oil equivalent terms and includes changes resulting from revisions to previous estimates, improved recovery, extensions, discoveries and other additions, excluding the impact of sales and purchases of reserves-in-place and excluding reserves related to equity-accounted entities. The proved reserve replacement ratio, including sales and purchases of reserves-in-place but excluding equity-accounted entities, was 64% (2003 39%, 2002 190%). The proved reserve replacement ratio for equity-accounted entities alone was 114% (2003 72%, 2002 100%), and the proved reserve replacement ratio for equity-accounted entities alone but including sales and purchases of reserves-in-place was 170% (2003 769%, 2002 270%). By their nature, there is always some risk involved in the ultimate development and production of reserves, including but not limited to final regulatory approval, the installation of new or additional infrastructure as well as changes in oil and gas prices and the continued availability of additional development capital.

        In 2004, total additions to the Group's proved reserves (excluding sales and purchases of reserves-in-place and equity-accounted entities) amounted to 796 mmboe, mostly through extensions to existing fields and discoveries of new fields. Of these reserve additions, approximately 64% are associated with new projects and are proved undeveloped reserve additions and the remainder are in existing developments where they represent a mixture of proved developed and proved undeveloped. Major new development projects typically take one to four years from the time of initial booking to the start of production. The principal reserve additions were in Angola (Rosa), Egypt (Taurt and Saqqara), Indonesia (Tangguh) and Trinidad (Chachalaca) and it is planned to bring these into production over the period 2007 - 2009.

        Total hydrocarbon proved reserves, on an oil equivalent basis for equity-accounted entities alone, comprised 3,672 mmboe at December 31, 2004, an increase of 9.2% compared with December 31, 2003. Natural gas represents about 13% of these reserves. This increase includes purchases of 252 mmboe associated with the TNK-BP acquisition of Slavneft and sales of 4 mmboe.

        Additions to proved developed reserves in 2004 for subsidiaries were 720 mmboe. This included some reserves which were previously classified as proved undeveloped. The proved developed reserve replacement ratio (including both sales and purchases of reserves-in-place) was 70% (2003 -2%, 2002 103%).

        Additions to proved developed reserves in 2004 for equity-accounted entities were 799 mmboe. This included some reserves which were previously classified as proved undeveloped. The proved developed reserve replacement ratio (including both sales and purchases of reserves-in-place) was 180% (2003 642%, 2002 265%).

26



        Our total hydrocarbon production during 2004 averaged 2,795 thousand barrels of oil equivalent per day (mboe/d), for subsidiaries and 1,202 mboe/d, for equity accounted entities, a decrease of 7.2% and an increase of 101.8%, respectively, compared with 2003. For subsidiaries this decrease includes 95 mboe/d impact of divestments and for equity-accounted entities an increase of 108 mboe/d from the TNK-BP share of Slavneft following its inclusion within TNK-BP in January 2004. For subsidiaries, 41% of our production was in the USA, 19% in the UK. For equity-accounted entities, 76% of production is from TNK-BP and the former Sidanco.

        Total production for 2005 is estimated at an average of between 2.85 and 2.9 mmboe/d for subsidiaries and between 1.25 and 1.3 mmboe/d for equity accounted entities; these estimates are before any divestments and are based on our $20/bbl planning basis. The exact level will depend on oil prices, divestments and many other factors.

        The anticipated decline in production volumes from subsidiaries in our existing profit centres is partly mitigated by the development of new projects and the investment in incremental reserves in and around existing fields. We expect that this overall decline in production from subsidiaries in our existing profit centres will be more than compensated for by strong increases in production from subsidiaries in our new profit centres over the next few years. Production in our equity-accounted joint venture, TNK-BP, is also expected to grow over the next few years.

        The most important determinants of cash flows in relation to our oil and natural gas production are the prices of these commodities. In a stable price environment, cash flows from currently developed proved reserves are expected to decline in a manner consistent with anticipated production decline rates. Development activities associated with recent discoveries, as well as continued investment in these producing fields, are expected to more than offset this decline, resulting in increased operating cash flows over the next few years. Cash flows from equity-accounted entities are expected to be in the form of dividend payments.

        The following tables show BP's estimated net proved reserves as at December 31, 2004.

Estimated net proved reserves of liquids at December 31, 2004 (a) (b)

 
  Developed

  Undeveloped

  Total

 
 
  (millions of barrels)

 
UK   559   210   769  
Rest of Europe   231   109   340  
USA   2,041   1,211   3,252  
Rest of Americas   311   299   610 (c)
Asia Pacific   65   85   150  
Africa   204   643   847  
Russia        
Other   62   725   787  
   
 
 
 
    3,473   3,282   6,755  
   
 
 
 
Equity-accounted entities           3,179 (d)
           
 

27


Estimated net proved reserves of natural gas at December 31, 2004 (a) (b)

 
  Developed

  Undeveloped

  Total

 
 
  (billion cubic feet)

 
UK   2,498   1,183   3,681  
Rest of Europe   248   1,254   1,502  
USA   10,811   3,270   14,081  
Rest of Americas   4,101   10,663   14,764 (e)
Asia Pacific   1,624   5,419   7,043  
Africa   1,015   1,886   2,901  
Russia        
Other   282   1,396   1,678  
   
 
 
 
    20,579   25,071   45,650  
   
 
 
 
Equity-accounted entities           2,857 (f)
           
 

Net proved reserves on an oil equivalent basis (mmboe)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
— Group           14,626  
— Equity-accounted entities           3,672  

(a)
Net proved reserves of crude oil and natural gas, stated as of December 31, 2004, exclude production royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, and include minority interests in consolidated operations. We disclose our share of reserves held in joint ventures and associated undertakings that are accounted for by the equity method although we do not control these entities or the assets held by such entities.

(b)
In certain deepwater fields, such as fields in the Gulf of Mexico, BP has claimed proved reserves before production flow tests are conducted in part because of the significant safety, cost and environmental implications of conducting these tests. The industry has made substantial technological improvements in understanding, measuring and delineating reservoir properties without the need for flow tests. The general method of reserves assessment to determine reasonable certainty of commercial recovery which BP employs relies on the integration of three types of data: (1) well data used to assess the local characteristics and conditions of reservoirs and fluids; (2) field scale seismic data to allow the interpolation and extrapolation of these characteristics outside the immediate area of the local well control; and (3) data from relevant analog fields. Well data includes appraisal wells or sidetrack holes, full logging suites, core data and fluid samples. BP considers the integration of this data in certain cases to be superior to a flow test in providing a better understanding of the overall reservoir performance. The collection of data from logs, cores, wireline formation testers, pressures and fluid samples calibrated to each other and to the seismic data can allow reservoir properties to be determined over a greater volume than the localized volume of investigation associated with a short term flow test.
(c)
Includes 40 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 30% minority interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.

(d)
Includes 127 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 5.9% minority interest in TNK-BP.

(e)
Includes 4,064 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 30% minority interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.

(f)
Includes 13 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 5.9% minority interest in TNK-BP.

28


        The following tables show BP's production by major field for 2004, 2003 and 2002.

Liquids

 
   
   
  Net production

Production

  Field or Area

  Interest

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
   
  (%)

  (thousand barrels per day)

Alaska   Prudhoe Bay*   26.4   97   105   113
    Kuparuk   39.2   68   73   74
    Northstar*   98.6   49   46   36
    Milne Point*   100.0   44   44   44
    Other   Various   37   43   42
           
 
 
Total Alaska           295   311   309
           
 
 
Lower 48 onshore (a)   Total   Various   142   160   192
           
 
 
Gulf of Mexico (a)   Horn Mountain*   66.6   41   42   1
    Mars   28.5   35   43   41
    Ursa   22.7   29   17   20
    Na Kika*   50.0   27    
    King*   100.0   26   31   12
    Other   Various   71   122   190
           
 
 
Total Gulf of Mexico           229   255   264
           
 
 
Total USA           666   726   765
           
 
 

UK offshore (a)

 

ETAP†

 

Various

 

55

 

56

 

61
    Foinaven*   Various   48   55   72
    Schiehallion/Loyal*   Various   39   42   43
    Magnus*   85.0   34   39   31
    Harding*   70.0   27   34   42
    Andrew*   62.8   12   17   23
    Other   Various   89   105   157
           
 
 
Total UK offshore           304   348   429
Onshore   Wytch Farm*   67.8   26   29   32
           
 
 
Total UK           330   377   461
           
 
 

Netherlands

 

Various

 

Various

 

1

 

1

 

1
Norway (a)   Draugen   18.4   27   25   37
    Valhall*   28.1   25   21   21
    Ula*   80.0   16   16   18
    Other   Various   8   21   27
           
 
 
Total Rest of Europe           77   84   104
           
 
 

*
BP operated.

BP operates the majority of the fields in this area.

29


 
 
 
   
  Net production

Production

Field or Area

  Interest

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
 
  (%)

  (thousand barrels per day)

Angola Girassol   16.7   31   33   29
    Xikomba   26.7   18   2  
    Kizomba A   26.7   16    
    Other   Various   6    
Australia Various   15.8   36   40   43
Azerbaijan Azeri-Chirag-Gunashli*   34.1   39   38   38
Canada Various   Various   11   13   16
Colombia Various   Various   48   53   46
Egypt Various   Various   57   73   85
Trinidad Various   100.0   59   74   67
Venezuela (a) Various   Various   55   53   51
Other (a) Various   Various   31   49   61
           
 
 
Total Rest of World         407   428   436
           
 
 
Total Group         1,480   1,615   1,766
           
 
 
Equity-accounted entities                  
Abu Dhabi (b) Various   Various   142   138   113
Argentina  - Pan American Energy Various   Various   64   60   53
Russia  - TNK-BP (a) Various   Various   831   296   73
Other Various   Various   14   12   13
           
 
 
Total equity-accounted entities         1,051   506   252
           
 
 

*
BP operated.

30


Natural gas

 
   
   
  Net production

Production

  Field or Area

  Interest

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
   
  (%)

  (million cubic feet per day)

Lower 48 States onshore (a)   San Juan*   Various   772   802   797
    Arkoma   Various   183   201   206
    Hugoton*   Various   158   182   169
    Jonah*   65.0   114   119   113
    Wamsutter*   70.5   105   111   108
    Tuscaloosa   Various   96   136   138
    Other   Various   514   558   715
           
 
 
Total Lower 48 onshore           1,942   2,109   2,246
           
 
 
Gulf of Mexico (a)   Na Kika*   50.0   133    
    Marlin*   78.2   43   93   106
    King's Peak*   55.0   39   91   16
    Other   Various   514   752   1,063
           
 
 
Total Gulf of Mexico           729   936   1,185
           
 
 
Alaska   Various   Various   78   83   52
           
 
 
Total USA           2,749   3,128   3,483
           
 
 

UK offshore (a)

 

Bruce*

 

37.0

 

163

 

222

 

221
    Braes   Various   147 174   116
    Shearwater   27.5   76   70   66
    Marnock*   62.0   70   98   135
    West Sole*   100.0   67   73   72
    Britannia   9.0   54   55   56
    Armada   18.2   50   58   71
    Other   Various   547   696   813
           
 
 
Total UK           1,174   1,446   1,550
           
 
 

Netherlands

 

P/18-2*

 

48.7

 

34

 

30

 

41
    Other   Various   46   37   46
Norway (a)   Various   Various   45   52   60
           
 
 
Total Rest of Europe           125   119   147
           
 
 

*
BP operated.

2004 includes 7 million cubic feet a day of natural gas received as in-kind tariff payments.

31


 
 
 
   
  Net production

Production

Field or Area

  Interest

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
 
  (%)

  (million cubic feet per day)

Australia Various   15.8   308   285   295
Canada Various   Various   349   422   514
China Yacheng   34.3   99   74   102
Egypt Ha'py*   50.0   80   83   74
    Others   Various   115   170   182
Indonesia Sanga-Sanga (direct)*   26.3   137   165   174
    Pagerungan*   100.0   68   121   189
    Other*   46.0   76   97   94
Sharjah Sajaa*   40.0   103   101   110
    Other   40.0   14   19   24
Trinidad Kapok*   100.0   553   79  
    Mahogany*   100.0   453   503   521
    Amherstia*   100.0   408   624   492
    Immortelle*   100.0   172   235   154
    Parang*   100.0   137   152  
    Cassia*   100.0   85   30  
    Flamboyant*   100.0   67   68   40
    Other*   100.0   44   3   31
Other (a) Various   Various   308   168   148
           
 
 
Total Rest of World         3,576   3,399   3,144
           
 
 
Total Group (c)(d)         7,624   8,092   8,324
           
 
 
Equity-accounted entities                  
Argentina  - Pan American Energy Various   Various   317   281   251
Russia  - TNK-BP (a) Various   Various   458   129   6
Other Various   Various   104   111   126
           
 
 
Total equity-accounted entities (d)       879   521   383
           
 
 

*
BP operated

(a)
In 2004, BP agreed with AAR to incorporate their 50% interest in Slavneft into TNK-BP, an equity-accounted entity. BP also acquired minor additional working interests in Canada and the United States. BP diluted its working interests in King's Peak and divested the Swordfish assets in the deepwater Gulf of Mexico. Additionally, BP sold various properties including its interest in the South Pass 60 in the Gulf of Mexico Shelf, various assets in Alberta in Canada, and the Kangean Production Sharing Contract (PSC) in Indonesia. In 2003, BP and AAR merged certain of their Russian and Ukranian oil and gas businesses to create TNK-BP. BP also acquired the interests of Amerada Hess in Colombia and disposed of its interests in Forties, Montrose/Arbroath and Bacton Area assets in the UK North Sea, Gyda in Norway, LL652 in Venezuela, QHD and Liuhua in China, the Malaysia Thailand Joint Development Area, Aspen in the Gulf of Mexico, various shallow water fields in the Gulf of Mexico and various fields in the US Lower 48 states. In 2002, BP acquired additional working interest in the Badin acreage (Pakistan) from the government and disposed of its interest in the Al Rayyan field (Qatar), Qadirpur field (Pakistan) and Elgin/Franklin field (UK).

(b)
The BP Group holds proportionate interests, through associated undertakings, in onshore and offshore concessions in Abu Dhabi expiring in 2014 and 2018, respectively.

(c)
Includes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of 67 mb/d, 70 mb/d, and 69 mb/d for 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively. The related reserves are excluded from the Group's reserves.

(d)
Natural gas production volumes exclude gas consumed in operations within the lease boundaries of the producing field, but the related reserves are included in the Group's reserves.

32


United States

        2004 liquids production at 666 thousand barrels per day (mb/d) decreased 8% from 2003, while natural gas production at 2,749 million cubic feet per day (mmcf/d) decreased 12% compared with 2003.

        On September 15, 2004, Hurricane Ivan passed directly over the eastern portion of the Gulf of Mexico requiring the shut-in of all BP's floating facilities in the area. These conditions resulted in damage to operated and non-operated assets in both our upstream and midstream activitites. Repairs have been completed.

        Crude oil production decreased 60 mb/d, with production from new projects being offset by the impact of Hurricane Ivan and natural reservoir decline. The decline in the NGLs component of liquids production (12 mb/d) was primarily caused by divestments. Gas production was lower (379 mmcf/d) because of Hurricane Ivan, divestments, natural reservoir decline and investment choices.

        Development expenditure in the USA (excluding midstream) during 2004 was $3,248 million, compared with $3,474 million in 2003 and $3,607 million in 2002. This reflects our continued focus on investing in the best opportunities and optimizing operating efficiency.

        Our activities within the United States take place in four main areas. Significant events during 2004 within each of these are indicated below.

Deepwater Gulf of Mexico

        Deepwater Gulf of Mexico is one of our new profit centres and our largest area of growth in the United States. In 2004, our deepwater Gulf of Mexico crude oil production was 182.3 mb/d and gas production was 489 mmcf/d. On November 28, the profit centre achieved a record production rate of 360 mboe/d.

        Significant events included:

        Development of two major projects continued in the Gulf of Mexico during 2004 — Thunder Horse (BP 75% and operator) is scheduled to commence production in 2005 with Atlantis (BP 56% and operator) following in 2006. Along with Holstein and Mad Dog, these projects will be the major contributor to the anticipated growth in production over the next several years.

        In 2004, BP divested its interest in the Swordfish Development and completed the sale of approximately one half of its interest in the Troika asset.

Gulf of Mexico Shelf

        The Shelf is a mature basin, with decline rates that average 40-50% per year. In accordance with our strategy, in the third quarter of 2004, we continued to increase the quality of our portfolio by completing the disposal of the Vermilion 14, Eugene Island 240, Main Pass 264 and South Pass 60 properties. These fields accounted for approximately 42 mmcf/d. Our gas production from Gulf of Mexico Shelf operations was 240 mmcf/d in 2004, down 36% compared to 2003. Liquids production was

33



24 mb/d, down 38% compared to 2003. The year-on-year drop in production was the result of the divestment programme, normal decline, the effects of Hurricane Ivan and reduced capital spending.

Lower 48 States

        In the Lower 48 States (Onshore), our 2004 natural gas production was 1,942 mmcf/d, which was down 8% compared to 2003. Liquids production was 142 mb/d, down 11% compared to 2003. The year-on-year decrease in production is attributed to normal decline. In 2004, we drilled approximately 400 wells as operator and continued to maintain a level programme of drilling activity throughout the year.

        Production is derived primarily from two main areas:

        Significant events included:

Alaska

        In Alaska, BP net crude oil production in 2004 was 295 mb/d, a decrease of 5% from 2003, due principally to mature field decline partially offset by increases in Northstar production and development of satellite fields around Prudhoe Bay and Kuparuk.

        Key activities in Alaska:

34


United Kingdom

        We are the largest producer of oil and second largest producer of gas in the UK. BP remains the largest overall producer in the UK of hydrocarbons. In 2004, total liquids production was 330 mb/d, a 12% decrease on 2003, and gas production was 1,174 mmscf/d, a 19% decrease on 2003. This decrease in production was driven by the full year's impact of the assets divested in 2003, namely Forties, Montrose/Arbroath and Bacton Area assets, representing 35% of the decrease, along with the natural decline of the mature North Sea basin (65% of the decrease). Our activities in the North Sea are focused on operations efficiency, in-field drilling and selected new field developments. Our development expenditure in the UK was $679 million in 2004 compared to $740 million in 2003 and $895 million in 2002.

        Significant activities included the following:

Rest of Europe

        Development expenditure, excluding midstream, in the Rest of Europe was $262 million compared with $236 million in 2003 and $219 million in 2002.

Norway

        In 2004, total Norway production was 84 mboe/d, a 9% decrease on 2003. This decrease in production was driven by the divestment of the Gyda asset to Talisman, natural decline and shutdown of the Tambar field for just over three months owing to operational problems. The decrease was partly offset by high operational efficiency on the BP operated Ula and Valhall fields, and new wells coming on stream on the two Valhall Flank platforms. The Tambar field was returned to production during the year.

35


        Significant activities included the following:

Rest of World

        Development expenditure, excluding midstream, in Rest of World was $3,082 million in 2004 compared with $3,085 million in 2003 and $2,503 million in 2002.

Rest of Americas

        Canada

        Trinidad

        Venezuela

36


        Colombia

        Argentina and Bolivia

Africa

        Algeria

37


        Angola

        BP has interests in four deepwater licence blocks, including two of which it is operator. We have built a strong foundation for long-term growth in Angola through both exploration and development.

        Activities in 2004 included the following:

        Egypt

38


Asia Pacific

        Indonesia

        Vietnam

        China

        Australia

Russia

        TNK-BP

39


        TNK-BP Group Restructuring

Other

        Middle East and Pakistan

        Azerbaijan


Midstream Activities

Oil and Natural Gas Transportation

        The Group has direct or indirect interests in certain crude oil transportation systems, the principal ones of which are the Trans Alaska Pipeline System (TAPS) in the USA and the Forties Pipelines System (FPS) in the UK sector of the North Sea. We also operate the Central Area Transmission System (CATS) for natural gas in the UK sector of the North Sea.

        BP, as operator, manages and holds a 30.1% interest in the Baku-Tbilisi-Ceyhan (BTC) oil pipeline inaugurated in May 2005. BP, as operator of AIOC, also operates the Western Export Route Pipeline between Azerbaijan and the Black Sea coast of Georgia and the Azeri leg of the Northern Export Route Pipeline between Azerbaijan and Russia.

40



        Our onshore US crude oil and product pipelines and related transportation assets are included under "Refining and Marketing" in this item. Revenue is earned on pipelines through charging tariffs. Our gas marketing business is described under "Gas, Power and Renewables" in this item.

        Activity in oil and natural gas transportation during 2004 included:

Alaska

North Sea

41


Asia (including the former Soviet Union)

Gulf of Mexico


Liquefied Natural Gas

        Within BP, Exploration and Production is responsible for the supply of LNG and the Gas, Power and Renewables business is responsible for the subsequent marketing and distribution of LNG (see details under Gas, Power and Renewables — New Market Development and LNG in this Item on page 67). BP Exploration and Production has interests in four major LNG plants. The Atlantic LNG plant in Trinidad (BP 34% in Train 1, 42% in Trains 2 and 3, and 37.8% in Train 4); in Indonesia through our interests in Sanga-Sanga PSA, (BP 38%), which supplies natural gas to the Bontang LNG plant, and Tangguh (PSA, BP 37%), which is under construction; and in Australia through our share of LNG from the North West Shelf natural gas development (BP 16.7%).

42



        Significant activity during 2004 included the following:

43



REFINING AND MARKETING

        Our Refining and Marketing business is responsible for the supply and trading, refining, marketing and transportation of crude oil and petroleum products to wholesale and retail customers. BP markets its products in over 100 countries. We operate primarily in Europe and North America, but also market our products across Australasia and in parts of Southeast Asia, Africa and Central and South America.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Turnover (a)   179,587   149,477   125,836
Total operating profit   6,084   2,483   1,969
Total assets   66,289   58,602   54,505
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   3,014   3,080   7,753

 

 

($ per barrel)

Global Indicator Refining Margin (b)

 

6.08

 

3.88

 

2.11

(a)
Excludes BP's share of joint venture turnover of $594 million in 2004, $453 million in 2003, and $415 million in 2002.

(b)
The Global Indicator Refining Margin is the average of six regional industry indicator margins which we weight for BP's crude refining capacity in each region. Each regional indicator margin is based on a single representative crude with product yields characteristic of the typical level of upgrading complexity. The refining margins are industry specific rather than BP specific measures, which we believe are useful to investors in analysing trends in the industry and their impact on our results. The margins are calculated by BP based on published crude oil and product prices and take account of fuel utilization and catalyst costs. No account is taken of BP's other cash and non-cash costs of refining, such as wages and salaries and plant depreciation. The indicator margin may not be representative of the margins achieved by BP in any period because of BP's particular refining configurations and crude and product slate.

        There are four areas of business in Refining and Marketing: Refining, Retail, Lubricants and Business to Business Marketing. Our strategy is to continue our focused investment in key assets and market positions. In all areas, we aim for greater operational efficiency, and at the same time we seek to improve our asset portfolio. The acquisition of Veba's marketing and refining operations in 2002 provided an important addition to our operations, particularly in Germany.

        Refining and Marketing manages a portfolio of assets that we believe are competitively advantaged across the chain of downstream activities. Such advantage may derive from several factors, including location, operating cost and physical asset quality.

        We are one of the major refiners of gasoline and hydrocarbon products in the USA, Europe and Australia. We have significant retail and business to business market positions in the USA, UK, Germany and the rest of Europe, Australasia, Africa and Southeast Asia and we are enhancing our presence in China and Mexico.

        During the course of 2004, BP disposed of its one-third share of the Singapore Refining Company Private Limited, with one sixth being sold to each of Caltex Singapore Private Limited and Singapore Petroleum Company Limited. The sale was completed in June. The refinery had total crude distillation capacity of 248,000 barrels per day. BP also terminated refining operations at the ATAS Refinery in Mersin, south eastern Turkey. The site had a crude distillation capacity of 100,000 barrels per day and will continue to operate as a fuels terminal.

44



        BP announced the sale of its 70% share in its Malaysia fuels business to 30% shareholder Lembaga Tabung Angkatan Tentera (LTAT). The business comprises 240 service stations, a modern fuel terminal and two joint-venture automated LPG bottling plants with turnover of $500 million and employs 250 staff. The transaction is expected to complete in the third quarter of 2005.

        In July 2004 BP announced conditional agreement had been reached with Singapore Petroleum Company Limited (SPC) for sale of BP's retail and LPG business in Singapore. The retail business comprises 30 stations and associated business administration and the LPG business comprises BP's 70% shareholding in BP Wearnes Gas Ltd. The transaction was completed in the third quarter of 2004.

        During 2003, divestments mandated in connection with the Veba transaction as a condition of regulatory approval of the deal were completed with the sale of a 45% stake in Bayernoil refinery, an 18% stake in the Trans Alpine Pipeline (TAL), 741 retail stations in Germany, 55 stations in Hungary and 11 in Slovakia in separate packages to PKN Orlen and OMV AG, for a total of $580 million in cash and assumption of debt.

        Capital expenditure and acquisitions in 2004 was $3,014 million compared with $3,080 million in 2003 and $7,753 million in 2002 (including $5,038 million for the Veba acquisition). Excluding acquisitions, capital expenditure was $2,831 million in 2004 compared with $3,006 million in 2003 and $2,682 million in 2002. Capital expenditure excluding acquisitions is expected to be around $3.2 billion in 2005.

Resegmentation in 2005

        Since the end of 2004, BP has made a number of organizational changes. With effect from January 1, 2005:

Texas City Refinery

        On March 23, 2005, an explosion and fire occurred in the Isomerization Unit of the BP Texas City refinery as the unit was coming out of planned maintenance. Fifteen contractors involved in maintenance work died in the incident. Other contractors and employees were injured, some very seriously. The US Occupational Safety and Health Administration, the US Chemical Safety and Hazard Investigation Board and the Texas Commission on Environmental Quality, among others, are conducting investigations. BP has finalized or is in process of negotiating settlements in respect of fatalities and personal injury claims arising from the incident. BP currently expects that the total amount of these settlements will not be material to the Group's results of operations or financial position for the year 2005. However, such amount may be material to the Group's results of operations for a particular quarter.

Refining

        The Company's global refining strategy is to own interests in and to operate advantaged refineries that provide distinctive returns through vertical integration with our marketing and trading operations and horizontal integration with other parts of the Group's business. Refining's focus is to maintain and improve competitive position through sustainable, safe, reliable and efficient operations of the refining system and disciplined investment for growth.

45



        For BP, the strategic advantage of a refinery relates to the refinery's location, the refinery's scale and its configuration to produce fuels in line with the demand of the region from low-cost feedstocks. Efficient operations are measured primarily using regional refining surveys conducted by third parties. The surveys assess our competitive position against benchmarked industry measures for margin, energy efficiency and costs per barrel. Investments in our refineries are focused on maintaining our competitive position and developing the capability to produce the cleaner fuels that meet our customers' and the communities' requirements.

        The following table summarizes the BP Group interests and crude distillation capacities at December 31, 2004:

 
   
   
  Crude distillation
capacities (a)

 
   
   
  (mb/d)

 
  Refinery

  Group interest (b)
%

  Total

  BP
Share

UK   Coryton*   100.00   172   172
    Grangemouth*   100.00   207   207
           
 
Total UK           379   379
           
 
Rest of Europe                
France   Lavéra*   100.00   218   218
    Reichstett   17.00   84   14
Germany   Bayernoil   22.50   269   61
    Gelsenkirchen*   50.00   272   136
    Karlsruhe   12.00   308   37
    Lingen*   100.00   87   87
    Schwedt   18.75   221   41
Netherlands   Nerefco*   69.00   400   276
Spain   Castellón*   100.00   110   110
           
 
Total Rest of Europe           1,969   980
           
 
USA                
California   Carson*   100.00   260   260
Washington   Cherry Point*   100.00   232   232
Indiana   Whiting*   100.00   405   405
Ohio   Toledo*   100.00   155   155
Texas   Texas City*   100.00   470   470
           
 
Total USA           1,522   1,522
           
 
Rest of World                
Australia   Bulwer*   100.00   97   97
    Kwinana*   100.00   137   137
New Zealand   Whangerei   23.66   109   26
Kenya   Mombasa   17.00   91   16
South Africa   Durban   50.00   182   91
           
 
Total Rest of World           616   367
           
 
Total           4,486   3,248
           
 

*
Indicates refineries operated by BP.

(a)
Crude distillation capacity is gross rated capacity which is defined as the maximum achievable utilization of capacity (24-hour assessment) based on standard feed.

(b)
BP share of equity, which is not necessarily the same as BP share of processing entitlements.

46


        The following table outlines by region the volume of crude oil and feedstock processed by BP for its own account and for third parties and for the Group by other refiners under processing agreements. Corresponding BP refinery capacity utilization data are summarized.

 
  Years ended December 31,

Refinery throughputs (a)

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (thousand barrels per day)

UK   407   397   389
Rest of Europe   854   932   918
USA   1,373   1,386   1,439
Rest of World   342   382   357
   
 
 
    2,976   3,097   3,103
For BP by others       14
   
 
 
Total   2,976   3,097   3,117
   
 
 
Refinery capacity utilization            
Crude distillation capacity at December 31, (b)   3,248   3,408   3,534
Crude distillation capacity utilization (c)   92%   91%   91%
  United States   95%   91%   93%
  Europe   90%   90%   91%
  Rest of World   87%   94%   85%

(a)
Refinery throughput reflects crude and other feedstock volumes.

(b)
Crude gross rated capacity is defined as the maximum achievable utilization of capacity (24 hour assessment) based on standard feed.

(c)
Crude distillation capacity utilization is defined as the percentage utilization of capacity per calendar day over the year after making allowances for average annual shutdowns at BP refineries (i.e. net rated capacity).

        BP's 2004 refinery throughput decreased in the Rest of Europe compared with 2003 primarily due to the closure of operations at Mersin and the Bayernoil refinery divestment mandated in connection with the Veba acquisition. The decrease in Rest of World is primarily due to the disposal of BP's interests in Singapore Refining Company Private Limited (SRC). The decrease in the USA in 2004 was largely due to the impact of a fire at Texas City. BP's 2003 refinery throughput increased in the Rest of Europe compared with 2002, primarily due to higher margins. In 2002 lower margins required that many of the refineries reduce throughput. The decrease in the USA in 2003 was due to the sale of the Yorktown, Virginia refinery in May 2002, reducing capacity by 23 mb/d, and the balance was due to major turnaround activities in 2003 compared with 2002.

47



Marketing

        Marketing comprises three business areas: Retail, Lubricants and Business to Business Marketing. We market a comprehensive range of refined oil products worldwide. These products include gasoline, gasoil, marine and aviation fuels, heating fuels, LPG, lubricants and bitumen.

 
  Years ended December 31,

Sales of refined products (a)

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (thousand barrels per day)

Marketing sales:            
  UK (b)   322   275   253
  Rest of Europe   1,360   1,308   1,467
  USA   1,682   1,766   1,874
  Rest of World   638   620   586
   
 
 
Total marketing sales (c)   4,002   3,969   4,180
Trading/supply sales (d)   2,396   2,719   2,383
   
 
 
Total refined products   6,398   6,688   6,563
   
 
 

 

 

($ million)
Proceeds from sale of refined products   124,458   102,003   87,520

(a)
Excludes sales to other BP businesses.

(b)
UK area includes the UK-based international activities of Refining and Marketing.

(c)
Marketing sales are sales to service stations, end-consumers, bulk buyers, jobbers, i.e. third parties who own networks of a number of service stations and small resellers.

(d)
Trading/supply sales are to large unbranded resellers and other oil companies.

        The following table sets out marketing sales by major product group:

 
  Years ended December 31,

Marketing sales by product

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (thousand barrels per day)

Aviation fuel   494   530   529
Gasolines   1,675   1,714   1,744
Middle distillates   1,255   1,203   1,232
Fuel oil   343   296   451
Other products   235   226   224
   
 
 
Total marketing sales   4,002   3,969   4,180
   
 
 

        In marketing, our aim is to increase total margin by focusing on both volumes and margin per unit. We do this by growing our customer base, both in existing and new markets, by attracting new customers and by covering a wider geographic area. We also work to improve the efficiency of our operations through reducing the cost of goods sold and improving our product mix. In addition, we recognize that our customers are demanding a wider choice of fuels, particularly fuels that are cleaner and more efficient. Through our integrated refining and marketing operations, we believe we are better able to meet these customer demands.

        During the course of the year we have been successful in maintaining overall volumes despite rising oil and product prices and continuing competitive pressures.

        BP's marketing sales volumes in 2004 were similar to those in 2003.

48


Retail

        Our retail strategy is to focus our capital into the best locations in high growth metropolitan markets where we can be number one or two in market share, whilst continuing to upgrade our offers and drive for operational efficiencies.

        There are two components of our retail offer: convenience and fuels. The convenience offer comprises sales of convenience items to customers from advantaged locations in metropolitan areas; whereas our fuel offer is deployed at service station locations in all our markets, in many cases without the convenience offer. We execute our convenience offer through a quality store format in each of our key markets, whether it is the BP Connect offer in Europe and the Eastern USA, the am/pm offer west of the Rocky Mountains in the USA, or the Aral offer in Germany. Each of these brands carries a very strong offer in itself, but we also aim to share best practices between them. Since 2003, we have also upgraded our fuel offer with the introduction of Ultimate gasoline and diesel products, which have greater efficiency and power and lesser environmental impacts. In 2004, we continued our roll-out of new generation Ultimate gasoline and diesel fuels, now available in the UK, Germany, Austria, Spain, Portugal, Greece, France, Poland, Australia and the US.

        We also aim to focus on operational efficiencies through targeted programmes for performance improvement. These have allowed us to increase our fuel throughput per site and increase our store sales per square metre. We aim to increase site performance through fuel marketing and retailing efficiencies.

        In 2004, across the network, our large format stores achieved store sales growth slightly above the market average. Total store sales, reflecting investment in new selling space, grew by 6%.

 
  Years ended December 31,

Store sales (a)

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

UK   655   567   527
Rest of Europe   3,090   3,000   2,638
USA   1,715   1,620   1,585
Rest of World   601   521   421
   
 
 
Total   6,061   5,708   5,171
   
 
 

Direct — managed

 

2,319

 

2,090

 

1,869
Franchise   3,623   3,508   3,216
Store alliances   119   110   86
   
 
 
Total   6,061   5,708   5,171
   
 
 

(a)
Store sales reported are sales through direct-managed stations, franchises and the BP share of store alliances and joint ventures. Sales figures exclude sales taxes and lottery sales but include quick service restaurant sales. Fuel sales are not included in these figures.

        Our retail network is largely concentrated in Europe and the USA, with established operations in Australasia, Southeast Asia and Southern & Eastern Africa. We are developing networks in China and Mexico.

        BP's worldwide network consists of nearly 27,000 stations branded BP, Amoco, ARCO and Aral. We expect the total number of service stations carrying our brands to decline further in future years, reflecting the continued optimization of our retail network and efforts to increase the consistency of our site offer. We also continue to improve the efficiency of our retail asset network through a process

49



of regular review. In July 2004, following a strategic review, we announced the divestment of our retail network in Singapore. This transaction was completed in the third quarter. In addition during 2004, further portfolio upgrading was achieved through the divestment of around a further 660 sites primarily due to underperformance.

        In 2004, we continued the rollout of the BP Connect offer at sites in the UK and USA continuing our retail strategy that builds on our advantaged locations, strong market positions and brand. These are service stations with large convenience stores that provide our customers cleaner fuels, a wider range of services and a distinctive food offer. The new BP Connect sites include service stations that are new, those that have been rebuilt, and those where extensive upgrading and remodeling has taken place. At December 31, 2004, nearly 600 BP Connect stations were open. In addition, the number of stores with the new BP Helios design increased by about 3,100 during 2004 to a total of around 19,800.

        At December 31, 2004, BP's retail network in the USA comprised approximately 14,200 service stations, of which approximately 10,300 were owned by jobbers. Through regular review and execution of business opportunities we are continuing to concentrate our ownership of real estate in markets designated for development of the convenience offer. In the USA, we increased the number of stations with the new BP Helios design by approximately 2,300 in 2004.

        In the UK and the Rest of Europe, BP's network comprised about 9,300 service stations at December 31, 2004. During the year we opened 60 BP Connect sites in Europe with the majority being in metropolitan areas of the UK. The number of stations throughout Europe that use the new BP Helios design was about 6,400 by the end of 2004.

        At December 31, 2004, BP's retail network in the rest of the world comprised some 3,300 service stations. Our established networks are primarily in Australia, New Zealand, Southern Africa and Southeast Asia. During 2004, BP China and Sinopec announced the establishment of the BP-Sinopec (Zhejiang) Petroleum Co. Ltd., a retail joint venture between BP and Sinopec. Based on the existing service station network of Sinopec, the new joint venture has plans to build, operate and manage a network of 500 service stations in Hangzhiou, Ningbo and Shaoxing. Also during the year, BP China and PetroChina announced the establishment of BP-PetroChina Petroleum Company Limited. Located in Guangdong, one of the most developed provinces in China, the joint venture is intended to acquire, build, operate and manage 500 service stations in the province. The initial investment in both joint ventures amounted to $106 million.

Lubricants

        We manufacture and market lubricant products and also supply related products and services to business customers and end-consumers in over 60 countries directly, and to the rest of the world through local distributors. Our business is concentrated on the higher margin sectors of automotive lubricants, especially in the consumer sector, but also has a strong presence in business markets such as commercial vehicle fleets, aviation, marine and specialized industrial segments.

        We aim to achieve growth by further focusing our resources and capabilities on selected market sectors. Customer focus, distinctive brands and superior technology remain the cornerstone of our long-term strategy.

        BP markets through its two major brands, Castrol and BP, and several secondary brands including Duckhams and Veedol. The Veba acquisition in 2002 strengthened our lubricants position in Germany and in Central Europe with the addition of the Aral brand to the BP Lubricants portfolio.

        In the consumer sector of the automotive segment we supply lubricants, other products and related business services to intermediate customers (e.g., retailers, workshops) who in turn serve end-consumers (e.g., car, motorcycle, leisure craft owners) in the mature markets of Western Europe and North America and also in the fast growing markets of the developing world (e.g., Russia, China,

50



India, Middle East, South America and Africa). The Castrol brand is recognized worldwide and we believe it provides us with a significant competitive advantage.

        In commercial vehicle and general industrial markets we supply lubricants and lubricant-related services to the transportation industry and to automotive manufacturers.

Business to Business Marketing

        Business to Business Marketing encompasses marketing a comprehensive range of products to other businesses. This business aims to build relationships with customers that not only purchase a wide variety of products in large quantities but also additional services. Interfaces with Retail, Refining and Logistics play a crucial role in this business. We aim to attract more customers through innovation in multi-product offers and cleaner fuels, packaged with a range of value-added services and solutions.

        Air BP is one of the world's largest aviation businesses supplying aviation fuel and lubricants to the airline, military and general aviation sectors. It supplies customers in approximately 100 countries, has annual sales of around 24 million tonnes (approximately 500,000 bbl/day) and has key relationships with most of the major commercial airlines. Our strategic aim is to strengthen our position in our existing markets (Europe/US/Asia Pacific) whilst creating opportunities in the emerging economies such as South America, China, Russia and Ukraine.

        The LPG businesses sell bulk, bottled, automotive and wholesale products to a wide range of customers in over 19 countries. During the past few years, our LPG business has strengthened its position in established markets, pursued opportunities in new and emerging markets and rationalized its operations. During 2004, BP remained the leading importer of LPG into the China market, where we continued to grow our business. LPG Product sales in 2004 were nearly 3.4 million tonnes (approximately 100,000 bbl/day).

        Marine comprises three global businesses: Marine Fuels, Marine Lubricants, and Power Generation and Offshore, which supplies specialist lubricants to the power generation and offshore industry. Under the BP and Castrol brands, the business is the lubricants market leader and has a strong trading and bunker presence in the fuels market. The business has offices in 40 countries and operates in over 800 ports.

        The Wholesale and Reseller business has activities in 11 European countries, has annual sales of 27.5 million tonnes (approximately 530,000 bbl/day) and employs nearly 250 people. The business markets fuels and heating oil, mostly as pick-up business at refineries, terminals and depots.

        Our Business to Business Marketing activities also include Industrial Lubricants (selling industrial lubricants and services to manufacturing companies in approximately 40 countries), European Fleet Services (serving commercial road transport customers in 12 countries), and the supply of bitumen to the road and roofing industries. The business seeks to increase value by building from the technology, marketing and sales capabilities of a business to business operation.

Supply and Trading

        The Group has a long established supply and trading activity responsible for delivering value across the overall crude and oil products supply chain. This activity identifies the best markets and prices for our crude oil, sources optimal feedstock to our refining assets and sources marketing activities with flexible and competitive supply. Additionally, the function creates incremental trading gains through holding commodity derivative contracts and trading inventory. To achieve these objectives in a liquid and volatile international market the Group enters into a range of commodity derivative contracts including exchange traded futures and options, over-the-counter options, swaps and forward contracts as well as physical term and spot contracts.

51



        Exchange traded contracts are traded on liquid regulated markets which transact in key crude grades, such as Brent and West Texas Intermediate and the main product grades such as gasoline and gasoil. These exchanges exist in each of the key markets in the US, Western Europe and Far East. Over-the-counter contracts include a variety of options and most importantly swaps. These swaps price in relation to a wider set of grades than those traded through the exchanges where counterparties contract for differences between, for example, fixed and floating prices. The contracts we use are described in more detail below. Additionally, physical crude can be traded forward by using specific over-the-counter contracts pricing in reference to Brent and West Texas Intermediate grade. Over-the-counter crude forward sales contracts are used by BP to both buy and sell the underlying physical commodity as well as a risk management and trading instrument. The scale and application of these over-the-counter forward contracts, when measured by volume, has not changed significantly over the period 2002 to 2004. The volumes of crude oil sold through over-the-counter forward sales contracts was 1,276 mb/d in 2002, 1,284 mb/d in 2003 and 1,303 mb/d in 2004. The turnover associated with these contracts increased as a function of the increasing price of crude oil over the period.

        Risk management is undertaken when the Group is exposed to market risk primarily due to the timing of sales and purchases, which may occur for both commercial and operational reasons. For example, if the Group has delayed a purchase and has a lower than normal inventory level, the associated price exposure may be limited by taking an offsetting position in the most suitable commodity derivative contract described above. Where trading is undertaken, the Group actively combines a range of derivative contracts and physical positions to create incremental trading gains by arbitraging prices, typically between locations and time periods. This range of contract types includes futures, swaps, options and forward sale and purchase contracts, these contracts are described further below. The nature and purpose of this activity is broadly unchanged, though the volume of activity has grown slightly over the period 2002 to 2004.

        Through these transactions the Group sells crude production into the market allowing more suitable higher margin crude to be supplied to our refineries. The Group may also actively buy and sell crude on a spot and term basis to further improve selections of crude for refineries. In addition, where refinery production is surplus to marketing requirements or can be sourced more competitively, it is sold into the market. This latter activity also encompasses opportunities to maximise the value of the whole supply chain through the optimisation of storage and pipeline assets including the purchase of product components that are blended into finished products. The Group also owns and contracts for storage and transport capacity to facilitate this activity.

        The range of transactions that the Group enters into is described below in more detail:

(a)
Exchange traded commodity derivatives
(b)
Over-the-counter (OTC) contracts, excluding forward contracts

52


(c)
Over-the-counter forward contracts
(d)
Spot and term contracts

        The following table describes how these types of transactions contributed to turnover over the period 2002 to 2004:

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
   
  2004

  2003

  2002

Sale of crude oil through spot and term contracts   ($ million)   25,027   23,915   18,150
Sale of crude oil, through over-the-counter forward contracts   ($ million)   18,485   14,098   11,599
Marketing, spot and term sales of refined products   ($ million)   124,458   102,003   87,520
Other sales including non-oil and to other segments   ($ million)   11,617   9,461   8,567
       
 
 
        179,587   149,477   125,836
       
 
 
Sale of crude oil through spot and term contracts   (mb/d)   2,505   2,553   2,659
Sale of crude oil, through over-the-counter forward contracts   (mb/d)   1,303   1,284   1,276
Marketing, spot and term sales of refined products   (mb/d)   6,398   6,688   6,563

        Refer to Item 5 — Operating and Financial Review — Refining and Marketing on page 91 and Item 11 — Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk on page 168 for further information.

53



Transportation

        Our Refining and Marketing business owns, operates or has an interest in extensive transportation facilities for crude oil, refined products and petrochemical feedstock in the US.

        We transport crude oil to our refineries principally by ship and through pipelines from our import terminals. We have interests in crude oil pipelines in the UK, the Rest of Europe and in the US.

        Bulk products are transported between refineries and storage terminals by pipeline, ship, barge, and rail. Onward delivery to customers is primarily by road. We have interests in major product pipelines in the UK, the Rest of Europe and in the US.

Shipping

        BP Shipping owns or operates an international fleet of crude oil and product tankers and LNG carriers transporting cargoes for the Group and for third parties. It also offers a wide range of marine-related services to Group customers.

        Excluding BP companies in the USA, at December 31, 2004 BP Shipping managed an international fleet of 34 oil tankers (comprising four very large crude carriers, 29 medium sized crude carriers and one North Sea shuttle tanker) and eight LNG ships with capacity of approximately 4.8 million cubic metres (comprising three trading globally, four for Abu Dhabi contracted gas and one for the Western Australia NWS Project). In addition, BP holds an interest in a further six NWS LNG carriers. BP also owned two UK coastal tankers.

        These ships are manned either by BP Maritime Services personnel or by third party manning contractors who operate to BP Shipping's standards and reporting requirements. All the chartering of ships is controlled by BP Shipping, and the ships are utilized to carry either BP cargoes or third party cargoes.

        BP Shipping is in the middle of a new building programme, which saw 12 leased ships delivered into service in 2004.

        BP companies in the USA had one large crude carrier, six medium crude carriers, and one product carrier totalling approximately 0.7 million dead weight tonnes (dwt) on long-term charter. BP owns four barges totalling 0.1 million dwt and took delivery of the first of four state-of-the-art double-hulled 1.3 million barrel Alaskan Class tankers from National Steel and Shipbuilding Company of San Diego, California during the year.

54



PETROCHEMICALS

        Our petrochemicals businesses produce chemicals and plastics through subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated undertakings. The petrochemicals businesses are also responsible for the supply, marketing and distribution of chemical products to bulk, wholesale and retail customers. BP has operations principally in the USA and Europe. We are increasing our activities in the Asia-Pacific region.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Turnover (a)   21,209   16,075   13,064
Total operating profit   12   585   447
Total assets   18,877   16,677   15,783
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   2,289   775   823

 

 

($/tonne)

Chemicals Indicator Margin (b)

 

140

 

112

 

104

(a)
Excludes BP's share of joint venture turnover of $462 million in 2004, $434 million in 2003 and $511 million in 2002.

(b)
The Chemicals Indicator Margin (CIM) is a weighted average of externally based industry product margins. It is based on market data collected by Nexant in their quarterly market analyses, which we weight based on BP's product portfolio. While it does not cover our entire portfolio, it includes a broad range of products. Among the products and businesses covered in the CIM are the olefins and derivatives, the aromatics and derivatives, linear alpha-olefins (LAOs), acetic acid, vinyl acetate monomers and nitriles. Not included are fabrics and fibres, poly alpha-olefins (PAOs), anhydrides, speciality intermediates and the remaining parts of the solvents and acetyls businesses. CIM is an environmental trend indicator. Changes in CIM are indicative of market environment trends rather than representative of the actual margins achieved by BP in any particular period.

        We are now managing our portfolio in two distinct parts — Aromatics and Acetyles (A&A), comprising PTA, PX and acetic acid, and Olefins and Derivatives, (O&D) comprising principally ethylene and related co-products, polypropylene, HDPE and acrylonitrile. We intend to retain and grow the A&A businesses, which were transferred to the Refining and Marketing segment on January 1, 2005. The Petrochemical facilities of BP Refining and Petrochemicals (BPRP) at Gelsenkirchen and Munchmunster in Germany will also remain with BP and were transferred to the Refining and Marketing segment on January 1, 2005 along with the following other petrochemical products: Napthalene dicarboxylate (NDC), vinyl acetate monomer (VAM) and ethyl acetate.

        In April 2004, we announced our intention to set up a separate corporate entity for the O&D businesses. It is our intention to divest this O&D entity, possibly starting with an initial public offering in the second half of 2005, subject to market conditions and the receipt of necessary approvals. In November 2004, we announced our intention to include two European oil refineries in the new O&D entity. The refineries at Grangemouth, UK and Lavéra, France, are closely integrated with their neighbouring chemicals plants which take refinery products as feedstock. The following other petrochemical products are also included within the new O&D entity: linear low density polyethylene (LLDPE), low density polyethylene (LDPE), ethylene oxide, ethanol, LAO, PAO, polybutene and styrene monomer and polymer. The new O&D entity is called Innovene and was formed as a separate entity within the BP Group in April 2005. Innovene is being reported within Other Businesses and Corporate from January 1, 2005.

55



        Our core products are eventually used in the manufacture of a wide variety of consumer goods, including plastic drinks bottles, computer housings, adhesives, inks, rigid packaging, pipes, food packaging and automobile components. We compete through proprietary technology, leadership positions and value associated with the integration of Group hydrocarbons and sites. Our investment and divestment activities are aligned with this strategy.

        Significant investment activities during 2004:

        Capital expenditure and acquisitions in 2004 was $2,289 million compared with $775 million in 2003 and $823 million in 2002. Excluding acquisitions, capital expenditure was $934 million, $775 million and $810 million respectively. 2004 includes $1,355 million for the acquisition of Solvay's interests in BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe and BP Solvay Polyethylene North America.

        Significant divestment activities during 2004:

56


Manufacturing Facilities

        BP has large-scale manufacturing facilities in Europe and the USA. The Group's major sites, with our share of their capacities, are: Grangemouth (3,045 ktepa) and Hull (1,535 ktepa) in the UK; Lavéra (1,940 ktepa) in France; Marl (635 ktepa), Gelsenkirchen (1,455 ktepa) and Köln (4,615 ktepa) in Germany; Geel (2,045 ktepa) in Belgium; and Texas City, Texas (2,850 ktepa), Chocolate Bayou, Texas (2,705 ktepa), Decatur, Alabama (2,250 ktepa), and Cooper River, South Carolina (1,335 ktepa) in the USA.

        We aim to grow in the Asia-Pacific region, which we believe offers good prospects for demand growth. Our intention is to build further on the positions that the Group now holds in the region through planned investment and commercial relationships, such as joint ventures. Our share of capacity in Asia amounts to 4,775 ktepa, as follows: Indonesia (245 ktepa), South Korea (1,020 ktepa), Malaysia (1,505 ktepa), Taiwan (1,250 ktepa) and China (755 ktepa). When on line in 2005, our share of the SECCO petrochemical complex in Shanghai, (BP 50%), is expected to add 1,700 ktepa of capacity.

 
  Years ended December 31,

Production by region (a)

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (ktepa)

UK   3,328   3,186   3,221
Rest of Europe   10,990   10,958   10,526
USA   10,204   9,797   9,934
Rest of World   4,405   4,002   3,307
   
 
 
Total Production (a)   28,927   27,943   26,988
   
 
 

(a)
Includes BP share of joint ventures, associated undertakings and other interests in production.

        BP's petrochemical products are sold to companies in a number of industries that manufacture components used in a wide range of applications. These include the agriculture, automotive, construction, furniture, household products, insulation, packaging, paint, pharmaceuticals and textile industries. Our products are marketed through a network of sales personnel and agents who also provide technical services.

        During 2004, overall BP petrochemicals production capacity grew 3%.

57



        The following table shows BP production capacity (ktepa) by product and by region at December 31, 2004. This production capacity is based on original design capacity of the plants plus expansions.

Capacity by region (a)

  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
World

  Total

PTA     1,033   2,440   3,668   7,141
PX     501   2,350     2,851
Acetic acid   810     523   936   2,269
Ethylene and related co-products   1,592   4,263   2,315   66   8,236
Polypropylene   273   1,075   1,386     2,734
HDPE   252   1,153   1,031   185   2,621
Acrylonitrile/Acetonitrile     301   795     1,096
Other   1,654   4,880   1,601   301   8,436
   
 
 
 
 
Total   4,581   13,206   12,441   5,156   35,384
   
 
 
 
 

(a)
Includes BP share of joint ventures, associated undertakings and other interests in production.

Aromatics and Acetyls

Purified Terephthalic Acid

        PTA is important as a raw material for the manufacture of polyester used in textiles, fibres and films. BP is the world's largest producer of PTA, with an interest in approximately 20% of the world's PTA capacity. PTA is manufactured at Cooper River, South Carolina and Decatur, Alabama in the USA, Geel in Belgium, and Kuantan in Malaysia. We also produce PTA through BP Zhuhai (BP 85%), Samsung Petrochemical Company (SPC) in South Korea (BP 47.41%), CAPCO in Taiwan (BP 61.43%), PT AMI in Indonesia (BP 50%) and Rhodiaco in Brazil (BP 49%). The sites in Taiwan, South Korea, Belgium and the USA are among the largest PTA production sites in the world.

Major Activities

Paraxylene

        PX is feedstock for the production of PTA and is manufactured from mixed xylene streams acquired from BP refineries and third-party producers. We are currently one of the world's leading producers of PX in terms of capacity. Our plants are located in Decatur, Alabama and Texas City, Texas in the USA and Geel in Belgium. We engage with Refining and Marketing to optimize sourcing of xylenes feedstock from BP refineries.

Acetic Acid

        We are a major manufacturer and supplier of acetic acid, a versatile chemical used in a variety of products such as foodstuffs, textiles, paints, dyes and pharmaceuticals. Acetic acid is also used in the production of PTA. BP has acetic acid operations at Hull, UK; in the USA through a capacity rights agreement with Sterling Chemicals at Texas City, Texas; in South Korea through

58



Samsung — BP Chemicals (BP 51%); in China through Yangtze River Acetyls Company (BP 51%) and in Malaysia through BP Petronas Acetyls Sdn. Bhd. (BP 70%).

Major Activities


Other Products

        In addition to the above A&A products, we are involved in a number of other petrochemicals products which we also transferred to the Refining and Marketing segment on January 1, 2005. PIA is used for isopolyester resins and gel coats. NDC is used for photographic film and specialized packaging. Ethyl acetate and VAM are used in coatings and textile applications.

        NDC is produced at our plant in Decatur, Alabama in the USA.

        In South Korea, the Asian Acetyls Company (BP 34%) operates a 150-ktepa plant producing VAM, a derivative of acetic acid.

        BP operates ethyl acetate and VAM plants at Hull in the UK. The Yantze River Acetyls Company also operates an ethyl/butyl acetate plant.

Olefins and Derivatives

Ethylene (and Related Co-products)

        We produce and market the basic petrochemical building blocks, known as olefins, that are used primarily as raw material for other chemical products. These olefins are derived from the steam cracking of liquid and gaseous hydrocarbons.

        Olefins — ethylene, propylene and butadiene — are produced by crackers at Grangemouth, UK; Lavéra, France (Naphtachimie — BP 50%); Köln, Germany and Chocolate Bayou, Texas in the USA. Olefins are also manufactured by Ethylene Malaysia Sdn. Bhd. (BP 15%) at Kertih, Malaysia and by BPRP at Gelsenkirchen and Munchmunster in Germany. Crackers produce the raw materials for the production of derivative products including polyethylene, polypropylene, acrylonitrile, styrene, ethanol and ethylene oxide, which are also produced at various BP plants.

Major Activities

59


Polypropylene

        Polypropylene is used for moulded products, fibres and films. Polypropylene resins are also converted into woven and non-woven fabrics for industrial products, such as carpet backing, geotextiles and various packaging materials. We have manufacturing facilities at Chocolate Bayou and Deer Park, Texas and Carson City, California in the USA; Lillo and Geel, Belgium; Lavéra and Sarralbe, France and Grangemouth, UK.

Major Activities


High Density Polyethylene

        Polyethylene is used for packaging, pipes and containers. BP has HDPE plants at Grangemouth, UK; Lillo, Belgium; Sarralbe and Lavéra, France; and Rosignano, Italy. In addition, BP has a HDPE plant at Deer Park, Texas and a joint venture plant with Chevron Philips Chemical Company at Cedar Bayou, Texas. We also produce HDPE through Polyethylene Malaysia Sdn. Bhd. (BP 60%) at Kertih, Malaysia.

Major Activities

Acrylonitrile

        BP is the world's largest producer and marketer of acrylonitrile, which is used in textiles and plastics for the automobile and consumer goods industries. We operate two acrylonitrile plants at Green Lake, Texas and Lima, Ohio in the USA. Acrylonitrile is also produced at Köln, Germany and through a capacity rights agreement with Sterling Chemicals at Texas City, Texas.

Major Activities

Other Products

        In addition to the above products, we are involved in a number of other petrochemicals products which we are including within the new O&D entity. These include LLDPE and LDPE which are used in a wide range of applications including packaging, as is styrene. Ethylene oxide and ethanol are used in solvents, coatings and the automotive industry. LAOs are used as comonomers for polyethylenes and to manufacture synthetic lubricants, plasticizers, surfactants and oilfield chemicals. PAOs are used in both

60



synthetic lubricants and surfactants. Polybutene is used in lubricants and fuel additives. Butanediol (BDO) is used in synthetic materials and engineering plastics.

        BP operates LLDPE plants at Grangemouth in the UK and Köln in Germany. The complex at Köln also produces LDPE.

        We operate styrene monomer plants at Texas City, Texas in the USA and Marl in Germany. Polystyrene plants are operated at Marl in Germany, Wingles in France and Trelleborg in Sweden. Expanded polystyrene plants are operated at Wingles and Marl.

        BP manufactures polybutene at Whiting, Indiana in the USA and at Lavéra, France.

        LAOs are produced at our facilities in Pasadena, Texas in the USA; Joffre, Canada and Feluy, Belgium. We manufacture PAOs at our facilities in Deer Park, Texas in the USA and Feluy, Belgium.

        We manufacture BDO using our proprietary technology in a world-scale plant at Lima, Ohio in the USA. This plant was sold in March 2005.

Major Activities

        We have implemented or announced a number of structural changes that we believe should significantly improve our portfolio. The most significant changes were as follows:

61



GAS, POWER AND RENEWABLES

        The strategic purpose of the Gas, Power and Renewables segment comprises 3 elements:

        The segment is organized into four main activities: marketing and trading; natural gas liquids (NGL); new market development and LNG; and solar and renewables. As previously reported, on January 1, 2004, a number of worldwide NGL producing assets were transferred to Gas, Power and Renewables from the Exploration and Production segment in order to consolidate the management of our global NGL activity. The transferred assets included seven gas processing plants, six of which are located in the mid-continent of the United States in the Permian, Anadarko and Hugoton basins, and one in Northern Europe as well as the BP partnership interest in the construction of a gas processing plant, NGL storage and export facilities in Egypt. The 2003 and 2002 data below has been restated to reflect this transfer.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Turnover   83,320   65,639   37,580
Total operating profit   926   582   469
Total assets   17,069   10,607   7,243
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   538   441   448

        We seek to maximize the value of our gas by targeting higher value customer segments in selected markets and to optimize supply around our physical and contractual rights to assets. Marketing and trading activities are focused on the relatively open and deregulated natural gas and power markets of North America, the United Kingdom and certain parts of continental Europe. Some small elements of long-term natural gas contracting activity are also still included within the Exploration and Production business segment because of the nature of gas markets and the long-term sales contracts.

        Our NGLs business is engaged in the processing, fractionation and marketing of ethane, propane, butanes and pentanes extracted from natural gas. Our NGL activity is underpinned by our upstream asset base and serves third-party markets for both chemicals and clean fuels and also supplies BP's petrochemicals and refining activities.

        New market development and LNG activities involve developing opportunities to capture sales for our upstream natural gas resources and are conducted in close collaboration with the Exploration and Production business. Our strategy is to capture a greater share of the growth in the international demand for natural gas and is focused on markets which offer significant prospects for growth. These include the USA, Canada, UK, Spain and many of the emerging markets of the Asia Pacific region, notably China, where we believe there could be substantial growth in demand. For our undeveloped gas resources, we believe the key is to gain markets ahead of supply with a longer-term aim of allowing natural gas resources to move into the market with the same ease that oil does today. Our LNG activities involve the marketing of BP and third-party LNG.

        Our solar and renewables activities include the development, production and marketing of solar panels and the development of wind farms on certain Group sites.

62



        Other activities include gas-fired power generation projects, where our principal focus is on projects that will utilize our equity natural gas. Projects that will reduce Group power costs and/or reduce overall emissions are also a key focus area.

        Capital expenditure and acquisitions for 2004 was $538 million compared with $441 million in 2003 and $448 million in 2002. Excluding acquisitions, capital expenditure for 2004, 2003 and 2002 was $538 million, $441 million and $375 million, respectively. Capital expenditure excluding acquisitions for 2005 is planned to be around $300 million; the reduction versus the 2004 level is due to lower spending on the Guangdong terminal in China, the power project in Korea and payments for the construction of new LNG ships.

 
  Years ended December 31,

Group gas sales volumes (a)

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (million cubic feet per day)

UK (b)   4,679   6,801   5,603
Rest of Europe   411   441   399
USA   13,384   11,528   9,315
Rest of World   13,216   11,669   9,535
   
 
 
Total (c)   31,690   30,439   24,852
   
 
 

(a)   Includes marketing, trading and supply sales. Also includes the following volumes under OTC forward contracts.   22,776   20,635   15,012
(b)
UK volumes for 2003 and 2002 have been restated to include trading volumes consistent with other volumes presented in this table.

(c)
Included in the above are sales made directly by the Exploration and Production segment to third parties. In 2004, these were 3.7 bcf/d, of which 2.7 bcf/d are in Rest of World.

        Our policy toward natural gas price risk is described in Item 11 — Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk on page 173.

        The following table describes how these types of transactions contributed to turnover over the period 2002 to 2004:

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
   
  2004

  2003

  2002

Gas marketing sales   ($ million)   13,532   12,929   9,401
Sale of gas through over-the-counter forward contracts   ($ million)   43,099   32,338   14,049
Sale of power through over-the-counter forward contracts   ($ million)   16,110   11,950   8,138
Sale of NGLs through over-the-counter forward contracts   ($ million)   2,251   416   40
Other sales (including NGL marketing)   ($ million)   8,328   8,006   5,952
       
 
 
    ($ million)   83,320   65,639   37,580
       
 
 
Gas marketing sales volumes   (mmcf/d)   5,244   5,881   5,840
Natural gas sales by Exploration and Production   (mmcf/d)   3,670   3,923   4,000
Sale of gas through over-the-counter forward contracts   (mmcf/d)   22,776   20,635   15,012
       
 
 
Total natural gas sales volumes   (mmcf/d)   31,690   30,439   24,852
       
 
 
Sale of power through over-the-counter forward contracts   (gwh/d)   1,162   1,012   650
Sale of NGLs through over-the-counter forward contracts   (mb/d)   188   32   3

63


Marketing and Trading Activities

        Gas and power trading and marketing activity is undertaken in the US, Canada and the UK to dispose of BP's gas and power production, manage market price risk, supply marketing customers as well as create incremental trading gains through the use of commodity derivative contracts. Additionally, this activity generates fee income and enhanced margins from sources such as the management of price risk on behalf of third party customers. These markets are large, liquid and volatile and the Group enters into these transactions on a large scale to meet these objectives.

        In connection with the above activities, the Group uses a range of commodity derivative contracts and storage and transport contracts. These include commodity derivatives such as futures, swaps and options to manage price risk and forward contracts used to buy and sell gas and power in the market place. Using these contracts in combination with rights to access storage and transportation capacity allows the Group to access advantageous pricing differences between locations, time periods and arbitrage between markets. Gas futures and options are traded through exchanges whilst over-the-counter options and swaps are used for both gas and power transactions through bilateral arrangements. Futures and options are primarily used to trade the key index prices such as Henry Hub, whilst swaps can be tailored to price with reference to specific delivery locations where gas and power can be bought and sold. Over-the-counter forward contracts have evolved in both the US and UK markets enabling gas and power to be sold forward in a variety of locations and future periods. These contracts are used to both sell production into the wholesale markets and as trading instruments to buy and sell gas and power in future periods. The contracts we use are described in more detail below. Capacity contracts allow the Group to store, transport gas and transmit power between these locations. Additionally, activity is undertaken to risk manage power generation margins related to the Texas City co-generation plant using a range of gas and power commodity derivatives

        Our gas marketing and trading activities are concentrated primarily in the markets of North America and the United Kingdom. Gas sales volumes have increased from 24.9 billion cubic feet per day (bcf/d) in 2002 to 30.4 bcf/d in 2003 and 31.7 bcf/d in 2004. Most of this growth was realized in the USA and Canada, a trend expected to continue in the near term. Canada volumes are reported in the Rest of World volumes.

        The range of transactions that the Group enters into is described below in more detail:

(a)
Exchange traded commodity derivatives
(b)
Over-the-counter (OTC) contracts, excluding forward contracts
(c)
OTC forward contracts

64


(d)
Spot and term contract

        Refer to Item 5 — Operating and Financial Review — Gas, Power and Renewables on page 95 and Item 11 — Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk on page 168 for further information.

North America

        BP is one of the leading wholesale marketers and traders of natural gas in North America, the world's largest natural gas market, a business which has been built on the foundation of our position as the continent's leading producer of gas based on volumes. Our North American total natural gas sales volumes have grown from 16.1 bcf/d in 2002 to 20.6 bcf/d in 2003 and to 23.9 bcf/d in 2004. Of these sales volumes, 4.0 bcf/d was supplied from BP upstream producing operations in 2002, 3.6 bcf/d in 2003 and 3.1 bcf/d in 2004. The gas activity in the US and Canada has grown as the Group increased its scale through both organic growth of operations and through the acquisition of smaller marketing and trading companies, increasing reach into additional markets. At the same time this has occurred, the overall volumes in these markets have also increased. The Group also trades power in addition to selling and risk managing production from the Texas City co-generation facility in the US. Power trading activity grew by 10% per annum over the period 2002 to 2004.

        The scale of our gas and power businesses in North America grew over the period 2002 to 2004 because of a number of factors: (i) the market exit of two key competitors; (ii) our investment in transportation and storage facilities; (iii) expansion of our staff in our supply and trading activity; and (iv) acquisitions of smaller trading and marketing companies. The OTC market for NGLs developed during this period, but the scale of activity was not significant in the context of the Group's overall operations or overall supply and trading activity.

        Our North American natural gas marketing and trading strategy seeks to provide unconstrained market access for BP's equity gas. Our marketing strategy targets higher value customer segments through fully utilizing our rights to store and transport gas. These assets include those owned by BP and those contractually accessed through agreements with third parties such as pipelines and terminals.

65



United Kingdom

        The natural gas market in the UK is significant in size and is one of the most progressive in terms of deregulation when compared with other European markets. BP is one of the largest producers of natural gas in the UK based on volumes. Our total natural gas sales volumes in the UK were 4.7 bcf/d in 2004, 6.8 bcf/d in 2003 and 5.6 bcf/d in 2002. Of these volumes, 1.2 bcf/d (2003 1.4 bcf/d and 2002 1.6 bcf/d) were supplied by BP's Exploration and Production operations. The majority of natural gas sales are to power generation companies and to other gas wholesalers via long-term supply deals. Some of the natural gas continues to be sold under long-term natural gas supply contracts that were entered into prior to market deregulation. Commodity derivative contracts are used actively in combination with assets and rights to store and transport gas. This may include storing physical gas to sell in future periods or moving gas between markets to access higher prices. Commodity contracts such as over-the-counter forward contracts can be used to achieve this whilst other commodity contracts such as futures and options can be used to manage the market risk relating to changes in prices. The decline in the volumes of the activity, excluding sales of BP's own production, between 2003 and 2004 is primarily due to the overall UK market declining during the period. At the same time, however, the levels of power volumes traded increased most notably between 2002 and 2003 due to business growth.

        In the first quarter of 2005 we sold our 10% interest in the Interconnector, a 1.9-bcf/d, 240-kilometre, 40-inch diameter subsea natural gas pipeline between Bacton in the UK and Zeebrugge in Belgium.

Rest of Europe

        We are building a natural gas and power marketing and trading business in Europe. Our interest in the European market is driven by the size and growth potential of the market, deregulation and the proximity of BP natural gas supplies.

        In Europe, our main marketing activities are currently in Spain. The Spanish natural gas market has continued to grow and is now deregulated ahead of the deadlines set by European law. Since April 2000, we have built a market position which currently places us as the leading foreign entrant into the Spanish gas market. In July 2002, we purchased 5% of the shares in Enagas, the owner and operator of the majority of the high pressure Spanish gas transport grid and three of Spain's four regasification terminals.

Natural Gas Liquids

 
  Years ended December 31,

Group NGL sales volumes

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (thousand barrels per day)

UK   8   3   4
Rest of Europe   6    
USA (a)   393   329   296
Rest of World   203   205   232
   
 
 
Total   610   537   532
   
 
 

           
(a)   Includes the following volumes under OTC forward contracts   188   32   3

        BP is one of the leading producers and marketers of NGLs, based on sales volumes, in North America. NGLs, which are produced from gas chiefly sourced out of Alberta, Canada and the US onshore and Gulf Coast, are used as a heating fuel and as a feedstock for refineries and chemicals

66



plants. NGLs are sold to petrochemical plants and refineries, including our own, at prevailing market prices. In addition, a significant amount of NGLs are marketed on a wholesale basis under annual supply contracts that provide for price redetermination based on prevailing market prices.

        We operate natural gas processing facilities across North America with a total capacity of 8.7 bcf/d. These facilities, which we own or have an interest in, are located in major production areas across North America including Alberta, Canada, the US Rockies, the San Juan basin and coast of the Gulf of Mexico. We also own or have an interest in fractionation plants (which process the natural gas liquids stream into its separate component products) in Canada and the USA, and own or lease storage capacity in Alberta, Eastern Canada, the US Gulf Coast and mid-continent regions.

        In the UK we operate one plant and we are a partner (33.33%) in a gas processing plant in Egypt which completed construction at the end of 2004.

        Additionally, the Group established a trading activity in 2002 to augment certain of our activities in the US. This activity is responsible for delivering value across the overall NGL supply chain, sourcing optimal feedstock to our processing assets and securing marketing activities with flexible and competitive supply but primarily to create incremental trading gains through using storage capacity, inventory and commodity derivative contracts by arbitraging seasonal price differences. To achieve this objective, a range of commodity derivative contracts including over-the-counter options, swaps and physical forward contracts are used.

        Over-the-counter contracts include a variety of options and most importantly swaps. These swaps price in relation to a wider set of products than can be achieved through the exchanges where counterparties contract for differences between, for example, fixed and floating prices. The contracts we use are similar to those for gas and power which are described in greater detail within the Marketing and Trading section above. Additionally, physical NGLs can be traded forward by using specific over-the-counter contracts. Over-the-counter forward sales contracts are used by BP to both buy and sell the physical commodity as well as a hedging tool and to arbitrage between the different markets. The scale and application of these contracts as described has increased from 2002 to 2004 as this new activity has become established.

New Market Development and LNG

        Our new market development and LNG activities are focused on developing worldwide opportunities to capture international natural gas sales for our upstream natural gas resources.

        BP Exploration and Production has interests in major existing LNG projects in Trinidad and Tobago, ADGAS in Abu Dhabi, the North West Shelf in Australia and we also supply gas (from Virginia Indonesia Co.) to the Bontang LNG project in Indonesia. Additional LNG supplies are being pursued through expansions of existing LNG plants in Trinidad and Tobago, the North West Shelf in Australia and greenfield developments such as Tangguh in Indonesia.

        During 2004, we have taken a number of important steps to access major growth markets for the Group's equity gas. In Asia Pacific, agreements for the supply of LNG from the Tangguh development (BP 37.16%) were signed with POSCO and K Power for supply to South Korea and with Sempra for supply to Mexico and US markets. Together with an earlier agreement to supply LNG to China, markets for more than 7 million tonnes a year (9.7 bcma) of Tangguh LNG have been secured. In March 2005, Tangguh received key Government approvals for the two train launch and is now executing the major construction contracts, with start-up planned in late 2008.

        During the year, BP ordered four new LNG carriers from Hyundai Heavy Industries of South Korea and agreed options for an additional four ships.

67



        In the Atlantic and Mediterranean regions, significant progress was also made in creating opportunities to supply LNG to North American and European gas markets. In Egypt, we signed an agreement with Egyptian Natural Gas Holding Company (EGAS) to purchase 1.45 billion cubic metres per year of LNG (see Exploration and Production in this Item on page 38). Agreements were finalized with NGT Transco which will make BP and Sonatrach of Algeria the first companies for several decades to import LNG into the UK market from 2005.

        Plans for the development of new LNG import terminals on the US East and Gulf coasts continued. These new access points to market, together with existing capacity rights at Cove Point in Maryland, US, Bilbao in Spain and Isle of Grain, UK, should provide important opportunities to maximize the value of the Group's gas supplies from Trinidad, Egypt and elsewhere.

        In Southeast China, the construction of the Guangdong LNG Terminal and Trunkline Project (BP 30%) continued on track. First gas is scheduled for mid-2006 under the gas purchase agreement signed with Australia LNG in October 2002 that will involve deliveries from the North West Shelf project (BP 16.7%).

Solar and Renewables

        Global market trends indicate a general move towards greener energy sources, including solar and wind. BP intends to participate in this developing market.

        During 2003, BP repositioned BP Solar in order to improve business performance. A number of specific restructuring measures were taken in order to improve short-term results with the need to provide opportunities for long-term growth. These decisions involved the consolidation of manufacturing operations in Spain, US, India and Australia, significant staff and other overhead reductions across the global business and restructuring provisions related to improving the overall efficiency of the business.

        This restructuring has enabled the Group to focus on core markets supported by global technology and manufacturing functions. 2004 has seen strong industry demand for photovoltaic products with sales increasing 38% to 99 MW of solar panel generating capacity (2003 71 MW, 2002 67 MW).

        BP Solar's main production facilities are located in Frederick, Maryland USA; Madrid Spain; Sydney, Australia; and Bangalore, India. In October 2004, BP announced plans to strengthen its position in the solar electric market to support its strategic growth plan of increasing global production capacity to 200 MW by the end of 2006.

        In Germany last year we opened a 4 MW solar farm, one of the largest in the world, on the site of a former plant near Merseburg, supplying enough power for 1,000 four-person households.

        As a major solar operator, BP has become involved in several projects around the world. In Malaysia in 2004, we completed a $39 million project, funded by the Ministry of Rural Development, which supplied more than 13,000 systems to remote communities situated in dense tropical rainforest, high mountain ridges and flood-prone river deltas. The systems deliver power to homes, rural clinics, community halls, schools and churches.

        In the Philippines, we continue to work in 2004 on the Solar Power Technology Support (SPOTS) project which is being jointly undertaken by the Philippines and Spanish governments. It has brought electricity to around 40 communities for everything from lighting in schools to water pumping for clean drinking water and vaccine refrigeration.

        We are building expertise in wind energy and implementing wind projects on selected BP sites. In January 2005, we began construction of a 9 MW wind farm at our oil terminal in Amsterdam, the Netherlands. We continue to operate our 22.5 MW wind farm at the Nerefco oil refinery (both the

68



refinery and wind farm are jointly owned with Chevron (BP 69%)) in the Netherlands, which provides electricity to the local grid.

Other Activities

        We participate in power projects that support the marketing and sale of our natural gas and in cogeneration projects (i.e., power plants that produce more than one type of energy, typically power and steam) on certain BP refining and chemical manufacturing sites.

        During the year, a 776 MW gas-fired power generation facility and an associated LNG regasification facility at Bilbao, Spain (BP 25% share in each) were completed and commenced commercial operation. The construction of K Power's (BP 35%) 1,074 MW gas fired combined cycle power project at Gwangyang (Korea) has continued with start up on track for 2006. The 570 MW cogeneration plant (50:50 joint venture with Cinergy Solutions, Inc.) at Texas City, Texas commenced operations in early 2004. Texas City is BP's largest refining and petrochemicals complex. BP supplies natural gas to the Texas City plant and will use the excess generation capacity to support power marketing and trading activities. The construction of a 50 MW cogeneration plant near Southampton, UK (BP 100%) is now complete and commercial start-up took place in the first half of 2005.

        We also own and operate a 400 MW gas-fired power plant at Great Yarmouth in the UK (BP 100%).

        In alternative fuels, we are exploring market opportunities for hydrogen fuel cells through participation in various industry projects and organisations promoting fuel cells for transport and stationary power.

69



OTHER BUSINESSES AND CORPORATE

        Other businesses and corporate comprises Finance, the Group's coal asset (divested October 2003) the Group's aluminium asset, its investments in PetroChina and Sinopec (both divested in early 2004), interest income and costs relating to corporate activities worldwide.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Turnover   546   515   510  
Total operating loss   (973 ) (283 ) (730 )
Total assets   7,930   8,753   6,667  
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   215   346   410  

        Finance coordinates the management of the Group's major financial assets and liabilities. From locations in the UK, Europe, the USA and the Asia Pacific region, it provides the link between BP and the international financial markets and makes available a range of financial services to the Group including supporting the financing of BP's projects around the world.

        Coal activity consisted of our 50% interest in PT Kaltim Prima Coal, an Indonesian company which operates an opencast coal mine at Sangatta in Kalimantan, Indonesia. On October 10, 2003 we completed the sale of this interest to PT Bumi Resources.

        Aluminium. Our aluminium business is a non-integrated producer and marketer of rolled aluminium products, headquartered in Louisville, Kentucky, USA. Production facilities are located in Logan County, Kentucky and are jointly owned with Alcan Aluminum. The primary activity of our aluminium business is the supply of aluminium coil to the beverage can business.

        Investments in China. During 2000, BP made two investments in China, one of the world's fastest growing economies. BP invested $416 million in the China Petroleum and Chemical Corporation (Sinopec) and $578 million in PetroChina in the initial public offerings of both companies, obtaining around 2% in each company. During 2004 we sold these investments for aggregate proceeds of $2,360 million.

        Research, technology and engineering activities are carried out by each of the major business segments on the basis of a distributed programme coordinated by the BP Technology Council. This body provides leadership for scientific, technical and engineering activities throughout the Group and in particular promotes cross-business initiatives and the transfer of best practice between businesses. In addition, a group of eminent industrialists and academics form the Technology Advisory Council, which advises senior management on the state of technology within the Group and helps identify current trends and future developments in technology.

        Research and development is carried out using a balance of internal and external resources. Involving third parties in the various steps of technology development and application enables a wider range of technology solutions to be considered and implemented, improving the productivity of research and development activities.

        The innovative application of technology and the rapid transfer of this knowledge through the Group make a key contribution to improving BP's business performance, particularly in the areas of the introduction of new products, safety, the environment, cost reduction and efficiency of business operations. We believe that, in addition to improving existing business performance, the use of innovative technology can create new possibilities for the organic growth of our energy- and petrochemical-related businesses.

70



        Across the Group, expenditure on research for 2004 was $439 million, compared with $349 million in 2003 and $373 million in 2002.

        Insurance. The Group generally restricts its purchase of insurance to situations where this is required for legal or contractual reasons. This is because external insurance is not considered an economic means of financing losses for the Group. Losses will therefore be borne as they arise, rather than being spread over time through insurance premia with attendant transaction costs. The position is reviewed from time to time.

71



REGULATION OF THE GROUP'S BUSINESS

        BP's exploration and production activities are conducted in many different countries and are therefore subject to a broad range of legislation and regulations. These cover virtually all aspects of exploration and production activities, including matters such as licence acquisition, production rates, royalties, pricing, environmental protection, export, taxes and foreign exchange. The terms and conditions of the leases, licences and contracts under which these oil and gas interests are held vary from country to country. These leases, licences and contracts are generally granted by or entered into with a government entity or state company and are sometimes entered into with private property owners. These arrangements usually take the form of licences or production sharing agreements.

        Licences (or concessions) give the holder the right to explore for and exploit a commercial discovery. Under a licence, the holder bears the risk of exploration, development and production activities and provides the financing for these operations. In principle, the licence holder is entitled to all production minus any royalties that are payable in kind. A licence holder is generally required to pay production taxes or royalties, which may be in cash or in kind.

        Production sharing agreements entered into with a government entity or state company generally obligate BP to provide all the financing and bear the risk of exploration and production activities in exchange for a share of the production remaining after royalties, if any.

        In certain countries, separate licences are required for exploration and production activities and, in certain cases, production licences are limited to a portion of the area covered by the exploration licence. Both exploration and production licences are generally for a specified period of time (except for licences in the United States which remain in effect until production ceases). The term of BP's licences and the extent to which these licences may be renewed vary by area.

        In general, BP is required to pay income tax on income generated from production activities (whether under a licence or production sharing agreement). In addition, depending on the area, BP's production activities may be subject to a range of other taxes, levies and assessments, including special petroleum taxes and revenue taxes. The taxes imposed upon oil and gas production profits and activities may be substantially higher than those imposed on other activities, particularly in the UK, Norway, Angola and Trinidad.

        BP's other activities are also subject to a broad range of legislation and regulations in various countries in which it operates.

        Health, safety and environmental regulations are discussed in more detail in Environmental Protection in this Item on page 73.

72



ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION

Health, Safety and Environmental Regulation

        The Group is subject to numerous national and local environmental laws and regulations concerning its products, operations and activities. Current and proposed fuel and product specifications under a number of environmental laws will have a significant effect on the production, sale and profitability of many of our products. Environmental laws and regulations also require the Group to remediate or otherwise redress the effects on the environment of prior disposal or release of chemicals or petroleum substances by the Group or other parties. Such contingencies may exist for various sites including refineries, chemicals plants, natural gas processing plants, oil and natural gas fields, service stations, terminals and waste disposal sites. In addition, the Group may have obligations relating to prior asset sales or closed facilities. Provisions for environmental restoration and remediation are made when a clean-up is probable and the amount is reasonably determinable. Generally, their timing coincides with the commitment to a formal plan of action or, if earlier, on divestment or on closure of inactive sites. The provisions made are considered by management to be sufficient for known requirements.

        The extent and cost of future environmental restoration, remediation and abatement programmes are often inherently difficult to estimate. They depend on the magnitude of any possible contamination, the timing and extent of the corrective actions required and BP's share of liability relative to that of other solvent responsible parties. Though the costs of future restoration and remediation could be significant, and may be material to the results of operations in the period in which they are recognized, it is not expected that such costs will be material to the Group's overall results of operations or financial position. Refer to Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 32 on page F-56 for the amounts provided in respect of environmental remediation and decommissioning.

        The Group's operations are also subject to environmental and common law claims for personal injury and property damage caused by the release of chemicals, hazardous materials or petroleum substances by the Group or others. Thirteen proceedings instituted by governmental authorities are pending or known to be contemplated against BP and certain of its US subsidiaries under US federal, state or local environmental laws, each of which could result in monetary sanctions in excess of $100,000. No individual proceeding is, nor are the proceedings as a group, expected to be material to the Group's results of operations or financial position.

        On March 23, 2005, an explosion and fire occurred in the Isomerization Unit of the BP Texas City refinery as the unit was coming out of planned maintenance. Fifteen contractors involved in maintenance work died in the incident. Other contractors and employees were injured, some very seriously. The US Occupational Safety and Health Administration, the US Chemical Safety and Hazard Investigation Board and the Texas Commission on Environmental Quality, among others, are conducting investigations. BP has finalized or is in process of negotiating settlements in respect of fatalities and personal injury claims arising from the incident. BP currently expects that the total amount of these settlements will not be material to the Group's results of operations or financial position for the year 2005. However, such amount may be material to the Group's results of operations for a particular quarter.

        Management cannot predict future developments, such as increasingly strict requirements of environmental laws and the resulting enforcement policies thereunder, that might affect the Group's operations or affect the exploration for new reserves or the products sold by the Group. A risk of increased environmental costs and impacts is inherent in particular operations and products of the Group and there can be no assurance that material liabilities and costs will not be incurred in the future. In general, the Group does not expect that it will be affected differently from other companies

73



with comparable assets engaged in similar businesses. Management believes that the Group's activities are in compliance in all material respects with applicable environmental laws and regulations.

        For a discussion of the Group's environmental expenditures see Item 5 — Operating and Financial Review — Environmental Expenditure on page 97.

        BP operates in over 100 countries worldwide. In all regions of the world, BP has processes to ensure compliance with applicable regulations. In addition, each individual in the Group is required to comply with the BP health, safety and environment policy and associated expectations and standards. Our partners, suppliers and contractors are also encouraged to adopt them. The Group is working with the equity-accounted entity TNK-BP to develop management information to allow for the assessment and measurement of their activities in relation to health, safety and environment regulations and obligations. This document focuses primarily on the US and the European Union (EU), where approximately 80% of our property, plant and equipment is located, and on two issues of a global nature: climate change programmes and maritime oil spills regulations.

Climate Change Programmes

Kyoto Protocol

        In December 1997, at the Third Conference of the Parties to the United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change (UNFCCC) in Kyoto, Japan, the participants agreed on a system of differentiated internationally legally binding targets for the first commitment period of 2008 to 2012. Upon ratification by Russia in 2004, the conditions for the treaty to enter into force (minimum 55 nations representing 55% of global anthropogenic emissions) were satisfied, and it entered into force on February 16, 2005. The impact of the Kyoto agreements on global energy (and oil and gas) demand is expected to be small (see International Energy Agency World Energy Outlook 2004).

        Since 1997, BP has been actively involved in policy debate. We also ran a global programme that reduced our operational greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions by 10% between 1998 and 2001. Since then, we have been taking further steps to manage GHG emissions. In assessing our performance, we look at two principal kinds of emissions: emissions generated from our operations such as refineries, chemicals plants and production facilities — operational emissions; and emissions generated by our customers when they use the fuels that we sell — product emissions.

        Market mechanisms to allow optimum utilization of resources to meet the national Kyoto targets are being considered, developed or implemented by individual countries and also internationally through the European Union. The relative success of these systems will determine the extent to which alternative fiscal or regulatory measures may be applied. Some EU member States have indicated that they require energy product taxes to enable them to meet their Kyoto commitments within the EU burden sharing agreement.

European Union Emissions Trading Scheme

        In July 2003, final agreement was reached on a Directive establishing a scheme for greenhouse gas emission allowance trading within the EU, and in January 2005, the scheme entered into force, capping the greenhouse gas emissions of major industrial emitters. Member states have finalized their National Allocation Plans, setting out how emission allowances will be allocated. BP was well prepared for the EU emission trading system (ETS), building on our experiences from our own internal emissions trading system (operated between 1999-2001) and the UK ETS. We are approaching the EU ETS on a regional, integrated basis to optimize compliance and value for the BP sites (representing roughly 25% of our global GHG emissions) that are affected.

74



Maritime Oil Spill Regulations

        Within the United States, the Oil Pollution Act of 1990 significantly increased oil spill prevention requirements. Details of this legislation are provided in the United States Regional Review in this Item on page 75. Outside the United States, the BP operated fleet of tankers is subject to international spill response and preparedness regulations that are typically promulgated through the International Maritime Organization (IMO) and implemented by the relevant flag state authorities. The International Convention for the Prevention of Pollution From Ships (Marpol 73/78) requires vessels to have detailed shipboard emergency and spill prevention plans. The International Convention on Oil Pollution, Preparedness, Response and Co-Operation (OPRC) requires vessels to have adequate spill response plans and resources for response anywhere the vessel travels to. These conventions and separate Marine Environmental Protection Circulars also stipulate the relevant state authorities around the globe that require engagement in the event of a spill. All of these requirements together are addressed by the vessel owners in Shipboard Oil Pollution Emergency Plans. BP Shipping's liabilities for oil pollution damage under the United States Oil Pollution Act 1990 and outside the United States under the 1969/1992 International Convention on Civil Liability for Oil Pollution Damage are covered by marine liability insurance having a maximum limit of $1 billion for each accident or occurrence. This insurance cover is provided by two mutual insurance associations, The United Kingdom Steam Ship Assurance Association (Bermuda) Limited and The Britannia Steam Ship Insurance Association Limited.

        At the end of 2004, the international fleet we managed numbered 34 oil tankers, all double hulled with an average age of less than two years and eight LNG ships with an average age of seven years. The international fleet renewal programme will continue into the future and should see 13 new double hulled oil tankers, four new very large liquefied petroleum gas carriers and four new liquefied natural gas carriers delivered between 2005 and 2008. In addition to its own fleet, BP will continue to charter quality ships; currently these vessels include both single- and double-hulled designs but all are vetted prior to each use to ensure they are operated and maintained to meet BP's standards.

United States Regional Review

        The following is a summary of significant US environmental issues and legislation affecting the Group.

        The Clean Air Act and its regulations require, among other things, new fuel specifications and sulphur reductions, enhanced monitoring of major sources of specified pollutants; stringent air emission limits and new operating permits for chemical plants, refineries, marine and distribution terminals; and risk management plans for storage of hazardous substances. This law affects BP facilities producing, refining, manufacturing and distributing oil and products as well as the fuels themselves. Federal and state controls on ozone, carbon monoxide, benzene, sulphur, MTBE, nitrogen dioxide, oxygenates and Reid Vapor Pressure impact BP's activities and products in the US. BP is continually adapting its business to these rules and has the know-how to produce quality and competitive products in compliance with their requirements. Beginning January 2006, all gasoline produced by BP will have to meet the Environmental Protection Agency's (EPA's) stringent low sulphur standards. Furthermore, by June 2006, at least 80% of the highway diesel fuel produced by BP will have to meet a sulphur cap of 15 parts per million (ppm) and by June 2007, all non-road diesel fuel production will have to meet a sulphur cap of 500 ppm and then 15 ppm by June 2012.

        In 2001, BP entered into a consent decree with the EPA and several states that settled alleged violations of various Clean Air Act requirements related largely to emissions of sulphur dioxide and nitrogen oxides at BP's refineries. Implementation of the decrees requirement's continues.

        In March 2003 and January 2005, the South Coast Air Quality Management District filed civil lawsuits against BP's Carson, California refinery, seeking penalties of approximately $600 million for various alleged air quality violations. In March 2005, BP, without admitting liability, agreed to settle all

75



outstanding claims for $25 million in cash penalties and approximately $6 million in past emissions fees. BP further agreed to provide $30 million over ten years in community benefit programmes and $20 million in new refinery projects aimed at reducing emissions. In addition, in 2004 (and early 2005), BP paid approximately $4 million in fines and penalties in the US, about half of which was paid in settlement of matters in Alaska and California.

        Throughout 2004, BP continued to comply with a plea agreement with the US Justice Department to develop, implement and maintain a nationwide environmental management system (EMS) consistent with the best environmental practices at Group facilities engaged in oil exploration, drilling and/or production in the US and its territories. BP fully implemented EMSs in Alaska and Lower 48 exploration and production performance units during 2003 and met the requirement to spend at least $15 million on the programme. The plea agreement and the associated period of organizational probation ended on January 31, 2005.

        The Clean Water Act is designed to protect and enhance the quality of US surface waters by regulating the discharge of wastewater and other discharges from both onshore and offshore operations. Facilities are required to obtain permits for most surface water discharges, install control equipment and implement operational controls and preventative measures, including spill prevention and control plans. Requirements under the Clean Water Act have become more stringent in recent years, including coverage of storm and surface water discharges at many more facilities and increased control of toxic discharges.

        More specifically, recently adopted and proposed water protection initiatives have the potential to affect BP operations over the next several years. These include total maximum daily load allocations to bring surface waters into compliance with water quality standards, water quality criteria for methylmercury, selenium and nutrients, whole effluent toxicity controls, requirements for cooling water intake structures, the revision or adoption of effluent limitations guidelines and spill prevention control and countermeasure planning requirements.

        The Oil Pollution Act of 1990 (OPA 90) significantly increased oil spill prevention requirements, spill response planning obligations and spill liability for tankers and barges transporting oil and for offshore facilities such as platforms and onshore terminals. To ensure adequate funding for response to oil spills and compensation for damages, when not fully covered by a responsible party, OPA 90 created a $1-billion fund which is funded by a tax on imported and domestic oil. OPA 90 also provides that all new tank vessels operating in US waters must have double hulls and existing tank vessels without double hulls must be phased out by 2015. In 2002, BP contracted with National Steel and Ship Building Company (NASSCO) for the construction of four double-hull tankers in San Diego, California. The first of these new vessels began service in 2004, demise chartered to and operated by Alaska Tanker Company (ATC). NASSCO is expected to deliver two more in 2005. The current ATC fleet consists of seven tankers: three with double bottoms and four with double hulls. By the end of 2006, all ATC vessels are expected to be double hulled.

        BP has a national spill response team, the BP Americas Response Team (BART), consisting of approximately 250 trained emergency responders at Group locations throughout North America. Supporting the BART are six Regional Response Incident Management Teams and five HAZMAT Strike Teams. Collectively, these teams are ready to assist in a response to a major incident.

        The Resource Conservation and Recovery Act (RCRA) regulates the storage, handling, treatment, transportation and disposal of hazardous and non-hazardous wastes. It also requires the investigation and remediation of certain locations at a facility where such wastes have been handled, released or disposed of. BP facilities generate and handle a number of wastes regulated by RCRA and have units that have been used for the storage, handling or disposal of RCRA wastes that are subject to investigation and corrective action.

76



        Under the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and Liability Act (also known as CERCLA or Superfund), waste generators, site owners, facility operators and certain other parties are strictly liable for part or all of the cost of addressing sites contaminated by spills or waste disposal regardless of fault or the amount of waste sent to a site. Additionally, each state has laws similar to CERCLA.

        BP has been identified as a Potentially Responsible Party (PRP) under CERCLA and similar state statutes at approximately 800 sites. A PRP has joint and several liability for site remediation costs under some of these statutes and so BP may be required to assume, among other costs, the share attributed to insolvent, unidentified or other parties. BP has the most significant exposure for remediation costs at 64 of these sites. For the remaining sites, the number of PRPs can range up to 200 or more. BP expects its share of remediation costs at these sites to be small in comparison to the major sites. BP has estimated its potential exposure at all sites where it has been identified as a PRP and has established provisions accordingly. BP does not anticipate that its ultimate exposure at these sites individually, or in aggregate, will be significant except as reported for Atlantic Richfield Company in the matters below.

        The United States and the State of Montana seek to hold Atlantic Richfield Company liable for environmental remediation, related costs, and natural resource damages arising out of mining-related activities by Atlantic Richfield's predecessors in the upper Clark Fork River Basin ("the basin"). US EPA has estimated that the future cost of performing selected and proposed remedies in certain areas in the basin is approximately $350 million. In addition, EPA filed an action, entitled US vs. Atlantic Richfield Company, to recover past and future response costs that EPA incurred at the basin sites. In 2004, Atlantic Richfield agreed to pay $50 million plus interest to resolve EPA's claims for past costs at most sites in the basin, and the parties' consent decree settlement was approved by the court in January 2005. On a parallel track, a pending lawsuit by the state, entitled Montana vs. Atlantic Richfield Company, seeks to recover damages for alleged natural resources injuries in the basin. The United States also has claims for injury to natural resources on federal property. In 1999, Atlantic Richfield settled most of the State's claims for damages, as well as all natural resource damage claims asserted by a local Native American Tribe. The parties have not resolved the United States' claims, and they have not settled the State's claims for approximately $182.5 million in restoration damages at three sites in the basin. Atlantic Richfield Company has challenged certain government cost estimates and asserted defences and counterclaims to certain remaining claims. Past settlements among the parties may provide a framework for possible future settlement of the remaining claims in the basin.

        The Group is also subject to other claims for natural resource damages (NRD) under CERCLA, OPA, and various other federal and state laws. NRD claims have been asserted by government trustees against several refineries and other Group operations. This is a developing area of the law which could impact the cost of responding to environmental conditions at some sites in the future.

        In the US, many environmental cleanups are the result of strict groundwater protection standards at both the state and federal level. Contamination or the threat of contamination of current or potential drinking water resources can result in stringent cleanup requirements, but some states have addressed contamination of nonpotable water resources using similarly strict standards. BP has encouraged risk-based approaches to these issues and seeks to tailor remedies at its facilities to match the level of risk presented by the contamination.

        Other significant legislation includes the Toxic Substances Control Act which regulates the development, testing, import, export and introduction of new chemical products into commerce; the Occupational Safety and Health Act which imposes workplace safety and health, training and process standards to reduce the risks of chemical exposure and injury to employees; the Emergency Planning and Community Right-to-Know Act which requires emergency planning and spill notification as well as public disclosure of chemical usage and emissions. In addition, the US Department of Transportation through agencies such as the Office of Pipeline Safety and the Office of Hazardous Materials Safety

77



regulates in a comprehensive manner the transportation of the Company's products such as gasoline and chemicals to protect the health and safety of the public.

        BP is subject to the Marine Transportation Security Act and the Department of Transportation Hazardous Materials security compliance regulations in the United States. These regulations require many of our US businesses to conduct Security Vulnerability Assessments and prepare security mitigation plans which require the implementation of upgrades to security measures, the appointment and the submission of plans for approval and inspection.

        See also Item 8 — Financial Information — Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information — Legal Proceedings on page 156.

European Union Regional Review

        Within the European Union, member states either apply the Directives of the European Commission or enact regulations. By joint agreement, European Union Directives may also be applied within countries outside Europe.

        A European Commission Directive for a system of Integrated Pollution Prevention and Control (IPPC) was approved in 1996. This system requires permitting through the application of Best Available Techniques (BAT) taking into account the costs and benefits. In the event that the use of BAT is likely to result in the breach of an environmental quality standard, plant emissions must be reduced further. The European Commission has stated that it hopes that all processes to which it applies will be licensed by July 2005. All plants must have a permit in accordance with the requirements of the IPPC Directive by November 2007. The Directive encompasses most activities and processes undertaken by the oil and petrochemical industry within the European Union and requires capital and revenue expenditure across these BP sites. The European Commission is expected to make recommendations for amendments to the IPPC Directive in 2005.

        The European Union Large Combustion Plant Directive sets emission limit values for sulphur dioxide, nitrogen oxides and particulates from large combustion plants. It also required phased reductions in emissions from existing large combustion plants at the latest by April 1, 2001. A revised Large Combustion Plant Directive has been agreed and implementation was required by November 27, 2002. Plants will have to comply by 2008. The second important set of air emission regulations affecting BP European operations is the Air Quality Framework Directive and its three daughter Directives on ambient air quality assessment and management, which prescribe, among other things, ambient limit values for sulphur dioxide, oxides of nitrogen, particulate matter, lead, carbon monoxide, ozone, cadmium, arsenic, nickel, mercury and polyaromatic hydrocarbons. Measured or modelled exceedences of air quality limit values will require local action to reduce emissions and may impact any BP operations whose emissions contribute to such exceedences.

        The Commission's Clean Air for Europe Programme is due to lead to the publication of a Thematic Strategy on Air Pollution (TSAP) during the first half of 2005. It will outline the environmental objectives for air quality and measures to be taken to achieve these objectives. Measures are likely to include revisions to the National Emissions Ceilings Directive, regulation of the concentration of fine particles (PM2.5—particulate matter less than 2.5 microns diameter) in ambient air; and new emission limits for light and heavy duty diesel vehicles, revised fuel quality and plant emission standards, and new EU measures e.g. to control evaporative losses from vehicle refuelling at service stations.

        The EU has set stringent objectives to control exhaust emissions from vehicles, which are being implemented in stages. Maximum sulphur levels for gasoline and diesel fuels to apply from 2005 have also been agreed at 50 ppm and 35% maximum aromatic content for gasoline from the same date. Agreement was reached in December 2002 on a further Directive to make petrol and diesel with a maximum sulphur content of 10 ppm mandatory throughout the EU from January 2009, and from 2005

78



member states will also have to supply low-sulphur fuel at enough locations to allow the circulation of new low-emission engines requiring the cleaner fuel. Further measures on sulphur levels of shipping fuels and/or reduction of emissions using such fuels are expected in 2005. Possible restrictions and measures include sulphur levels in fuels of 0.1% for inland vessels by January 2010 and 1.5% for passenger ships by May 19, 2006. The impact on BP should be from installation of flue gas desulphurisation on ships and higher cost fuel. The overall impact would not be material to the Group's results of operations or financial position.

        In Europe there is no overall soil protection regulation, although proposals on measures will be presented by the Commission in 2005. Certain individual member states have soil protection policies, but each has its own contaminated land regulations. There are common principles behind these regulations, including a risk based approach and recognition of costs versus benefits.

        The European Commission adopted an official proposal on October 29, 2003 for a future regulation on European Chemical Policy referred to as REACH: Registration, Evaluation and Authorization of Chemicals. This proposal is now being discussed by the European Parliament and Council. Dependent on the discussions, entry in force of the regulation could happen by mid-2007. Although oil and natural gas have been temporarily exempted from the scope under the current proposal, about 30,000 other chemicals will have to be re-registered and evaluated. For the Group, this will primarily affect our refinery products, lubricants and chemicals that are manufactured and imported in the EU. Local costs will be associated with further testing, data availability systems, management and administration.

        The European Commission adopted a Directive on Environmental Liability on April 21, 2004. The proposal seeks to implement a strict liability approach for damage to biodiversity and services lost from high-risk operations by April 30, 2007. Member states are considering how to implement the regime. Possibilities of damage insurance, increased preventive provisions and injunctive relief to third parties are also possible.

        Other environment-related existing regulations which may have an impact on BP's operations include: the Major Hazards Directive which requires emergency planning, public disclosure of emergency plans and ensuring that hazards are assessed, and effective emergency management systems are in place; the Water Framework Directive which includes protection of groundwater; and the Framework Directive on Waste to ensure that waste is recovered or disposed without endangering human health and without using processes or methods which could harm the environment.

79



PROPERTY, PLANTS AND EQUIPMENT

        BP has freehold and leasehold interests in real estate in numerous countries throughout the world, but no one individual property is significant to the Group as a whole. See Exploration and Production heading under this Item for a description of the Group's significant reserves and sources of crude oil and natural gas. Significant plans to construct, expand or improve specific facilities are described under each of the business headings within this Item.

80



ORGANIZATIONAL STRUCTURE

        The significant subsidiary undertakings of the Group at December 31, 2004 and the Group percentage of ordinary share capital (to nearest whole number) are set out below. The principal country of operation is generally indicated by the company's country of incorporation or by its name. Those held directly by the Company are marked with an asterisk (*), the percentage owned being that of the Group unless otherwise indicated. Refer to Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 42 on page F-82 and Note 45 on page F-86 for information on significant joint ventures and associated undertakings of the Group.

Subsidiary undertakings

  %
  Country of incorporation

  Principal activities

International              
BP Chemicals Investments   100   England     Petrochemicals
BP Exploration Operating Co.   100   England     Exploration and production
BP Global Investments*   100   England     Investment holding
BP International*   100   England     Integrated oil operations
BP Oil International   100   England     Integrated oil operations
BP Shipping*   100   England     Shipping
Burmah Castrol*   100   Scotland     Lubricants
Algeria              
BP Amoco Exploration (In Amenas)   100   Scotland     Exploration and production
BP Exploration (El Djazair)   100   Bahamas     Exploration and production
Angola              
BP Exploration (Angola)   100   England     Exploration and production
Australia              
BP Australia   100   Australia     Integrated oil operations
BP Australia Capital Markets   100   Australia     Finance
BP Developments Australia   100   Australia     Exploration and production
BP Finance Australia   100   Australia     Finance
Azerbaijan              
Amoco Caspian Sea Petroleum   100   British Virgin Islands     Exploration and production
BP Exploration (Caspian Sea)   100   England     Exploration and production
Canada              
BP Canada Energy   100   Canada     Exploration and production
BP Canada Finance   100   Canada     Finance
Egypt              
BP Egypt Co.   100   US     Exploration and production
BP Egypt Gas Co.   100   US     Exploration and production
France              
BP France   100   France     Refining and marketing and petrochemicals
Germany              
Deutsche BP   100   Germany     Refining and marketing and petrochemicals
Veba Oil   100   Germany     Refining and marketing and petrochemicals

81


Subsidiary undertakings

  %
  Country of incorporation

  Principal activities

Netherlands              
BP Capital   100   Netherlands     Finance
BP Nederland   100   Netherlands     Refining and marketing
New Zealand              
BP Oil New Zealand   100   New Zealand     Marketing
Norway              
BP Norge   100   Norway     Exploration and production
Spain              
BP España   100   Spain     Refining and marketing
South Africa              
BP Southern Africa*   75   South Africa     Refining and marketing
Trinidad              
BP Trinidad (LNG)   100   Netherlands     Exploration and production
BP Trinidad and Tobago   70   US     Exploration and production
UK              
BP Capital Markets   100   England     Finance
BP Chemicals   100   England     Petrochemicals
BP Oil UK   100   England     Refining and marketing
Britoil   100   Scotland     Exploration and production
Jupiter Insurance   100   Guernsey     Insurance
US              
Atlantic Richfield Co.   100   US      
BP America*   100   US      
BP America Production Company   100   US     Exploration and production,
BP Amoco Chemical Company   100   US     gas, power and renewables,
BP Company North America   100   US     refining and marketing,
BP Corporation North America   100   US     pipelines and petrochemicals
BP Products North America   100   US      
BP West Coast Products   100   US      
The Standard Oil Company   100   US      
BP Capital Markets America   100   US     Finance

82



ITEM 5 — OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW


GROUP OPERATING RESULTS

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million except per share amounts)

 
Turnover   285,059   232,571   178,721  
Profit for the year   15,731   10,482   6,795  
Exceptional items, net of tax   (1,076 ) (708 ) (1,043 )
   
 
 
 
Profit before exceptional items   14,655   9,774   5,752  
   
 
 
 
Profit for the year per ordinary share (cents)   72.08   47.27   30.33  
Dividends per ordinary share (cents)   29.45   26.00   24.00  

        On November 2, 2004, Solvay exercised its option to sell its interests in BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe and BP Solvay Polyethylene North America to BP. These ventures have been consolidated within the Group's results from this date.

        On February 1, 2002, BP acquired a 51% interest in and operational control of Veba. Veba has been fully consolidated within the Group's results from this date. The remaining 49% of Veba was acquired on June 30, 2002.

        Trading conditions in 2004 were affected by tight supplies in oil markets and by strong world economic growth.

        Average crude oil prices in nominal terms in 2004 were the highest for 20 years, driven by exceptionally strong global oil demand growth and the physical disruption to US oil operations caused by Hurricane Ivan. The Brent price averaged $38.27 per barrel, an increase of more than $9 per barrel over the $28.83 per barrel average seen in 2003, and varied between $29.13 and $52.03 per barrel.

        Natural gas prices in the US were also strong during 2004. The Henry Hub First of the Month Index averaged $6.13 per mmbtu, up by more than $0.70 per mmbtu compared with the 2003 average of $5.37 per mmbtu. Prices fell slightly relative to oil prices as the levels of gas in storage rose sharply. UK gas prices were also up strongly in 2004, averaging 24.39 pence per therm at the National Balancing Point compared with a 2003 average of 20.28 pence per therm.

        Refining margins averaged record highs in 2004, despite weakening towards the end of the year. This reflected strong oil demand growth and record refinery throughput levels. Retail margins weakened in 2004, as rising product prices and price volatility made their impact in a competitive marketplace.

        In Petrochemicals, generally improved market conditions led to a gradual increase in both volumes and margins through the year. Such gains were, however, partially offset by high and volatile energy and feedstock prices, together with adverse foreign exchange impacts.

        Trading conditions in 2003 were affected by tight supplies in oil and gas markets and by the early signs of a world economic recovery, following two years of below-trend growth.

        Average crude oil prices in 2003 were driven by supply disruptions in Venezuela, Nigeria and Iraq, OPEC market management and a recovery in oil demand growth following three exceptionally weak years. The Brent price averaged $28.83 per barrel, an increase of almost $4 per barrel over the $25.03 per barrel average seen in 2002 and moved in a range between $22.88 and $34.73 per barrel.

        Natural gas prices in the USA were also exceptionally strong during 2003. The Henry Hub First of the Month index averaged $5.37 per mmbtu, up by more than $2 per mmbtu compared with the 2002 average of $3.22 per mmbtu. A combination of cold first quarter weather and weak domestic production

83



kept working gas inventories relatively low for much of the year. UK gas prices were also up strongly in 2003, averaging 20.28 pence per therm at the National Balancing Point versus a 2002 average of 15.78 pence per therm.

        Refining margins weakened somewhat towards the end of the year but were above historical average levels for 2003 as a whole, reflecting low commercial product inventories in key US and European markets. Retail margins for the year were relatively strong, especially in the US and Europe. Petrochemicals margins remained depressed in 2003, coming under pressure from high feedstock prices.

        The trading environment was challenging during 2002, with natural gas prices and refining margins significantly weaker than in the previous year, owing to the global economic slowdown. Demand improved in most parts of the business after the first half of the year but economic conditions remained sluggish. The adverse business conditions had the greatest impact on Refining and Marketing. Worldwide refining margins were depressed for much of the year, at nearly half the average level of 2001. Margins in Petrochemicals were at levels similar to the bottom of previous cycles.

        Oil prices were volatile in 2002. The Brent price ranged from around $18 per barrel to above $31 per barrel. The crude oil price increased during the second half of the year, partly reflecting a 'war premium'. Brent prices averaged $25.03 per barrel compared with $24.44 per barrel in 2001. Natural gas prices in the USA were on average lower than in 2001, at around $3.36 per mmbtu compared with $3.96 per mmbtu, owing to a large surplus of natural gas in storage during the 2001-2002 heating season. Cold weather and the start of a decline in domestic production in the USA brought about a rise in price to around $5 per mmbtu towards the end of 2002.

        Hydrocarbon production for subsidiaries decreased by 7.2% in 2004, reflecting a decrease of 8.4% for liquids and a decrease of 5.8% for natural gas. The decrease includes 95 mboe/d impact of divestments. Hydrocarbon production for equity-accounted entities increased by 101.8% reflecting an increase of 108% for liquids and an increase of 69% for natural gas. This includes an increase of 108 mboe/d from the TNK-BP share of Slavneft from January 2004.

        Hydrocarbon production for subsidiaries decreased by 6% in 2003, reflecting a decrease of 8.6% for liquids and a decrease of 2.8% for natural gas. The decrease reflects the 135 mboe/d impact of divestments. Hydrocarbon production for equity-accounted entities increased by 87%, reflecting an increase of 101% for liquids and an increase of 36% for natural gas. The increase reflects the inclusion of 205 mboe/d volumes incremental to Sidanco from August 29, 2003.

        The increase in turnover (before the elimination of sales between businesses) for 2004 includes approximately $14 billion from higher sales prices related to gas, power, NGLs and crude oil over-the-counter forward contracts, approximately $47 billion from higher prices related to marketing and other sales (spot and term contracts, petrochemicals products, oil and gas realizations and other sales), approximately $7 billion from higher volumes of gas, power, NGLs and crude oil over-the-counter forward contracts and $8 billion from foreign exchange movements due to sales in local currencies being translated into the US dollar. This was partly offset by a net decrease of approximately $16 billion from lower volumes of marketing and other sales and a decrease of around $3 billion related to lower production volumes.

        The increase in turnover (before the elimination of sales between businesses) for 2003 principally includes approximately $16 billion from higher sales prices related to gas, power, NGLs and crude oil over-the-counter forward contracts, approximately $28 billion from higher prices related to marketing and other sales (spot and term contracts, petrochemicals products, oil and gas realizations and other sales), approximately $8 billion from higher volumes of gas, power, NGLs and crude oil over-the-counter forward contracts, approximately $2 billion from higher volumes of marketing and other sales and

84



approximately $8 billion from foreign exchange movements due to sales in local currencies being translated into the US dollar.

        Under UK GAAP, over-the-counter crude oil, gas, power and NGL forward contracts are reported gross in the income statement, whereas under US GAAP, they are reported net in the income statement. Adjusting for transactions which under US GAAP should be reported net reduces revenues by $82 billion, $59 billion and $33 billion for the years 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively. On this basis, US GAAP revenues were $203 billion, $174 billion and $146 billion for 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively. There is a compensating reduction in cost of sales such that the overall result is unchanged. Under UK and US GAAP, changes in the fair value of exchange traded commodity derivatives and OTC options, swaps and forwards are reported net in the income statement. See Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 50 on page F-103.

        Profit for 2004 was $15,731 million including inventory holding gains of $1,643 million and net exceptional gains after tax of $1,076 million in respect of the sale of fixed assets and businesses or termination of operations. Inventory holding gains or losses represent the difference between the cost of sales calculated using the average cost of supplies incurred during the year and the cost of sales calculated using the first-in first-out method. The result for 2004 includes:

        Refer to Environmental Expenditure in this Item on page 97 for more information on environmental charges.

        Profit for 2003 was $10,482 million including inventory holding gains of $16 million and net exceptional gains after tax of $708 million in respect of net profits on the sale of fixed assets and businesses or termination of operations. The result for 2003 includes:

85


        Profit for 2002 was $6,795 million including inventory holding gains of $1,104 million and net exceptional gains after tax of $1,043 million in respect of net profits on the sale of fixed assets and businesses or termination of operations. The result for 2002 includes:

        In addition to the factors above, the increase in the 2004 result compared with 2003 primarily reflects higher liquids and gas realizations, higher refining margins with some offset from lower marketing margins, higher petrochemicals margins, higher contributions from the natural gas liquids and solar businesses and the impact of higher oil and gas production volumes. These increases were partly offset by higher costs and portfolio impacts.

        In addition to the factors above, the increase in the 2003 result compared with 2002 primarily reflects higher oil and gas prices, higher refining and marketing margins and higher production. Further information on the impact of these factors and others on our results is included in the Business Operating Results section following.

        Profits and margins for the Group and for individual business segments can vary significantly from period to period as a result of changes in such factors as oil prices, natural gas prices, refining margins and petrochemicals feedstock prices. Accordingly, the results for the current and prior periods do not necessarily reflect trends, nor do they provide indicators of results for future periods.

        Employee numbers decreased from 115,250 at December 31, 2002 to 103,700 at December 31, 2003 to 102,900 at December 31, 2004. The decrease in 2003 resulted from the disposal of Fosroc Mining

86



(20%), the reduction of service station staff in the US (20%), the transfer of employees in Russia into TNK-BP (17%) and reorganization of Refining and Marketing operations in Germany (16%).

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
Capital expenditure and acquisitions

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Exploration and Production   9,839   9,576   9,226  
Refining and Marketing   2,887   3,006   2,682  
Petrochemicals   929   775   810  
Gas, Power and Renewables   538   441   375  
Other businesses and corporate   215   188   210  
   
 
 
 
Capital expenditure   14,408   13,986   13,303  
Acquisitions   2,841   6,026   5,790  
   
 
 
 
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   17,249   20,012   19,093  
Disposals   (5,048 ) (6,432 ) (6,782 )
   
 
 
 
Net Investment   12,201   13,580   12,311  
   
 
 
 

        Capital expenditure and acquisitions in 2004, 2003 and 2002 amounted to $17,249 million, $20,012 million and $19,093 million, respectively. Acquisitions during 2004 included $1,354 million for including TNK's interest in Slavneft within TNK-BP and $1,355 million for the acquisition of Solvay's interests in BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe and BP Solvay Polyethylene North America. Acquisitions in 2003 included $5,794 million for the acquisition of our interest in TNK-BP. Acquisitions during 2002 included $5,038 million for Veba, an additional 15% interest in Sidanco and several minor acquisitions. Excluding acquisitions, capital expenditure for 2004 was $14,408 million compared with $13,986 million in 2003 and $13,303 million in 2002.

Exceptional Items

        For 2004, net exceptional gains, consisting of the profit or loss on sale of fixed assets and businesses or termination of operations, were $815 million before tax ($1,076 million after tax). The major elements of the profit on sale of fixed assets of $1,829 million relate to the divestment of the Group's interests in PetroChina and Sinopec, the divestment of interests in oil and natural gas properties in Australia, Canada and the Gulf of Mexico, the reversal of the provision for the loss on sale of $217 million for the Desarrollo Zuli Occidental (DZO) and Boqueron fields in Venezuela (see Exploration and Production in this Item on page 90), the sale of the Cushing and other pipeline interests in the US, and the divestment of BP's interests in two natural gas liquids plants in Canada. The churn of retail assets and other minor divestments also contributed to the gain. The loss on sale of businesses or termination of operations for 2004 of $695 million primarily relates to the sale of the speciality intermediate chemicals business, the sale of the Fabrics and Fibres business, the closure of two petrochemicals manufacturing plants at Hull, UK, the closure of the linear alpha-olefins production facility at Pasadena, Texas, the closure of the lubricants operation of the Coryton refinery in the UK and the closure of refining operations at the ATAS refinery in Mersin, Turkey. The loss of sale of fixed assets of $319 million included the sale of interests in oil and natural gas properties in Indonesia and Gulf of Mexico, the divestment of our interest in the Singapore Refining Company Private Limited and retail churn.

        Net exceptional gains were $831 million before tax ($708 million after tax) in 2003. The major elements of the profit on sale of fixed assets of $1,894 million relate to the divestment of a further 20% interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC to Repsol and the sale of the Group's 96.14% interest in the Forties oil field in the UK North Sea. The sale of a package of UK Southern North Sea gas fields, the divestment of our interest in the In Amenas gas condensate project in Algeria to Statoil and the disposal

87



of BP's interest in PT Kaltim Prima Coal also contributed to the profit on disposal. The loss on sale of fixed assets of $1,035 million includes losses on exploration and production properties in China, Norway and the US, the loss on the sale of refining and marketing assets in Germany and Central Europe and the provision for losses on sale in early 2004 of exploration and production properties in Canada and Venezuela. The loss on sale of businesses or termination of operations for 2003 of $28 million relates to the sale of our European oil speciality products business.

        For 2002, net exceptional gains were $1,168 million before tax ($1,043 million after tax). The major part of the profit on the sale of fixed assets during 2002 arises from the divestment of the Group's shareholding in Ruhrgas. The other significant elements of the profit for the year are the gain on the redemption of certain preferred limited partnership interests BP retained following the Altura Energy common interest disposal in 2000 in exchange for BP loan notes held by the partnership, the profit on the sale of the Group's interest in the Colonial pipeline in the US and the profit on the sale of a US downstream electronic payment system. The profit on the sale of businesses relates mainly to the disposal of the Group's retail network in Cyprus and the UK contract energy management business. The major element of the loss on sale of fixed assets for the year relates to provisions for losses on sale of exploration and production properties in the US announced in early 2003. For 2002 the loss on sale of businesses or termination of operations relates to the disposal of our plastic fabrications business, the sale of the former Burmah Castrol speciality chemicals business Fosroc Construction, our withdrawal from solar thin film manufacturing and the provision for the loss on divestment of the former Burmah Castrol speciality chemicals businesses Sericol and Fosroc Mining.

Interest Expense and Other Finance Expense

        Interest expense comprises Group interest less amounts capitalized together with interest related to equity-accounted entities. Interest expense in 2004 was $642 million compared with $644 million in 2003 and $1,067 million in 2002. These amounts included charges arising from early bond redemption of $31 million in 2003 and $15 million in 2002. The charge for 2004 reflects lower interest rates and lower debt buyback costs compared with 2003 offset by the inclusion of a full year's equity accounted interest for the TNK-BP joint venture. The charge in 2003 reflects lower interest rates and lower debt compared with 2002.

        Other finance expense includes net pension finance costs, the interest accretion on provisions and interest accretion on the deferred consideration for the acquisition of investment in TNK-BP. Other finance expense in 2004 was $357 million compared with $547 million in 2003 and $73 million in 2002. The decrease in 2004 compared with 2003 primarily reflects a reduction in net pension finance costs partly offset by a revaluation of environmental and other provisions at a lower discount rate and the inclusion of a full year's charge for interest accretion on the deferred consideration for the investment in TNK-BP. The increase in 2003 compared with 2002 reflects an increase in net pension finance costs.

Taxation

        The charge for corporate taxes in 2004 was $8,282 million, compared with $6,111 million in 2003 and $4,317 million in 2002. The effective rate was 34% in 2004, 36% in 2003 and 39% in 2002. The lower rate in 2004 compared with 2003 reflects the significantly higher inventory holding gain in 2004 as well as the low tax charge on the exceptional gains reported in 2004. The lower rate in 2003 compared with 2002 reflects tax restructuring benefits in 2003, as well as the rateably lower impact of goodwill amortization and depreciation on uplifted asset values (for which no tax deduction is available) on higher income in 2003. The tax rate in 2002 additionally reflected the inclusion of a $355 million charge to increase the North Sea deferred tax provision for the supplementary UK tax, and these combined effects more than offset the impact of higher inventory holding gains in 2002 compared with 2003.

88



Business Operating Results

        Total operating profit, which is before interest expense, other finance expense, taxation, minority interests and exceptional items, was $24,427 million in 2004, $17,123 million in 2003 and $11,161 million in 2002.

Exploration and Production

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
   
  2004

  2003

  2002

Turnover   ($ million)   34,914   30,753   25,083
       
 
 
Profit before interest and tax   ($ million)   18,530   14,669   8,280
Exceptional (gains) losses   ($ million)   (152 ) (913 ) 726
       
 
 
Total operating profit   ($ million)   18,378   13,756   9,006
       
 
 
Results included:                
  Exploration expense   ($ million)   637   542   644
Key statistics:                
  Average BP crude oil realizations (a)   ($ per barrel)   36.45   28.23   24.06
  Average BP NGL realizations (a)   ($ per barrel)   26.75   19.26   12.85
  Average BP liquids realizations (a) (b)   ($ per barrel)   35.39   27.25   22.69
  Average West Texas Intermediate oil price   ($ per barrel)   41.49   31.06   26.14
  Average Brent oil price   ($ per barrel)   38.27   28.83   25.03
  Average BP US natural gas realizations (a)   ($ per thousand cubic feet)   5.11   4.47   2.63
  Average Henry Hub gas price (c)   ($/mmbtu)   6.13   5.37   3.22
Total liquids production for subsidiaries (b) (d)   (mb/d)   1,480   1,615   1,766
Total liquids production for equity-accounted entities (b) (d)   (mb/d)   1,051   506   252
Natural gas production for subsidiaries (d)   (mmcf/d)   7,624   8,092   8,324
Natural gas production for equity-accounted entities (d)   (mmcf/d)   879   521   383
Total production for subsidiaries (d) (e)   (mboe/d)   2,795   3,011   3,201
Total production for equity-accounted entities (d) (e)   (mboe/d)   1,202   595   318

(a)
The Exploration and Production business does not undertake any hedging activity. Consequently, realizations reflect the market price achieved.

(b)
Crude oil and NGL.

(c)
Henry Hub First of Month Index.

(d)
Net of royalties.

(e)
Expressed in thousands of barrels of oil equivalent per day (mboe/d). Natural gas is converted to oil equivalent at 5.8 billion cubic feet: 1 million barrels.

        Turnover for 2004 was $35 billion compared with $31 billion in 2003 and $25 billion in 2002. The increase in 2004 reflected higher liquids and gas realizations of around $7 billion with an offset of around $3 billion due to lower production volumes (for subsidiaries) as a result of divestment activity in 2003. The increase in 2003 reflected the impact of higher liquids and natural gas realizations of approximately $7 billion with an offset of around $1 billion as a result of a decrease in production volumes in the USA and UK following divestments.

        Total production for 2004 was 2,795 mboe/d for subsidiaries and 1,202 mboe/d for equity-accounted entities, compared with 3,011 mboe/d and 595 mboe/d, respectively, in the prior period. For

89



subsidiaries, the 7.2% decrease includes 95 mboe/d impact of divestments and for equity-accounted entities the increase of 101.8% includes an increase of 108 mboe/d from the TNK-BP share of Slavneft from January 2004.

        Profit before interest and tax for 2004 includes net exceptional gains of $152 million which includes the reversal of a previously reported exceptional loss on disposal in respect of our interests in Desarrollo Zuli Occidental (DZO) and Boqueron in Venezuela (as a result of the lapse of the sales agreement we retained our interests in the fields), losses on the divestment of our interest in the Kangean Production Sharing Contract and our participating interest in the Muriah Production Sharing Contract, a gain on the sale of our interest in Swordfish in the deepwater Gulf of Mexico, a gain on the sale of 5.3% of our reserves in the North West Shelf in Australia and net losses resulting from the sale of various other upstream assets. Profit before interest and tax for 2003 includes net exceptional gains of $913 million, which includes a gain on the sale of the UK North Sea Forties oil field together with a package of shallow-water assets in the Gulf of Mexico, a gain resulting from Repsol's exercise of its option to acquire a further 20% interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC and net losses resulting from the sale of various other upstream assets. Profit before interest and tax for 2002 includes net exceptional losses of $726 million, which includes a gain resulting from the redemption of certain preferred partnership interests BP retained following the disposal in 2000 of the Altura Energy common interest in exchange for BP loan notes held by the partnership and net losses on the disposal of various other upstream interests.

        Total operating profit for 2004 was $18,378 million including inventory holding gains of $10 million and is after an impairment charge of $267 million in respect of fields in the deepwater Gulf of Mexico and US Onshore, an impairment charge of $60 million in respect of the partner operated Temsah platform in Egypt following a blow-out, a charge of $35 million in respect of Alaskan tankers that are no longer required, an impairment charge of $108 million in respect of a gas processing plant in the USA and a field in the Gulf of Mexico Shelf and an impairment charge of $186 million related to our interests in DZO and Boqueron in Venezuela. We previously reported an exceptional loss on disposal of $217 million in respect of these assets; however, the sales agreement has lapsed and we will retain our interests in the fields. As a result of the lapse of the agreement, the exceptional loss was reversed and an impairment charge was recognized in the first quarter of 2004.

        Total operating profit for 2003 was $13,756 million including inventory holding gains of $3 million. The result for 2003 includes an impairment charge of $296 million related to four assets in the Gulf of Mexico Shelf following technical reassessments and reevaluation of future investments options; an impairment charge of $133 million related to the Miller field in the UK following a decision not to proceed with waterflood and gas import options; an impairment charge of $108 million related to the Kepodang field in Indonesia; an impairment charge of $105 million related to the Yacheng field in China; and a $49 million write-down of the Viscount asset in the North Sea. Although all of these fields continue in operation, BP has disposed of its interest in the Kepodang field in 2004. Additionally, there were restructuring charges of $117 million in respect of ongoing restructuring activities in the UK and North America.

        Total operating profit for 2002 was $9,006 million including inventory holding gains of $3 million. The result for 2002 includes a charge of $1,091 million related to the impairments of Shearwater in the North Sea, Rhourde El Baguel in Algeria, LL652 and Boqueron in Venezuela, Pagerungan in Indonesia and Badami in Alaska, following full technical reassessments and reevaluations of future investment opportunities. All these fields continued in operation. In addition, there were restructuring charges of $184 million relating to significant restructuring to reposition the business in North America and the North Sea, $94 million for the write-off of our Gas-to-Liquids demonstration plant in Alaska and $55 million of litigation costs. The restructuring costs comprised $145 million of severance, $19 million repatriation and other costs of $20 million, which were mostly settled in 2002.

        The primary reasons for the increase in operating profit for 2004 compared with 2003 are higher liquids and gas realizations of around $5,150 million combined with an increase of $400 million due to higher volumes, partly offset by adverse foreign exchange impacts and inflationary pressures of around $350 million and higher costs of around $650 million. Operating profit for 2004 includes a charge of $191 million, reflecting an increase in the provision for unrealized profit in inventory compared with a charge of $61 million in 2003.

90


        The primary reasons for the increase in operating profit in 2003 compared with 2002 are higher natural gas realizations partly offset by higher costs and other factors. Higher natural gas realizations contributed $5,400 million to operating profit. This was offset by an increase of approximately $790 million in the charge for depreciation and an increase in other costs of around $340 million. Lower production volumes in the USA and the UK reduced profit by approximately $100 million and the net impact of acquisitions and divestments was a further reduction of about $100 million. Exploration expense was $102 million lower in 2003 compared with 2002. Operating profit for 2003 includes a charge of $61 million reflecting an increase in the provision for unrealized profit in inventory compared with a charge of $154 million in 2002.

        Total hydrocarbon production for 2003 was 3,010 mboe/d for subsidiaries and 596 mboe/d for equity-accounted entities compared with 3,201 mboe/d and 252 mboe/d, respectively, in 2002. For subsidiaries this includes the 135 mboe/d impact of divestments and for equity-accounted entities reflects the inclusion of 205 mboe/d volumes incremental to Sidanco, from August 29, 2003.

Refining and Marketing

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
   
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
Turnover (a)   ($ million)   179,587   149,477   125,836  
       
 
 
 
Profit before interest and tax   ($ million)   5,967   2,270   2,582  
Exceptional (gains) losses   ($ million)   117   213   (613 )
       
 
 
 
Total operating profit   ($ million)   6,084   2,483   1,969  
       
 
 
 

Global Indicator Refining Margin (b)

 

($/bbl)

 

6.08

 

3.88

 

2.11

 

Refining availability (c)

 

(%)

 

95.4

 

95.5

 

96.1

 
Refinery throughputs   (mb/d)   2,976   3,097   3,103  
Total marketing sales   (mb/d)   4,002   3,969   4,180  

(a)
Excludes BP's share of joint venture turnover of $594 million in 2004, $453 million in 2003 and $415 million in 2002.

(b)
The Global Indicator Refining Margin is the average of six regional industry indicator margins which we weight for BP's crude refining capacity in each region. Each regional indicator margin is based on a single representative crude with product yields characteristic of the typical level of upgrading complexity. The refining margins are industry specific rather than BP specific measures, which we believe are useful to investors in analysing trends in the industry and their impact on our results. The margins are calculated by BP based on published crude oil and product prices and take account of fuel utilization and catalyst costs. No account is taken of BP's other cash and non-cash costs of refining, such as wages and salaries and plant depreciation. The indicator margin may not be representative of the margins achieved by BP in any period because of BP's particular refining configurations and crude and product slate.

(c)
Refining availability is the weighted average percentage of the period that refinery units are available for processing, after accounting for downtime such as turnarounds.

91


        The changes in turnover are explained in more detail below:-

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
   
  2004

  2003

  2002

Sale of crude oil through spot and term contracts   ($ million)   25,027   23,915   18,150
Sale of crude oil, through over-the-counter forward contracts   ($ million)   18,485   14,098   11,599
Marketing, spot and term sales of refined products   ($ million)   124,458   102,003   87,520
Other sales including non-oil and to other segments   ($ million)   11,617   9,461   8,567
       
 
 
        179,587   149,477   125,836
       
 
 
Sale of crude oil through spot and term contracts   (mb/d)   2,505   2,553   2,659
Sale of crude oil through over-the-counter forward contracts   (mb/d)   1,303   1,284   1,276
Marketing, spot and term sales of refined products   (mb/d)   6,398   6,688   6,563

        Turnover for 2004 was $180 billion compared with $149 billion in 2003 and $126 billion in 2002. The increase in turnover in 2004 compared with 2003 was principally due to an increase of around $23 billion in marketing, spot and term sales of refined products. This was due to higher prices of $28 billion and a positive foreign exchange impact due to a weaker dollar of $8 billion, offset by lower volumes of $13 billion. Additionally, sales of crude oil, spot and term contracts increased by $1 billion due to higher prices of $2 billion partly offset by lower volumes of $1 billion; and sales of crude oil through over-the-counter forward contracts increased by $4 billion and other sales increased by $2 billion, primarily due to higher prices. The $24 billion increase in turnover in 2003 compared to 2002 was primarily due to due an increase in marketing, spot and term sales of refined products of around $15 billion. This was due to higher prices of $5 billion, a positive foreign exchange impact due to a weaker dollar of $8 billion and higher volumes of $2 billion. Additionally, sales of crude oil, spot and term contracts increased by $6 billion due to higher prices of $7 billion, partly offset by lower volumes of $1 billion. Sales of crude oil through over-the-counter forward contracts increased by $2 billion primarily due to higher prices and other sales increased by around $1 billion, primarily due to higher volumes.

        For both UK and US GAAP spot and term contracts are reported gross in the income statement except where transactions have been determined to be agency arrangements. Under UK GAAP, over-the-counter crude oil forward contracts are reported gross in the income statement, whereas under US GAAP, they are reported net in the income statement. Adjusting for transactions which under US GAAP should be reported net reduces revenues by $22.1 billion, $15.8 billion and $11.6 billion for the years 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively. On this basis, US GAAP sales were $157.5 billion, $133.7 billion and $114.2 billion for 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively. There is a compensating reduction in the segment cost of sales such that the overall segment result is unchanged. Under UK and US GAAP, changes in the fair value of exchange traded commodity derivatives and OTC options, swaps and forwards are reported net in the income statement. See Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 50 on page F-103.

        Refer to Item 4 — Information on the Company — Refining and Marketing on page 44 for further information.

        Profit before interest and tax for 2004 includes net exceptional losses of $117 million which includes a gain on disposal of the Cushing to Chicago Pipeline in the US, and losses on the disposal of our interest in the Singapore Refining Company Private Limited and the closure of the lubricants operation of the Coryton Refinery in the UK. Profit before interest and tax for 2003 includes net exceptional losses of $213 million resulting from a number of disposals which primarily relate to retail assets. Profit before interest and tax for 2002 includes net exceptional gains of $613 million which include gains on the sale of our interest in Colonial Pipeline and a US downstream electronic payment system, along with a number of smaller items.

92



        Total operating profit for 2004 was $6,084 million, including inventory holding gains of $1,245 million, and is after charging $206 million in relation to new, and revision to existing, environmental and other provisions. The Group undertakes an annual review of its environmental provisions in relation to current and former refinery, retail and other sites taking account of new legislation and emerging industry practice.

        Total operating profit for 2003 was $2,483 million after inventory holding losses of $48 million and is after Veba integration costs of $287 million, a $369 million charge in relation to new, and revisions to existing, environmental and other provisions, and a credit of $10 million arising from the reversal of restructuring provisions.

        Total operating profit for 2002 was $1,969 million including inventory holding gains of $1,049 million and is after a credit related to business interruption insurance proceeds of $184 million, as well as charges of $348 million related to Veba integration, $132 million restructuring costs, $62 million costs associated with an Olympic pipeline incident in 1999, a $35 million write-down of retail assets in Venezuela and $22 million settlement costs associated with a pre-acquisition Atlantic Richfield Company US MTBE supply contract.

        The increase in operating profit for 2004 compared with 2003 is primarily due to stronger refining margins contributing approximately $3,100 million, offset by a decrease in marketing margins of approximately $400 million, the impact of weaker US dollar of approximately $250 million and charges of around $310 million related primarily to a review of carrying value of fixed and current marketing assets. The increase was further offset by higher purchased energy costs of around $100 million and portfolio impacts of around $100 million. Refining throughputs at 2,976 kb/d were 4% lower than in 2003 due principally to the disposal of BP's interests in SRC, the closure of refining operations at the ATAS Refinery in Mersin, south eastern Turkey and the disposal of the Bayernoil refinery in Germany in the second quarter of 2003. Refining availability for the year was 95.4% compared with 95.5% in 2003 and marketing volumes were relatively flat compared with 2003.

        In addition to the factors above, operating profit for 2003 compared with 2002 reflects approximately $1,400 million from improved refining margins and approximately $600 million from marketing margins improvement. This was offset by adverse foreign exchange effects of around $100 million and additional portfolio impacts of around $150 million. Refining throughputs were relatively flat compared with 2002, with refining availability for the year at 95.5% in 2003 compared with 96.1% in 2002. Marketing volumes for 2003 were 4% lower than 2002, due to divestments.

        The integration of Veba, which began in February 2002, was essentially completed during 2003. The 2003 charges of $287 million relating to the Veba acquisition comprised some $46 million of severance costs, $37 million of other integration costs such as consulting, studies and internal project teams, $48 million of system infrastructure and application costs and the balance of $156 million related to additional synergy projects. 2003 cash outflows related to these charges were approximately $260 million.

        The 2002 charges of $348 million related to the Veba acquisition comprised $210 million of severance costs, $77 million of other integration costs such as consulting, studies and internal project teams, $24 million of system infrastructure and application costs, $22 million of office consolidation and relocation and $15 million of additional synergy projects. 2002 cash outflows related to these charges were approximately $140 million. The $132 million restructuring costs were associated with several restructuring and cost reduction initiatives during 2002 in different business units and support functions, primarily in the USA, Western Europe and in Africa. The largest single functional area affected was information technology. In Venezuela an impairment review was triggered by the current political crisis and poor business performance in 2002.

93



Petrochemicals

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
   
  2004

  2003

  2002

Turnover   ($ million)   21,209   16,075   13,064
       
 
 
Profit before interest and tax   ($ million)   (551 ) 623   191
Exceptional (gains) losses   ($ million)   563   (38 ) 256
       
 
 
Total operating profit   ($ million)   12   585   447
       
 
 
Chemicals Indicator Margin (a)   ($/te)   140   112   104
Production volumes (b)   (kte)   28,927   27,943   26,988

(a)
The Chemicals Indicator Margin (CIM) is a weighted average of externally based industry product margins. It is based on market data collected by Nexant in their quarterly market analyses, which we weight based on BP's product portfolio. While it does not cover our entire portfolio, it includes a broad range of products. Among the products and businesses covered in the CIM are the olefins and derivatives, the aromatics and derivatives, LAOs, acetic acid, vinyl acetate monomers and nitriles. Not included are fabrics and fibres, PAOs, anhydrides, speciality intermediates and the remaining parts of the solvents and acetyls businesses. CIM is an environmental trend indicator. Changes in CIM are indicative of market environment trends rather than representative of the actual margins achieved by BP in any particular period.

(b)
Includes BP share of joint ventures, associated undertakings and other interests in production.

        Turnover has increased from $13 billion in 2002 to $16 billion in 2003 and to $21 billion in 2004. The increase in turnover for 2004 compared with 2003 was attributable principally to an increase of around $4 billion from higher prices, and an increase of around $1 billion from higher sales volumes, primarily to Asia. The increase in turnover for 2003 compared with 2002 primarily reflects higher sales prices.

        Profit before interest and tax for 2004 includes net exceptional losses of $563 million associated largely with the closure of two plants at Hull, the sale of our Fabrics and Fibres business, the closure of the linear alpha-olefins production facility at Pasadena, Texas, the sale of our speciality intermediates businesses and the exit from the Baglan Bay site in the UK. Profit before interest and tax for 2003 includes net exceptional gains of $38 million resulting from a number of small transactions. Profit before interest and tax for 2002 includes net exceptional losses of $256 million, including a loss on the sale of our plastic fabrications business, a loss on the sale of Fosroc Construction, a loss associated with the closure of polypropylene capacity at Cedar Bayou, Texas and several other small transactions.

        Total operating profit for 2004 was $12 million including inventory holding gains of $349 million and is after a charge of $1,110 million in respect of asset impairments, a charge of $39 million in respect of restructuring and a charge of $58 million in respect of revisions to environmental and other provisions.

        Total operating profit for 2003 was $585 million including inventory holding gains of $55 million and is after a $36 million charge comprising a provision to cover future rental payments on surplus property, a charge of $20 million resulting from revisions to environmental and other provisions and a credit of $5 million resulting from a reduction in the provision for costs associated with the closure of polypropylene capacity in the USA.

        Total operating profit for 2002 was $447 million including inventory holding gains of $26 million and is after a $140 million write-down of our Indonesian manufacturing assets held for sale following a review of immediate prospects and opportunities for future growth in a highly competitive market,

94


costs of $81 million related to major site restructuring and Solvay and Erdölchemie integration and $29 million for restructuring our research and technology facilities.

        In addition to the factors above, operating profit for 2004 compared with 2003 reflects higher margins of approximately $660 million and higher sales volumes of approximately $190 million, offset partially by higher fixed costs, adverse foreign exchange impacts and portfolio change of approximately $560 million.

        In addition to the factors above, operating profit for 2003 reflects a decrease of around $180 million resulting from prolonged margin weakness, primarily in our European polymers business, a result from SARS-affected businesses in Asia that was approximately $60 million lower during the first half of the year and additional charges of $55 million related to additional depreciation from new plants, asset writedowns and provisions for bad debt, partly offset by an increase of $130 million due to higher sales volumes and lower fixed costs of around $60 million when compared to 2002.

        BP's share of production for 2004 was 28,927 thousand tonnes, up 4% on 2003 due to higher asset utilization and increased Asian PTA capacity during the year, with additional High Density Polyethylene capacity in the fourth quarter from the acquisition of the BP Solvay ventures. Production for 2003 was 27,943 thousand tonnes, up 3.5% on 2002 due to improved asset utilization across the business as well as new production capacity and increased ownership in our Asian associated undertakings.

Gas, Power and Renewables

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
   
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
Turnover   ($ million)   83,320   65,639   37,580  
       
 
 
 
Profit before interest and tax   ($ million)   982   576   2,020  
Exceptional (gains) losses   ($ million)   (56 ) 6   (1,551 )
       
 
 
 
Total operating profit   ($ million)   926   582   469  
       
 
 
 
Total natural gas sales volumes (a)   (mmcf/d)   31,690   30,439   24,852  

(a)
Includes marketing, trading and supply sales.

        The changes in turnover are explained in more detail below:

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
   
  2004

  2003

  2002

Gas marketing sales   ($ million)   13,532   12,929   9,401
Sale of gas through over-the-counter forward contracts   ($ million)   43,099   32,338   14,049
Sale of power through over-the-counter forward contracts   ($ million)   16,110   11,950   8,138
Sale of NGLs through over-the-counter forward contracts   ($ million)   2,251   416   40
Other sales (including NGL marketing)   ($ million)   8,328   8,006   5,952
       
 
 
    ($ million)   83,320   65,639   37,580
       
 
 
Gas marketing sales volumes   (mmcf/d)   5,244   5,881   5,840
Natural gas sales by Exploration and Production   (mmcf/d)   3,670   3,923   4,000
Sale of gas through over-the-counter forward contracts   (mmcf/d)   22,776   20,635   15,012
       
 
 
Total natural gas sales volumes   (mmcf/d)   31,690   30,439   24,852
       
 
 
Sale of power through over-the-counter forward contracts   (gwh/d)   1,162   1,012   650
Sale of NGLs through over-the-counter forward contracts   (mb/d)   188   32   3

95


        Turnover for 2004 was $83 billion compared with $66 billion in 2003. Gas marketing sales increased by $0.6 billion as price increases of $1.8 billion more than offset lower volumes of $1.2 billion. Sales of gas through over-the-counter forward contracts increased by $10.8 billion due to increased volumes of $3.0 billion and increased prices of $7.8 billion. The increase in sales of power through over-the-counter forward contracts of $4.2 billion related to higher prices of $2.4 billion and higher volumes of $1.8 billion and the increase in sales of NGLs through over-the-counter forward contracts of $1.8 billion primarily related to higher volumes. Finally, other sales (including NGL marketing) rose by $0.3 billion, of which $1.7 billion related to higher prices and $1.4 billion to lower volumes. Turnover for 2003 was $66 billion compared with $38 billion in 2002. Gas marketing sales increased by $3.5 billion primarily due to higher prices. Sales of gas through over-the-counter forward contracts increased by $18.3 billion due to higher prices of $14.5 billion and higher volumes of $3.8 billion. The increase of $3.8 billion in sales of power through over-the-counter forward contracts and the increase of $0.4 billion in sales of NGLs through over-the-counter forward contracts related primarily to higher volumes. Finally, other sales increased by around $2.0 billion primarily as a result of higher prices. Volumes of gas and power sold through over-the-counter forward contracts increased in 2003 and 2004 as operations grew both organically and through acquisition of smaller marketing and trading companies. Volumes of NGLs sold through over-the-counter forward contracts grew over the period as a result of incremental trading and wholesale activities in the US that were established in 2002 and grew significantly in 2004.

        Under UK and US GAAP spot and term contracts are reported gross in the income statement except where transactions have been determined to be agency arrangements. Under UK GAAP, sales of gas, power and NGLs through over-the-counter forward contracts are reported gross in the income statement, whereas under US GAAP they are reported net in the income statement. Adjusting for transactions which under US GAAP should be reported net reduces revenues by $59.5 billion, $43.1 billion and $21.1 billion for the years 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively. On this basis, US GAAP sales were $23.9 billion, $22.6 billion and $16.4 billion for 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively. There is a compensating reduction in the segment cost of sales such that the overall segment result is unchanged. Under UK and US GAAP, changes in the fair value of exchange traded commodity derivatives and OTC options, swaps and forwards are reported net in the income statement. See Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 50 on page F-103.

        Refer to Item 4 — Information on the Company — Gas, Power and Renewables on page 62 for further information.

        Profit before interest and tax for 2004 includes exceptional gains of $56 million from the disposal of BP's interests in NGL plants in Canada. Profit before interest and tax for 2003 includes net exceptional losses of $6 million resulting from several small transactions. Profit before interest and tax for 2002 includes net exceptional gains of $1,551 million that primarily relate to the disposal of our interest in Ruhrgas.

        Total operating profit for 2004 was $926 million including inventory holding gains of $39 million.

        Total operating profit for 2003 was $582 million including inventory holding gains of $6 million.

        Total operating profit for 2002 was $469 million including inventory holding gains of $51 million, and is after a charge of $30 million related to the impairment of a cogeneration power plant under construction in the UK. The impairment is the result of a significant fall in power prices in the UK over the previous two years.

        In addition to the factors above, the principal additional factors contributing to the increase in operating profit in 2004 compared with 2003 were a higher contribution from the natural gas liquids and solar businesses of approximately $350 million due to higher unit margins and higher volumes.

        In addition to the factors above, the increase in operating profit for 2003 compared with 2002 reflects improvement in the marketing and trading business. Marketing and trading results increased by

96



approximately $250 million with equal contributions from higher volumes and improved margins. Results for the LNG business also improved showing an increase of $90 million. This more than offset decreases of $70 million in the NGL business due to high natural gas prices relative to liquids prices in North America which led to lower sales volumes, the absence of any contribution from the Ruhrgas shareholding (sold in August 2002 and contributed $112 million in 2002) and a restructuring charge of $45 million in our Solar business.

Other Businesses and Corporate

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
   
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
Turnover   ($ million)   546   515   510  
Profit (loss) before interest and tax   ($ million)   314   (184 ) (744 )
Exceptional (gains) losses   ($ million)   (1,287 ) (99 ) 14  
Total operating loss   ($ million)   (973 ) (283 ) (730 )

        Other businesses and corporate comprises Finance, the Group's coal asset (divested October 2003), the Group's aluminium asset, its investments in PetroChina and Sinopec (both divested in early 2004), interest income and costs relating to corporate activities.

        The profit before interest and tax for 2004 includes exceptional gains of $1,287 million primarily related to the sale of our investment in PetroChina and our investment in Sinopec. The loss before interest and tax for 2003 includes net exceptional gains of $99 million, which includes a gain on the sale of our interest in PT Kaltim Prima Coal, an Indonesian coal mining company, partly offset by net losses on several small transactions. The loss before interest and tax in 2002 includes net exceptional losses of $14 million resulting from several small transactions.

        The net cost of Other businesses and corporate amounted to $973 million in 2004, $283 million in 2003 and $730 million in 2002. The operating loss for 2004 includes a charge of $225 million relating to new, and revisions to existing, environmental and other provisions, a charge of $102 million in respect of the separation of the Olefins and Derivatives business and a credit of $66 million primarily resulting from the reversal of vacant space provisions in the UK and the US. The operating loss for 2003 includes a charge of $193 million relating to new, and revisions to existing, environmental and other provisions, a credit of $648 million relating to a US medical plan and a charge of $74 million in respect of provisions for future rental payments on surplus leasehold properties. The operating loss for 2002 includes provisions of $140 million for future rentals on surplus leasehold property and a charge of $46 million for environmental liabilities in respect of a divested business.

Environmental Expenditure

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Operating expenditure   526   498   485
Clean-ups   25   45   49
Capital expenditure   524   546   548
New provisions for environmental remediation   588   515   312
New provisions for decommissioning   294   1,159   308

        Operating and capital expenditure on the prevention, control, abatement or elimination of air, water and solid waste pollution is often not incurred as a discrete identifiable transaction. Instead, it forms part of a larger transaction that includes, for example, normal maintenance expenditure. The

97



figures for environmental operating and capital expenditure in the table are therefore estimates, based on the definitions and guidelines of the American Petroleum Institute.

        Environmental operating and capital expenditures for 2004 were broadly in line with 2003. Similar levels of operating capital expenditures are expected in the foreseeable future. In addition to operating and capital expenditures, we also create provisions for future environmental remediation. Expenditure against such provisions is normally in subsequent periods and is not included in environmental operating expenditure reported for such periods. The charge for environmental remediation provisions in 2004 includes $484 million resulting from a reassessment of existing site obligations and $104 million in respect of provisions for new sites.

        Provisions for environmental remediation are made when clean-up is probable and the amount reasonably determinable. Generally, their timing coincides with commitment to a formal plan of action or, if earlier, on divestment or on closure of inactive sites.

        The extent and cost of future remediation programmes are inherently difficult to estimate. They depend on the scale of any possible contamination, the timing and extent of corrective actions and also the Group's share of liability. Although the cost of any future remediation could be significant and may be material to the result of operations in the period in which it is recognized, we do not expect that such costs will have a material effect on the Group's financial position or liquidity. We believe our provisions are sufficient for known requirements; and we do not believe that our costs will differ significantly from those of other companies (with similar assets) engaged in similar industries or that our competitive position will be adversely affected as a result.

        In addition, we make provisions to meet the cost of eventual decommissioning of our oil- and gas-producing assets and related pipelines and other assets where the fair value of the asset retirement obligation can be reasonably estimated. On installation of oil or natural gas production facility a provision is established which represents the discounted value of the expected future cost of decommissioning the asset. Additionally, we undertake periodic reviews of existing provisions. These reviews take account of revised cost assumptions, changes in decommissioning requirements and any technological developments.

        Provisions for environmental remediation and decommissioning are usually set up on a discounted basis, as required by Financial Reporting Standard No. 12, 'Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets'. Further details of decommissioning and environmental provisions appear in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 32 on page F-56. See also Item 4 — Information on the Company — Environmental Protection on page 73.

Insurance

        The Group generally restricts its purchase of insurance to situations where this is required for legal or contractual reasons. This is because external insurance is not considered an economic means of financing losses for the Group. Losses will therefore be borne as they arise rather than being spread over time through insurance premia with attendant transaction costs. The position will be reviewed periodically.

98



LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

Cash Flow

 
  Years ended December 31,
 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Net cash inflow from operating activities   28,554   21,698   19,342  
Dividends from joint ventures   1,908   131   198  
Dividends from associated undertakings   291   417   368  
Net cash outflow from servicing of finance and returns on investment   (342 ) (711 ) (911 )
Tax paid   (6,378 ) (4,804 ) (3,094 )
Net cash outflow for capital expenditure and financial investment   (8,712 ) (6,124 ) (9,628 )
Net cash outflow from acquisitions and disposals   (3,242 ) (3,548 ) (1,337 )
Equity dividends paid   (6,041 ) (5,654 ) (5,264 )
   
 
 
 
Net cash inflow (outflow) before financing   6,038   1,405   (326 )
   
 
 
 
Financing   6,777   1,129   (163 )
Management of liquid resources   132   (41 ) (220 )
Increase (decrease) in cash   (871 ) 317   57  
   
 
 
 
    6,038   1,405   (326 )
   
 
 
 

        Net cash inflow from operating activities increased to $28,554 million from $21,698 million in 2003, reflecting an increase in profit of $7,288 million, an increase in depreciation and amounts provided of $1,643 million and the absence of discretionary funding for the Group's pension plans of $2,533 million which was incurred in 2003. This was partially offset by an additional working capital requirement of $2,618 million and a higher share of profits of joint ventures and associated undertakings of $2,136 million. Net cash inflow from operating activities increased to $21,698 million in 2003 from $19,342 million in 2002, reflecting an increase in profit of $5,625 million partly offset by $2,533 million discretionary funding for the Group's pension plans, an additional working capital requirement of $1,091 million and higher share of profits of joint ventures and associated undertakings of $472 million.

        Dividends from joint ventures and associated undertakings were $2,199 million in 2004 compared with $548 million in 2003 and $566 million in 2002. The increase in 2004 compared with 2003 is primarily due to the dividend from TNK-BP. The decrease in 2003 compared with 2002 was related to the Ruhrgas and Altura transactions in 2002 partly offset by the dividend from TNK-BP in 2003.

        The net cash outflow from servicing of finance and returns from investments was $342 million in 2004, $711 million in 2003 and $911 million in 2002. The lower cash outflow in 2004 and 2003 is primarily due to lower interest payments. Additionally, interest received was higher in 2004.

        Tax paid increased to $6,378 million in 2004 from $4,804 million in 2003 and $3,094 million in 2002, primarily reflecting the increase in profits in each period.

        Net cash outflow for capital expenditure and financial investment amounted to $8,712 million in 2004 compared with $6,124 million in 2003 and $9,628 million in 2002. The increase in 2004 compared with 2003 reflects lower disposal proceeds of $1,930 million and an increase in payments for fixed assets of $667 million. The decrease in 2003 over 2002 reflects higher disposal proceeds of $3,783 million.

        Net cash outflow from acquisitions and disposals produced net cash outflows of $3,242 million in 2004, $3,548 million in 2003 and $1,337 million in 2002. The lower outflow in 2004 compared with 2003 reflects higher disposal proceeds of $546 million and increased acquisition spending of $191 million.

99



The higher outflow in 2003 compared with 2002 reflects lower disposal proceeds of $4,133 million and lower acquisition spending of $1,762 million.

        Overall net cash outflow for capital expenditure and acquisitions, net of disposals, was $11,954 million in 2004 compared with $9,672 million in 2003 and $10,965 million in 2002.

        Equity dividends paid have increased to $6,041 million in 2004 compared with $5,654 million in 2003 and $5,264 million in 2002. The increase in both years reflects the impact of the higher dividend per share, partly offset by share repurchases.

        Overall net cash inflow before financing was $6,038 million in 2004, $1,405 million in 2003 and was a net outflow of $326 million in 2002 as a result of the factors outlined above.

        Net cash inflow from Financing was $6,777 million in 2004 compared with $1,129 million in 2003 and an outflow of $326 million in 2002. The increases in 2004 and 2003 are primarily due to the repurchase of ordinary share capital. See Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 37 on page F-74.

        The Group has had significant levels of investment for many years. Investment, excluding acquisitions, was $14.4 billion in 2004, $14.0 billion in 2003 and $13.3 billion in 2002. Sources of funding are completely fungible, but the majority of the Group's funding requirements for new investment come from cash generated by existing operations. There has been little change in the Group's level of net debt, that is debt less cash and liquid resources; net debt was $20.3 billion at the end of 2002, $20.2 billion at the end of 2003 and was $21.6 billion at the end of 2004.

        Over the period 2000 to 2004 our cash inflows and outflows were balanced, with sources and uses both totalling $152 billion. Since 2000, the year in which we completed the purchase of Atlantic Richfield Company, the price of Brent has averaged $29.00/bbl, somewhat higher than was expected as the period opened. The following table summarizes the five year sources and uses of cash:

Sources

  $ billion

  Uses

  $ billion

Operating cash flow   112   Capital expenditure   66
Dividends from joint       Acquisitions   17
    ventures and associated       Servicing of finance and and    
    undertakings   5       returns on investments   4
Divestments   33   Tax paid   25
Movement in net debt   2   Share buybacks   14
        Dividends   26
   
     
    152       152
   
     

        Significant acquisitions made for cash were more than offset by divestitures. Net investment over the same period has averaged $10 billion per year. Dividends, which grew on average by 8.2% per year in dollar terms, used $26 billion. $14 billion was used for share repurchases. Finally, cash was used to strengthen the financial condition of certain of our pension funds.

Trend information

        Over the next three or four years we expect to see additional cash flows coming from three main sources:

100


        We expect capital expenditure, excluding acquisitions, to be around $14 billion in 2005; the exact level will depend on the level of the dollar and is subject to our ability to continue to offset normal underlying inflation of around 2% per annum. Refer to Item 4 for further information.

        Further out, for the medium term, a level of around $14 billion is a reasonable expectation.

        Total production for 2005 is estimated at an average of between 2.85 and 2.9 mmboe/d for subsidiaries and between 1.25 and 1.3 mmboe/d for equity accounted entities; these estimates are before any divestments and are based on our $20/bbl planning basis. The exact level will depend on oil prices, divestments and many other factors.

        The anticipated decline in production volumes from subsidiaries in our existing profit centres is partly mitigated by the development of new projects and the investment in incremental reserves in and around existing fields. We expect that this overall decline in production from subsidiaries in our existing profit centres will be more than compensated for by strong increases in production from subsidiaries in our new profit centres over the next few years. Production in our equity-accounted joint venture, TNK-BP, is also expected to grow over the next few years.

        The most important determinants of cash flows in relation to our oil and natural gas production are the prices of these commodities. In a stable price environment, cash flows from currently developed proved reserves are expected to decline in a manner consistent with anticipated production decline rates. Development activities associated with recent discoveries, as well as continued investment in these producing fields, are expected to more than offset this decline, resulting in increased operating cash flows over the next few years. Cash flows from equity-accounted entities are expected to be in the form of dividend payments.

Dividends and Other Distributions to Shareholders and Gearing

        Our dividend policy is to progressively grow the dividend. In pursuing this policy and in setting the levels of dividends we are guided by several considerations, including:

        Under UK GAAP our gearing band was 25-35%. Subsequent to the adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) from January 1, 2005, we reduced our gearing band from 25-35% to 20-30% in order to maintain the economic substance of our financial framework. This new band continues to give us an efficiently leveraged capital structure, and adequate protection against unforeseen events. This reduction brings the gearing band back to where it was, prior to the introduction of FRS19 in 2002.

101



        We remain committed to returning 100% of the excess of net cash inflow before equity dividends paid to our investors so long as oil prices remain above $20/bbl, all other things being appropriate. Though we could use some of the excess of net cash inflow before equity dividends paid, for example, for material acquisitions if we saw opportunities which fitted the strategy, but we see no such opportunities at present.

        We plan to continue our programme of share buybacks, subject to market conditions. Since the completion of the Atlantic Richfield acquisition in 2000 until the end of 2004 we have repurchased some 1,602 million shares at a cost of $13.5 billion, reducing the number of shares in issue (after accounting for the issuance of shares under employee stock programmes and to AAR in respect of TNK) by more than 5.2%. During the first quarter of 2005, we bought back 193 million shares, at a cost of $2 billion.

        The discussion above and following contains forward-looking statements with regard to future cash flows, future levels of capital expenditure and divestments, future production volumes, working capital, the renewal of borrowing facilities, shareholder distributions and share buybacks, expected payments under contractual and commercial commitments. These forward-looking statements are based on assumptions which management believes to be reasonable in the light of the Group's operational and financial experience, however, no assurance can be given that the forward-looking statements will be realized. You are urged to read the cautionary statement under Item 3 — Key Information — Forward-Looking Statements on page 13 and Item 3 — Key Information — Risk Factors on pages 11 and 12 which describe the risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results and developments to differ materially from those expressed or implied by these forward-looking statements. The Company provides no commitment to update the foward-looking statements or to publish financial projections for forward-looking statements in the future.

Financing the Group's Activities

        The Group's principal commodity, oil, is priced internationally in US dollars. Group policy has been to minimize economic exposure to currency movements by financing operations with US dollar debt wherever possible, otherwise by using currency swaps when funds have been raised in currencies other than US dollars.

        The Group's finance debt is almost entirely in US dollars and at December 31, 2004 amounted to $23,091 million (2003 $22,325 million) of which $10,184 million (2003 $9,456 million) was short term.

        Net debt was $21,607 million at the end of 2004, a decrease of $1,414 million compared with 2003. The ratio of net debt to net debt plus equity was 22% at the end of 2004 and 22% at the end of 2003.

        The maturity profile and fixed/floating rate characteristics of the Group's debt are described in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Notes 27 and 30 on pages F-43 and F-53, respectively.

        We have in place a European Debt Issuance Programme (DIP) under which the Group may raise $8 billion of debt for maturities of one month or longer. At June 28, 2005, the amount drawn down against the DIP was $5,987 million.

        In addition, the Group has in place a US Shelf Registration under which it may raise $6 billion of debt for maturities of one month or longer. At June 28, 2005 $5,475 million had been raised under the US Shelf Registration.

        Commercial paper markets in the USA and Europe are a primary source of liquidity for the Group. At December 31, 2004 the outstanding commercial paper amounted to $4,180 million (2003 $4,243 million).

        BP believes that, taking into account the substantial amounts of undrawn borrowing facilities available, the Group has sufficient working capital for foreseeable requirements.

102



        In addition to reported debt, BP uses conventional off balance sheet arrangements such as operating leases and borrowings in joint ventures and associated undertakings. At December 31, 2004 the Group's share of third party borrowings of joint ventures and associated undertakings was $2,821 million (2003 $2,151 million) and $1,048 million (2003 $922 million) respectively. These amounts are not reflected in the Group's debt on the balance sheet.

        The Group has issued third party guarantees under which amounts outstanding at December 31, 2004 are summarized below. Some guarantees outstanding are in respect of borrowings of joint ventures and associated undertakings noted above.

 
  Guarantees expiring by period

 
  Total

  2005

  2006

  2007

  2008

  2009

  2010 and
thereafter

 
  ($ million)

Guarantees issued in respect of:                            
Borrowings of joint ventures and associated undertakings   1,281   175   155   103   207   87   554
Liabilities of other third parties   650   138   71   352   40   10   39

        At December 31, 2004 contracts had been placed for authorized future capital expenditure estimated at $6,765 million. Such expenditure is expected to be financed largely by cash flow from operating activities. The Group also has access to significant sources of liquidity in the form of committed facilities and other funding through the capital markets. At December 31, 2004, the Group had available undrawn committed borrowing facilities of $4,500 million ($3,700 million at December 31, 2003).

Contractual Commitments

        The following table summarizes the Group's principal contractual obligations at December 31, 2004. Further information on borrowings and capital leases is given in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 30 on page F-53 and further information on operating leases is given in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 18 on page F-30.

 
  Payments due by period

Expected payments by period under
contractual obligations and
commercial commitments

  Total

  2005

  2006

  2007

  2008

  2009

  2010 and
thereafter

 
  ($ million)

Borrowings (a)   20,693   10,069   3,014   2,682   1,539   1,724   1,665
Capital lease obligations   4,752   152   254   258   268   280   3,540
Operating leases   8,354   1,483   1,106   944   858   754   3,209
Decommissioning liabilities   8,247   140   215   194   164   139   7,395
Environmental liabilities   2,620   517   499   428   322   205   649
Pensions (b)   21,707   967   959   954   946   938   16,943
Other postretirement benefits (c)   11,357   256   240   243   242   244   10,132
Purchase obligations (d)   95,204   65,635   9,852   3,736   2,623   2,317   11,041

(a)
Expected payments exclude interest payments on borrowings.

(b)
Represents the expected future contributions to funded pension plans and payments by the Group for unfunded pension plans.

(c)
Represents the expected future payments for postretirement benefits.

(d)
Represents any agreement to purchase goods or services that is enforceable and legally binding and that specifies all significant terms. The amounts shown include arrangements to secure long-term access to supplies of crude oil, natural gas, feedstocks and pipeline systems. In addition, the

103


        The following table summarizes the nature of the Group's unconditional purchase obligations.

 
  Payments due by period

   
Purchase obligations payments due by period

  Total

  2005

  2006

  2007

  2008

  2009

  2010 and
thereafter

 
  ($ million)

Crude oil and oil products   42,139   35,408   2,930   787   621   596   1,797
Natural gas   23,373   14,919   2,725   1,207   740   585   3,197
Chemicals and other refinery feedstocks   11,588   4,677   1,618   917   620   542   3,214
Utilities   11,928   8,825   1,618   239   172   173   901
Transportation   3,006   890   574   304   231   234   773
Use of facilities and services   3,170   916   387   282   239   187   1,159
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total   95,204   65,635   9,852   3,736   2,623   2,317   11,041
   
 
 
 
 
 
 

        The following table summarizes the Group's capital expenditure commitments at December 31, 2004 and the proportion of that expenditure for which contracts have been placed. The Group expects its total capital expenditure excluding acquisitions to be around $14 billion in 2005 and for the medium term.

Capital expenditure commitments
including amounts for which contracts
have been placed

  Total

  2005

  2006

  2007

  2008

  2009

  2010 and
thereafter

 
   
   
   
  ($ million)

   
   
Committed on major projects   16,860   7,185   3,693   2,301   1,309   860   1,512
Amounts for which contracts have been placed   6,765   4,381   1,510   610   159   91   14

Liquidity Risk

        Liquidity risk is the risk that suitable sources of funding for the Group's business activities may not be available. The Group has long-term debt ratings of Aa1 and AA+ assigned respectively by Moody's and Standard & Poor's.

        The Group has access to a wide range of funding at competitive rates through the capital markets and banks. It co-ordinates relationships with banks, borrowing requirements, foreign exchange requirements and cash management centrally. The Group believes it has access to sufficient funding, including through the commercial paper markets, and also has undrawn committed borrowing facilities to meet currently foreseeable borrowing requirements. At December 31, 2004, the Group had substantial amounts of undrawn borrowing facilities available, including committed facilities of $4,500 million expiring in 2005 ($3,700 million expiring in 2004). These facilities are with a number of international banks and borrowings under them would be at pre-agreed rates. The Group expects to renew the facilities on an annual basis. Certain of these facilities support the Group's commercial paper programme.

Credit Risk

        Credit risk is the potential exposure of the Group to loss in the event of non-performance by a counterparty. The credit risk arising from the Group's normal commercial operations is controlled by individual operating units within guidelines. In addition, as a result of its use of derivatives to manage market risk, the Group has credit exposures through its dealings in the financial and specialized oil, natural gas and power markets. The Group controls the related credit risk through credit approvals, limits, use of netting arrangements and monitoring procedures. Counterparty credit validation, independent of the dealers, is undertaken before contractual commitment.

104



OUTLOOK

        World economic growth was sustained across all regions into the second quarter of 2005, albeit at slightly lower rates than in 2004. The current outlook is for continued moderation of economic growth towards the long-term trend. Growth is expected to remain positive, if less synchronized, across all regions in 2005.

        Oil prices reached a further record average of $47.62 per barrel (dated Brent) in the first quarter and have increased further during the second quarter to date, averaging $51.50 (April 1 to close June 28). Total Russian industry production growth has slowed to 3% over the first five months 2005 but Chinese import growth has also slowed. Prices remain supported by limited spare production capacity even though OECD commercial inventories are above seasonal five year average levels. OPEC's decision in mid June to raise quotas by 500,000 b/d is unlikely to increase actual production significantly.

        US gas prices averaged $6.27/mmbtu (Henry Hub first of month index) in the first quarter and have increased during the second quarter, averaging $6.75/mmbtu (April 1 to June 28). US working gas inventories remain above year-earlier and five year average levels but the futures market continues to signal a supply-constained market.

        Refining margins averaged $5.94/bbl during the first quarter and have increased sharply to $8.49/bbl during the second quarter to date (April 1 to June 28). Margin levels in April were a record for any month since 1990. Gasoline appears well-supplied ahead of the driving season but the refining environment continues to be underpinned by robust demand growth and recently by concerns over distillate supply this coming winter.

        After a very weak first quarter, retail margins improved significantly during the first six weeks of the second quarter. From late May, rising crude and product prices have since dampened marketing margins, and the outlook remains volatile.

105



CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND NEW ACCOUNTING STANDARDS

UK Generally Accepted Accounting Policies

        BP prepares its financial statements in accordance with UK generally accepted accounting practice (UK GAAP). The Group's significant accounting policies are summarized in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 1 on Page F-10.

        The accounts for the year ended December 31, 2004 have been prepared using accounting policies consistent with those adopted in the preparation of the 2003 accounts, except for the change in accounting policy for pensions and other postretirement benefits and for shares held in employee share ownership plans for the benefit of employee share schemes.

        Segment information for 2003 has been restated to reflect the transfer of NGLs activities from Exploration and Production to Gas, Power and Renewables.

        Inherent in the application of many of the accounting policies used in the preparation of the financial statements is the need for BP management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities at the date of the accounts and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual outcomes could differ from the estimates and assumptions used. The following summary provides further information about the critical accounting policies that could have a significant impact on the results of the Group and should be read in conjunction with the Notes on Accounts.

        The accounting policies and areas that require the most significant judgements and estimates to be used in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements are in relation to oil and natural gas accounting, including the estimation of reserves; impairment; and provisions for deferred taxation, decommissioning, environmental liabilities, pensions and other postretirement benefits.

Accounting policy changes in 2004

        From January 1, 2004, BP changed its accounting policies for pensions and other postretirement benefits. In addition, BP also changed its accounting policy for shares held in employee share ownership plans for the benefit of employee share schemes.

        With effect from January 1, 2004, BP has adopted a new UK accounting standard: Financial Reporting Standard No. 17 'Retirement Benefits' (FRS 17). FRS 17 requires that the assets and liabilities arising from an employer's retirement benefit obligations and any related funding should be included in the financial statements at fair value and that the operating costs of providing retirement benefits to employees should be recognized in the income statement in the periods in which the benefits are earned by employees. This contrasts with SSAP 24, which requires the cost of providing pensions to be recognized on a systematic and rational basis over the period during which the employer benefits from the employee's services. The difference between the amount charged in the income statement and the amount paid as contributions into the pension fund is shown as a prepayment or provision on the balance sheet.

        Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract No. 38 'Accounting for Employee Share Ownership Plan (ESOP) Trusts' (Abstract No. 38) changes the presentation of an entity's own shares held in an ESOP trust from requiring them to be recognized as assets to requiring them to be deducted in arriving at shareholders' funds. Transactions in an entity's own shares by an ESOP trust are similarly recorded as changes in shareholders' funds and do not give rise to gains or losses. This treatment is in line with the accounting for purchases and sales of own shares set out in Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract No. 37 'Purchases and Sales of Own Shares' (Abstract 37).

106



        Abstract No. 37 requires a holding of an entity's own shares to be accounted for as a deduction in arriving at shareholders' funds, rather than being recorded as assets. Transactions in an entity's own shares are similarly recorded as changes in shareholders' funds and do not give rise to gains or losses. Abstract No. 37 applies where a company purchases treasury shares under new legislation that came into effect in December 2003.

        Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract No. 17 'Employee share schemes' (Abstract 17) was amended by Abstract No. 38 to reflect the consequences for the profit and loss account of the changes in the presentation of an entity's own shares held by an ESOP trust. Amended Abstract No. 17 requires that the minimum expense should be the difference between the fair value of the shares at the date of award and the amount that an employee may be required to pay for the shares (i.e. the 'intrinsic value' of the award). The expense was previously determined either as the intrinsic value or, where purchases of shares had been made by an ESOP trust at fair value, by reference to the cost or book value of shares that were available for the award.

        These changes in accounting policy have resulted in a prior year adjustment. BP shareholders' interest at January 1, 2002 has been reduced by $150 million, profit for the year ended December 31, 2002 decreased by $50 million and profit for the year ended December 31, 2003 increased by $215 million.

Oil and natural gas accounting

        Accounting for oil and gas exploration activity is subject to special accounting rules that are unique to the oil and gas industry. In the UK, these are contained in the Statement of Recommended Practice (SORP) 'Accounting for Oil and Gas Exploration, Development, Production and Decommissioning Activities'.

        The Group follows the successful efforts method of accounting for its oil and natural gas exploration and production activities.

        The acquisition of geological and geophysical seismic information, prior to the discovery of proved reserves, is expensed as incurred, similar to accounting for research and development costs.

        Licence and property acquisition costs are initially capitalized as unproved properties within intangible assets. These costs are amortized on a straight-line basis until such time as either exploration drilling is determined to be successful or it is unsuccessful and all costs are written off. Each property is reviewed on an annual basis to confirm that drilling activity is planned and it is not impaired. If no future activity is planned the remaining balance of the licence and property acquisition costs is written off.

        For exploration wells and exploratory-type stratigraphic test wells, costs directly associated with the drilling of wells are temporarily capitalized within intangible fixed assets, pending determination of whether potentially economic oil and gas reserves have been discovered by the drilling effort. These costs include employee remuneration, materials and fuel used, rig costs, delay rentals and payments made to contractors. The determination is usually made within one year after well completion, but can take longer, depending on the complexity of the geologic structure. If the well did not encounter potentially economic oil and gas quantities, the well costs are expensed as a dry hole and are reported in exploration expense. Exploration wells that discover potentially economic quantities of oil and gas and are in areas where major capital expenditure (e.g. offshore platform or a pipeline) would be required before production could begin, and where the economic viability of that major capital expenditure depends upon the successful completion of further exploration work in the area, remain capitalized on the balance sheet as long as additional exploration appraisal work is under way or firmly planned.

107



        For complicated offshore exploration discoveries, it is not unusual to have exploration wells and exploratory-type stratigraphic test wells remaining suspended on the balance sheet for several years while additional appraisal drilling and seismic work on the potential oil and gas field is performed or while the optimum development plans and timing are established. All such carried costs are subject to regular technical, commercial and management review, on at least an annual basis, to confirm the continued intent to develop, or otherwise extract value from, the discovery. If this is no longer the case, the costs are immediately expensed.

        Once a project is sanctioned for development, the carrying values of licence and property acquisition costs and exploration and appraisal costs are transferred to production assets within tangible assets.

        Field development costs subject to depreciation are expenditures incurred to date together with sanctioned future development expenditure approved by the Group.

        The capitalized exploration and development costs for proved oil and gas properties (which include the costs of drilling unsuccessful wells) are amortized on the basis of oil-equivalent barrels that are produced in a period as a percentage of the estimated proved reserves. The estimated proved reserves used in these unit-of-production calculations vary with the nature of the capitalized expenditure. The reserves used in the calculation of the unit-of-production amortization are as follows:

        The impact of changes in estimated proved reserves is dealt with prospectively by amortizing the remaining book value of the asset over the expected future production. If proved reserve estimates are revised downwards, earnings could be affected by higher depreciation expense or an immediate write-down of the property's book value (see discussion of impairment of fixed assets and goodwill below).

        Given the large number of producing fields in the Group's portfolio, it is unlikely that any changes in reserve estimates, year on year, will have a significant effect on prospective charges for depreciation.

        US GAAP requires the unit-of-production depreciation rate to be calculated on the basis of development expenditure incurred to date and proved developed reserves. If production commences before all development wells are drilled, a portion of the development costs incurred to date should be excluded from the unit-of production depreciation rate. In respect of the Group's portfolio of fields there is no material difference between the Group's charge for depreciation determined on a UK GAAP basis and on a US GAAP basis.

Oil and natural gas reserves

        As a UK-registered company reporting under UK GAAP, BP estimates its proved reserves under UK accounting rules for oil and gas companies contained in the Statement of Recommended Practice, 'Accounting for Oil and Gas Exploration, Development, Production and Decommissioning Activities' (UK SORP). This differs from the basis for determining reserve required by the US Securities and Exchange Commission. In estimating its reserves under UK SORP, BP uses long-term planning prices; these are the long term price assumptions on which the Group makes decisions to invest in the development of a field. Using planning prices for estimating proved reserves removes the impact of the volatility inherent in using year-end spot prices on our reserve base and on cash flow expectations over the long term. The Group's planning prices for estimating reserves through the end of 2004 were $20/bbl for oil and

108



$3.50/mmbtu for natural gas. However, in light of sustained high oil prices, the Group is in the course of reviewing these planning prices. Applying higher year-end prices to reserve estimates and assuming they apply to the end-of-field life has the effect of increasing proved reserves associated with concessions (tax and royalty arrangements) for which additional development opportunities become economic at higher prices or where higher prices make it more economic to extend the life of a field. On the other hand, applying higher year-end prices to reserves in fields subject to PSAs has the effect of decreasing proved reserves from those fields because higher prices result in lower volume entitlements. We believe that our long-term planning price assumptions provide the most appropriate basis for estimating oil and gas reserves and we will continue to use this basis for our UK reporting.

        In determining 'reasonable certainty' for UK SORP purposes, BP applies a number of additional internally imposed assessment principles, such as the requirement for internal approval and final investment decision (which we refer to as project sanction), or for such project sanction within six months and, for additional reserves in existing fields, the requirement that the reserves be included in the business plan and scheduled for development within three years. These principles are also applied for SEC reporting purposes.

        The Company's proved reserves estimates for the year ended December 31, 2004 reported in this Form 20-F reflect year-end prices and some adjustments which have been made vis-à-vis individual asset reserve estimates based on different applications of certain SEC interpretations of SEC regulations relating to the use of technology (mainly seismic) to estimate reserves in the reservoir away from wellbores and the reporting of fuel gas (i.e. gas used for fuel in operations on the lease) within proved reserves. The 2004 year-end marker prices used were Brent $40.24/bbl and Henry Hub $6.01/mmbtu. The other 2004 movements in proved reserves, are reflected in the tables showing movements in oil and gas reserves by region in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Supplementary Oil and Gas Information on pages S-1 to S-8.

        The Group manages its hydrocarbon resources in three major categories: prospect inventory, non-proved resources and proved reserves. When a discovery is made, volumes transfer from the prospect inventory to the non-proved resource category. The reserves move through various non-proved resources sub-categories as their technical and commercial maturity increases through appraisal activity. Reserves in a field will only be categorized as proved when all the criteria for attribution of proved status have been met, including an internally imposed requirement for project sanction, or for sanction expected within six months. Internal approval and final investment decision are what we refer to as project sanction.

        At the point of sanction, all booked reserves will be categorized as proved undeveloped (PUD). Volumes will subsequently be recategorized from PUD to proved developed (PD) as a consequence of development activity. The first PD bookings will occur at the point of first oil or gas production. Major development projects typically take one to four years from the time of initial booking to the start of production. Adjustments may be made to booked reserves due to production, reservoir performance, commercial factors, acquisition and divestment activity and additional reservoir development activity.

        The Group reassesses its estimate of proved reserves on an annual basis. The estimated proved reserves of oil and natural gas are subject to future revision. As discussed below, oil and natural gas reserves have a direct impact on certain amounts reported in the financial statements.

        Proved reserves do not include reserves that are dependent on the renewal of exploration and production licences unless there is strong evidence to support the assumption of such renewal.

Impairment of fixed assets and goodwill

        BP assesses its fixed assets, including goodwill, for possible impairment if there are events or changes in circumstances that indicate that carrying values of the assets may not be recoverable. Such

109



indicators include changes in the Group's business plans, changes in commodity prices leading to unprofitable performance and, for oil and gas properties, significant downward revisions of estimated proved reserve quantities. The assessment for impairment entails comparing the carrying value of the income-generating unit and associated goodwill with the recoverable amount of the asset, that is, the higher of net realizable value and value in use. Value in use is usually determined on the basis of discounted estimated future net cash flows.

        Determination as to whether and how much an asset is impaired involves management estimates on highly uncertain matters such as future commodity prices, the effects of inflation and technology improvements on operating expenses, production profiles and the outlook for global or regional market supply-and-demand conditions for crude oil, natural gas, commodity chemicals and refined products.

        For oil and natural gas properties, the expected future cash flows are estimated based on the Group's plans to continue to produce and develop proved and associated risk-adjusted probable and possible reserves. Expected future cash flows from the sale or production of reserves are calculated based on the Group's best estimate of future oil and gas prices. Previously, these were a Brent Oil price of $20 per barrel and a Henry Hub gas price of $3.50 per mmbtu. Beginning in the fourth quarter of 2004, this has been modified. Prices used for future cash flow calculations are assumed to decline from existing levels in equal steps over the next three years to the long-term planning assumptions ($20/$3.50 for Brent and Henry Hub at December 31, 2004). These long-term planning assumptions are subject to periodic review and modification. In light of sustained high oil prices, the Group is in the course of reviewing these planning assumptions. The estimated future level of production is based on assumptions about future commodity prices, lifting and development costs, field decline rates, market demand and supply, economic regulatory climates and other factors.

        Charges for impairment are recognized in the Group's results from time to time as a result of, among other factors, adverse changes in the recoverable reserves from oil and natural gas fields, low plant utilization or reduced profitability. If there are low oil prices or natural gas prices or refining margins or chemicals margins over an extended period, the Group may need to recognize significant impairment charges.

Deferred taxation

        The Group has approximately $7.7 billion of carry-forward tax losses in the UK and Germany, which would be available to offset against future taxable income. It is unlikely that the Group's effective tax rate will be significantly affected in the near term by utilization of losses not previously recognized as deferred tax assets. Carry-forward tax losses in other taxing jurisdictions have not been recognized as deferred tax assets, and are unlikely to have a significant effect on the Group's tax rate in future years.

        Deferred taxation is not generally provided in respect of liabilities that may arise on the distribution of accumulated reserves of overseas subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated undertakings.

Decommissioning costs

        The Group holds provisions for the future decommissioning of oil and natural gas production facilities and pipelines at the end of their economic lives. The largest asset removal obligations facing BP relate to the removal and disposal of oil and natural gas platforms and pipelines around the world. The estimated discounted costs of dismantling and removing these facilities are accrued on the installation of those facilities, reflecting our legal obligations at that time. Most of these removal events are many years in the future and the precise requirements that will have to be met when the removal event actually occurs are uncertain. Asset removal technologies and costs are constantly changing, as well as political, environmental, safety and public expectations. Consequently, the timing and amounts of future cash flows are subject to significant uncertainty.

110



        Decommissioning provisions associated with downstream and petrochemical facilities are generally not provided for as such potential obligations cannot be measured given their indeterminate settlement dates. The Group performs periodic reviews of its downstream and petrochemical long-lived assets for any changes in facts and circumstances that might require the recognition of a decommissioning provision.

        The timing and amount of future expenditures are reviewed annually, together with the interest rate to be used in discounting the cash flows. The interest rate used to determine the balance sheet obligation at the end of 2004 was 2.0%, 0.5% lower than at the end of 2003. The interest rate represents the real rate (i.e. adjusted for inflation) on long-dated government bonds.

Environmental costs

        BP also makes judgements and estimates in recording costs and establishing provisions for environmental clean-up and remediation costs, which are based on current information on costs and expected plans for remediation.

        For environmental provisions, actual costs can differ from estimates because of changes in laws and regulations, public expectations, discovery and analysis of site conditions and changes in clean-up technology.

        The provision for environmental liabilities is reviewed at least annually. The interest rate used to determine the balance sheet obligation at December 31, 2004 was 2.0%, 0.5% lower than at the previous balance sheet date.

Pensions and other postretirement benefits

        Accounting for pensions and other postretirement benefits involves judgement about uncertain events, including estimated retirement dates, salary levels at retirement, mortality rates, rates of return on plan assets, determination of discount rates for measuring plan obligations, healthcare cost-trend rates and rates of utilization of healthcare services by retirees. These assumptions are based on the environment in each country. Determination of the projected benefit obligations for the Group's defined benefit pension and postretirement plans is important to the recorded amounts for such obligations on the balance sheet and to the amount of benefit expense in the income statement. The assumptions used may vary from year to year, which will affect future results of operations. Any differences between these assumptions and the actual outcome also affect future results of operations.

        Pension and other postretirement benefit assumptions are discussed and agreed with the independent actuaries in December each year. These assumptions are used to determine the projected benefit obligation at the year end and hence the surplus and deficits recorded on the Group's balance sheet, and pension and postretirement expense for the following year.

        The pension assumptions at December 31, 2004 and 2003 under FRS17 are summarized below.

 
  UK
  Other
  USA
 
  2004
  2003
  2004
  2003
  2004
  2003
 
  (%)

Rate of return on assets   7.0   7.0   6.0   6.0   8.0   8.0
Discount rate   5.25   5.5   5.0   5.5   5.75   6.0
Future salary increases   4.0   4.0   4.0   4.0   4.0   4.0
Future pension increases   2.5   2.5   2.5   2.5   nil   nil
Inflation   2.5   2.5   2.5   2.5   2.5   2.5

111


        The assumed rate of investment return and discount rate have a significant effect on the amounts reported. A one-percentage-point change in these assumptions for the principal plans would have the following effects:

 
  One-percentage point

 
  Increase

  Decrease

 
  ($ million)

Investment return:        
  Effect on pension expense in 2005   (312 ) 314
Discount rate:        
  Effect on pension expense in 2005   (87 ) 88
  Effect on pension obligation at December 31, 2004   (4,508 ) 5,575

        The assumptions used in calculating the charge for US postretirement benefits are consistent with those shown above for US pension plans. The assumed future healthcare cost trend rate is shown below.

 
  2005
  2006
  2007
  2008
  2009 and
subsequent
years

 
  (%)

Beneficiaries aged under 65   9   8   7   6   5
Beneficiaries aged over 65   12   10   8   7   6

        The assumed healthcare cost trend rate has a significant effect on the amounts reported. A one-percentage-point change in the assumed healthcare cost trend rate would have the following effects:

 
  One-percentage point

 
  Increase

  Decrease

 
  ($ million)

Effect on total of postretirement benefit expense in 2005   39   (31)
Effect on postretirement obligation at December 31, 2004   458   (373)

Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS)

        An 'International Accounting Standards Regulation' was adopted by the Council of the European Union (EU) in June 2002. This regulation requires all EU companies listed on an EU stock exchange to use 'endorsed' International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), published by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB), to report their consolidated results with effect from January 1, 2005. The IASB completed its development of IFRS to be adopted in 2005 during the first half of 2004, but has also published certain amendments and interpretations of IFRS which would be available for early adoption if endorsed by the EU.

        The process of endorsement of IFRS by the EU to allow adoption by companies in 2005 is well advanced but not yet complete.

        BP's project team includes a broadly based representation from across the Group designed to plan for and achieve a smooth transition to IFRS. The project team has examined all implementation aspects, including changes to accounting policies, the presentation of the Group's results, systems impacts and the wider business issues that may arise from such a fundamental change. The Group has reported its results from the first quarter of 2005 using IFRS. However, the implementation may still be affected by developments in the IASB's standard-setting process and the endorsement of standards and interpretations by the EU.

112



        The Group has decided that, for the purposes of the restatement of prior periods currently reported under UK GAAP, the date of transition to IFRS is January 1, 2003. However, in accordance with the provisions of IFRS 1, the date of adoption of International Accounting Standards Nos. 32 and 39, which deal with the recognition and presentation of financial instruments, is set at January 1, 2005, with no restatement of prior periods' results.

        The process of finalizing the restatements of the results and financial position for 2003 and 2004 under IFRS, was completed in March 2005. The major effects of changing from current accounting practice to IFRS are in the following areas: goodwill acquired in a business combination; deferred tax related to business combinations and in respect of the valuation of inventories; accounting for items falling within the scope of IAS Nos. 32 and 39, including embedded derivatives and hedge accounting; the treatment of major overhaul expenditure; exchanges of fixed assets; recognition of dividend liabilities; and share-based payments. Certain joint arrangements with third parties, where BP currently accounts for its share of individual assets, liabilities, income and expense, will be accounted for using the equity method, resulting in reclassifications within the income statement and balance sheet.

        The adoption of IFRS, subject to developments in the standard-setting process and the endorsement of standards and interpretations, resulted in a $1,344 million and $1,966 million increase in profit for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2003, respectively, and a $236 million increase in BP shareholders' interest at December 31, 2004.

US Generally Accepted Accounting Principles

        The consolidated financial statements of the BP Group are prepared in accordance with UK GAAP, which differs in certain respects from US generally accepted accounting principles (US GAAP). The principal differences between US GAAP and UK GAAP for BP Group reporting are discussed in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 50 on page F-103.

Impact of New US Accounting Standards

        Other postretirement benefits:    In May 2004, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued Staff Position No. 106-2 'Accounting and Disclosure Requirements Related to the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003' (the Medicare Act). The provisions of the Medicare Act provide for a federal subsidy for plans that provide prescription drug benefits and meet certain qualifications, and alternatively would allow prescription drug plan sponsors to co-ordinate with the Medicare benefit. The Group reflected the impact of the legislation by reducing its actuarially determined obligation for postretirement benefits at December 31, 2004 and will reduce the net cost for postretirement benefits in subsequent periods. The $577 million reduction in liability was reflected as an actuarial gain (assumption change).

        Inventory:    In November 2004, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 151 'Inventory Costs an amendment of ARB No. 43, Chapter 4' (SFAS 151). SFAS 151 requires that items, such as idle facility expense, excessive spoilage, double freight and re-handling costs, be recognized as current-period charges. SFAS 151 also requires that the allocation of fixed production overheads to the costs of conversion be based on the normal capacity of the production facilities. SFAS 151 is effective for accounting periods beginning after June 15, 2005. The adoption of SFAS 151 is not expected to have a significant effect on profit, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, or BP shareholders' interest, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP.

        Discontinued operations:    In November 2004, the Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) reached a consensus on Issue No. 03-13 'Applying the Conditions in Paragraph 42 of FASB Statement No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets, in Determining Whether to Report Discontinued Operations' (EITF 03-13). Under EITF 03-13, a disposed component of an enterprise is classified as a discontinued operation only where the ongoing entity has no continuing direct cash flows

113



and does not retain an interest, contract or other arrangement sufficient to enable the entity to exert significant influence over the disposed component's operating and financial policies after disposal. EITF 03-13 is effective for a component of an enterprise that is either disposed of or classified as held for sale in accounting periods beginning after December 15, 2004.

        Revenue:    In November 2004, the EITF began discussion of Issue No. 04-13 'Accounting for Purchases and Sales of Inventory with the Same Counterparty' (EITF 04-13). EITF 04-13 addresses accounting issues that arise when a company both sells inventory to and buys inventory from another entity in the same line of business. The purchase and sale transactions may be pursuant to a single contractual arrangement or separate contractual arrangements and the inventory purchased or sold may be in the form of raw material, work-in-process or finished goods. At issue is whether the revenue, inventory cost and cost of sales should be recorded at fair value or whether the transactions should be classified as nonmonetary transactions. The EITF, which did not reach a consensus on the issue, requested the FASB staff to further explore the alternative views.

        Practice within the oil and natural gas industry varies for buy/sell arrangements with common counterparties and physical exchanges. The Group accounts for buy/sell arrangements and physical exchanges on a net basis.

        Nonmonetary asset exchanges:    In December 2004, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 153 'Exchanges of Nonmonetary Assets an amendment of APB Opinion No. 29' (SFAS 153). SFAS 153 eliminates the Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 29 exception for nonmonetary exchanges of similar productive assets and replaces it with an exception for exchanges of nonmonetary assets that do not have commercial substance. SFAS 153 is effective for nonmonetary asset exchanges occurring in accounting periods beginning after June 15, 2005. The Group adopted SFAS 153 with effect from January 1, 2005. The adoption of SFAS 153 did not have a significant effect on profit, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, or BP shareholders' interest, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP.

        Share options:    In December 2004, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123 (revised 2004) 'Share-Based Payment' (SFAS 123R). SFAS 123R, which is a revision of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123 'Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation' (SFAS 123), supersedes APB Opinion No. 25 'Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees'. Under SFAS 123R, share-based payments to employees and others are required to be recognized in the income statement based on their fair value. Pro forma disclosure is no longer a permitted alternative. SFAS 123R must be adopted no later than July 1, 2005.

        The Group currently accounts for share-based employee compensation based on the intrinsic value method and, as such, generally recognizes no compensation cost for employee share options. Disclosure of the pro forma effect on net income and earnings per share if the Group had applied the fair value recognition provisions of SFAS 123 to share-based employee compensation in prior years is included in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 38 on page F-75.

        Effective January 1, 2005, as part of the adoption of IFRS, the Group adopted International Financial Reporting Standard No. 2 'Share-based Payment' (IFRS 2). IFRS 2 requires the recognition of expense when goods or services are received from employees or others in consideration for equity instruments or amounts that are based on the value of an entity's equity instruments. The recognition and measurement provisions of IFRS 2 are similar to those of SFAS 123R.

        In adopting IFRS 2, the Group elected to restate prior years to recognize the expense associated with equity-settled share-based payment transactions that were not fully vested as of January 1, 2003 and the liability associated with cash-settled share-based payment transactions as of January 1, 2003.

114



        The Group adopted SFAS 123R with effect from January 1, 2005. Had the Group adopted SFAS 123R in prior years, the impact would have approximated the pro forma expense included in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 38 on page F-75.

        Taxation:    In December 2004, the FASB issued Staff Position No. 109-1 'Application of FASB Statement No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes, to the Tax Deduction on Qualified Production Activities Provided by the American Jobs Creation Act of 2004' (FSP 109-1). FSP 109-1, effective upon issuance, requires that the manufacturers' deduction provided for under the American Jobs Creation Act of 2004 (the Jobs Creation Act) be accounted for as a special deduction in accordance with FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 109, 'Accounting for Income Taxes,' rather than a tax rate reduction. The manufacturers' deduction will be recognized by the Company in the year the benefit is earned.

        In December 2004, the FASB issued Staff Position No. 109-2 'Accounting and Disclosure Guidance for the Foreign Earnings Repatriation Provision within the American Jobs Creation Act of 2004' (FSP 109-2). The Jobs Creation Act provides a special one-time provision allowing earnings of certain non-US companies to be repatriated to a US parent company at a reduced tax rate. FSP 109-2, effective upon issuance, permits additional time beyond the financial reporting period of enactment in order to evaluate the effect of the Jobs Creation Act without undermining an entity's assertion that repatriation of non-US earnings to a US parent company is not expected within the foreseeable future. As provided by FSP 109-2, the Group has elected to defer a decision on potentially altering current plans regarding the permanent reinvestment in certain non-US subsidiaries and corporate joint ventures. The income tax effects associated with any repatriation of unremitted earnings as a result of the Jobs Creation Act cannot be reasonably estimated at this time.

        Provisions:    In March 2005, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 47 'Accounting for Conditional Asset Retirement Obligations an interpretation of FASB Statement No. 143' (Interpretation 47). Under Interpretation 47, a conditional asset retirement obligation represents an unconditional obligation to perform an asset retirement activity where the timing or method of settlement are conditional on a future event that may or may not be within the control of the entity. Interpretation 47 clarifies that an entity is required to recognize a liability, when incurred, for the fair value of a conditional asset retirement obligation if the fair value of the liability can be reasonably estimated. Uncertainty about the timing or method of settlement of a conditional asset retirement obligation is factored into the measurement of the liability when sufficient information exists. SFAS 143 acknowledges that in some cases, sufficient information may not be available to reasonably estimate the fair value of an asset retirement obligation. Interpretation 47 also clarifies when an entity would have sufficient information to reasonably estimate the fair value of an asset retirement obligation. Interpretation 47 is effective for fiscal years ending after December 15, 2005. The Group has not yet completed its evaluation of the impact of adopting Interpretation 47 on the Group's profit, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, or BP shareholders' interest, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP.

        Fixed assets:    FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 19 'Financial Accounting and Reporting by Oil and Gas Producing Companies' (SFAS 19) requires the cost of drilling an exploratory well (exploration or exploratory-type stratigraphic test wells) to be capitalized pending determination of whether the well has found proved reserves. If this determination cannot be made at the conclusion of drilling, SFAS 19 sets out additional requirements for continuing to carry the cost of the well as an asset. These requirements include firm plans for further drilling and a one-year time limitation on continued capitalization in certain situations. Subsequent to the issuance of SFAS 19, as a result of the increasing complexity of oil and gas projects due to drilling in remote and deepwater offshore locations, entities increasingly require more than one year to complete all of the activities that permit recognition of proved reserves. In addition, because of new technologies, in certain situations additional exploratory wells may no longer be required before a project can commence.

115



        In April 2005, the FASB issued Staff Position No. 19-1 'Accounting for Suspended Well Costs' (FSP 19-1). FSP 19-1 amends SFAS 19 to permit the continued capitalization of exploratory well costs beyond one year if (a) the well found a sufficient quantity of reserves to justify its completion as a producing well and (b) the entity is making sufficient progress assessing the reserves and the economic and operating viability of the project. If either condition is not met, or if an entity obtains information that raises substantial doubt about the economic or operational viability of the project, the exploratory well is assumed to be impaired, and its costs, net of any salvage value, is charged to expense. FSP 19-1 provides a number of indicators that would be considered in order to demonstrate that sufficient progress was being made in assessing the reserves and the economic viability of the project. FSP 19-1 is effective for accounting periods beginning after April 4, 2005. Early application of the guidance is permitted in periods for which financial statements have not yet been issued.

        BP's accounting policy is that costs associated with an exploration well are capitalized as an intangible asset until the drilling of the well is complete and the results have been evaluated. If hydrocarbons are found, and, subject to further appraisal activity which may include the drilling of further wells (exploration or exploratory-type stratigraphic test wells), are likely to be capable of commercial development, the costs continue to be carried as an asset. All such carried costs are subject to technical, commercial and management review at least once a year to confirm the continued intent to develop or otherwise extract value from the discovery. When this is no longer the case, the costs are written off. When proved reserves of oil and natural gas are determined and development is sanctioned, the relevant expenditure is transferred to tangible production assets. We have adopted the FSP with effect from January 1, 2004. No previously capitalized costs were expensed upon the adoption of the FSP.

        Accounting changes and error corrections:    In May 2005, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 154 'Accounting Changes and Error Corrections, a replacement of APB Opinion No. 20 and FASB Statement No. 3' (SFAS 154). SFAS 154 applies to all voluntary changes in accounting principle and changes the requirements for the accounting for and reporting of a change in accounting principle. SFAS 154 requires retrospective application to prior period financial statements of a voluntary change in accounting principle unless it is impracticable. Previously, most voluntary changes in accounting principle were recognized by including in net income of the period of the change the cumulative effect of changing to the new accounting principle. SFAS 154 also requires that a change in the method of depreciation, amortization or depletion for long-lived nonfinancial assets be accounted for as a change in accounting estimate that is effected by a change in accounting principle. Previously, such changes were reported as a change in accounting principle. SFAS 154 is effective for accounting changes and corrections of errors made in accounting periods beginning after December 15, 2005. The adoption of SFAS 154 is not expected to have a significant effect on profit, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, or BP shareholders' interest, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP.

116



ITEM 6 — DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES


DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT

        The following lists the Company's directors and senior management as at June 24, 2005.

Name

   
  Initially elected
or appointed

P D Sutherland   Non-executive chairman (a)   Chairman since May 1997
Director since July 1995
Sir Ian Prosser   Non-executive deputy chairman (a)(b)(c)   Deputy chairman since February 1999
Director since May 1997
The Lord Browne of Madingley   Executive director (group chief executive)   September 1991
R C Alexander   Chief executive, Innovene   April 2002
Dr D C Allen   Executive director (group chief of staff)   February 2003
P B P Bevan   Group general counsel   September 1992
S Bott   Executive vice president, human resources   March 2005
I C Conn   Executive director, (group executive officer, strategic resources)   July 2004
V Cox   Executive vice president, Gas, Power & Renewables   July 2004
Dr A B Hayward   Executive director (chief executive, Exploration and Production)   February 2003
A G Inglis   Deputy chief executive, Exploration and Production   July 2004
J A Manzoni   Executive director (chief executive, Refining and Marketing)   February 2003
Dr B E Grote   Executive director (chief financial officer)   August 2000
J H Bryan   Non-executive director (a)(c)   December 1998
A Burgmans   Non-executive director (a)(d)   February 2004
E B Davis, Jr   Non-executive director (a)(b)(c)   December 1998
D J Flint   Non-executive director (a)(c)   January 2005
Dr D S Julius   Non-executive director (a)(b)   November 2001
Sir Tom McKillop   Non-executive director (a)(b)   July 2004
Dr W E Massey   Non-executive director (a)(d)   December 1998
H M P Miles   Non-executive director (a)(c)(d)   June 1994
M H Wilson   Non-executive director (a)(c)(d)   December 1998

(a)
Member of the chairman's committee.

(b)
Member of the remuneration committee.

(c)
Member of the audit committee.

(d)
Member of the ethics and environment assurance committee.

117


        Mr R L Olver resigned as an executive director on July 1, 2004. Mr C F Knight and Sir Robin Nicholson retired as non-executive directors on April 14, 2005. At the Company's Annual General Meeting (AGM) the following directors retired, and offered themselves for re-election and were duly re-elected: Dr Allen, The Lord Browne of Madingley, Mr J H Bryan, Mr A Burgmans, Mr E B Davis, Jr, Dr B E Grote, Dr A B Hayward, Dr D S Julius, Mr J A Manzoni, Dr W E Massey, Mr H M P Miles, Sir Ian Prosser, Mr M H Wilson and Mr P D Sutherland. Mr I C Conn was appointed as an executive director and Sir Tom McKillop was appointed as a non-executive director on July 1, 2004, and Mr D J Flint was appointed as a non-executive director on 1 January 2005; each offered themselves for election as a director at the AGM and were duly elected.

        The biographies of the directors and senior management are set out below.

        P D Sutherland, KCMG — Peter Sutherland (59) rejoined BP's board in 1995, having been a non-executive director from 1990 to 1993, and was appointed chairman in 1997. He is non-executive chairman of Goldman Sachs International and a non-executive director of The Royal Bank of Scotland Group p.l.c.

        Sir Ian Prosser — Sir Ian (61) joined BP's board in 1997 and was appointed non-executive deputy chairman in 1999. He retired as chairman of InterContinental Hotels Group PLC, previously Bass PLC in 2003. He was a non-executive director of The Boots Company from 1984 to 1996, of Lloyds Bank PLC from 1988 to 1995 and of Lloyds TSB Group PLC from 1995 to 1999. In 1999, he was appointed a non-executive director of GlaxoSmithKline and in 2004 he was appointed a non-executive director of Sara Lee Corporation.

        The Lord Browne of Madingley, FREng — Lord Browne (57) joined BP in 1966 and subsequently held a variety of Exploration and Production and Finance posts in the US, UK and Canada. He was appointed an executive director in 1991 and group chief executive in 1995. He is a non-executive director of Intel Corporation and Goldman Sachs. He was knighted in 1998 and made a life peer in 2001.

        R C Alexander — Ralph Alexander (50) joined BP in 1982. Since then, he has worked in a variety of roles in BP, including vice president of BP's operations in the Gulf of Mexico, CEO of Air BP and group vice president responsible for new markets development. His most recent post was CEO of BP's Gas, Power & Renewables segment. He was appointed CEO of the Petrochemicals segment in July 2004, transitioning into his current position as CEO of Innovene (BP's new petrochemicals subsidiary).

        Dr D C Allen — David Allen (50) joined BP in 1978 and subsequently undertook a number of Corporate and Exploration and Production roles in London and New York. He moved to BP's Corporate Planning function in 1986, becoming group vice president in 1999. He was appointed an executive vice president and group chief of staff in 2000 and an executive director of BP in 2003.

        P B P Bevan — Peter Bevan (61) joined BP after qualifying as a solicitor with a City of London firm. He worked initially in the law department of BP Chemicals. He became group general counsel in 1992 following roles as manager of the Legal function of BP Exploration, assistant company secretary and deputy group legal adviser. He was appointed an executive vice president of BP p.l.c. in 1998.

        S Bott (56) — joined BP in March 2005 as an executive vice president responsible for human resources management. She joined Citibank in 1970 and following a variety of roles, was appointed a Vice President in human resources in 1979 subsequently holding a series of positions as a human resources director to sectors of Citibank. In 1994, she joined BZW, an investment bank, as head of human resources and in 1996 became group human resources director of Barclays Group. From 2000 to early 2005, she was managing director and head of global human resources at Marsh Inc., insurance brokers.

118



        I C Conn — Iain Conn (42) joined BP in 1986. Following a variety of roles in oil trading, refining, commercial marketing, Exploration and Production, in 2000 he became group vice president of BP's Refining and Marketing business. From 2002 to 2004, he was chief executive of Petrochemicals. He was appointed group executive officer with a range of regional and functional responsibilities and an executive director in July 2004. He was appointed to the board of Rolls-Royce Group plc in January 2005.

        V Cox — Vivienne Cox (45) joined BP in 1981. Following a series of commercial roles, she was appointed chief executive of Air BP in 1998. From 1999 until 2001 she was group vice president in BP Oil responsible for business to business marketing in oil, supply and trading. In 2001, she became group vice president integrated supply and trading (IST) and in 2004 she was appointed an executive vice president, additionally responsible for Gas, Power and Renewables

        Dr B E Grote — Byron Grote (57) joined BP in 1987 following the acquisition of The Standard Oil Company of Ohio, where he had worked since 1979. He became group treasurer in 1992 and in 1994 regional chief executive in Latin America. In 1999, he was appointed an executive vice president of Exploration and Production, and chief executive of Chemicals in 2000. He was appointed an executive director of BP in 2000 and chief financial officer in 2002.

        Dr A B Hayward — Tony Hayward (48) joined BP in 1982. He became a director of Exploration and Production in 1997, the segment in which he had previously held a series of roles. In 2000, he was made group treasurer and an executive vice president in 2002. He was appointed chief operating officer for Exploration and Production in 2002 and an executive director of BP in 2003. He is a non-executive director of Corus Group.

        A G Inglis — Andrew Inglis (46) joined BP in 1980 working on various North Sea Projects. Following a series of commercial roles in BP Exploration, in 1996 he became chief of staff, Exploration and Production. From 1997 until 1999, he was responsible for leading BP's activities in the Deepwater Gulf of Mexico. In 1999, he was appointed vice president of BP's US western gas business unit and in 2004 he became executive vice president and deputy chief executive of Exploration and Production.

        J A Manzoni — John Manzoni (45) joined BP in 1983. He became group vice president for European marketing in 1999 and BP regional president for the eastern US in 2000. In 2001, he became an executive vice president and chief executive for Gas and Power. He was appointed chief executive of Refining and Marketing in 2002 and an executive director of BP in 2003. He is a non-executive director of SABMiller plc.

        J H Bryan — John Bryan (68) joined BP's board in 1998, having previously been a director of Amoco. He serves on the boards of General Motors Corporation and Goldman Sachs. He retired as chairman of Sara Lee Corporation in 2001. He is chairman of Millennium Park Inc. in Chicago.

        A Burgmans — Antony Burgmans (58) joined BP's board in 2004. He was appointed to the board of Unilever in 1991. In 1999, he became chairman of Unilever NV and vice chairman of Unilever PLC. He is also a member of the supervisory board of ABN AMRO Bank NV.

        E B Davis, Jr — Erroll B Davis, Jr (60) joined BP's board in 1998, having previously been a director of Amoco. He is chairman and chief executive officer of Alliant Energy, a member of the advisory board of the Federal Reserve Bank of Chicago and a non-executive director of PPG Industries, Union Pacific Corporation and the US Olympic Committee.

        D J Flint — Douglas Flint (49) joined BP's board in January 2005. He trained as a chartered accountant and became a partner at KPMG in 1988. In 1995, he was appointed group finance director of HSBC Holdings p.l.c. He is chairman of the Financial Reporting Council's review of the Turnbull Guidance on Internal Control. Between 2001 and 2004, he served on the Accounting Standards Board and the Standards Advisory Council of the International Accounting Standards Board.

119



        Dr D S Julius, CBE — DeAnne Julius (56) joined BP's board in 2001. She began her career as a project economist with the World Bank in Washington. From 1986 until 1997, she held a succession of posts, including chief economist at British Airways and Royal Dutch Shell Group. From 1997 to 2001, she was a full-time member of the Monetary Policy Committee of the Bank of England. She is chairman of the Royal Institute of International Affairs and a non-executive director of Lloyds TSB Group PLC, Serco and Roche Holdings SA.

        Sir Tom McKillop — Sir Tom (62) joined BP's board in July 2004. Sir Tom was appointed chief executive of AstraZeneca PLC after the merger of Astra AB and Zeneca Group PLC in 1999. He was a non-executive director of Lloyds TSB Group PLC until 2004 and is chairman of the British Pharma Group.

        Dr W E Massey — Walter Massey (67) joined BP's board in 1998, having previously been a director of Amoco. He is president of Morehouse College, a non-executive director of Motorola, Bank of America and McDonald's Corporation and a member of President Bush's Council of Advisors on Science & Technology.

        H M P Miles, OBE — Michael Miles (69) joined BP's board in 1994. In 1988, he became an executive director of John Swire & Sons Ltd. He was chairman of Swire Pacific between 1984 and 1988. He is chairman of Schroders plc, non-executive chairman of Johnson Matthey Plc and a director of BP Pension Trustees Ltd.

        M H Wilson — Michael Wilson (67) joined BP's board in 1998, having previously been a director of Amoco. He was a member of the Canadian Parliament from 1979 to 1993 and held various ministerial posts, including Finance, Industry, Science, Technology, and International Trade. He is chairman of UBS Canada and a non-executive director of Manufacturers Life Insurance Company. He is an officer of the Order of Canada.

120



COMPENSATION

        The remuneration committee determines the terms of engagement and remuneration of the executive directors and monitors the policies applied by the group chief executive in remunerating other senior executives.

Reward Policy

        A key priority for the remuneration committee in 2004 has been its comprehensive and independent review of all elements of remuneration policy for executive directors prior to seeking specific shareholder approval for renewal of the Executive Directors' Incentive Plan, which expires in 2005. This wide-ranging review sought to address the fundamental bases of the remuneration policies and plans for the executive directors. It involved significant academic research as well as seeking the views of plan participants, major shareholders and professional advisers. The committee focused on seeking to ensure that, in determining remuneration policy, there is a clear link between the Company's purpose, the business plans and executive reward.

        As part of its review, the committee developed the following key principles to guide its policy:

Key policy decisions

        The committee then reviewed the existing remuneration policies and plans against these principles and made the following key policy decisions:

121


Elements of Remuneration

        The executive directors' total remuneration will continue to consist of salary, annual bonus, long-term incentives, pensions and other benefits. This reward structure will be regularly reviewed by the committee to ensure that it is achieving its objectives. In 2005, over three-quarters of executive directors' potential direct remuneration will again be performance-related.

Salary

        The committee expects to review salaries in 2005. In doing so, the committee considers both Europe-based top global companies and the US oil and gas sector; each of these groups is defined and analysed by the committee's independent external remuneration advisers. The committee then assesses the market information and advice and applies its judgement in setting the salary levels.

Annual Bonus

        Each executive director is eligible to participate in an annual performance-based bonus scheme. The committee reviews and sets bonus targets and levels of eligibility annually.

        For 2005, the target level will be increased from 100% to 120% of base salary (except for Lord Browne, for whom, as group chief executive, it is considered appropriate to increase his target from 110% to 130%). These increases reflect part of the value previously attributed to the share option element of their remuneration packages. In normal circumstances, the maximum payment level for substantially exceeding targets will continue to be 150% (165% for the group chief executive) of base salary. In exceptional circumstances, outstanding performance may be recognized by bonus payments moderately in excess of the 150% (and 165%) levels at the discretion of the remuneration committee.

122



Similarly, bonuses may be reduced where the committee considers that this is warranted and, in exceptional circumstances, bonuses can be reduced to zero.

        The committee recognizes that it is responsible to shareholders to use its discretion in a reasonable and informed manner in the best interests of the Group and that it has a corresponding duty to be accountable and transparent as to the manner in which it exercises its discretion. The committee will explain any significant exercise of discretion in the subsequent directors' remuneration report.

        The key aim of the revised annual bonus is to ensure that it is closely tied to the annual business plan and that it reflects short-term deliverables towards the creation of long-term shareholder value.

        Executive directors' annual bonus awards for 2005 will be based on a mix of demanding financial targets, based on the Group's annual plan and leadership objectives established at the beginning of the year, in accordance with the following weightings:


        In assessing the final outcome of the individual bonuses each year, the committee will also carefully review the underlying performance of the Group in the context of the five-year Group business plan, as well as looking at competitor results, analysts' reports and the views from the chairmen of other BP board committees. All the calculations are reviewed by the auditors.

Long-term Incentives

        Long-term incentives will continue to be provided under the EDIP. It will continue to have within its framework three elements: a share element, a share option element and a cash element. The committee does not currently intend to use either the share option or cash elements but, in exceptional circumstances, may do so.

        Each executive director participates in the EDIP. The committee's policy, subject to unforeseen circumstances, is that this should continue until the EDIP expires or is renewed in 2010.

        The committee's policy continues to be that each executive director should hold shares equivalent in value to 5 times the director's base salary within five years of being appointed an executive director. This policy is reflected in the terms of the EDIP, as shares awarded under the share element will only be released at the end of the three-year retention period (as described below) if the minimum shareholding guidelines have been met.

Share Element

        The committee may make conditional share awards (performance shares) to executive directors, which will only vest to the extent that a demanding performance condition imposed by the committee is met at the end of a three-year performance period. As explained above, for 2005 and future years, the committee currently intends that the share element alone will provide the long-term performance-based component of the executive directors' package, and award levels have been adjusted to reflect this.

        Share element awards have been made in 2001 to 2004 inclusive using performance units that may convert into ordinary shares at a ratio of up to two shares for each performance unit (full details of which are set out in Compensation — 2004 Remuneration for Executive Directors — Long-term Performance-based Components in this Item on page 129). To simplify the operation of the plan and

123



increase transparency, the award of performance shares will, for 2005 and future years, replace performance units. Vesting of performance shares will be at a maximum ratio of one-for-one. This change will not increase the value of the award levels or make performance conditions easier to achieve.

        The maximum number of performance shares that may be awarded to an executive director in any one year will be determined at the discretion of the remuneration committee and will not normally exceed 5.5 times base salary and, in the case of the group chief executive, 7.5 times base salary.

        In addition to the performance condition described below, the committee will have an overriding discretion, in exceptional circumstances, to reduce the number of shares which vest (or to provide that no shares vest).

        The shares which vest will normally be subject to a compulsory retention period determined by the committee, which will not normally be less than three years. This gives executive directors a six-year incentive structure, and is designed to ensure that their interests are aligned with those of shareholders. Where shares vest under awards made in 2005 and future years, the executive director will receive additional shares representing the value of reinvested dividends on these shares.

        For share element awards in 2005, the performance condition will relate to BP's TSR performance against the other oil majors (ExxonMobil, Shell, Total and Chevron) over a three-year period. TSR is calculated by taking the share price performance of a company over the period, assuming dividends to be reinvested in the company's shares. All share prices will be averaged over the three months before the beginning and end of the performance period and will be measured in US dollars. At the end of the performance period, the TSR performance of each of the companies will be ranked to establish the relative total return to shareholders over the period. Shares under the award will vest as to 100%, 70% and 35% if BP achieves first, second or third place respectively; no shares will vest if BP achieves fourth or fifth place.

        Extensive research was independently commissioned by the committee into alternative measures of business performance. After careful review of the studies, the committee is satisfied that relative TSR is the most appropriate measure of performance for BP's long-term incentives for executive directors as it best reflects the creation of long-term shareholder value. Relative performance of the peer group is particularly key in order to minimize the influence of sector-specific effects, including oil price.

        The committee is convinced that this comparator group, while small, has the distinct advantage of being very clearly comprised of BP's global competitors. Consultation with major shareholders confirmed that this is the group already used by most of them, as well as by management, in assessing BP's comparative performance. The committee will have the discretion to amend this peer group in appropriate circumstances, for example, in the case of any significant consolidations in the industry.

        The committee is mindful of the possibility that a simple ranking system may in some circumstances give rise to distorted results in view of the broad similarity of the oil majors' underlying businesses, the small size of the comparator group and inherent imperfections in measurement. To counter this, the committee will have the ability to exercise discretion in a reasonable and informed manner to adjust (upwards or downwards) the vesting level derived from the ranking if it considers that the ranking does not fairly reflect BP's underlying business performance relative to the comparator group.

        The exercise of this discretion would be made after a broad analysis of the underlying health of BP's business relative to competitors, as shown by a range of other measures including, but not limited to, return on average capital employed (ROACE), earnings per share (EPS) growth, reserves replacement and cash flow. This will enable a more comprehensive review of long-term performance, with the aims of tempering anomalies created by relying solely on a formula-based approach and ensuring that the objectives of the plan are met.

124



        It is anticipated that the need to use discretion is most likely to arise where the TSR performance of some companies is clustered, so that a relatively small difference in TSR performance would produce a major difference in vesting levels. In these circumstances, the committee will have power to adjust the vesting level, normally by determining an average vesting level for the companies affected by the clustering.

        In line with its policy on transparency, the committee will explain any adjustment to the relative TSR ranking in the next directors' remuneration report following the vesting.

        The committee may amend the performance conditions if events occur that would make the amended condition a fairer measure of performance and provided that any amended condition is no easier to satisfy.

        For 2005, all executive directors will receive performance share awards on the above basis, over a maximum number of shares set by reference to 5.5 times base salary. For awards under the share element in future years, the committee may continue with the same performance condition, or may impose a different condition which it considers to be no less demanding.

        As group chief executive, Lord Browne is eligible for performance share awards of up to 7.5 times base salary. The committee has determined that, while the largest part of this should relate to the TSR measure described above, it is appropriate that a specific part (up to 2 times base salary) should be based on long-term leadership measures. These will focus on sustaining BP's financial, strategic and organizational health and will include, but not be limited to, maintenance of BP's performance culture and the continued development of BP's business strategy, executive talent and internal organization. As with the TSR part of his award, this part will be measured over three-year performance periods.

Share element awards made in previous years

        For outstanding awards of performance units made under the plans for the periods 2002-2004, 2003-2005 and 2004-2006, the existing performance conditions will apply for the three-year performance periods in each of the plans. The primary measure is BP's shareholder return against the market (SHRAM), which accounts for nearly two-thirds of the potential total award, the remainder being assessed on BP's relative return on ROACE and EPS growth.

        BP's SHRAM is measured against the companies in the FTSE All World Oil & Gas Index. Companies within the index are weighted according to their market capitalization at the beginning of each three-year period in order to give greatest emphasis to oil majors. BP's ROACE and EPS growth are measured against ExxonMobil, Shell, Total and Chevron. All calculations are reviewed by the auditors to ensure that they meet an independent objective standard. The relative position of the company within the comparator group determines the number of shares awarded per performance unit, subject to a maximum of two shares per unit.

Share Option Element

        The share option element of the EDIP permits options to be granted to executive directors at an exercise price no lower than the market value of a share at the date the option is granted. The committee does not currently intend to use this element.

Cash Element

        The cash element allows the committee to grant long-term cash-based incentives. This element was not used during the first five years of the EDIP and the committee would only do so in special circumstances.

125



Pensions

        Executive directors are eligible to participate in the appropriate pension schemes applying in their home countries.

Benefits and Other Share Schemes

        Executive directors are eligible to participate in regular employee benefit plans and in all-employee share schemes and savings plans applying in their home countries. Benefits in kind are not pensionable.

Resettlement Allowance

        Expatriates may receive a resettlement allowance for a limited period.

2004 Remuneration for Executive Directors

        Amounts shown are in the currency received by executive directors. For information, the average exchange rate for 2004 was £1=$1.83. Annual bonus is shown in the year it was earned.

 
  Annual remuneration

  Long term Performance Plan (LTPP)

  Grants under EDIP

 
   
   
   
   
   
  2002-2004 LTPP
(awarded in Feb 2005)

  2001-2003 LTPP
(awarded in Feb 2004)

  2004-2006
share element

  Share option
element

 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
  (granted in Feb 2004)

Summary of 2004 remuneration

  Salary
'000

  2004 annual
performance
bonus '000

  Other
benefits
'000

  2004
total
'000

  2003
total
'000

  Actual
award
(shares)(a)

  Value
'000(b)

  Actual
award
(shares)

  Value
'000(c)

  (performance
units)(d)

  (options)(e)

The Lord Browne of Madingley     £1,382   £2,280   £82     £3,744     £3,277   356,667     £1,905   352,750     £1,457   634,447   1,500,000
Dr D C Allen     £410   £   615   £11     £1,036     £828   60,000     £320   62,518     £258   188,235   275,000
Mr I C Conn(f)     £200   £   300   £42     £542       51,750     £276          
Dr B E Grote   $ 841   $1,262     $ 2,103   $ 1,950 (g) 136,960   $ 1,381   131,750   $ 1,053   212,669   349,998
Dr A B Hayward     £410   £   615   £36     £1,061     £829   55,125     £294   54,825     £226   188,235   275,000
J A Manzoni(h)     £410   £   615   £46     £1,071     £878   60,000     £320   51,170     £211   188,235   275,000

Directors who left the board in 2004

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
R L Olver(i)     £292   £   438   £42     £772     £1,354   147,222     £786   144,500     £597    

(a)
Gross award of shares based on a performance assessment by the remuneration committee and on the other terms of the plan. Sufficient shares are sold to pay for tax applicable. Remaining shares are held in trust until 2008, when they are released to the individual.

(b)
Based on the closing price of BP shares on February 3, 2005 (£5.34 per share) or the cost of acquiring ADSs ($60.49 per ADS).

(c)
Based on the average market price on date of award (£4.13 per share/$47.96 per ADS).

(d)
Performance units granted under the 2004-2006 share element of the EDIP are converted to shares at the end of the performance period. Maximum of two shares per performance unit.

(e)
Options granted in February 2004 have a grant price of £4.22 per share. Dr Grote holds options over ADSs; the above numbers reflect calculated equivalents.

(f)
Reflects remuneration received by Mr Conn since appointment as executive director on July 1, 2004.

(g)
Includes resettlement allowances for Dr Grote of $175,000, which expired in 2003.

(h)
Mr Manzoni also received compensation of £50,000 in 2004 relating to expatriate costs prior to his appointment as an executive director.

126


(i)
Amounts for Mr Olver reflect the period until his retirement in July 1, 2004.

Salary

        Following a review of appropriate comparator groups of Europe-based top global companies and the US oil and gas sector, base salaries for Lord Browne, Dr Allen, Dr Hayward and Mr Manzoni were increased by 5% per annum with effect from July 1, 2004. On his appointment to the board in 2004, Mr Conn's salary was determined by reference to the same comparator groups.

        In deciding upon these new salary levels the committee applied its judgement, taking into account the modest market movements in Europe and the US and the fact that no salary increases had been received by the three executive directors appointed in February 2003 since that time.

        Dr Grote's salary was increased in the context of the comparative market information by approximately 15% with effect from July 1, 2004 to reflect his expanded senior role following the retirement of Mr Olver.

Annual Bonus

        Fifty per cent of the annual bonus awards for 2004 is based on a mix of financial targets (primarily cash from operations) and 50% is based on long-run metrics and wide-ranging milestones that drive performance improvement and measure the continuing delivery of strategy (including production and sales levels, efficiency, cost management, business development, project delivery and technology progress). All the targets were established at the beginning of the year by the remuneration committee. 2004 was an extremely good year. The Group met or exceeded its annual plan in all material respects. The primary financial target, cash from operations, was exceeded. All the key metrics and milestones were delivered, along with some notable successes in relation to Russia and exploration in Egypt and the Gulf of Mexico. Assessment of all the results, including those on people, safety, environment and organization, resulted in awards of 150% of salary for the executive directors. The committee determined that, given the year's excellent performance, it was appropriate that Lord Browne receive 165% of salary, reflecting his higher bonus target level. All calculations have been reviewed by the auditors.

Past Directors

        Following his retirement from BP p.l.c., Mr Olver was appointed on July 1, 2004 as a consultant to BP in relation to its activities in Russia. He had previously been appointed as a BP-nominated director of TNK-BP Limited, a joint venture company owned 50% by BP, effective April 20, 2004. Under the consultancy agreement, he received £150,000 in fees in 2004 and, as a director, deputy chairman and chairman of the audit committee of the joint venture company, he received $90,000 in fees from TNK-BP Limited.

        Following his retirement in May 2003, Mr. Rodney Chase was engaged as a consultant to BP in relation to the TNK-BP transaction and was appointed as a BP-nominated director of TNK-BP-Limited. Mr Chase's consultancy to BP ended in May 2004 and he left the board of TNK-BP Limited in March 2004. Under the consultancy agreement, he received $250,000 in 2004 and as a director, deputy chairman and chairman of the audit committee of TNK-BP Limited he received $30,000 in fees from that company.

        Long-term awards for both former directors of BP p.l.c. are in accordance with scheme rules and are outlined in Compensation — 2004 Remuneration for Executive Directors — Long-term Performance-based Components in this Item on page 129.

127



Long-term Performance-based Components

Share Element of EDIP and Long Term Performance Plans (LTPPs)

        Under the share element of the EDIP and the Long Term Performance Plans, performance units were granted at the beginning of the three-year period and converted into an award of shares at the end of the period, depending on performance. There is a maximum of two shares per performance unit. For 2005 and future years, a different grant mechanism will apply (as described in Compensation — Elements of Remuneration — Long-term Incentives — Share Element in this Item on page 123).

        For the 2002-2004 share element of the EDIP and the LTPPs, BP's performance was assessed in terms of SHRAM, ROACE and EPS growth. BP's three-year SHRAM was measured against the companies in the FTSE All World Oil & Gas Index. Companies within the index are weighted according to their market capitalization at the beginning of each three-year period in order to give greatest emphasis to oil majors. BP's ROACE and EPS were measured against ExxonMobil, Shell, Total and Chevron. Based on a performance assessment of 75 points out of 200 (0 for SHRAM, 50 for ROACE and 25 for EPS growth), the committee made awards of shares to executive directors as highlighted in the 2002-2004 lines of the table below.

128


        The following table summarizes the LTPPs and share elements of the executive directors' remuneration for 2004.

 
  LTPP/Share element interests

  Interests vested

 
   
   
  Market price
of each share
at date of
grant of
performance
units
£

   
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
   
  Performance Units (b)

   
   
  Market price
of each share
at share
award date
£

 
   
  Date of
grant of
performance
units

  Number of
ordinary
shares
awarded (c)

   
 
  Performance
period (a)

  At Jan 1,
2004

  Granted
2004

  At Dec 31,
2004

  Share award
date

The Lord Browne of Madingley   2001-2003   Feb 19, 2001   5.80   415,000       352,750   Feb 12, 2004   4.13
    2002-2004   Feb 18, 2002   5.73   475,556     475,556   356,667   February 9, 20055.49
    2003-2005   Feb 17, 2003   3.96   632,512     632,512      
    2004-2006   Feb 25, 2004   4.25     634,447   634,447      

Dr D C Allen

 

2001-2003

 

Mar 12, 2001

 

5.88

 

73,550

 


 


 

62,518

 

Feb 12, 2004

 

4.13
    2002-2004   Mar 6, 2002   5.99   80,000     80,000   60,000   February 9, 20055.49
    2003-2005   Feb 17, 2003   3.96   197,044     197,044      
    2004-2006   Feb 25, 2004   4.25     188,235   188,235      

Dr B E Grote

 

2001-2003

 

Feb 19, 2001

 

5.80

 

155,000

 


 


 

131,750

 

Feb 12, 2004

 

4.13
    2002-2004   Feb 18, 2002   5.73   182,613     182,613   136,960   February 9, 20055.49
    2003-2005   Feb 17, 2003   3.96   233,638     233,638      
    2004-2006   Feb 25, 2004   4.25     212,669   212,669      

Dr A B Hayward(d)

 

2001-2003

 

Mar 12, 2001

 

5.88

 

64,500

 


 


 

54,825

 

Feb 12, 2004

 

4.13
    2002-2004   Mar 6, 2002   5.99   73,500     73,500   55,125   February 9, 20055.49
    2003-2005   Feb 17, 2003   3.96   197,044     197,044      
    2004-2006   Feb 25, 2004   4.25     188,235   188,235      

J A Manzoni(d)

 

2001-2003

 

Mar 12, 2001

 

5.88

 

60,200

 


 


 

51,170

 

Feb 12, 2004

 

4.13
    2002-2004   Mar 6, 2002   5.99   80,000     80,000   60,000   February 9, 20055.49
    2003-2005   Feb 17, 2003   3.96   197,044     197,044      
    2004-2006   Feb 25, 2004   4.25     188,235   188,235      

Directors appointed to the board in 2004

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

I C Conn

 

2001-2003

 

Mar 12, 2001

 

5.88

 

60,200

(e)


 


 

51,170

 

Feb 12, 2004

 

4.13
    2002-2004   Mar 6, 2002   5.99   69,000 (e)   69,000   51,750   February 9, 20055.49
    2003-2005   Feb 17, 2003   3.96   91,000 (e)   91,000      
    2004-2006   Feb 25, 2004   4.25     91,000   91,000      

Directors who left the board in 2004

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

R L Olver

 

2001-2003

 

Feb 19, 2001

 

5.80

 

170,000

 


 


 

144,500

 

Feb 12, 2004

 

4.13
    2002-2004   Feb 18, 2002   5.73   196,296     196,296(f ) 147,222   February 9, 20055.49
    2003-2005   Feb 17, 2003   3.96   274,138     274,138(f )    

Former Directors

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

R F Chase

 

2001-2003

 

Feb 19, 2001

 

5.80

 

205,000

 


 


 

174,250

 

Feb 12, 2004

 

4.13
    2002-2004   Feb 18, 2002   5.73   237,037     237,037   177,778   February 9, 20055.49
    2002-2004   Mar 13, 2002   6.17   34,994     34,994   26,245   February 9, 20055.49

Dr J G S Buchanan

 

1998-2000

 

Feb 5, 1998

 

4.05

 

159,900

 


 


 

351,453

(g)

Feb 12, 2004

 

4.13
    2001-2003   Feb 19, 2001   5.80   165,000       140,250   Feb 12, 2004   4.13
    2002-2004   Feb 18, 2002   5.73   192,593     192,593   144,445   February 9, 20055.49
    2002-2004   Mar 13, 2002   6.17   28,433     28,433   21,325   February 9, 20055.49

W D Ford

 

2001-2003

 

Feb 19, 2001

 

5.80

 

170,000

 


 


 

144,500

 

Feb 12, 2004

 

4.13

(a)
Dr Allen, Dr Hayward and Mr Manzoni continue to have performance units for the performance periods 2001-2003 and 2002-2004 granted under LTPPs, and Mr Conn for the periods 2001-2003 to 2004-2006 inclusive. They are not required to relinquish these rights, which were granted prior to their appointments as executive directors. All other units were granted under the EDIP as explained

129


(b)
Represents number of performance units, each having a maximum potential of two shares depending on performance.

(c)
Represents awards of shares made at the end of the relevant performance period based on performance achieved under rules of the plan.

(d)
Dr Hayward and Mr Manzoni elected to defer to 2005 the determination of whether LTPP awards should be made for the 1999-2001 performance period. As this period ended prior to their appointment as directors, the expected awards are not included in the table.

(e)
On appointment to the board of BP p.l.c. on July 1, 2004.

(f)
On leaving the board of BP p.l.c. on July 1, 2004.

(g)
Dr Buchanan elected to defer to 2004 the determination of whether an award should be made for the 1998-2000 period. This number includes dividends.

130


Share Options

        The table below represents the interests of executive directors in options over ordinary shares during 2004.

 
  Option
type

  At Jan 1,
2004

  Granted

  Exercised

  At
Dec 31, 2004

  Option
price

  Market
price at
date of
exercise

  Date from
which first
exercisable

  Expiry date

The Lord Browne of Madingley   SAYE   4,550       4,550   £ 3.50       Sept 1, 08   Feb 28, 09
    EDIP   408,522       408,522   £ 5.99       May 15, 01   May 15, 07
    EDIP   1,269,843       1,269,843   £ 5.67       Feb 19, 02   Feb 19, 08
    EDIP   1,348,032       1,348,032   £ 5.72       Feb 18, 03   Feb 18, 09
    EDIP   1,348,032       1,348,032   £ 3.88       Feb 17, 04   Feb 17, 10
    EDIP     1,500,000     1,500,000   £ 4.22       Feb 25, 05   Feb 25, 11

Dr D C Allen

 

EXEC

 

37,000

 


 


 

37,000

 

£

5.99

 

 


 

May 15, 03

 

May 15, 10
    EXEC   87,950       87,950   £ 5.67       Feb 23, 04   Feb 23, 11
    EXEC   175,000       175,000   £ 5.72       Feb 18, 05   Feb 18, 12
    EDIP   220,000       220,000   £ 3.88       Feb 17, 04   Feb 17, 10
    EDIP     275,000     275,000   $ 4.22       Feb 25, 05   Feb 25, 11

Dr B E Grote (a)

 

SAR

 

40,800

 


 

40,800

 


 

$

16.63

 

$

48.67

 

Mar 25, 97

 

Mar 25, 04
    SAR   35,600     35,600     $ 19.16   $ 61.60   Feb 28, 98   Feb 28, 05
    SAR   35,200       35,200   $ 25.27       Mar 6, 99   Mar 6, 06
    SAR   40,000       40,000   $ 33.34       Feb 28, 00   Feb 28, 07
    BPA   10,404       10,404   $ 53.90       Mar 15, 00   Mar 14, 09
    BPA   12,600       12,600   $ 48.94       Mar 28, 01   Mar 27, 10
    EDIP   40,182       40,182   $ 49.65       Feb 19, 02   Feb 19, 08
    EDIP   58,173       58,173   $ 48.82       Feb 18, 03   Feb 18, 09
    EDIP   58,173       58,173   $ 37.76       Feb 17, 04   Feb 17, 10
    EDIP     58,333     58,333   $ 48.53       Feb 25, 05   Feb 25, 11

Dr A B Hayward

 

SAYE

 

3,302

 


 


 

3,302

 

£

5.11

 

 


 

Sept 1, 06

 

Feb 28, 07
    EXEC   34,000       34,000   £ 5.99       May 15, 03   May 15, 10
    EXEC   77,400       77,400   £ 5.67       Feb 23, 04   Feb 23, 11
    EXEC   160,000       160,000   £ 5.72       Feb 18, 05   Feb 18, 12
    EDIP   220,000       220,000   £ 3.88       Feb 17, 04   Feb 17, 10
    EDIP     275,000     275,000   £ 4.22       Feb 25, 05   Feb 25, 11

J A Manzoni

 

SAYE

 

750

 


 

750

 


 

£

4.50

 

£

5.04

 

Sept 1, 04

 

Feb 28, 05
    SAYE   878       878   £ 4.52       Sept 1, 07   Feb 28, 08
    SAYE   2,548       2,548   £ 3.50       Sept 1, 08   Feb 28, 09
    SAYE     847     847   £ 3.86       Sept 1, 09   Feb 28, 10
    EXEC   12,000       12,000   £ 2.04       Feb 28, 98   Feb 28, 05
    EXEC   34,000       34,000   £ 5.99       May 15, 03   May 15, 10
    EXEC   72,250       72,250   £ 5.67       Feb 23, 04   Feb 23, 11
    EXEC   175,000       175,000   £ 5.72       Feb 18, 05   Feb 18, 12
    EDIP   220,000       220,000   £ 3.88       Feb 17, 04   Feb 17, 10
    EDIP     275,000     275,000   £ 4.22       Feb 25, 05   Feb 25, 11

Directors appointed to the board in 2004

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

I C Conn

 

SAYE

 

1,050

(b)


 

1,050

 


 

£

4.50

 

£

5.04

 

Sept 1, 04

 

Feb 28, 05
    SAYE   1,355 (b)     1,355   £ 4.98       Sept 1, 05   Feb 28, 06
    SAYE   1,456 (b)     1,456   £ 3.50       Sept 1, 08   Feb 28, 09
    SAYE     1,186     1,186   £ 3.86       Sept 1, 09   Feb 28, 10
    EXEC   900 (b)     900   £ 5.67       Feb 23, 04   Feb 23, 11
    EXEC   71,350 (b)     71,350   £ 5.67       Feb 23, 04   Feb 23, 11
    EXEC   4,356 (b)     4,356   £ 5.72       Feb 18, 05   Feb 18, 12
    EXEC   125,644 (b)     125,644   £ 5.72       Feb 18, 05   Feb 18, 12
    EXEC   160,000 (b)     160,000   £ 3.88       Feb 17, 06   Feb 17, 13
    EXEC     126,000 (b)   126,000   £ 4.22       Feb 25, 07   Feb 25, 14

Director who left the board in 2004

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

R L Olver

 

SAYE

 

2,642

 


 


 

2,642

(c)

£

3.50

 

 


 

Sept 1, 06

 

Feb 28, 07
    EDIP   71,847       71,847 (c) £ 5.99       May 15, 01   May 15, 07
    EDIP   260,319       260,319 (c) £ 5.67       Feb 19, 02   Feb 19, 08
    EDIP   370,956       247,304 (c)(d) £ 5.72       Feb 18, 03   Feb 18, 09
    EDIP   370,956       123,652 (c)(d) £ 3.88       Feb 17, 04   Feb 17, 10
    EDIP     400,000     (c)(d) £ 4.22        

131



        The closing market prices of an ordinary share and of an ADS on 31 December 2004 were £5.08 and $58.40 respectively. During 2004, the highest market prices were £5.56 and $62.10 respectively, and the lowest market prices were £4.13 and $46.65 respectively.

EDIP Executive Directors' Incentive Plan adopted by shareholders in April 2000 as described in Compensation — Elements of Remuneration — Long-Term Incentives in this Item on pages 123-125. The grants were made taking into consideration the ranking of the company's TSR against the TSR of the FTSE Global 100 group of companies over the three-year period prior to the grant.

BPA


BP Amoco share option plan, which applied to US executive directors prior to the adoption of the EDIP.

SAR


Stock Appreciation Rights under BP America Inc. Share Appreciation Plan. In keeping with the US market practice, none of the options under the BPA and SAR is subject to performance conditions because they were granted under American plans to the relevant individuals.

SAYE


Save As You Earn employee share option scheme. These options are not subject to performance conditions because this is an all-employee share scheme governed by specific tax legislation.

EXEC


Executive Share Option Scheme. These options were granted to the relevant individuals prior to their appointments as directors and are not subject to performance conditions.
(a)
Numbers shown are ADSs under option. One ADS is equivalent to six ordinary shares.

(b)
On appointment to the board of BP p.l.c. on 1 July 2004.

(c)
On leaving the board of BP p.l.c. on 1 July 2004.

(d)
Remaining options after deduction of those that lapsed on retirement.

132


Pensions

        In the table below, amounts are shown in the currency received. For information, the average exchange rate for 2004 was £1 = $1.83. Lord Browne, Dr Allen, Mr Conn, Dr Hayward and Mr Manzoni accrued pension benefits in pounds sterling (the currency of payment). Similarly, Dr Grote accrued pension benefits in US dollars.

 
  Service at
Dec 31, 2004

  Accrued
pension
entitlement at
Dec 31, 2004

  Additional
pension earned
during the
year ended
Dec 31, 2004

  Transfer
value of
accrued
benefit at
Dec 31,
2003 (a)
A

  Transfer
value of
accrued
benefit at
Dec 31,
2004 (a)
B

  Amount of
B-A less
contributions
made by
the director
in 2004

 
  (thousand)

The Lord Browne of Madingley (UK)   38 years   £944   £45   £13,921   £15,189   £1,268
Dr D C Allen (UK)   26 years   £183   £15   £2,089   £2,264   £175
I C Conn (UK)   19 years   £127   £35   £849   £1,217   £368
Dr B E Grote (US)   25 years   $465   $94   $4,814   $5,529   $715
Dr A B Hayward (UK)   23 years   £188   £18   £1,967   £2,255   £288
J A Manzoni (UK)   21 years   £149   £14   £1,395   £1,595   £200
Director who left the board in 2004                        
R L Olver (UK) (b)   31 years   £390     £6,271   £9,098   £2,827

(a)
Transfer values have been calculated in accordance with version 8.1 of guidance note GN11 issued by the actuarial profession.

(b)
Mr Olver retired on July 1, 2004 and elected to take a lump sum of £905,194 in lieu of part of his entitlement. The figures in the table include the allowance for this lump sum.

UK Directors

        UK directors are members of the regular BP Pension Scheme. Scheme members' core benefits are non-contributory. They include a pension accrual of 1/60th of basic salary for each year of service, subject to a maximum of two-thirds of final basic salary; and a dependant's benefit of two-thirds of the member's pension. Bonuses are not pensionable for UK directors. The scheme pension is not integrated with state pension benefits.

        Normal retirement age is 60, but scheme members who have 30 or more years' pensionable service at age 55 can elect to retire early without an actuarial reduction being applied to their pension.

        In accordance with the Company's past practice for executive directors who retire from BP on or after age 55 having accrued at least 30 years' service, Lord Browne remains eligible for consideration for a payment from the company of an ex-gratia lump-sum superannuation payment equal to one year's base salary following his retirement. All matters relating to such superannuation payments are considered by the remuneration committee. Any such payment would be additional to his pension entitlements referred to above. No other executive director is eligible for consideration for a superannuation payment on retirement, as the remuneration committee decided in 1996 that appointees to the board after that time should cease to be eligible for consideration for such a payment.

        The UK government has announced important proposals on pensions, the impact of which will be reviewed further by the committee in 2005 in conjunction with studies being carried out by the

133



Company into the wider effects of the new legislation for employees. The intention is that the approach to the new legislation should be consistent for directors and other employees. The committee will report further on the outcome of these studies in the next remuneration report.

US Directors

        Dr Grote as a US director participates in the US BP Retirement Accumulation Plan (US plan), which features a cash balance formula. The current design of the US plan became effective on 1 July 2000.

        Consistent with US tax regulations, pension benefits are provided through a combination of tax-qualified and non-qualified benefit restoration plans, as applicable.

        The Supplemental Executive Retirement Benefit (supplemental plan) is a non-qualified top-up arrangement that became effective on January 1, 2002 for US employees above a specified salary level.

        The benefit formula is 1.3% of final average earnings, which comprise base salary and bonus in accordance with standard US practice (as specified under the qualified arrangement) multiplied by years of service, with an offset for benefits payable under all other BP qualified and non-qualified pension arrangements. This benefit is unfunded and therefore paid from corporate assets.

        Dr Grote is an eligible participant under the supplemental plan, and his pension accrual for 2004 includes the total amount that may become payable under all plans.

Executive Directors' Shareholdings —

Executive directors' interest in BP ordinary shares or calculated equivalents

  At
January 1, 2004
or on
appointment

  At
December 31, 2004

  At
June 28, 2005

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Current directors              
Dr D C Allen   371,365   408,342   443,742 (a)
The Lord Browne of Madingley   1,816,054   2,031,279   2,241,712 (b)
I C Conn   119,098 (c) 121,187   153,389 (d)
Dr B E Grote   788,313   888,213   969,021 (e)
A B Hayward   121,692   206,084   300,691  
J A Manzoni   127,821   196,336   271,161  
 
  At
January 1, 2004

  At retirement

   
 
Director who left the board in 2004              
R L Olver   798,326   884,408 (f)    

(a)
Includes 25,368 shares held as ADSs.

(b)
Includes 57,471 shares held as ADSs.

(c)
On appointment on July 1, 2004.

(d)
Includes 38,244 shares held as ADSs.

(e)
Held as ADSs

(f)
On leaving the board on July 1, 2004.

134


        In disclosing the above interests to the Company under the Companies Act 1985, directors did not distinguish their beneficial and non-beneficial interests.

        Executive directors are also deemed to have an interest in such shares of the Company held from time to time by The BP Employee Share Ownership Plan (No. 2) to facilitate the operation of the Company's option schemes.

        No director has any interest in the preference shares or debentures of the Company, or in the shares or loan stock of any subsidiary company.

Remuneration of Non-Executive Directors

Policy

        The board sets the level of remuneration for all non-executive directors within the limit approved from time to time by shareholders. In line with BP's governance policies, the remuneration of the chairman is set by the board rather than by the remuneration committee, since the performance of the chairman is a matter for the board as a whole rather than any one committee.

        The board has adopted the following policies to guide its current and future decision-making with regard to non-executive directors' remuneration.

Elements of remuneration

        Non-executive directors' pay comprises cash fees, paid monthly, with increments for positions of additional responsibility, reflecting additional workload and consequent potential liability. For all non-executive directors, except the chairman, a fixed sum allowance is paid for transatlantic travel undertaken for the purpose of attending a board or board committee meeting. In addition, non-executive directors receive reimbursement of reasonable travel and related business expenses. No share or share option awards are made to any non-executive director in respect of service on the board.

Letters of appointment

        Non-executive directors have letters of appointment, which recognize that, subject to the Articles of Association, their service is at the discretion of the shareholders. All directors stand for re-election at each annual general meeting.

135


Non-Executive Directors' Annual Fee Structure

        The fees paid to non-executive directors are set by the board within the limit set by shareholders in accordance with the Articles. Shareholders approved an increase to this limit at the 2004 AGM. All fees are fixed and paid in pounds sterling. Fees payable to non-executive directors were adjusted as from January 1, 2005.

 
  2005
£

  2004
£

 
 
  (thousands)

  (thousands)

 
Chairman   500 (a) 390 (a)
Deputy chairman   100 (b) 85 (b)
Board member   75   65  
Committee chairmanship fee   20   15  
Transatlantic attendance allowance (c)   5   5  

(a)
The chairman is not eligible for committee chairmanship fees or transatlantic attendance allowance but has the use of a fully maintained office for company business and a chauffeured car.

(b)
The deputy chairman receives a £20,000 (2005: £25,000) increment on top of the standard board fee. In addition, he is eligible for committee chairmanship fees and the transatlantic attendance allowance. The deputy chairman is currently chairman of the audit committee.

(c)
This allowance is payable to non-executive directors undertaking transatlantic travel for the purpose of attending a board meeting or board committee meeting.

 
  2004

  2003

Remuneration of Non-Executive Directors

  $ (a)

  £

  $ (b)

  £

 
  (thousands)

J H Bryan   183   100   155   95
A Burgmans (c)   97   53   n/a   n/a
E B Davis, Jr   192   105   147   90
Dr D S Julius   137   75   130   80
C F Knight*   165   90   155   95
Sir Tom McKillop (d)   70   38   n/a   n/a
Dr W E Massey   210   115   179   110
H M P Miles (e)   137   75   130   80
Sir Robin Nicholson (f)*   165   90   155   95
Sir Ian Prosser   201   110   187   115
P D Sutherland   714   390   636   390
M H Wilson   174   95   155   95
Director who left the board in 2004                
F A Maljers (g)   29   16   130   80

(a)
Sterling payments converted at the average 2004 exchange rate of £1 = $1.83.

(b)
Sterling payments converted at the average 2003 exchange rate of £1 = $1.63.

(c)
Appointed on February 5, 2004.

(d)
Appointed on July 1, 2004.

(e)
Also received £600 in 2003 for serving as a director of BP Pension Trustees Limited. These fees are no longer payable to BP non-executive directors.

(f)
Also received £20,000 each year for serving as the board's representative on the BP technology advisory council.

(g)
Retired at AGM on April 15, 2004.

*
Retired at AGM on April 14, 2005.

136


Long-Term Incentives (Residual)

        Non-executive directors of Amoco Corporation were allocated restricted stock in the Amoco Non-Employee Directors' Restricted Stock Plan by way of remuneration for their service on the board of Amoco Corporation prior to its merger with BP in 1998. On merger, interests in Amoco shares in the plan were converted into interests in BP ADSs. Under the terms of the plan, the restricted stock will vest upon the retirement of the non-executive director having reached age 70 or upon earlier retirement at the discretion of the board. Since the merger, no further entitlements have accrued to any director under the plan.

Amoco Non-Employee Directors' Restricted Stock Plan

        The table below sets out the residual entitlements of non-executive directors who were formerly non-executive directors of Amoco Corporation under the Amoco Non-Employee Directors' Restricted Stock Plan.

 
  Interest in BP ADSs
at January 1, 2004 and
December 31, 2004 (a)

  Date on which director
reaches age 70 (b)

 
J H Bryan   5,546   October 5, 2006  
E B Davis, Jr   4,490   August 5, 2014  
Dr W E Massey   3,346   April 5, 2008  
M H Wilson   3,170   November 4, 2007  
Director who left the board in 2004          
F A Maljers   2,906   August 12, 2003 (c)

(a)
No awards were granted and no awards lapsed during 2004.

(b)
For the purposes of the regulations, the date on which the director retires from the board at or after the age of 70 is the end of the qualifying period. If the director retires prior to this date, the board may waive the restrictions.

(c)
Mr Maljers retired from the board on April 15, 2004 and, in accordance with the terms of the plan, his awards vested on that date (when the BP ADS closing price was $54.16) without payment by him. These awards over BP ADS derived from awards over Amoco shares granted between April 26, 1994 and April 28, 1998. The awards were granted over Amoco stock prior to the merger but their notional weighted average market value at the date of grant (applying the subsequent merger ratio of 0.66167 of a BP ADS for every Amoco share) was $27.87 per BP ADS.

Superannuation Gratuities

        In accordance with the Company's long-standing practice, non-executive directors who retire from the board after at least six years' service are, at the time of their retirement, eligible for consideration for a superannuation gratuity. The board is authorized to make such payments under the Company's Articles. The amount of the payment is determined at the board's discretion (having regard to the director's period of service as a director and other relevant factors).

        In 2002, the board revised its policy with respect to such payments so that: (i) non-executive directors appointed to the board after July 1, 2002 would not be eligible for consideration for such a payment; and (ii) while non-executive directors in service at July 1, 2002 would remain eligible for consideration for a payment, service after that date would not be taken into account by the board in considering the amount of any such payment.

        The board made no superannuation gratuity payments during 2004.

137



Non-Executive Directors' Shareholdings

Non-Executive Directors' interest in BP ordinary shares or calculated equivalents

  At
December 31, 2004

  At January 1, 2004
or on
appointment

  Change from
December 31, 2004
to June 28, 2005

A Burgmans (b)   10,000   10,000  
J H Bryan   158,760 (a) 158,760 (a)
E B Davis, Jr   66,349 (a) 65,162 (a) 641
D J Flint (c)       15,000
Dr D S Julius   15,000   15,000  
C F Knight*   98,578 (a) 95,610 (a) 204
Dr W E Massey   49,722 (a) 49,261 (a)
Sir Tom McKillop (d)   20,000    
H M P Miles   22,145   22,145    
Sir Robin Nicholson*   4,020   3,897   32
Sir Ian Prosser   16,301   16,301  
P D Sutherland   30,079   30,079  
M H Wilson   60,000 (a) 60,000 (a)

(a)
Held as ADSs.

(b)
Mr. A Burgmans was appointed February 5, 2004.

(c)
Mr D J Flint was appointed January 1, 2005

(d)
Sir Tom McKillop was appointed July 1, 2004

*
Retired at AGM on April 14, 2005.

        In disclosing the above interests to the Company under the Companies Act 1985, directors did not distinguish their beneficial and non-beneficial interests.

        No director has any interest in the preference shares or debentures of the Company, or in the shares or loan stock of any subsidiary company.

Total Remuneration

        Total remuneration includes salary and benefits earned and paid during the relevant year, plus bonuses, which are paid in the following year, plus for 2004 the value of the awards made under the 2001 to 2003 LTPP in respect of the three years covered by that plan. The total remuneration paid during 2004 to all directors and senior management as a group (22 persons at December 31, 2004) was $32 million. Total share options granted during 2004 to all directors and senior management as a group was 3,539,998; these have an option price of £4.22 and expire in 2011. The amount accrued during 2004 to provide pension benefits to all directors and senior management as a group was $14 million.

        During 2005, the Company will introduce a new Medium Term Performance Plan (MTPP) and a new Deferred Annual Bonus Plan (DABP) for Senior Management. Executive Directors will not participate in either plan. Under the MTPP, Performance Units will be granted at the start of a three-year performance period, representing the maximum potential share award. At the end of this period, shares will be awarded based on BP's performance against two measures and the number of Performance Units granted to the individual. Under the DAPB, shares will be awarded to participants annually to reflect a proportion of the annual cash bonus that their performance has earned. The shares will vest after a three-year retention period. Both plans will have effect from January 1, 2005. The MTPP replaces the existing LTPP element of senior management's total remuneration and, with effect from January 1, 2005, senior management no longer receives annual grants of share options under the BP Share Option Plan.

138



BOARD PRACTICES

Directors' Terms of Office

  Date of expiration of
current term of office (a)

  Period during which the
director has served in
this office (from
appointment to June 2005)

Dr D C Allen   April 2006   2 years 3 months
The Lord Browne of Madingley   April 2006   13 years 9 months
J H Bryan (b)   April 2006   6 years 6 months
A Burgmans   April 2006   1 year 4 months
I C Conn   April 2006   11 months
E B Davis, Jr (b)   April 2006   6 years 6 months
D J Flint   April 2006   5 months
Dr B E Grote   April 2006   4 years 10 months
Dr A B Hayward   April 2006   2 years 4 months
Dr D S Julius   April 2006   3 years 7 months
Sir Tom McKillop   April 2006   11 months
J A Manzoni   April 2006   2 years 4 months
Dr W E Massey (b)   April 2006   6 years 6 months
H M P Miles   April 2006   11 years 0 months
Sir Ian Prosser   April 2006   8 years 1 month
P D Sutherland (c)   April 2006   9 years 11 months
M H Wilson (b)   April 2006   6 years 6 months

(a)
Shareholders approved an amendment to the Articles of Association such that at each AGM held after December 31, 2004, all directors shall retire from office and may offer themselves for re-election. Therefore all directors will retire or offer themselves for re-election in accordance with the Articles of Association at the 2005 AGM.

(b)
Does not include service on the board of Amoco Corporation

(c)
Mr Sutherland previously served as a director from 1990-1993.

Directors' Service Contracts Providing for Benefits upon Termination of Employment

        All service contracts expire at normal retirement date and have a notice period of one year.

        The service contracts of Dr Allen, Dr Hayward, Mr Manzoni and Mr Conn may also be terminated by the Company at any time with immediate effect on payment in lieu of notice equivalent to one year's salary or the amount of salary that would have been paid if the contract had terminated on the expiry of the remainder of the notice period.

        Dr Grote's service contract is with BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. He is seconded to BP p.l.c. under a secondment agreement dated August 7, 2000. At December 31, 2004, this secondment agreement had an unexpired term of three years. The secondment may be terminated by one month's notice by either party and terminates automatically on the termination of Dr Grote's service contract.

        There are no other provisions for compensation payable on early termination of the above contracts. In the event of early termination under any of the above contracts by the Company other than for cause (or under a specific termination payment provision), the relevant director's then current salary and benefits would be taken into account in calculating any liability of the Company.

139



        Since January 2003, the committee has included a provision in new service contracts to allow for severance payments to be phased, where appropriate to do so. It will also consider mitigation to reduce compensation to a departing director, where appropriate to do so.

Governance and the role of our board

        Good governance is often defined in terms of the presence or absence of particular practices without reference to the underlying purpose of governance processes. We believe that governance is a more powerful concept.

        Governance is not an exercise in compliance nor is it a higher form of management. Governance lies at the heart of all the board does and it is the task our owners entrust to the board. It has a clear objective — ensuring the pursuit of the Company's purpose. The board's role is focused on this task, which is unique to it as the representative of BP's owners. This task is discharged by the board through undertaking such activities as are necessary for the effective promotion of shareholder interest.

        Governance is the system by which the Company's owners and their representatives on the board ensure that it pursues, does not deviate from and only allocates resources to its defined purpose.

        As a Company, we recognize the importance of good governance and that it is a discrete task from management. Clarity of roles is key to our approach. Policies and processes depend upon the people who operate them. Governance requires distinct skills and processes. In the context of BP, governance is overseen by our board while management is delegated to the group chief executive by means of the board governance policies.

        Our board governance policies use a coherent, principles-based approach, which anticipated many developments in UK governance regulation. They ensure that our board and management operate within a clear and efficient governance framework that goes beyond regulatory compliance and places shareholder interest at the heart of all we do.

Accountability to shareholders

        Our board is accountable in a variety of ways. It is required to be proactive in obtaining an understanding of shareholder preferences and to evaluate systematically the economic, social, environmental and ethical matters that may influence or affect the interest of our shareholders.

        Our board is accountable to shareholders for the performance and activities of the entire BP Group. It embeds shareholder interest in the goals established for the Company.

        In carrying out its work in policy-making and monitoring and in its active consideration of Group strategy, our board exercises judgement on how best to further shareholder interest. The board seeks to do so by maximizing the expected value of shareholders' interest in the Company, not by eliminating the possibility of any adverse outcomes.

Reporting

        Our board makes use of a number of formal communication channels to account to shareholders for the performance of the Group. These include the Annual Report and Accounts, the Annual Review, the Annual Report on Form 20-F, quarterly Forms 6-K and announcements made through stock exchanges on which BP shares are listed, as well as through the AGM.

Dialogue with directors

        Presentations given at appropriate intervals to representatives of the investment community are available to all shareholders by internet broadcast or open conference call. Less formal processes include contacts with institutional shareholders by the chairman and other non-executive directors. This

140



is supported by the dialogue with shareholders concerning the governance and operation of the Group maintained by the company secretary's office, investor relations and other BP teams.

AGM and voting

        Given the size and geographical diversity of our shareholder base, the opportunities for shareholder interaction at the AGM are limited. However, the chairman and all board committee chairmen were present at the 2004 and 2005 AGMs to answer shareholders' questions and hear their views during the meeting. Members of the board met informally with shareholders afterwards. All votes at shareholder meetings, whether by proxy or in person, are counted since votes on all matters, except procedural issues, are taken by way of a poll. We have pioneered the use of electronic communications to facilitate the exercise of shareholder control rights and continue to promote the use of electronic voting through our registrar's website and through CREST.

Directors' elections

        Directors are required to stand for re-election each year. New directors are subject to election at the first opportunity following their appointment. All names submitted to shareholders for election are accompanied by detailed biographies.

How our board governs the Company

        The board's governance policies regulate its relationship with shareholders, the conduct of board affairs and the board's relationship with the group chief executive. The policies recognize the board's separate and unique role as the link in the chain of authority between the shareholders and the group chief executive. It is this unique task that gives the board its central role in governance.

        The dual role played by the group chief executive and executive directors as both members of the board and leaders of the executive management is also recognized and addressed. The policies require a majority of the board to be composed of independent non-executive directors. To assure the integrity of the governance process, the relationship between the board and the group chief executive is governed by the non-executive directors, particularly through the work of the board committees they populate.

        Recognizing that as a group its capacity is limited, our board reserves to itself the making of broad policy decisions. It delegates more detailed considerations involved in meeting its stated requirements either to board committees and officers (in the case of its own processes) or to the group chief executive (in the case of the management of the Company's business activities). The board governs BP through setting general policy for the conduct of business (and critically, by clearly articulating its objective) and by monitoring its implementation by the group chief executive.

        To discharge its governance function in the most effective manner, our board has laid down rules for its own activities in a board process policy. The board process policy covers:

141


        The responsibility for implementation of this policy is placed on the chairman.

        The board-executive linkage policy sets out how the board delegates authority to the group chief executive and the extent of that authority. In its goals policy, the board states the long-term outcome and required results it expects the group chief executive to deliver. The restrictions on the manner in which the group chief executive may achieve the required results are set out in the executive limitations policy. This policy addresses internal control, risk preferences, financing, ethical behaviour, health, safety, the environment, treatment of employees and political considerations. Through the goals and executive limitations policies, the board shapes BP's values and standards.

Accountability in our business

        Our group chief executive outlines how he intends to deliver the required outcome in annual and medium-term plans, which also address a comprehensive assessment of the Group's risks. Progress towards the expected outcome forms the basis of a report to the board that covers actual results and a forecast of results for the current year. This report is reviewed at each board meeting.

        The group chief executive is obliged through dialogue and systematic review to discuss with our board all material matters currently or prospectively affecting the Company and its performance and all strategic projects or developments. This key dialogue specifically includes any materially under-performing business activities and actions that breach the executive limitations policy and material matters of a social, environmental and ethical nature.

        The board-executive linkage policy also sets out how the group chief executive's performance will be monitored and recognizes that, in the multitude of changing circumstances, judgement is always involved. The systems set out in the board-executive linkage policy are designed to manage, rather than to eliminate, the risk of failure to achieve the board goals policy or observe the executive limitations policy. They provide reasonable, not absolute, assurance against material misstatement or loss.

Who is on the board?

        Governance policies and processes depend upon the quality and commitment of the people who operate them.

        The board is composed of the chairman, 12 non-executive and six executive directors. In total, five nationalities are represented on the board. Directors' biographies are set out in Directors and Senior Management in this Item on pages 118-120. As reported last year, the board is actively engaged in succession planning issues. As a result, the size of the board has increased during the past year despite the departure of Mr Maljers and Mr Olver. Mr Burgmans (February), Sir Tom McKillop (July) and Mr Flint (from January 2005) were appointed as non-executive directors, while Mr Conn joined the board as an executive director in July.

        The efficiency and effectiveness of the board are paramount concerns. Our board is large but this is necessary to allow sufficient executive director representation to cover the breadth of the Group's business activities and sufficient non-executive representation to reflect the scale and complexity of BP and to staff our board committees. A board of this size allows orderly succession planning for key roles.

        We believe refreshing the composition of the board should be an orderly process of evolution that ensures its continuing effectiveness. New non-executive directors will be appointed over the coming

142



years. Mr Knight and Sir Robin Nicholson retired at the 2005 AGM. Mr Miles will retire in 2006 and subject to their annual re-election, Mr Bryan and Mr Wilson in 2007.

Board independence

        The qualification for board membership includes a requirement that all our non-executive directors be free from any relationship with the executive management of the Company that could materially interfere with the exercise of their independent judgement. In the board's view, all our non-executive directors fulfil this requirement. It determined all 12 who served during 2004 to be independent directors.

        Mr Knight and Sir Robin Nicholson were appointed to the BP board in 1987 and Mr Miles was appointed in 1994. The length of their respective service on the board exceeds the nine years referred to in the Combined Code. The board considers that the experience and long-term perspective of each of these directors on BP's business during its recent period of growth provide a valuable contribution to the board, given the long-term nature of our business. The integrity and independence of character of these directors are beyond doubt. Both Mr Knight and Sir Robin retired at the 2005 AGM. Mr Miles will retire in 2006.

        Those directors who joined the BP board in 1998 after service on the board of Amoco Corporation (Messrs Bryan, Massey, Wilson and Davis) are considered independent since the most senior executive management of BP comprises individuals who were not previously Amoco employees. While Amoco businesses and assets are a key part of the Group, the scope and scale of BP since its acquisition of the ARCO, Burmah Castrol and Veba businesses are fundamentally different from those of the former Amoco Corporation.

        The board has satisfied itself that there is no compromise to the independence of those directors who serve together as directors on the boards of outside entities (or who have other appointments in outside entities). Where necessary, our board ensures appropriate processes are in place to manage any possible conflict of interest.

        Sir Robin Nicholson received fees during 2004 for representing the board on the BP technology advisory council. Since these fees relate to board representation, they did not compromise Sir Robin's independence. Full details of these fees are disclosed in Compensation — Remuneration of Non-Executive Directors in this Item on page 136.

Directors' appointments, retirement policies and insurance

        The chairman and non-executive directors of BP are elected each year and, subject to BP's Articles of Association, serve on the basis of letters of appointment. Executive directors of BP have service contracts with the Company. Details of all payments to directors are set out in Compensation in this Item on pages 121-138.

        Annual elections for all directors and the provision of independent support to our board and board committees underscore our commitment to good governance practice.

        BP's policy on directors' retirement is as follows: executive directors retire at age 60, while non-executive directors ordinarily retire at the AGM following their 70th birthday. It is the board's policy that non-executive directors are not generally expected to hold office for more than 10 years.

        In accordance with BP's Articles of Association, directors are granted an indemnity from the Company to the extent permitted by law in respect of liabilities incurred as a result of their office. In respect of those liabilities for which directors may not be indemnified, the Company purchased and maintained a directors' and officers' liability insurance policy throughout 2004. This insurance cover was

143



renewed at the beginning of 2005. Neither the Company's indemnity nor insurance provides cover in the event that the director is proved to have acted fraudulently or dishonestly.

Board and committees: meetings and attendance

        In addition to the AGM (which all but one director attended), the board met eight times during 2004, five times in the UK, twice in the US and once in continental Europe. Two of these meetings were two-day strategy discussions. 2004 saw an increased number of committee meetings, with no sign that this trend will reverse.

        The board requires all members to devote sufficient time to the work of the board to discharge the office of director and to use their best endeavours to attend meetings. During 2004, directors attended at least 75% of meetings, except Mr Burgmans. Several board meetings coincided with commitments entered into by Mr Burgmans before his appointment to the board in February 2004, a matter made known to the board on his appointment. The board and Mr Burgmans are looking forward to his full participation in the years ahead.

Serving as a director: induction, training and evaluation

Induction

        Directors receive induction on their appointment to the board as appropriate, covering matters such as the operation and activities of the Group (including key financial, business, social and environmental risks to the Group's activities), the role of the board and the matters reserved for its decision, the tasks and membership of the principal board committees, the powers delegated to those committees, the board's governance policies and practices, and the latest financial information about the Group. The chairman is accountable for the induction of new board members.

Training

        Our directors are updated on BP's business, the environment in which it operates and other matters throughout their period in office. We advise directors on their appointment of the legal and other duties and obligations they have as directors of a listed company. The board regularly considers the implications of these duties under our board governance policies. Our non-executive directors receive training specific to the tasks of the particular board committees on which they serve.

Outside appointments

        As part of their ongoing development, our executive directors are permitted to take up an external board appointment, subject to the agreement of our board. Executive directors retain any fees received in respect of such external appointments.

        Generally outside appointments for executive directors are limited to one outside company board only, although our group chief executive, by exception, serves on two outside company boards. Our board is satisfied that these appointments do not conflict with his duties and commitment to BP. Non-executive directors may serve on a number of outside boards, always provided they continue to demonstrate the requisite commitment to discharge effectively their duties to BP. The nomination committee keeps the extent of directors' other interests under review to ensure that the effectiveness of our board is not compromised.

Evaluation

        During 2004, our board continued its ongoing evaluation processes to assess its performance and identify areas in which its effectiveness, policies or processes might be enhanced. The board reviewed

144



the conclusions and actions from the 2003 evaluation and determined that there should be a focus on evaluating the performance of the board committees during 2004.

        Regular evaluation of board effectiveness underpins our confidence in BP's governance policies and processes and affords opportunity for their development.

        Evaluations of both the audit and the ethics and environment assurance committees took place during 2004. An evaluation of the work of the remuneration committee will take place in 2005 as the review of executive remuneration is concluded and Dr Julius has assumed chairmanship of the committee. Work on a further evaluation of the board and the performance of individual directors has commenced.

The chairman and senior independent director

        BP's board governance policies require the chairman and deputy chairman to be non-executive directors; throughout 2004 the posts were held by Mr Sutherland and Sir Ian Prosser respectively. Sir Ian also acts as our senior independent director and is the director whom shareholders may contact if they feel their concerns are not being addressed through normal channels.

        Between board meetings, the chairman has responsibility for ensuring the integrity and effectiveness of the board/executive relationship. This requires his interaction with the group chief executive between board meetings, as well as his contact with other board members and shareholders. The chairman represents the views of the board to shareholders on key issues, not least in succession planning issues for both executive and non-executive appointments. The chairman and all the non-executive directors meet periodically as the chairman's committee (see Board Practices — Chairman's committee report in this Item on page 149). The performance of the chairman is evaluated each year at a meeting of the chairman's committee, for which item of business he is not present. The company secretary reports to the chairman and is not part of the executive management.

Board committees

        The board process policy allocates the tasks of monitoring executive actions and assessing performance to certain board committees. These tasks, rather than any terms of reference, prescribe the authority and the role of the board committees. Reports for each of the committees for 2004 appear below. In common with the board, each committee has access to independent advice and counsel as required and each is supported by the company secretary and his office, which is demonstrably independent of the executive management of the Group.

Audit committee report

Schedule and composition

        The committee met 13 times during 2004 and comprised the following directors: Sir Ian Prosser (chairman), J H Bryan, E B Davis, Jr, H M P Miles, M H Wilson.

        All members of the audit committee are independent non-executive directors. The board considers that the membership of the audit committee as a whole has sufficient recent and relevant financial experience to discharge its functions, but it has determined that during 2004 no one member of the audit committee had all the attributes of an audit committee financial expert as defined for purposes of disclosure Item 16A of Form 20-F. The Company did not have an audit committee financial expert because the board considered that the membership of the audit committee as a whole had sufficient recent and relevant financial experience to discharge its functions

        Douglas Flint joined the board as a non-executive director on January 1, 2005 and joined the audit committee on March 16, 2005. He is group finance director of HSBC Holdings plc, and former member

145



of the Accounting Standards Board and the Standards Advisory Council of the International Accounting Standards Board. The board determined that with effect from March 16, 2005 Mr Flint may be regarded as an audit committee financial expert as defined for purposes of disclosure Item 16A of Form 20-F.

        The external auditors' lead partner, the BP general auditor (head of internal audit), together with the group chief financial officer, the chief accounting officer and the group controller, attend each meeting at the request of the committee chairman. At least twice a year, the committee meets with the external auditor without the executive management being present. The committee also meets in private session with the general auditor.

Role and authority

        The audit committee's tasks are considered by the committee to be broader than those envisaged under UK Combined Code Provision C.3.2. The committee is satisfied that it addresses each of those matters identified as properly falling within an audit committee's purview. The committee has full delegated authority from the board to address those tasks assigned to it. In common with the board and all committees, it may request any information from the executive management necessary to discharge its functions and may, where it considers necessary, seek independent advice and counsel.

Process

        The committee structures its work programme so as to discharge its tasks, which include systematic monitoring and obtaining assurance that the legally required standards of disclosure are being fully and fairly observed and that the executive limitations relating to financial matters are being observed. The committee chairman reports on the committee's activities to the board meeting immediately following a committee meeting. Between meetings, the committee chairman reviews emerging issues with the group chief financial officer, the external auditor and the BP general auditor. He is supported in this task by the company secretary's office.

        During 2004, external specialist legal and regulatory advice has also been provided to the committee by Sullivan & Cromwell LLP. With significant changes in accounting practices being introduced in 2005, the committee undertook initial training in the implementation of International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) and how these standards are expected to affect the Group's reported results.

Activities in 2004

Financial reports

        During the year, the committee reviewed all annual and quarterly financial reports before recommending their publication on behalf of the board. In particular, the committee discussed significant accounting policies, estimates and judgements that had been applied in preparing these reports and received independent advice from the external auditors.

Accounting treatment

        The committee also received during the year separate reports concerning the Group's environmental and decommissioning provisions, tax exposures, pension assumptions and the status of current litigation. The committee gained assurance that such liabilities and contingencies were appropriately reflected in the financial results.

System of internal control

        Each year, specific reports on risk management and internal control within selected business and functional activities are considered. During 2004, the Exploration and Production and Petrochemicals

146



segments were reviewed, along with accounting issues of the supply and trading function that services all BP's businesses. Given the increased public and regulatory attention to hydrocarbon reserves reporting, the committee sought and received additional assurance that BP's management and recording processes are applied in a consistent and coherent manner throughout the Group. Following the adoption of the US Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, an increased regulatory requirement has been placed on all companies that offer shares by listing on US stock exchanges. The committee has monitored the Company's response to the applicable requirements of this Act and, in particular, its progress in evaluating internal controls as required by rules pursuant to Section 404 of the Act.

Employee concerns reporting/whistleblowing

        The committee receives regular reports of the matters raised through the employee concerns programme (OpenTalk) and, through this process, is alerted to instances of potential fraud or matters of concern raised related to the finances and financial accounting policies of the Group.

Auditor independence and rotation

        The committee reviews on behalf of the board the independence, objectivity and viability of the auditors before an appointment recommendation is made to shareholders at the AGM. A new lead audit partner is appointed every five years and other senior audit staff are rotated every seven years.

Policy on non-audit services provided by the auditor

        To safeguard the independence of the audit process, non-audit services provided by the auditor are limited to defined audit-related work and tax services that fall within specific categories. Additionally, all such services must be pre-approved by the committee. These services have been substantially reduced in 2004 but overall fees paid to Ernst & Young have increased, since audit fees have risen significantly across the market due to the increased regulatory burden on listed companies.

Internal audit

        The committee considers the internal auditor's programme and its effectiveness twice a year. It receives regular reports of work undertaken, actions recommended and the executive management's responses to those recommendations.

Performance evaluation

        Each year the committee critically reviews its own performance and considers where improvements can be made. During 2004, the committee strengthened its tracking of outstanding issues and clarified the scope of its role and relationship with that of the ethics and environment assurance committee. It also allocated additional time to training, not least on the implications of the introduction of IFRS. To accommodate all such matters and discharge its ongoing tasks the committee increased the number of meetings from nine in 2003 to 13 in 2004.

Ethics and environment assurance committee report

Schedule and composition

        The committee met six times during 2004 and comprised the following directors: Dr W E Massey (chairman), A Burgmans (from October 2004), F A Maljers (to April 2004), H M P Miles, M H Wilson.

        All members of the ethics and environment assurance committee are independent non-executive directors. The external auditors' lead partner and the BP general auditor (head of internal audit) attend each meeting at the request of the committee chairman. The committee met once during 2004 with the general auditor and external auditor but without the executive management being present.

147



Role and authority

        The task of the committee is to monitor matters relating to the executive management's processes to address environmental, health and safety, security and ethical behaviour issues. The committee monitors the observance of the executive limitations relating to non-financial risks to the Group.

Process and activities in 2004

        At each meeting, the committee considered a report from executive management on current developments in business and functional areas giving rise to ongoing and emergent non-financial risks to the Group's activities. In particular, during the course of 2004, the committee directed its attention to the BTC pipeline project and operations in Alaska and Russia. The committee's work programme also addressed:

Environmental liabilities

        Including a review of the Group's approach to remediation at operational and disused sites, encompassing all businesses ranging from mining activities to oil terminals to service stations.

Health, safety and environmental performance

        Greenhouse gas and other emissions, spills and containment practices and safety at work issues, both group-wide and in specific businesses and locations (for example, shipping, road safety and the operational integrity of plant and equipment).

Security

        Group preparedness and mitigation plans in respect of identified and potential security threats to staff, physical infrastructure and the digital infrastructure of the Group.

Employees

        The results of the annual People Assurance Survey, employee health and welfare and the impact of HIV/AIDS on our business.

Ethical behaviour

        Matters arising from the annual ethics certification process and OpenTalk (BP's employee concerns reporting programme), as well as other conduct and compliance issues.

Disaster recovery and business continuity planning and capability

        Development of the Group's capacity and capability to respond to catastrophic events and to maintain its business activities.

Performance evaluation

        The committee addressed the nature of its remit and authority, its interface with the audit committee and the scope and focus of its activities, as well as its overall effectiveness and refinements to its processes. The committee increased the number of its meetings from five in 2003 to six in 2004.

148



Remuneration committee report

Schedule and composition

        The committee met seven times during 2004 and comprised the following directors: Sir Robin Nicholson (chairman, retired at the 2005 AGM), Dr D S Julius (chairman elect), E B Davis, C F Knight (retired at the 2005 AGM), Sir Ian Prosser, J H Bryan (from November 2004), Sir Tom McKillop (from November 2004).

        All members of the remuneration committee are non-executive directors and are considered by the board to be independent. The chairman of the board also attends committee meetings. The committee is independently advised.

Role and authority

        The committee's main task is to determine the terms of engagement and remuneration of the executive directors. A key priority for the committee in 2004 was its review of executive directors' remuneration policy in preparation for the renewal of the long-term incentive plan for executive directors at the 2005 AGM.

Remuneration Committee Report

        Full details of executive directors' remuneration is set out in Compensation in this Item on pages 121-138.

Chairman's committee report

Schedule and composition

        The chairman's committee met three times during 2004 and comprised all the non-executive directors.

Role and authority

        The task of the committee is to consider broad issues of governance, including the performance of the chairman and the group chief executive, succession planning, the organization of the Group and any matters referred to it for an opinion from another board committee.

Process and activities in 2004

        At its various meetings, the committee evaluated the performance of the chairman and the group chief executive, considered the plan for executive succession and considered a number of other broad matters of governance, including the future governance of the Olefins and Derivatives business as it is prepared for its planned disposal. Additionally, the committee addressed non-executive succession planning issues in co-ordination with the nomination committee.

Nomination committee report

Schedule and composition

        The committee met twice during 2004 and comprised the following directors: P D Sutherland (chairman), Dr W E Massey, Sir Robin Nicholson, Sir Ian Prosser. All members of the nomination committee are considered by the board to be independent.

149



Role and authority

        The task of the nomination committee is to identify and evaluate candidates for appointment and reappointment as director or company secretary of BP.

Process

        During the year, the nomination committee carried out a detailed review of the skills and expertise of the non-executive directors as part of the board succession planning described earlier. The committee receives external assistance as required. The committee consults with the group chief executive concerning the identification and appointment of new executive directors.

Activities in 2004

        The committee considered the composition of the board and board committees in the context of forthcoming work programmes, BP's strategy and business activities and retirements from the board. Board and committee evaluation processes informed its work in identifying the skills and experience sought from potential candidates.

        External search consultants were retained in the UK, continental Europe and the US to assist the committee in the identification of potential candidates as non-executive directors. In close co-ordination with the chairman's committee (all the non-executive directors), the nomination committee recommended the appointment of the following directors during the year: Sir Tom McKillop, I C Conn and D J Flint.

150



EMPLOYEES

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
World

  Total

Number of employees at December 31,
2004
                   
Exploration and Production   2,900   650   5,000   7,100   15,650
Refining and Marketing   10,200   18,800   25,300   12,950   67,250
Petrochemicals   2,350   5,750   3,500   800   12,400
Gas, Power and Renewables   200   800   1,450   1,600   4,050
Other businesses and corporate   1,750     1,700   100   3,550
   
 
 
 
 
    17,400   26,000   36,950   22,550   102,900
   
 
 
 
 
2003                    
Exploration and Production   3,000   650   4,650   6,850   15,150
Refining and Marketing   10,050   17,850   25,700   12,550   66,150
Petrochemicals   2,500   5,950   6,150   1,350   15,950
Gas, Power and Renewables   200   800   1,350   1,400   3,750
Other businesses and corporate   1,300     1,250   150   2,700
   
 
 
 
 
    17,050   25,250   39,100   22,300   103,700
   
 
 
 
 
2002                    
Exploration and Production   3,500   800   5,300   7,000   16,600
Refining and Marketing   9,950   22,250   28,100   12,000   72,300
Petrochemicals   2,800   5,800   6,650   3,700   18,950
Gas, Power and Renewables   250   1,000   1,700   1,650   4,600
Other businesses and corporate   1,250     1,450   100   2,800
   
 
 
 
 
    17,750   29,850   43,200   24,450   115,250
   
 
 
 
 

        Employee numbers decreased in 2003 compared with 2002, with 21% of the decrease resulting from the disposal of Fosroc Mining, 20% from the reduction of service station staff in the US, 17% from the transfer of employees in Russia into TNK-BP and 12% from reorganization of Refining and Marketing operation in Germany.

        The Company seeks to maintain constructive relationships with labour unions.

151



SHARE OWNERSHIP

Directors and Senior Management

        As at June 28, 2005 the following directors of BP p.l.c. held interests in BP ordinary shares of 25 cents each or their calculated equivalent as set out below:

Dr D C Allen   443,742   436,623 (b)
The Lord Browne of Madingley   2,241,712   2,006,767 (b)
I C Conn   153,389   415,832 (b)
Dr B E Grote   969,021   501,780 (b)
Dr A B Hayward   300,691   436,623 (b)
J A Manzoni   271,161   436,623 (b)
J H Bryan   158,760    
A Burgmans   10,000    
E B Davis, Jr   66,990    
D J Flint   15,000    
Dr D S Julius   15,000    
Dr W E Massey   49,722    
Sir Tom McKillop   20,000    
H M P Miles   22,145    
Sir Ian Prosser   16,301    
P D Sutherland   30,079    
M H Wilson   60,000    

        As at June 28, 2005, the following directors of BP p.l.c. held options under the BP Group share option schemes for ordinary shares or their calculated equivalent as set out below:

Dr D C Allen   794,950      
The Lord Browne of Madingley   5,878,979      
I C Conn   492,247      
Dr B E Grote   1,427,190 (a)    
Dr A B Hayward   769,702      
J A Manzoni   780,523      

(a)
In addition to the above, Dr Grote holds 75,200 Stock Appreciation Rights (equivalent to 451,200 ordinary shares).

(b)
Performance shares awarded on April 28, 2005 under the BP Executive Directors Incentive Plan. These represent the maximum possible vesting levels. The actual number of shares/ADSs which vest will depend on the extent to which performance conditions have been satisfied over a three year period.

        There are no directors or members of senior management who own more than 1% of the ordinary Shares outstanding. At June 28, 2005, all directors and senior management as a group held interests in 10,788,278 ordinary shares or their calculated equivalent and 12,416,830 options for ordinary shares or their calculated equivalent under the BP Group share options schemes.

        Additional details regarding the options granted, including exercise price and expiry dates, are found in this item under the heading 'Compensation — Share Options.'

152



Employee Share Plans

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (options thousands)

Employee share options granted during the year (a)            
Executive Directors' Incentive Plan   2,783   2,728   2,068
BP Share Option Plan   71,750   78,109   66,771
Savings-related schemes   5,861   23,922   9,719
   
 
 
    80,394   104,759   78,558
   
 
 

(a)
The exercise prices for BP options granted during the year were £4.22/$7.73 (weighted average price) for Executive Directors' Incentive Plan (2,783,333 options); £4.38/$8.01 (weighted average price) for 71,750,436 options granted under the BP Share Option Plan; and £3.86/$7.06 (5,860,991 options) for savings-related and similar plans.

        BP offers most of its employees the opportunity to acquire a shareholding in the Company through savings-related and/or matching share plan arrangements. Such arrangements are now in place in more than 80 countries. BP also uses long-term performance plans (see Item 18 — Financial Statements Note 39 on page F-79) and the granting of share options as elements of remuneration for executive directors and senior employees.

        During 2004, share options were granted to the executive directors under the EDIP. For these options, the option exercise price was the market value (as determined in accordance with the plan rules) on the grant date. The options granted to executive directors reflect BP's performance in terms of total shareholder return, that is, share price increase with all dividends reinvested, relative to the FTSE Global 100 group of companies over the three years preceding the grant as well as the underlying health of the business and the competitive marketplace. Options have not been granted in any year unless the criteria for an award of shares under the share element of the EDIP (see Item 18 — Financial Statements Note 39 on page F-79) have been met. Options vest over three years (one-third each after one, two and three years respectively) and have a life of seven years after the grant.

        Share options were also granted in 2004 under the BP Share Option Plan to certain categories of employees. Subject to certain vesting requirements, the options are exercisable between the third and 10th anniversaries of the date of grant. There are no performance conditions attaching to the options granted during the year.

        Under the BP ShareSave Plan (a savings-related share option plan), employees save on a monthly basis over a three- or five-year period towards the purchase of shares at a price fixed when the option is granted. The option price is usually set at a 20% discount to the market price at the time of grant. The option must be exercised within six months of maturity of the savings contract; otherwise it lapses. The plan is run in the UK and a small number of other countries.

        Under the BP ShareMatch Plan, BP matches employees' own contributions of shares, up to a predetermined limit. The shares are then held in trust for a defined minimum period. The plan is run in the UK and in over 70 other countries.

        The Company sponsors a number of savings plans covering most US employees. Under these plans, most employees may contribute up to 100% of their salary subject to certain regulatory limits. Most employees are eligible for a dollar-for-dollar Company-matched contribution for the first 7% of eligible pay contributed on a before-tax or after-tax basis, or a combination of both. The precise arrangement may vary in certain business units. Plan participants may invest contributions in more than 200 investment options, including a fund comprised primarily of BP ADSs. The Company's contributions

153



generally vest over a period of three years (0% for years one and two and 100% after completion of three years). Company contributions to savings plans during the year were $138 million ($130 million).

        An Employee Share Ownership Plan (ESOP) was established in 1997 to acquire BP shares to satisfy future requirements of employee share plans. The Company provides funding to the ESOP. Until such time as the Company's own shares held by the ESOP trust vest unconditionally in employees, the amount paid for those shares is deducted in arriving at shareholders' interest (see Item 18 — Financial Statements Note 35 on page F-72). Other assets and liabilities of the ESOP are recognized as assets and liabilities of the Company. The ESOP has waived its rights to dividends.

        During 2004, the ESOP released 14,156,047 shares (16,892,853 shares) for the matching share plans. The cost of shares released for these plans has been charged in BP's accounts. At December 31, 2004, the ESOP held 2,682,860 shares (7,811,544 shares), which had a market value of $26 million ($63 million).

        Pursuant to the various BP Group share option schemes, the following options for Ordinary Shares of the Company were outstanding at June 28, 2005:

Options outstanding

  Expiry
dates of
options

  Exercise
price
per share

(shares)

   
   
478,416,804   2005-2015   $4.22-$10.63

        Further details on share options appear in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 38 on page F-75.

154



ITEM 7 — MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS


MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS

        At June 28, 2005, the Company has been notified that JPMorgan Chase Bank, as depositary for American Depositary Shares (ADSs), holds interests through its nominee, Guaranty Nominees Limited, in 7,004,020,650 ordinary shares (33.07% of the Company's ordinary share capital). Included in this total is part of the holding of the Kuwait Investment Office (KIO). Either directly or through nominees, the KIO holds interests in 715,040,000 ordinary shares (3.32% of the Company's ordinary share capital). The KIO does not have any different voting rights from the rights of other ordinary shareholders. At the same date, Barclays plc holds interests in 750,956,107 ordinary shares (3.52% of the Company's ordinary share capital) and Legal and General holds interests in 768,172,570 ordinary shares (3.57% of the Company's share capital).

        At the date of this report the Company has also been notified of the following interests in preference shares. Co-operative Insurance Society Limited holds interests in 1,475,538 8% 1st preference shares (20.40% of that class) and 1,789,796 9% 2nd preference shares (32.70% of that class). The National Farmers Mutual Insurance Society Ltd holds 945,000 8% 1st preference shares (13.07% of that class) and 987,000 2nd preference shares (18.03% of that class). Prudential plc holds interests in 528,150 8% 1st preference shares (7.30% of that class) and 644,450 9% 2nd preference shares (11.77% of that class). Royal & SunAlliance Insurance plc holds interests in 287,500 8% 1st preference shares (3.97% of that class) and 250,000 2nd preference shares (4.57% of that class). Ruffer Limited Liability Partnership holds interests in 750,000 9% preference shares (13.70% of that class).


RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

        The Group had no material transactions with joint ventures and associated undertakings during the period commencing January 1, 2004 to the date of this filing. Transactions between the Group and its significant joint ventures and associated undertakings are summarized in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 42 on page F-82.

        In the ordinary course of its business the Group has transactions with various organizations with which certain of its directors are associated but, except as described in this report, no material transactions responsive to this item have been entered into in the period commencing January 1, 2004 to June 28, 2005.


ITEM 8 — FINANCIAL INFORMATION


CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS AND OTHER FINANCIAL INFORMATION

Financial Statements

        See Item 18 — Financial Statements.

Dividends

        The total dividends announced for 2004 were $6,371 million, compared with $5,753 million in 2003 and $5,375 million in 2002. Dividends per share for 2004 were 29.45 cents, compared with 26.00 cents per share in 2003 (an increase of 13%) and 24.00 cents per share in 2002 (an increase of 8.3% over 2002). For information on our policy on distributions to shareholders, refer to Item 5 — Operating and Financial Review — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Dividends and Other Distributions to Shareholders and Gearing on page 101.

155



Legal Proceedings

        Save as disclosed in the following paragraphs, no member of the Group is a party to, and no property of a member of the Group is subject to, any pending legal proceedings which are significant to the Group.

        Approximately 200 lawsuits were filed in State and Federal Courts in Alaska seeking compensatory and punitive damages arising out of the Exxon Valdez oil spill in Prince William Sound in March 1989. Most of those suits named Exxon (now ExxonMobil), Alyeska Pipeline Service Company (Alyeska), which operates the oil terminal at Valdez, and the other oil companies which own Alyeska. Alyeska initially responded to the spill until the response was taken over by Exxon. BP owns a 47% interest (reduced during 2001 from 50% by a sale of 3% to Phillips) in Alyeska through a subsidiary of BP America Inc. and briefly indirectly owned a further 20% interest in Alyeska following BP's combination with Atlantic Richfield. Alyeska and its owners have settled all the claims against them under these lawsuits. Exxon has indicated that it may file a claim for contribution against Alyeska for a portion of the costs and damages which it has incurred. If any claims are asserted by Exxon which affect Alyeska and its owners, BP will defend the claims vigorously.

        Since 1987, Atlantic Richfield Company, a current subsidiary of BP, has been named as a co-defendant in numerous lawsuits brought in the United States alleging injury to persons and property caused by lead pigment in paint. The majority of the lawsuits have been abandoned or dismissed as against Atlantic Richfield. Atlantic Richfield (and in one case two of its affiliates) is named in these lawsuits as alleged successor to International Smelting and Refining which, along with a predecessor company, manufactured lead pigment during the period 1920-1946. Plaintiffs include individuals and governmental entities. Several of the lawsuits purport to be class actions. The lawsuits (depending on plaintiff) seek various remedies including: compensation to lead-poisoned children; cost to find and remove lead paint from buildings; medical monitoring and screening programmes; public warning and education of lead hazards; reimbursement of government healthcare costs and special education for lead-poisoned citizens; and punitive damages. No lawsuit against Atlantic Richfield has been settled or tried to conclusion. The amounts claimed and, if such suits were successful, the costs of implementing the remedies sought in the various cases could be substantial. While it is not possible to predict the outcome of these legal actions, Atlantic Richfield believes that it has valid defenses and it intends to defend such actions vigorously and thus the incurrence of liability by Atlantic Richfield is remote. Consequently, BP believes that the impact of these lawsuits on the Group's results of operations, financial position or liquidity will not be material.

        For certain information regarding environmental proceedings see Item 4 — Environmental Protection — United States Regional Review on page 75.

        For certain information regarding the explosion and fire at the Texas City Refinery on March 23, 2005, see Item 4 — Refining and Marketing on page 45 and Item 4 — Environmental Protection — Health, Safety and Environmental Regulation on page 73.


SIGNIFICANT CHANGES

        None.


ITEM 9 — THE OFFER AND LISTING

Markets and Market Prices

        The primary market for BP's ordinary shares is the London Stock Exchange (LSE). BP's ordinary shares are a constituent element of the Financial Times Stock Exchange 100 Index. BP's ordinary shares are also traded on stock exchanges in France, Germany, Japan and Switzerland.

156



        Trading of BP's shares on the LSE is primarily through the use of the Stock Exchange Electronic Trading Service (SETS), introduced in 1997 for the largest companies in terms of market capitalization whose primary listing is the LSE. Under SETS, buy and sell orders at specific prices may be sent to the exchange electronically by any firm which is a member of the LSE, on behalf of a client or on behalf of itself acting as a principal. The orders are then anonymously displayed in the order book. When there is a match on a 'buy' and a 'sell' order, the trade is executed and automatically reported to the LSE. Trading is continuous from 8:00 a.m. to 4:30 p.m. UK time, but in the event of a 20% movement in the share price either way the LSE may impose a temporary halt in the trading of that company's shares in the order book, to allow the market to re-establish equilibrium. Dealings in ordinary shares may also take place between an investor and a market-maker, via a member firm, outside the electronic order book.

        In the United States and Canada the Company's securities are traded in the form of American Depositary Shares (ADSs), for which JPMorgan Chase Bank is the depositary (the Depositary) and transfer agent. The Depositary's address is 1 Chase Manhattan Plaza, 40th Floor, New York, NY 10081, USA. Each ADS represents six Ordinary shares. ADSs are listed on the New York Stock Exchange, and are also traded on the Chicago, Pacific and Toronto Stock Exchanges. ADSs are evidenced by American Depositary Receipts, or ADRs, which may be issued in either certificated or book entry form.

157


        The following table sets forth for the periods indicated the highest and lowest middle market quotations for the Ordinary shares of BP p.l.c. for 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 and 2004. These are derived from the Daily Official List of the LSE, and the highest and lowest sales prices of ADSs as reported on the New York Stock Exchange composite tape.

 
 
  Ordinary shares
  American
Depositary
Shares (a)

 
 
  High

  Low

  High

  Low

 
 
  (Pence)

  (Dollars)

Year ended December 31,                
2000   671.00   444.50   60.63   43.13
2001   647.00   491.50   54.86   43.23
2002   625.00   392.50   53.88   36.78
2003   454.50   356.50   49.59   34.67
2004   556.50   413.50   62.10   46.65
Year ended December 31,                
2003: First quarter   429.25   356.50   41.94   34.67
  Second quarter   446.00   395.00   45.34   37.75
  Third quarter   449.50   404.25   43.54   39.25
  Fourth quarter   454.50   404.75   49.59   41.65
2004: First quarter   457.00   413.50   51.48   46.65
  Second quarter   500.50   455.50   54.99   50.75
  Third quarter   539.00   481.00   59.04   51.95
  Fourth quarter   556.50   500.50   62.10   57.31
2005: First quarter   576.00   504.00   66.65   56.60
  Second quarter (through June 28)   595.00   523.00   64.94   57.95
Month of                
December 2004   532.00   500.50   61.92   57.93
January 2005   533.00   504.00   60.39   56.60
February 2005   568.00   534.00   66.05   59.95
March 2005   576.00   547.00   66.65   61.00
April 2005   570.00   523.00   64.49   58.75
May 2005   560.50   528.00   62.50   57.95
June 2005 (through June 28)   595.00   558.00   64.94   60.48

(a)
An ADS is equivalent to six Ordinary Shares.

        Market prices for the ordinary shares on the LSE and in after-hours trading off the LSE, in each case while the New York Stock Exchange is open, and the market prices for ADSs on the New York Stock Exchange and other North American stock exchanges, are closely related due to arbitrage among the various markets, although differences may exist from time to time due to various factors including UK stamp duty reserve tax. Trading in ADSs began on the LSE on August 3, 1987.

        On June 28, 2005, 1,167,336,775 ADSs (equivalent to 7,004,020,650 ordinary shares or some 33.07% of the total) were outstanding and were held by approximately 160,118 ADR holders. Of these, about 158,241 had registered addresses in the USA at that date. One of the registered holders of ADSs represents some 824,600 underlying holders.

        On June 28, 2005 there were approximately 334,287 holders of record of ordinary shares. Of these holders, around 1,399 had registered addresses in the USA and held a total of some 3,455,341 ordinary shares.

158



ITEM 10 — ADDITIONAL INFORMATION


MEMORANDUM AND ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION

        The following summarizes certain provisions of BP's Memorandum and Articles of Association and applicable English law. This summary is qualified in its entirety by reference to the UK Companies Act and BP's Memorandum and Articles of Association. Information on where investors can obtain copies of the Memorandum and Articles of Association is described under the heading "Documents on Display" under this Item.

        On April 24, 2003, the shareholders of BP voted at the AGM to adopt new Articles of Association to consolidate amendments which have been necessary to implement legislative changes since the previous Articles of Association were adopted in 1983.

        At the AGM held on April 15, 2004, shareholders approved an amendment to the Articles of Association such that at each AGM held after December 31, 2004, all directors shall retire from office and may offer themselves for re-election. There have been no further amendments to the Articles of Association.

Objects and Purposes

        BP is incorporated under the name BP p.l.c. and is registered in England and Wales with registered number 102498. Clause 4 of BP's Memorandum of Association provides that its objects include the acquisition of petroleum bearing lands; the carrying on of refining and dealing businesses in the petroleum, manufacturing, metallurgical or chemicals businesses; the purchase and operation of ships and all other vehicles and other conveyances; and the carrying on of any other businesses calculated to benefit BP. The memorandum grants BP a range of corporate capabilities to effect these objects.

Directors

        The business and affairs of BP shall be managed by the directors.

        The Articles of Association place a general prohibition on a director voting in respect of any contract or arrangement in which he has a material interest other than by virtue of his interest in shares in the Company. However, in the absence of some other material interest not indicated below, a director is entitled to vote and to be counted in a quorum for the purpose of any vote relating to a resolution concerning the following matters:

159


        The UK Companies Act requires a director of a company who is in any way interested in a contract or proposed contract with the company to declare the nature of his interest at a meeting of the directors of the company. The definition of 'interest' now includes the interests of spouses, children, companies and Trusts. The directors may exercise all the powers of the company to borrow money, except that the amount remaining undischarged of all moneys borrowed by the company shall not, without approval of the shareholders, exceed the amount paid up on the share capital plus the aggregate of the amount of the capital and revenue reserves of the company. Variation of the borrowing power of the board may only be effected by amending the Articles of Association.

        Remuneration of non-executive directors shall be determined in the aggregate by resolution of the shareholders. Remuneration of executive directors is determined by the remuneration committee. This committee is made up of non-executive directors only. Any director attaining the age of 70 shall retire at the next AGM. There is no requirement of share ownership for a director's qualification.

Dividend Rights; Other Rights to Share in Company Profits; Capital Calls

        If recommended by the directors of BP, BP shareholders may, by resolution, declare dividends but no such dividend may be declared in excess of the amount recommended by the directors. The directors may also pay interim dividends without obtaining shareholder approval. No dividend may be paid other than out of profits available for distribution, as determined under UK GAAP and the UK Companies Act. Dividends on ordinary shares are payable only after payment of dividends on BP preference shares. Any dividend unclaimed after a period of twelve years from the date of declaration of such dividend shall be forfeited and reverts to BP.

        The directors have the power to declare and pay dividends in any currency provided that a sterling equivalent is announced. It is not the Company's intention to change its current policy of paying dividends in US dollars.

        Apart from shareholders' rights to share in BP's profits by dividend (if any is declared), the Articles of Association provide that the directors may set aside:

        Any such sums so deposited may be distributed in accordance with the manner of distribution of dividends as described above.

        Holders of shares are not subject to calls on capital by the Company, provided that the amounts required to be paid on issue have been paid off. All shares are fully paid.

Voting Rights

        The Articles of Association of BP provide that voting on resolutions at a shareholders' meeting will be decided on a poll other than resolutions of a procedural nature, which may be decided on a show of hands. If voting is on a poll, every shareholder who is present in person or by proxy has one vote for every ordinary share held and two votes for every £5 in nominal amount of BP preference shares held. If voting is on a show of hands, each shareholder who is present at the meeting in person or whose duly appointed proxy is present in person will have one vote, regardless of the number of shares held, unless a poll is requested. Shareholders do not have cumulative voting rights.

160



        Holders of record of ordinary shares may appoint a proxy, including a beneficial owner of those shares, to attend, speak and vote on their behalf at any shareholders' meeting.

        Record holders of BP ADSs also are entitled to attend, speak and vote at any shareholders' meeting of BP by the appointment by the approved depositary, JPMorgan Chase Bank, of them as proxies in respect of the ordinary shares represented by their ADSs. Each such proxy may also appoint a proxy. Alternatively, holders of ADSs are entitled to vote by supplying their voting instructions to the depositary, who will vote the ordinary shares represented by their ADSs in accordance with their instructions.

        Proxies may be delivered electronically.

        Matters are transacted at shareholders' meetings by the proposing and passing of resolutions, of which there are three types: ordinary, special or extraordinary.

        An ordinary resolution requires the affirmative vote of a majority of the votes of those persons voting at a meeting at which there is a quorum. Special and extraordinary resolutions require the affirmative vote of not less than three-fourths of the persons voting at a meeting at which there is a quorum. Any AGM at which it is proposed to put a special or ordinary resolution requires 21 days' notice. An extraordinary resolution put to the AGM requires no notice period. Any extraordinary general meeting at which it is proposed to put a special resolution requires 21 days' notice; otherwise, the notice period for an extraordinary general meeting is 14 days.

        At the AGM held on April 15, 2004, shareholders approved an amendment to the Articles of Association such that at each AGM held after December 31, 2004, all directors shall retire from office and may offer themselves for re-election.

Liquidation Rights; Redemption Provisions

        In the event of a liquidation of BP, after payment of all liabilities and applicable deductions under UK laws and subject to the payment of secured creditors, the holders of BP preference shares would be entitled to the sum of (i) the capital paid up on such shares plus, (ii) accrued and unpaid dividends and (iii) a premium equal to the higher of (a) 10% of the capital paid up on the BP preference shares and (b) the excess of the average market price over par value of such shares on the London Stock Exchange during the previous six months. The remaining assets (if any) would be divided pro rata among the holders of Ordinary Shares.

        Without prejudice to any special rights previously conferred on the holders of any class of shares, BP may issue any share with such preferred, deferred or other special rights, or subject to such restrictions as the shareholders by resolution determine (or, in the absence of any such resolutions, by determination of the directors), and may issue shares which are to be or may be redeemed.

Variation of Rights

        The rights attached to any class of shares may be varied with the consent in writing of holders of 75% of the shares of that class or upon the adoption of an extraordinary resolution passed at a separate meeting of the holders of the shares of that class. At every such separate meeting, all of the provisions of the Articles of Association relating to proceedings at a general meeting apply, except that the quorum with respect to a meeting to change the rights attached to the preference shares is 10% or more of the shares of that class, and the quorum to change the rights attached to the ordinary shares is one third or more of the shares of that class.

161



Shareholders' Meetings and Notices

        Shareholders must provide BP with a postal or electronic address in the UK in order to be entitled to receive notice of shareholders' meetings. In certain circumstances, BP may give notices to shareholders by advertisement in UK newspapers. Holders of BP ADSs are entitled to receive notices under the terms of the deposit agreement relating to BP ADSs. The substance and timing of notices is described above under the heading Voting Rights.

        Under the Articles of Association, the AGM of shareholders will be held within 15 months after the preceding AGM. All other general meetings of shareholders shall be called Extraordinary General Meetings and all general meetings shall be held at a time and place determined by the directors within the United Kingdom. If any shareholders' meeting is adjourned for lack of quorum, notice of the time and place of the meeting may be given in any lawful manner, including electronically. Powers exist for action to be taken either before or at the meeting by authorized officers to ensure its orderly conduct and safety of those attending.

Limitations on Voting and Shareholding

        There are no limitations imposed by English law or BP's Memorandum or Articles of Association on the right of non-residents or foreign persons to hold or vote the Company's ordinary shares or ADSs, other than limitations that would generally apply to all of the shareholders.

Disclosure of Interests in Shares

        The UK Companies Act permits a public company, on written notice, to require any person whom the company believes to be or, at any time during the previous three years prior to the issue of the notice, to have been interested in its voting shares, to disclose certain information with respect to those interests. Failure to supply the information required may lead to disenfranchisement of the relevant shares and a prohibition on their transfer and receipt of dividends and other payments in respect of those shares. In this context the term 'interest' is widely defined and will generally include an interest of any kind whatsoever in voting shares, including any interest of a holder of BP ADSs.

162



MATERIAL CONTRACTS

        None.


EXCHANGE CONTROLS AND OTHER LIMITATIONS AFFECTING SECURITY HOLDERS

        There are currently no UK foreign exchange controls or restrictions on remittances of dividends on the ordinary shares or on the conduct of the Company's operations.

        There are no limitations, either under the laws of the UK or under the Articles of Association of BP p.l.c., restricting the right of non-resident or foreign owners to hold or vote BP ordinary or preference shares in the Company.

163



TAXATION

        This section describes the material United States federal income tax and UK taxation consequences of owning ordinary shares or ADSs to a US holder that holds the ordinary shares or ADSs as capital assets for tax purposes. It does not apply, however, to members of special classes of holders subject to special rules and holders that, directly or indirectly, hold 10% or more of the Company's voting stock.

        A US holder is any beneficial owner of ordinary shares or ADSs that is for United States federal income tax purposes (i) a citizen or resident of the United States, (ii) a United States domestic corporation, (iii) an estate whose income is subject to United States federal income taxation regardless of its source, or (iv) a trust if a United States court can exercise primary supervision over the trust's administration and one or more United States persons are authorized to control all substantial decisions of the trust.

        This section is based on the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, its legislative history, existing and proposed regulations thereunder, published rulings and court decisions, and the taxation laws of the United Kingdom, all as currently in effect, as well as on the income tax convention between the United States and the United Kingdom entered into force in 1980 (the 'Old Treaty') and the income tax convention between the United States and the United Kingdom that entered into force on March 31, 2003 (the 'New Treaty'). These laws are subject to change, possibly on a retroactive basis.

        For purposes of the Old Treaty, the New Treaty, and the estate and gift tax Convention (the Estate Tax Convention), and for United States federal income tax and UK taxation purposes, a holder of ADRs evidencing ADSs will be treated as the owner of the Company's ordinary shares represented by those ADRs. Exchanges of ordinary shares for ADRs, and ADRs for ordinary shares, generally will not be subject to United States federal income tax or to UK taxation, other than stamp duty or stamp duty reserve tax, as described below.

        This section is further based in part upon the representations of the Depositary and assumes that each obligation in the Deposit Agreement and any related agreement will be performed in accordance with its terms.

        Investors should consult their own tax advisor regarding the United States federal, state and local, the UK and other tax consequences of owning and disposing of ordinary shares and ADSs in their particular circumstances, and in particular whether they are eligible for the benefits of the Old Treaty and the New Treaty.

Taxation of Dividends

United Kingdom Taxation

        Under current UK taxation law, no withholding tax will be deducted from dividends paid by the Company. A shareholder that is a company resident for tax purposes in the United Kingdom generally will not be taxable on a dividend it receives from the Company. A shareholder who is an individual resident for tax purposes in the United Kingdom is entitled to a tax credit on cash dividends paid on ordinary shares or ADSs of the Company equal to one-ninth of the cash dividend.

        Under the Old Treaty, a US holder entitled to its benefits was entitled to a refund from the UK Inland Revenue equal to the amount of the tax credit available to a shareholder resident in the United Kingdom (i.e., one-ninth of the dividend received), but the amount of the dividend plus the amount of the refund was also subject to withholding tax in an amount equal to the amount of the tax credit. Such US holder therefore did not receive any payment from the UK Inland Revenue in respect of a dividend from the Company and had no further UK tax to pay in respect of that dividend. Under the Old Treaty, special rules applied for determining the tax credit available to a corporation that, either alone or together with one or more associated corporations, controlled, directly or indirectly, 10% or more of the Company's voting stock.

164



        Under the New Treaty, a US holder is not entitled to a tax credit from the UK Inland Revenue in respect of dividends in the manner described above. However, dividends received by the US holder from the Company generally are not subject to a withholding tax by the United Kingdom.

        Generally, the New Treaty is effective in respect of taxes withheld at source for amounts paid or credited on or after May 1, 2003. Other provisions of the New Treaty, however, took effect for UK tax purposes for individuals on April 6, 2003 (April 1, 2003, for UK companies), and took effect for United States federal income tax purposes on January 1, 2004. The rules of the Old Treaty remained applicable until these effective dates. An eligible US holder could have elected to have the Old Treaty apply in its entirety for a period of twelve months after the applicable effective dates of the New Treaty, in which case it may have been eligible for the tax credit in respect of dividends noted above.

United States Federal Income Taxation

        A US holder is subject to United States federal income taxation on the gross amount of any dividend paid by the Company out of its current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined for United States federal income tax purposes). Dividends paid to a non-corporate US holder in taxable years beginning after December 31, 2002, and before January 1, 2009, that constitute qualified dividend income will be taxable to the holder at a maximum tax rate of 15%, provided that the holder has a holding period in the ordinary shares or ADSs of more than 60 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the ex-dividend date and meets other holding period requirements. Dividends paid by the Company with respect to the shares or ADSs will generally be qualified dividend income.

        A US holder that was eligible for the benefits of the Old Treaty could include in the gross amount of any dividend paid the UK tax deemed withheld from the dividend payment pursuant to the Old Treaty, as described above in 'United Kingdom Taxation'. Subject to certain limitations, the United Kingdom tax withheld in accordance with the Old Treaty and effectively paid over to the UK Inland Revenue was creditable against the US holder's United States federal income tax liability, provided the US holder was eligible for the benefits of the Old Treaty and appropriately filed Internal Revenue Form 8833. Special rules applied in determining the foreign tax credit limitation with respect to dividends that were subject to the maximum 15% tax rate.

        As noted above in 'United Kingdom Taxation', a US holder will not be entitled to a UK tax credit under the New Treaty, but also will not be subject to UK withholding tax. Under the New Treaty, the US holder will include in gross income for United States federal income tax purposes only the amount of the dividend actually received from the Company, and the receipt of a dividend will not entitle the US holder to a foreign tax credit.

        For United States federal income tax purposes, a dividend must be included in income when the US holder, in the case of ordinary shares, or the Depositary, in the case of ADSs, actually or constructively receives the dividend, and will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction generally allowed to United States corporations in respect of dividends received from other United States corporations. Dividends will be income from sources outside the United States, and generally will be 'passive income' or, in the case of certain US holders, 'financial services income', which is treated separately from other types of income for purposes of computing the allowable foreign tax credit.

        The amount of the dividend distribution on the ordinary shares or ADSs that is paid in pounds sterling will be the US dollar value of the pounds sterling payments made, determined at the spot pounds sterling/US dollar rate on the date the dividend distribution is includible in income, regardless of whether the payment is in fact converted into US dollars. Generally, any gain or loss resulting from currency exchange fluctuations during the period from the date the pounds sterling dividend payment is includible in income to the date the payment is converted into US dollars will be treated as ordinary income or loss. The gain or loss generally will be income or loss from sources within the United States for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.

165



        Distributions in excess of the Company's earnings and profits, as determined for United States federal income tax purposes, will be treated as a return of capital to the extent of the US holder's basis in the ordinary shares or ADSs and thereafter as capital gain, subject to taxation as described below in 'Taxation of Capital Gains-United States Federal Income Taxation'.

Taxation of Capital Gains

United Kingdom Taxation

        A US holder may be liable for both United Kingdom and United States tax in respect of a gain on the disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs if the US holder is (i) a citizen of the United States resident or ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom, (ii) a United States domestic corporation resident in the United Kingdom by reason of its business being managed or controlled in the United Kingdom or (iii) a citizen of the United States or a corporation that carries on a trade or profession or vocation in the United Kingdom through a branch or agency or, in respect of corporations for accounting periods beginning on or after January 1, 2003, through a permanent establishment, and that have used, held, or acquired the ordinary shares or ADSs for the purposes of such trade, profession or vocation of such branch, agency or permanent establishment. However, subject to applicable limitations and provisions of the Old Treaty, such persons may be entitled to a tax credit against their United States federal income tax liability for the amount of United Kingdom capital gains tax or UK corporation tax on chargeable gains (as the case may be) which is paid in respect of such gain.

        Under the New Treaty, capital gains on dispositions of ordinary shares or ADSs generally will be subject to tax only in the jurisdiction of residence of the relevant holder as determined under both the laws of the United Kingdom and the United States and as required by the terms of the New Treaty.

        Under the New Treaty, individuals who are residents of either the United Kingdom or the United States and who have been residents of the other jurisdiction (the United States or the United Kingdom, as the case may be) at any time during the six years immediately preceding the relevant disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs may be subject to tax with respect to capital gains arising from a disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs of the Company not only in the jurisdiction of which the holder is resident at the time of the disposition, but also in the other jurisdiction.

United States Federal Income Taxation

        A US holder that sells or otherwise disposes of ordinary shares or ADSs will recognize a capital gain or loss for United States federal income tax purposes equal to the difference between the US dollar value of the amount realized and the holder's tax basis, determined in US dollars, in the ordinary shares or ADSs. Capital gain of a noncorporate US holder that is recognized on or after May 6, 2003, and before January 1, 2009, is generally taxed at a maximum rate of 15% if the holder's holding period for such ordinary shares or ADSs exceeds one year. The gain or loss will generally be income or loss from sources within the United States for foreign tax credit limitation purposes. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations.

Additional Tax Considerations

UK Inheritance Tax

        The Estate Tax Convention applies to inheritance tax. ADSs held by an individual who is domiciled for the purposes of the Estate Tax Convention in the US and is not for the purposes of the Estate Tax Convention a national of the UK will not be subject to UK inheritance tax on the individual's death or on transfer during the individual's lifetime unless, among other things, the ADSs are part of the business property of a permanent establishment situated in the UK used for the performance of independent personal services. In the exceptional case where ADSs are subject both to inheritance tax and to US federal gift or estate tax, the Estate Tax Convention generally provides for tax payable in the

166



US to be credited against tax payable in the UK or for tax paid in the UK to be credited against tax payable in the US, based on priority rules set forth in the Estate Tax Convention.

UK Stamp Duty and Stamp Duty Reserve Tax

        The statements below relate to what is understood to be the current practice of the UK Inland Revenue under existing law.

        Provided that the instrument of transfer is not executed in the UK and remains at all times outside the UK, and the transfer does not relate to any matter or thing done or to be done in the UK, no UK stamp duty is payable on the acquisition or transfer of ADSs. Neither will an agreement to transfer ADSs in the form of ADRs give rise to a liability to stamp duty reserve tax.

        Purchases of ordinary shares, as opposed to ADSs, through the CREST system of paperless share transfers will be subject to stamp duty reserve tax at 0.5%. The charge will arise as soon as there is an agreement for the transfer of the shares (or, in the case of a conditional agreement, when the condition is fulfilled). The stamp duty reserve tax will apply to agreements to transfer ordinary shares even if the agreement is made outside the UK between two non-residents. Purchases of ordinary shares outside the CREST system are subject either to stamp duty at a rate of 50 pence per £100 (or part), or stamp duty reserve tax at 0.5%. Stamp duty and stamp duty reserve tax are generally the liability of the purchaser. A subsequent transfer of ordinary shares to the Depositary's nominee will give rise to further stamp duty at the rate of £1.50 per £100 (or part) or stamp duty reserve tax at the rate of 1.5% of the value of the ordinary shares at the time of the transfer.

        A transfer of the underlying ordinary shares to an ADR holder upon cancellation of the ADSs without transfer of beneficial ownership will give rise to UK stamp duty at the rate of £5 per transfer.

        An ADR holder electing to receive ADSs instead of a cash dividend will be responsible for the stamp duty reserve tax due on issue of shares to the Depositary's nominee and calculated at the rate of 1.5% on the issue price of the shares. Current UK Inland Revenue practice is to calculate the issue price by reference to the total cash receipt (i.e, cash dividend plus the Refund if any) to which a US Holder would have been entitled had the election to receive ADSs instead of a cash dividend not been made. ADR holders electing to receive ADSs instead of the cash dividend authorize the Depositary to sell sufficient shares to cover this liability.


DOCUMENTS ON DISPLAY

        It is possible to read and copy documents referred to in this annual report on Form 20-F that have been filed with the SEC at the SEC's public reference room located at 100 F Street NE, Washington, DC 20549. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on the public reference rooms and their copy charges. The SEC filings are also available to the public from commercial document retrieval services and, for most recent BP periodic filings only, at the Internet world wide web site maintained by the SEC at www.sec.gov.

167


ITEM 11 — QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

        BP is exposed to a number of different market risks arising from the Group's normal business activities. Market risk is the possibility that changes in currency exchange rates, interest rates or oil and natural gas prices will adversely affect the value of the Group's financial assets, liabilities or expected future cash flows. The Group has developed policies aimed at managing the volatility inherent in certain of these natural business exposures and in accordance with these policies the Group enters into various transactions using derivative financial and commodity instruments (derivatives). Derivatives are contracts whose value is derived from one or more underlying financial or commodity instruments, indices or prices which are defined in the contract. The Group also trades derivatives in conjunction with risk management activities.

        The Group's supply and trading activities in oil, natural gas, power and financial markets are managed within a single integrated function. This has the responsibility for ensuring high and consistent standards of control, making investments in the necessary systems and supporting infrastructure and providing professional management oversight. In market risk management and trading, conventional exchange-traded derivative instruments such as futures and options are used, as well as conventional non-exchange-traded instruments such as swaps, 'over-the-counter' options and forward contracts.

        Where derivatives constitute a hedge, the Group's exposure to market risk created by the derivative is offset by the opposite exposure arising from the asset, liability or transaction being hedged. By contrast, where derivatives are held for trading purposes realized and unrealized gains and losses, are recognized in the period in which they occur.

        All derivative activity, whether for risk management or trading, is carried out by specialist teams that have the appropriate skills, experience and supervision. These teams are subject to close financial and management control. The appropriate governance, control framework and reporting processes are in place to oversee these internal control activities. On an ongoing basis, an independent control function monitors compliance with BP's policies that are in line with generally accepted industry practice, reflecting the principles of the Group of Thirty Global Derivatives Study. The control framework includes prescribed trading limits that are reviewed regularly by senior management, daily monitoring of risk exposure using value-at-risk principles, marking trading exposures to market and stress testing to assess the exposure to potentially extreme market situations.

        Further information about BP's use of derivatives, their characteristics, and the accounting treatment thereof is given in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 1 and Note 28 on pages F-12 and F-48.

        The Group's accounting policies under UK GAAP do not satisfy the criteria for hedge accounting under SFAS No. 133 'Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities'. See Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 50 on page F-113 for further information.

Risk Management

Foreign Currency Exchange Rate Risk

        Fluctuations in exchange rates can have significant effects on the Group's reported results. The effects of most exchange rate fluctuations are absorbed in business operating results through changing cost competitiveness, lags in market adjustment to movements in rates, and conversion differences accounted for on specific transactions. For this reason, the total effect of exchange rate fluctuations is not identifiable separately in the Group's reported results.

        The main underlying economic currency of the Group's cash flows is the US dollar. This is because BP's major product, oil, is priced internationally in US dollars. BP's foreign exchange management policy is to minimize economic and material transactional exposures arising from currency movements against the US dollar. The Group co-ordinates the handling of foreign exchange risks centrally, by netting off

168



naturally occurring opposite exposures wherever possible, to reduce the risks, and then dealing with any material residual foreign exchange risks. Significant residual non-US dollar exposures are managed using a range of derivatives. The most significant of such exposures are the sterling-based capital leases, the capital expenditure and operational requirements, mainly in the UK, the sterling cash flow requirements for UK Corporation Tax and the net euro cash inflows mainly relating to downstream and petrochemicals in Europe. In addition, most of the Group's borrowings are in US dollars or are hedged with respect to the US dollar. At December 31, 2004, the total of foreign currency borrowings not swapped into US dollars amounted to $595 million. The principal elements of this are $297 million of borrowings in euros, $96 million in sterling, $88 million in Canadian dollars and $87 million in Trinidad and Tobago dollars.

        The following table provides information about the Group's foreign currency derivative financial instruments. These include foreign currency forward exchange agreements (forwards), cylinder option contracts (cylinders), and purchased call options that are sensitive to changes in the sterling/US dollar, euro/US dollar and Norwegian krone/US dollar exchange rates. Where foreign currency denominated borrowings are swapped into US dollars using forwards or cross currency swaps such that currency risk is completely eliminated, neither the borrowing nor the derivative are included in the table.

        For forwards, the tables present the notional amounts and weighted average contractual exchange rates by contractual maturity dates and exclude forwards that have offsetting positions. Only significant forward positions are included in the tables. The notional amounts of forwards are translated into US dollars at the exchange rate included in the contract at inception. The sterling forwards relate mainly to sterling-based capital leases which effectively convert the lease obligation from sterling into dollars and to payments for capital expenditure. The pay euro forwards relate mainly to net cash inflows from operations and the sale of business assets. The receive euro forwards relate mainly to payments for capital expenditure. The Norwegian krone forwards relate mainly to the Group's Norwegian tax payments over the next year. The fair value represents an estimate of the gain or loss which would be realized if the contracts were settled at the balance sheet date.

        Cylinders consist of purchased call option and written put option contracts. For cylinders and purchased call options, the tables present the notional amounts of the option contracts at December 31, 2004 and the weighted average strike rates. The receive sterling cylinders and purchased call options relate to the Group's expected sterling tax payments and to payments for capital and operational expenditure.

169



        The fair values for the foreign exchange contracts in the table below are based on market prices of comparable instruments (forwards) and pricing models which take into account relevant market data (options). These derivative contracts constitute a hedge; any change in the fair value or expected cash flows is offset by an opposite change in the market value or expected cash flows of the asset, liability or transaction being hedged.

 
  Notional amount by expected maturity date

   
   
 
 
   
  Fair value
asset/
(liability)

 
 
  2005

  2006

  2007

  2008

  2009

  Beyond
2009

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

 
At December 31, 2004                                    
Forwards                                    
  Receive sterling/pay US dollars                                    
    Contract amount     2,559   136   61   21   9   35   2,821   253  
    Weighted average contractual exchange rate     1.75                              
  Receive sterling/pay euro                                    
    Contract amount     24   29   15         68   (2 )
    Weighted average contractual exchange rate   £ 0.72                              
  Receive euro/pay US dollars                                    
    Contract amount     237   78   28   11   10   36   400   69  
    Weighted average contractual exchange rate     1.18                              
  Pay euro/receive US dollars                                    
    Contract amount     1,829   5           1,834   (5 )
    Weighted average contractual exchange rate     1.35                              
  Receive Norwegian krone/ pay US dollars                                    
    Contract amount     232   4           236   22  
    Weighted average contractual exchange rate (a)     6.66                              
Cylinders                                    
  Receive sterling/pay US dollars                                    
  Purchased call                                    
    Contract amount     904             904   32  
    Weighted average strike price     1.87                              
  Sold put                                    
    Contract amount     904             904   (3 )
    Weighted average strike price     1.75                              
Purchased call options                                    
  Receive sterling/pay US dollars                                    
  Purchased call                                    
    Contract amount     1,467             1,467   18  
    Weighted average strike price     1.97                              
  Receive euro/pay US dollars                                    
  Purchased call                                    
    Contract Amount     1,182             1,182   9  
    Weighted average strike price     1.44                              

(a)
Weighted average contractual exchange rates are expressed as US dollars per non-US dollar currency unit except Norwegian krone which are expressed as krone per US dollar.

170


 
  Notional amount by expected maturity date

   
   
 
 
   
  Fair value
asset/
(liability)

 
 
  2004

  2005

  2006

  2007

  2008

  Beyond
2008

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

   
 
At December 31, 2003                                    
Forwards                                    
  Receive sterling/pay US dollars                                    
    Contract amount     2,177   95   36   15   11   45   2,379   307  
    Weighted average contractual exchange rate     1.57                              
  Receive sterling/pay euro                                    
    Contract amount     340   26   27   14       407   (4 )
    Weighted average contractual exchange rate   £ 0.70                              
  Receive euro/pay US dollars                                    
    Contract amount     255   100   16   12   11   45   439   74  
    Weighted average contractual exchange rate     1.08                              
  Pay euro/receive US dollars                                    
    Contract amount     206   19   5         230   (16 )
    Weighted average contractual exchange rate     1.18                              
  Receive Norwegian krone/pay US dollars                                    
    Contract amount     170   21   1         192   16  
    Weighted average contractual exchange rate (a)     7.31                              
Cylinders                                    
  Receive sterling/pay US dollars                                    
  Purchased call                                    
    Contract amount     1,363             1,363   12  
    Weighted average strike price     1.80                              
  Sold put                                    
    Contract amount     1,363             1,363   (3 )
    Weighted average strike price     1.66                              
Purchased call options                                    
  Receive sterling/pay US dollars                                    
  Purchased call                                    
    Contract amount     779             779   14  
    Weighted average strike price     1.80                              

Interest Rate Risk

        BP is exposed to interest rate risk on short- and long-term floating rate instruments and as a result of the refinancing of fixed rate finance debt. Consequently, as well as managing the currency and the maturity of debt, the Group manages interest expense through the balance between generally lower-cost floating rate debt, which has inherently higher risk, and generally more expensive but lower-risk, fixed rate debt. The Group is exposed predominantly to US dollar LIBOR interest rates as borrowings are mainly denominated in, or swapped into, US dollars. The Group uses derivatives to achieve the required mix between fixed and floating rate debt. The proportion of floating rate debt at December 31, 2004 was 96% of total finance debt outstanding.

171



        The following table shows, by major currency, the Group's finance debt at December 31, 2004 and 2003 and the weighted average interest rates achieved at those dates through a combination of borrowings and other interest rate sensitive instruments entered into to manage interest rate exposure.

 
  Fixed rate debt

  Floating rate debt

   
 
  Weighted
average
interest
rate

  Weighted
average time
for which
rate is fixed

  Amount

  Weighted
average
interest
rate

  Amount

  Total

 
  (%)

  (years)

  ($ million)

  (%)

  ($ million)

  ($ million)

At December 31, 2004                        
US dollar   7   11   707   3   21,789   22,496
Sterling         5   96   96
Other currencies   9   15   167   4   332   499
           
     
 
Total loans           874       22,217   23,091
           
     
 
At December 31, 2003                        
US dollar   8   14   578   2   20,991   21,569
Sterling         4   107   107
Other currencies   9   15   141   3   508   649
           
     
 
Total loans           719       21,606   22,325
           
     
 

        The Group's earnings are sensitive to changes in interest rates over the forthcoming year as a result of the floating rate instruments included in the Group's finance debt at December 31, 2004. These include the effect of interest rate and currency swaps and forwards utilized to manage interest rate risk. If the interest rates applicable to floating rate instruments were to have increased by 1% on January 1, 2005, the Group's 2005 earnings before taxes would decrease by approximately $215 million. This assumes that the amount and mix of fixed and floating rate debt, including capital leases, remains unchanged from that in place at December 31, 2004 and that the change in interest rates is effective from the beginning of the year. Where the interest rate applicable to an instrument is reset during a quarter it is assumed that this occurs at the beginning of the quarter and remains unchanged for the rest of the year. In reality, the fixed/floating rate mix will fluctuate over the year and interest rates will change continually. Furthermore the effect on earnings shown by this analysis does not consider the effect of an overall reduction in economic activity which could accompany such an increase in interest rates.

Oil Price Risk

        The Group's risk management policy with respect to oil price risk is to manage certain exposures in respect of its equity share of production and certain of its refinery and marketing activities. To this end, BP's supply and trading function uses the full range of oil price-related commodity derivatives available in the oil markets.

        The derivative instruments used for hedging purposes do not expose the Group to market risk because the change in their market value is offset by an equal and opposite change in the market value of the asset, liability or transaction being hedged. The values at risk in respect of derivatives held for oil price risk management purposes are shown in isolation in the table below. The items being hedged are not included in the values at risk.

        The value-at-risk model used is that discussed under Trading below. Thus the value-at-risk calculation for oil price exposure includes derivative instruments such as exchange-traded futures and options, swap agreements and over-the-counter options and derivative commodity instruments (commodity contracts that permit settlement either by delivery of the underlying commodity or in cash)

172



such as forward contracts. The values at risk represent the potential gain or loss in fair values over a 24-hour period with a 99.7% confidence level.

        The following table shows values at risk for oil price risk management activities.

 
  High

  Low

  Average

  December 31

 
  ($ million)

2004                
Oil price contracts   11   1   6   10
2003                
Oil price contracts   9   5   7   7
2002                
Oil price contracts   13   11   12   11

Natural Gas Price Risk

        BP's general policy with respect to natural gas price risk is to manage only a portion of its exposure to price fluctuations. Natural gas swaps, options and futures are used to convert certain specific sales and purchases contracts from fixed prices to floating prices. Swaps are also used to hedge exposure to price differentials between locations.

        The table below provides information about the Group's material swaps contracts that are sensitive to changes in natural gas prices. Contract amount represents the notional amount of the contract. Fair value represents an estimate of the gain or loss which would be realized if the contracts were settled at the balance sheet date. Weighted average price represents the fixed price and the year-end forward price related to the settlement month for swaps.

173


        At December 31, 2004, in addition to the swaps contracts shown in the table there were options contracts with aggregate notional amounts of $130 million (December 31, 2003 $174 million and December 31, 2002 $11 million) and terms of up to one year.

 
   
   
  Fair value

  Weighted average price

 
  Quantity

  Contract
amount

  Asset

  Liability

  Receive

  Pay

 
  (btu trillion)(a)

  ($ million)

  ($ million)

  ($ per mmbtu)(b)

At December 31, 2004                        
Maturing in 2005                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed   20   113   5   (9 ) 5.67   5.90
  Receive fixed/pay variable   19   115   17   (1 ) 6.07   5.24
  Receive and pay variable   732   4,304   25   (16 ) 5.88   5.87
Maturing in 2006                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed     2     (1 ) 5.02   6.23
  Receive fixed/pay variable   9   50   6   (1 ) 5.85   5.19
  Receive and pay variable   142   871   7   (8 ) 6.12   6.13
Maturing in 2007                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed     2       5.04   5.84
  Receive fixed/pay variable   2   10   3     5.85   3.99
  Receive and pay variable   71   390   7   (6 ) 5.50   5.49
Maturing in 2008                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed            
  Receive fixed/pay variable   1   7   2     5.54   4.05
  Receive and pay variable   52   269   6   (6 ) 5.21   5.21
Maturing in 2009                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed            
  Receive fixed/pay variable            
  Receive and pay variable   49   241   7   (6 ) 4.94   4.92
Maturing beyond 2009                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed   1   5       4.85   4.71
  Received fixed/pay variable            
  Receive and pay variable   46   221   6   (5 ) 4.78   4.74

174


 
   
   
  Fair value

  Weighted average price

 
  Quantity

  Contract
amount

  Asset

  Liability

  Receive

  Pay

 
  (btu trillion)(a)

  ($ million)

  ($ million)

  ($ per mmbtu)(b)

At December 31, 2003                        
Maturing in 2004                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed   30   152   29   (2 ) 4.61   5.07
  Receive fixed/pay variable   26   128     (18 ) 4.84   4.74
  Receive and pay variable   758   3,991   51   (47 ) 5.27   5.27
Maturing in 2005                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed   5   22   3     4.06   4.48
  Receive fixed/pay variable   8   36     (5 ) 4.56   3.97
  Receive and pay variable   212   1,035   23   (22 ) 4.88   4.89
Maturing in 2006                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed   2   8   2     3.94   4.72
  Receive fixed/pay variable     1       4.72   4.32
  Receive and pay variable   88   404   5   (11 ) 4.62   4.56
Maturing in 2007                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed   2   8   1     3.99   4.63
  Receive fixed/pay variable     1       4.63   4.36
  Receive and pay variable   64   279   3   (8 ) 4.44   4.36
Maturing in 2008                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed   1   6   1     4.05   4.58
  Receive fixed/pay variable            
  Receive and pay variable   49   214   2   (6 ) 4.40   4.31
Maturing beyond 2008                        
Swaps                        
  Receive variable/pay fixed            
  Received fixed/pay variable   1   5       4.58   4.85
  Receive and pay variable   88   385   3   (7 ) 4.41   4.36

(a)
British thermal units (btu)

(b)
Million british thermal units (mmbtu)

Trading

        In conjunction with the risk management activities discussed above, BP also trades interest rate and foreign currency exchange rate derivatives, commodity derivatives and physical instruments. The Group controls the scale of the trading exposures by using a value-at-risk model with a maximum value-at-risk limit authorized by the board.

        In addition to the risk management activities related to equity crude disposal, refinery supply and marketing, BP's supply and trading function undertakes trading in the full range of conventional derivative financial and commodity instruments and physical cargoes available in the energy markets. The Group also uses financial and commodity derivatives in its trading activities. These activities are monitored and are subject to maximum value-at-risk limits authorized by the board.

175



        The Group measures its market risk exposure, i.e., potential gain or loss in fair values, on its trading activity using value-at-risk techniques. These techniques are based on a variance/covariance model or a Monte Carlo simulation and make a statistical assessment of the market risk arising from possible future changes in market values over a 24-hour period. The calculation of the range of potential changes in fair value takes into account a snapshot of the end-of-day exposures, and the history of one-day price movements, together with the correlation of these price movements. The potential movement in fair values is expressed to three standard deviations which is equivalent to a 99.7% confidence level. This means that, in broad terms, one would expect to see an increase or a decrease in fair values greater than the value-at-risk on approximately one occasion per year if the portfolio were left unchanged.

        The Group calculates value-at-risk on all instruments that are held for trading purposes and that therefore give an exposure to market risk. The value-at-risk models take account of derivative financial instruments such as interest rate forward and futures contracts and swap agreements; foreign exchange forward and futures contracts and swap agreements; and oil, natural gas and power price futures and swap agreements. Financial assets and liabilities and physical crude oil and refined products that are treated as trading positions are also included in these calculations. For options, a linear approximation is included in the value-at-risk models. The value-at-risk calculation for oil, natural gas and power price exposure also includes derivative commodity instruments (commodity contracts that permit settlement either by delivery of the underlying commodity or in cash), such as forward contracts.

        The following table shows values at risk for trading activities.

 
  High

  Low

  Average

  December 31

 
  ($ million)

2004                
Interest rate trading   1      
Foreign exchange trading   4   1   1   1
Oil price trading   55   18   29   45
Natural gas price trading   23   6   13   10
Power price trading   10   1   4   4

2003

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Interest rate trading   1      
Foreign exchange trading   4     2   1
Oil price trading   34   17   26   27
Natural gas price trading   29   4   16   18
Power price trading   13     4   6

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Interest rate trading        
Foreign exchange trading   2     1  
Oil price trading   34   14   23   19
Natural gas price trading   18   1   6   9
Power price trading   9   1   4   3

176


        The following tables show the changes during the year in the net fair value of instruments held for trading purposes for the years 2004 and 2003.

 
  Fair value
interest
rate
contracts

  Fair value
exchange
rate
contracts

  Fair value
oil
price
contracts

  Fair value
natural gas
price
contracts

  Fair value
power
price
contracts

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Fair value of contracts at January 1, 2004     (24 ) (81 ) 147   34  
Contracts realized or settled in the year     9   84   321   (30 )
Fair value of new contracts when entered into during the year       (25 ) 61   22  
Other changes in fair values     (39 ) 5   (302 ) 150  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of contracts at December 31, 2004     (54 ) (17 ) 227   176  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of contracts at January 1, 2003     12   22   157   19  
Contracts realized or settled in the year     (12 ) (29 ) 185   16  
Fair value of new contracts when entered into during the year       (43 ) (62 ) 36  
Other changes in fair values     (24 ) (31 ) (133 ) (37 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of contracts at December 31, 2003     (24 ) (81 ) 147   34  
   
 
 
 
 
 

        The following tables show the net fair value of contracts held for trading purposes at December 31, 2004 and 2003 analyzed by maturity period and by methodology of fair value estimation.

 
  Fair value of contracts at December 31, 2004

 
 
  Maturity
less than
1 year

  Maturity
1-3 years

  Maturity
4-5 years

  Maturity
over
5 years

  Total
fair
value

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Prices actively quoted   340   (47 ) 48     341  
Prices provided by other external sources   (35 ) (10 ) 10   12   (23 )
Prices based on models and other valuation methods   14         14  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    319   (57 ) 58   12   332  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Fair value of contracts at December 31, 2003

 
 
  Maturity
less than
1 year

  Maturity
1-3 years

  Maturity
4-5 years

  Maturity
over
5 years

  Total
fair
value

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Prices actively quoted   93   53   4     150  
Prices provided by other external sources   (81 ) (5 )   (5 ) (91 )
Prices based on models and other valuation methods   9   8       17  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    21   56   4   (5 ) 76  
   
 
 
 
 
 


ITEM 12 — DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES

        Not applicable

177



PART II

ITEM 13 — DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES

        None.


ITEM 14 — MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS

        None.


ITEM 15 — CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

        The Company maintains 'disclosure controls and procedures' as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(e), that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in reports the Company files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission rules and forms, and that such information is accumulated and communicated to management, including the Company's group chief executive and chief financial officer, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

        In designing and evaluating our disclosure controls and procedures, our management, including the group chief executive and chief financial officer, recognize that any controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the disclosure controls and procedures are met. Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, within the Company have been detected. Further, in the design and evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures our management necessarily was required to apply its judgment in evaluating the cost-benefit relationship of possible controls and procedures. Also, we have investments in certain unconsolidated entities. As we do not control these entities, our disclosure controls and procedures with respect to such entities are necessarily substantially more limited than those we maintain with respect to our consolidated subsidiaries. Because of the inherent limitations in a cost-effective control system, mis-statements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected. The Company's disclosure controls and procedures have been designed to meet, and management believe that they meet, reasonable assurance standards.

        During 2005, a review was undertaken into the accounting treatment under US GAAP for OTC forward contracts in oil, gas, NGLs and power in the context of the review undertaken for final transition to IFRS. As a result of this review the Group reassessed its recognition of revenues associated with these contracts under US GAAP and determined that these contracts should be reported net. (See Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 50 on page F-103.) Under the provisions of APB 20 the Company's management concluded that the change represented the correction of an accounting error and as a result revenues and cost of sales for US GAAP have been restated. Because under UK GAAP these transactions were reported gross, a difference in accounting treatment is now disclosed in Item 18 — Financial Statements — Note 50 on page F-103. In addition, in connection with the preparation of this Form 20-F/A, the Group identified additional transactions which should also have been presented net under US GAAP.

        In light of this subsequent restatement, the Company's management, including the group chief executive and the chief financial officer, re-evaluated the Company's disclosure controls and procedures as in effect at the end of 2004. Although the restatement for US GAAP purposes did not impact the Group's profit for the year as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, profit per ordinary share, cash flow or

178



financial position, the group chief executive and the chief financial officer have determined, due to the change in the US GAAP accounting treatment for OTC forward contracts, that the Company's disclosure controls and procedures at the end of the period were not effective to provide reasonable assurance that information required to be disclosed in the Company's reports filed or submitted under the Exchange Act was recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time period specified in the rules and forms of the SEC.

        Apart from the failure to account for OTC forward contracts on a net basis under US GAAP, the Company's management has not identified any other deficiencies that would have led the Company's management to conclude that the Group's disclosure controls and procedures were ineffective for the period covered by this annual report. The Company is not currently required to report on management's assessment of the effectiveness of the Group's internal controls over financial reporting and the Company has not undertaken the kind of review of such controls that would be required in order to make such a report.

        Following the review of the accounting treatment for OTC forward contracts under US GAAP, the Group has improved its disclosure controls and procedures by changing its US GAAP accounting policy for OTC forward contracts to conform to US GAAP, training the accounting staff regarding the policy change, implementing changes in its internal reporting systems to process and report sale and purchase contracts in accordance with Group US GAAP accounting policy for such transactions and increasing management oversight of compliance therewith.

Changes in Internal Controls

        There were no changes in the Company's internal controls over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by this Form 20-F that have materially affected or are reasonably likely to materially affect our internal controls over financial reporting.


ITEM 16A — AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT

        The Board determined that during 2004 no one member of the audit committee had all the attributes of an audit committee financial expert as defined for purposes of disclosure Item 16A of Form 20-F. The Company did not have an audit committee financial expert because the board considered that the membership of the audit committee as a whole had sufficient recent and relevant financial experience to discharge its functions.

        Douglas Flint joined the board as a non-executive director on January 1, 2005 and joined the audit committee on March 16, 2005. He is group finance director of HSBC Holdings p.l.c., and a former member of the Accounting Standards Board and the Standards Advisory Council of the International Accounting Standards Board. The Board determined that with effect from March 16, 2005 Mr Flint may be regarded as an audit committee financial expert as defined for purposes of disclosure Item 16A of Form 20-F.


ITEM 16B — CODE OF ETHICS

        The Company has adopted a Code of Ethics for its group chief executive, deputy group chief executive, chief financial officer, the general auditor, group chief accounting officer and group controller as required by the provisions of Section 406 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the rules issued by the SEC. There have been no amendments to, or waivers from, the code of ethics relating to any of those officers. The code of ethics has been filed as an exhibit to this report.

        In June 2005, BP published a Code of Conduct which is applicable to all employees.

179



ITEM 16C — PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

        The Audit Committee has established policies and procedures for the engagement of the independent registered public accounting firm, Ernst & Young LLP, to render audit and certain assurance and tax services. The policies provide for pre-approval by the audit committee of specifically defined audit, audit-related, tax and other services that are not prohibited by regulatory or other professional requirements. Ernst & Young is engaged for these services when its expertise and experience of BP are important. Most of this work is of an audit nature. Tax services were awarded either through a full competitive tender process or following an assessment of the expertise of Ernst & Young relative to that of other potential service providers. These services are for a fixed term.

        Under the policy, pre-approval is given for specific services within the following categories; advice on accounting, auditing and financial reporting matters; internal accounting and risk management control reviews (excluding any services relating to information systems design and implementation); non-statutory audit; project assurance and advice on business and accounting process improvement (excluding any services relating to information systems design and implementation relating to BP's financial statements or accounting records); due diligence in connection with acquisitions, disposals and joint ventures; income tax and indirect tax compliance and advisory services; and employee tax services (excluding tax services that could impair independence). Additionally, any proposed service not included in the pre-approved services, must be approved in advance prior to commencement of the engagement. The audit committee has delegated to the Chair of the Audit Committee authority to approve permitted services provided that the Chair reports any decisions to the committee at its next scheduled meeting.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Audit fees            
  Group audit   27   18   15
  Audit-related regulatory reporting   7   5   4
  Statutory audit of subsidiaries   16   13   10
   
 
 
    50   36   29
   
 
 

Audit-related fees

 

 

 

 

 

 
  Acquisition and disposal due diligence   7   9   13
  Pension scheme audits   1   1   1
  Other further assurance services   9   9   8
   
 
 
    17   19   22

Tax fees

 

 

 

 

 

 
  Compliance services   13   17   23
  Advisory services   1   2   4
   
 
 
    14   19   27
Other fees       1
   
 
 
Total non-audit fees   31   38   50
   
 
 

        The audit fees payable to Ernst & Young are reviewed by the Audit Committee in the context of other global companies for cost effectiveness. The committee keeps under review the scope and results of audit work, its cost-effectiveness and the independence and objectivity of the auditors. It requires the auditors to rotate their lead audit partner every five years.

180



        Other further assurance services within Audit-related fees include $3 million (2003 $2 million and 2002 $4 million) in respect of advice on accounting, auditing and financial reporting matters; $1 million (2003 $1 million and 2002 $3 million) in respect of internal accounting and risk management control reviews; $3 million (2003 $2 million and 2002 nil) in respect of non-statutory audits and $2 million (2003 $3 million and 2002 $1 million) in respect of project assurance and advice on business and accounting process improvement.

        The tax compliance services relate to income tax and indirect tax compliance and employee tax services.

        Other fees in 2002 relate to a working capital review.

        Fees paid to major firms of accountants other than Ernst & Young for other services amount to $82 million (2003 $44 million and 2002 $33 million).


ITEM 16D — EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES

        Not applicable.

181



ITEM 16E — PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS

        The following table provides details of ordinary shares repurchased.

 
  Total number of
shares purchased (a)

  Average price paid per share

  Total number
of shares purchased as part of publicly announced
programmes

  Maximum number
of shares that may yet be purchased under the programme (b)

 
   
  ($)

   
   
2004                
January          
February   62,884,938   7.93   62,884,938    
March   91,850,000   8.17   91,850,000    
April   36,996,257   8.79   36,996,257    
May   116,371,153   8.87   116,371,153    
June   71,550,915   8.98   71,550,915    
July   95,143,683   9.18   95,143,683    
August   97,182,890   9.29   97,182,890    
September   49,173,524   9.64   49,173,524    
October   70,840,000   9.85   70,840,000    
November   79,546,000   9.97   79,546,000    
December   55,731,000   10.04   55,731,000    
2005                
January   57,900,000   9.71   57,900,000    
February (c)   69,500,000   10.41   69,500,000    
March (d)   65,725,000   10.86   65,725,000    
April (d)   62,656,000   10.38   62,656,000    
May (d)   63,627,000   10.13   63,627,000    
June (through June 28 (d)   66,985,000   10.52   66,985,000    

(a)
All share purchases were open market transactions.

(b)
At the AGM on April 14, 2005, authorization was given to repurchase up to 2.1 billion ordinary shares in the period to the next AGM or July 13, 2006, the latest date by which an AGM must be held. This authorization is renewed annually at the AGM.

(c)
Includes 18,900,000 shares repurchased for cancellation and 50,600,000 shares held in treasury.

(d)
Held in treasury.

182


        The following table provides details of share purchases made by ESOP Trusts.

 
  Total number of
shares purchased

  Average price paid per share

  Total number
of shares purchased as part of publicly announced programmes (a)

  Maximum number
of shares that may yet be purchased under the programme (a)

 
   
  ($)

   
   
2004                
January   107,819   8.34        
February   1,854,878   7.65        
March   5,920   7.60        
April            
May   9,864   8.20        
June   5,000,000   8.85        
July   9,654,519   9.02        
August   203   8.91        
September            
October   5,498   9.71        
November   8,581   8.83        
December   205   9.50        
2005                
January   143,789   9.79        
February   7,128,864   10.47        
March   6,271,709   10.39        
April   1,219   9.64        
May            
June            

(a)
No shares were repurchased pursuant to a publicly announced plan. Transactions represent the purchase of ordinary shares by ESOP Trusts to satisfy future requirements of employee share schemes.

183



PART III

ITEM 17 — FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

        Not applicable.


ITEM 18 — FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

        The following financial statements, together with the reports of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm thereon, are filed as part of this annual report:

 
  Page
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm   F-1
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm   F-2
Consolidated Statement of Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2004, 2003, and 2002   F-3
Consolidated Balance Sheet at December 31, 2004 and 2003   F-4
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2004, 2003, and 2002   F-5
Statement of Total Recognized Gains and Losses for the Years Ended December 31, 2004, 2003, and 2002   F-6
Statement of Changes in BP Shareholders' Interest for the Years Ended December 31, 2004, 2003, and 2002   F-7
Notes to Financial Statements   F-10
 
The following supplementary information is filed as part of this annual report:

 

 

Supplementary Oil and Gas Information (Unaudited)

 

S-1
Schedule for the Years Ended December 31, 2004, 2003, and 2002 Schedule II Valuation and Qualifying Accounts   S-26


ITEM 19 — EXHIBITS

        The following documents are filed as part of this annual report:

Exhibit 1.   Memorandum and Articles of Association of BP p.l.c.*
Exhibit 4.1   The BP Executive Directors' Long Term Incentive Plan†
Exhibit 4.2   Directors' Service Contracts†
Exhibit 7.   Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges (Unaudited)†
Exhibit 8.   Subsidiaries†
Exhibit 11.   Code of Ethics*
Exhibit 12.   Rule 13a - 14(a) Certifications
Exhibit 13.   Rule 13a - 14(b) Certifications**

*
Incorporated by reference to the Company's Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2003.

**
Furnished only.

Previously filed on June 30, 2005 as an exhibit to the Company's Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2004.

        The total amount of long-term debt securities of the Registrant and its subsidiaries authorized under any one instrument does not exceed 10% of the total assets of BP p.l.c. and its subsidiaries on a consolidated basis. The Company agrees to furnish copies of any or all such instruments to the Securities and Exchange Commission upon request.

184



BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To:
The Board of Directors
BP p.l.c.

        We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of BP p.l.c. as of December 31, 2004 and 2003, and the related consolidated statements of income, changes in BP shareholders' interest, total recognized gains and losses, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2004. Our audits also included the financial statement schedule listed in the Index at Item 18. These financial statements and schedule are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and schedule based on our audits.

        We conducted our audits in accordance with United Kingdom auditing standards and the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. We were not engaged to perform an audit of the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Our audits included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

        In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of BP p.l.c. at December 31, 2004 and 2003, and the consolidated results of its operations and its consolidated cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2004, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United Kingdom which differ in certain respects from those generally accepted in the United States of America (see Note 50 of Notes to Financial Statements). Also, in our opinion, the related financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.

        As discussed in Note 46 of Notes to Financial Statements, in the year ended December 31, 2004 the Company changed its method of accounting for retirement benefits and employee share ownership plan trusts.

        As discussed in Note 50(s) of Notes to the Financial Statements, the turnover and cost of sales, reported under accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America, have been restated.

    /s/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP
   
London, England
February 7, 2005
Except for Note 50(s),
as to which the date is
June 13, 2006
  Ernst & Young LLP
   

F - 1



BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

        We consent to the incorporation by reference of our report dated February 7, 2005, except for Note 50(s), as to which the date is June 13, 2006 with respect to the consolidated financial statements and schedule of BP p.l.c. included in Amendment No. 1 to the Annual Report (Form 20-F) for the year ended December 31, 2004 in the following Registration Statements:

        Registration Statements (Form F-3 Nos. 333-9790, 333-65996 and 333-110203) of BP p.l.c.;

        Registration Statement (Form F-3 No. 333-83180) of BP Australia Capital Markets Limited, BP Canada Finance Company, BP Capital Markets p.l.c., BP Capital Markets America Inc. and BP p.l.c.; and

        Registration Statements (Form S-8 Nos. 333-21868, 333-9020, 333-9798, 333-79399, 333-34968, 333-67206, 333-74414, 333-102583, 333-103923, 333-103924, 333-119934, 333-123482, 333-123483, 333-132619, 333-131583, 333-131584 and 333-132619) of BP p.l.c.

    /s/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP
   
London, England
June 13, 2006
  Ernst & Young LLP
   

F - 2



BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF INCOME

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  Note
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
   
  ($ million, except per share amounts)

 
Turnover       294,849   236,045   180,186  
Less: Joint ventures       9,790   3,474   1,465  
       
 
 
 
Group turnover   2   285,059   232,571   178,721  
Cost of sales       247,110   201,335   154,615  
Production taxes   3   2,149   1,723   1,274  
       
 
 
 
Gross profit       35,800   29,513   22,832  
Distribution and administration expenses   4   14,988   14,072   12,632  
Exploration expense       637   542   644  
       
 
 
 
        20,175   14,899   9,556  
Other income   5   675   786   641  
       
 
 
 
Group operating profit       20,850   15,685   10,197  
Share of profits of joint ventures       2,943   924   347  
Share of profits of associated undertakings       634   514   617  
       
 
 
 
Total operating profit       24,427   17,123   11,161  
Profit (loss) on sale of businesses or termination of operations   7   (695 ) (28 ) (33 )
Profit (loss) on sale of fixed assets   7   1,510   859   1,201  
       
 
 
 
Profit before interest and tax       25,242   17,954   12,329  
Interest expense   8   642   644   1,067  
Other finance expense   9   357   547   73  
       
 
 
 
Profit before taxation       24,243   16,763   11,189  
Taxation   14   8,282   6,111   4,317  
       
 
 
 
Profit after taxation       15,961   10,652   6,872  
Minority shareholders' interest       230   170   77  
       
 
 
 
Profit for the year*       15,731   10,482   6,795  
Dividend requirements on preference shares*       2   2   2  
       
 
 
 
Profit for the year applicable to ordinary shares*       15,729   10,480   6,793  
       
 
 
 
Profit per ordinary share — cents                  
Basic   17   72.08   47.27   30.33  
Diluted   17   70.79   46.83   30.19  
       
 
 
 
Dividends per ordinary share — cents   16   29.45   26.00   24.00  
       
 
 
 
Average number outstanding of 25 cents ordinary shares (in thousands)       21,820,535   22,170,741   22,397,126  
       
 
 
 

*
A summary of the adjustments to profit for the year of the Group which would be required if generally accepted accounting principles in the United States had been applied instead of those generally accepted in the United Kingdom is given in Note 50.

The Notes to Financial Statements are an integral part of this Statement.

F - 3



BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET

 
   
  December 31,

 
 
  Note

  2004

  2003

 
 
   
  ($ million)

 
Fixed assets                      
  Intangible assets   21       12,076       13,642  
  Tangible assets   22       96,748       91,911  
  Investments                      
    Joint ventures                      
      Gross assets       18,244       15,265      
      Gross liabilities       6,316       5,111      
      Minority shareholders' interest       542       365      
       
     
     
    23   11,386       9,789      
      Loans   23   1,065       1,220      
      Net investment           12,451       11,009  
    Associated undertakings   23       5,488       4,870  
    Other   23       467       1,579  
           
     
 
            18,406       17,458  
           
     
 
Total fixed assets           127,230       123,011  

Current assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
  Inventories   24   15,698       11,617      
  Trade receivables   25   31,223       23,487      
  Other receivables falling due                      
    Within one year   25   13,172       7,897      
    After more than one year   25   2,301       2,518      
  Investments   26   328       185      
  Cash at bank and in hand       1,156       1,947      
       
     
     
        63,878       47,651      
       
     
     
Current liabilities — falling due within one year                      
  Finance debt   30   10,184       9,456      
  Trade payables   31   28,340       20,858      
  Other accounts payable and accrued liabilities   31   26,001       20,270      
       
     
     
        64,525       50,584      
       
     
     
Net current assets (liabilities)           (647 )     (2,933 )
           
     
 
Total assets less current liabilities           126,583       120,078  
Noncurrent liabilities                      
  Finance debt   30   12,907       12,869      
  Accounts payable and accrued liabilities   31   4,505       6,030      
Provisions for liabilities and charges                      
  Deferred taxation   14   15,050       14,371      
  Other   32   9,608       8,599      
       
     
     
            42,070       41,869  
           
     
 
Net assets excluding pension and other postretirement benefit balances           84,513       78,209  
Defined benefit pension plan surpluses   33       1,475       1,146  
Defined benefit pension plan deficits   33       (5,863 )     (5,005 )
Other postretirement benefit plan deficit   34       (2,126 )     (2,630 )
           
     
 
Net assets           77,999       71,720  
Minority shareholders' interest — equity           1,343       1,125  
           
     
 
BP shareholders' interest*           76,656       70,595  
           
     
 
Represented by:                      
Capital shares                      
  Preference           21       21  
  Ordinary           5,382       5,531  
Paid in surplus   35       6,366       4,480  
Merger reserve   35       27,162       27,077  
Other reserves   35       44       129  
Shares held by ESOP trusts   35       (82 )     (96 )
Retained earnings   35/36       37,763       33,453  
           
     
 
            76,656       70,595  
           
     
 

*
A summary of the adjustments to BP shareholders' interest which would be required if generally accepted accounting principles in the United States had been applied instead of those generally accepted in the United Kingdom is given in Note 50.

The Notes to Financial Statements are an integral part of this Balance Sheet.

F - 4



BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  Note

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
   
  ($ million)

 
Net cash inflow from operating activities   37   28,554   21,698   19,342  
       
 
 
 
Dividends from joint ventures       1,908   131   198  
       
 
 
 
Dividends from associated undertakings       291   417   368  
       
 
 
 
Servicing of finance and returns on investments                  
Interest received       332   175   231  
Interest paid       (694 ) (1,006 ) (1,204 )
Dividends received       53   140   102  
Dividends paid to minority shareholders       (33 ) (20 ) (40 )
       
 
 
 
Net cash outflow from servicing of finance and returns on investments       (342 ) (711 ) (911 )
       
 
 
 
Taxation                  
UK corporation tax       (1,447 ) (1,185 ) (979 )
Overseas tax       (4,931 ) (3,619 ) (2,115 )
       
 
 
 
Tax paid       (6,378 ) (4,804 ) (3,094 )
       
 
 
 
Capital expenditure and financial investment                  
Payments for tangible and intangible fixed assets       (13,035 ) (12,368 ) (12,049 )
Payments for fixed assets — investments         (9 ) (49 )
Proceeds from the sale of fixed assets   20   4,323   6,253   2,470  
       
 
 
 
Net cash outflow for capital expenditure and financial investment       (8,712 ) (6,124 ) (9,628 )
       
 
 
 
Acquisitions and disposals                  
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired       (1,503 ) (211 ) (4,324 )
Proceeds from the sale of businesses   20   725   179   1,974  
Acquisition of investment in TNK-BP joint venture       (1,250 ) (2,351 )  
Net investment in other joint ventures       (272 ) (178 ) (354 )
Investments in associated undertakings       (942 ) (987 ) (971 )
Proceeds from sale of investment in Ruhrgas   20       2,338  
       
 
 
 
Net cash outflow for acquisitions and disposals       (3,242 ) (3,548 ) (1,337 )
       
 
 
 
Equity dividends paid       (6,041 ) (5,654 ) (5,264 )
       
 
 
 
Net cash inflow (outflow)       6,038   1,405   (326 )
       
 
 
 
Financing   37   6,777   1,129   (163 )
Management of liquid resources   37   132   (41 ) (220 )
Increase (decrease) in cash   37   (871 ) 317   57  
       
 
 
 
        6,038   1,405   (326 )
       
 
 
 

For a cash flow statement and a statement of comprehensive income prepared on the basis of US GAAP see Note 50 — US generally accepted accounting principles.

The Notes to Financial Statements are an integral part of this Statement.

F - 5



BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES

STATEMENT OF TOTAL RECOGNIZED GAINS AND LOSSES

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Profit for the year   15,731   10,482   6,795  
Currency translation differences   2,351   3,681   3,426  
Actuarial gain (loss) relating to pensions and other postretirement benefits   107   76   (7,829 )
Unrealized gain on acquisition of further investment in equity-accounted investments   94      
Tax on currency translation differences   (208 ) (37 ) (142 )
Tax on actuarial gain (loss) relating to pensions and other postretirement benefits   96   (16 ) 2,459  
   
 
 
 
Total recognized gains and losses relating to the year   18,171   14,186   4,709  
       
 
 
Prior year adjustment — change in accounting policy   (132 )        
   
         
Total recognized gains and losses since last annual accounts   18,039          
   
         

The Notes to Financial Statements are an integral part of this Statement.

F - 6



BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES

STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN BP SHAREHOLDERS' INTEREST

        The Company's authorized ordinary share capital at December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002 was 36 billion shares of 25 cents each, amounting to $9 billion. In addition the Company has authorized preference share capital of 12,750,000 shares of £1 each ($21 million). Details of movements in share capital are shown in Note 35.

        The allotted, called up and fully paid share capital at December 31, was as follows:

 
  Shares

   
 
  Authorized

  Issued

  Amount

 
   
   
  ($ million)

Non-equity — preference shares            
8% cumulative first preference shares of £1 each at December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002   7,250,000   7,232,838   12
   
 
 
9% cumulative second preference shares of £1 each at December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002   5,500,000   5,473,414   9
   
 
 
Equity — ordinary shares of 25 cents each            
Authorized            
December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002   36,000,000,000        
   
       
 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
Issued

  Shares of
25 cents each

  Amount

  Shares of
25 cents each

  Amount

  Shares of
25 cents each

  Amount

 
 
  (thousands)

  ($ million)

  (thousands)

  ($ million)

  (thousands)

  ($ million)

 
January 1   22,122,610   5,531   22,378,651   5,595   22,432,077   5,608  
Employee share schemes (a)   62,224   16   32,889   8   33,821   9  
Atlantic Richfield (b)   29,288   7   9,786   2   12,894   3  
Issue of ordinary share capital for TNK-BP (c)   139,096   35          
Repurchase of ordinary share capital (d)   (827,240 ) (207 ) (298,716 ) (74 ) (100,141 ) (25 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31   21,525,978   5,382   22,122,610   5,531   22,378,651   5,595  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Paid in surplus                          
January 1       4,480       4,243       4,014  
Premium on shares issued:                          
  Employee share schemes (a)       311       127       129  
  Atlantic Richfield (b)       153       36       54  
  Issue of ordinary share capital for TNK-BP (c)       1,215              
Repurchase of ordinary share capital (d)       207       74       25  
Qualifying Employee Share Ownership Trust (e)                   21  
       
     
     
 
December 31       6,366       4,480       4,243  
       
     
     
 

The Notes to Financial Statements are an integral part of this Statement.

F - 7


 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Merger reserve              
January 1   27,077   27,033   26,983  
Atlantic Richfield (b)   85   44   50  
   
 
 
 
December 31   27,162   27,077   27,033  
   
 
 
 
Other reserves              
January 1   129   173   223  
Atlantic Richfield (b)   (85 ) (44 ) (50 )
   
 
 
 
December 31   44   129   173  
   
 
 
 
Shares held by ESOP trusts              
January 1   (96 ) (159 )  
Prior year adjustment — change in accounting policy       (266 )
   
 
 
 
As restated   (96 ) (159 ) (266 )
Currency translation differences   (7 ) (8 ) (19 )
Purchase of shares by ESOP trusts   (147 ) (63 ) (18 )
Release of shares by ESOP trusts   168   134   144  
   
 
 
 
December 31   (82 ) (96 ) (159 )
   
 
 
 
Retained earnings              
January 1   33,453   26,928   28,312  
Prior year adjustment — change in accounting policy       116  
   
 
 
 
As restated   33,453   26,928   28,428  
Currency translation differences (net of tax)   2,143   3,644   3,284  
Repurchase of ordinary share capital   (7,548 ) (1,999 ) (750 )
Actuarial gain (loss) (net of tax)   203   60   (5,370 )
Unrealized gain on acquisition of further investment in equity-accounted investments   94      
Charge for long-term performance plans and employee share schemes   226   225   81  
Release of shares by ESOP trusts   (168 ) (134 ) (144 )
Qualifying Employee Share Ownership Trust (e)       (21 )
Profit for the year   15,731   10,482   6,795  
Dividends (f)              
  Preference (non-equity)   (2 ) (2 ) (2 )
  Ordinary (equity)   (6,369 ) (5,751 ) (5,373 )
   
 
 
 
December 31   37,763   33,453   26,928  
   
 
 
 

(a)
Employee share schemes. During the year 62,224,092 ordinary shares were issued under the BP, Amoco and Burmah Castrol employee share schemes.

(b)
Atlantic Richfield. 29,288,178 ordinary shares were issued in respect of Atlantic Richfield employee share option schemes.

F - 8


(c)
Issue of ordinary share capital for TNK-BP. The Company issued 139,095,888 ordinary shares as the first tranche of deferred consideration for the acquisition of the investment in TNK-BP.

(d)
Repurchase of ordinary share capital. The Company purchased for cancellation 827,240,360 ordinary shares for a total consideration of $7,548 million.

(e)
See Note 38 — Employee share plans.

(f)
See Note 16 — Dividends per ordinary share.

(g)
See Note 36 — Retained earnings.

(h)
Voting on substantive resolutions tabled at a general meeting is on a poll. On a poll, shareholders present in person or by proxy have two votes for every £5 in nominal amount of the first and second preference shares held and one vote for every ordinary share held. On a show of hands vote on other resolutions (procedural matters) at a general meeting, shareholders present in person or by proxy have one vote each.

The Notes to Financial Statements are an integral part of this Statement.

F - 9



BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Note 1 — Accounting policies

Accounting standards

        These accounts are prepared in accordance with applicable UK accounting standards.

        In preparing the financial statements for the current year, the Group has adopted Financial Reporting Standard No. 17 'Retirement Benefits' (FRS 17) and Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract No. 38 'Accounting for Employee Share Ownership Plan (ESOP) Trusts' (Abstract No. 38). The adoption of FRS 17 and Abstract No. 38 has resulted in changes in accounting policy for pensions and other postretirement benefits and the accounting of ESOP trusts.

        In addition to the requirements of accounting standards, the accounting for exploration and production activities is governed by the Statement of Recommended Practice ('SORP') 'Accounting for Oil and Gas Exploration, Development, Production and Decommissioning Activities' issued by the UK Oil Industry Accounting Committee on June 7, 2001. These accounts have been prepared in accordance with the provisions of the SORP.

Basis of preparation

        The Group's main activities are the exploration and production of crude oil and natural gas; the marketing and trading of natural gas and power; the refining, marketing, supply and transportation of petroleum products; and the manufacturing and marketing of petrochemicals.

        The preparation of accounts in conformity with UK generally accepted accounting practice requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities at the date of the accounts and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual outcomes could differ from these estimates.

Group consolidation

        The Group financial statements comprise a consolidation of the accounts of the parent Company and its subsidiary undertakings (subsidiaries). The results of subsidiaries acquired or sold are consolidated for the periods from or to the date on which control passes.

        An associated undertaking (associate) is an entity in which the Group has a long-term equity interest and over which it exercises significant influence. The consolidated financial statements include the Group proportion of the operating profit or loss, exceptional items, interest expense, taxation and net assets of associates (the equity method).

        A joint venture is an entity in which the Group has a long-term interest and shares control with one or more co-venturers. The consolidated financial statements include the Group proportion of turnover, operating profit or loss, exceptional items, interest expense, taxation, gross assets, gross liabilities and minority shareholders' interest of the joint venture (the gross equity method).

        Certain of the Group's activities are conducted through joint arrangements and are included in the consolidated financial statements in proportion to the Group's interest in the income, expenses, assets and liabilities of these joint arrangements.

        On the acquisition of a subsidiary, or of an interest in a joint venture or associate, fair values reflecting conditions at the date of acquisition are attributed to the identifiable net assets acquired. When the cost of acquisition exceeds the fair values attributable to the Group's share of such net assets

F - 10



the difference is treated as purchased goodwill. This is capitalized and amortized on a straight-line basis over its estimated useful economic life, which is usually 10 years.

        Where an interest in a separate business of an acquired entity is held temporarily pending disposal, it is carried on the balance sheet at its estimated net proceeds of sale.

Accounting convention

        The accounts are prepared under the historical cost convention, except as explained under inventory valuation.

Inventory valuation

        Inventories, other than inventory held for trading purposes, are valued at cost to the Group using the first-in first-out method or at net realizable value, whichever is the lower. Stores are valued at cost to the Group mainly using the average method or net realizable value, whichever is the lower.

        Inventory held for trading purposes is marked-to-market and any gains or losses are recognized in the income statement rather than the statement of total recognized gains and losses. The directors consider that the nature of the Group's trading activity is such that, in order for the accounts to show a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Group and the results for the year, it is necessary to depart from the requirements of Schedule 4 to the Companies Act 1985. Had the treatment in Schedule 4 been followed, the profit and loss account reserve would have been reduced by $100 million (2003 $150 million and 2002 $209 million) and a revaluation reserve established and increased accordingly.

Revenue recognition

        Revenues associated with the sale of oil, natural gas, LNG, petroleum and chemical products and all other items are recognized when the title passes to the customer. Supply buy/sell arrangements with common counterparties are reported net, as are physical exchanges. Oil, natural gas, NGL and power over-the-counter forward sales contracts where the Group acts as principal rather than agent are reported gross and included in turnover. The Group was deemed to be the principal in the over-the-counter forward sales transactions because: (i) the Group was the primary obligator in the arrangement; (ii) the Group had discretion to set the selling price with the customer; (iii) the Group had discretion to select the supplier; (iv) the Group took title to the commodity, albeit often for a short period of time; and (v) the Group was invoiced for the full amount of the transaction and had this liability to a third party, although master netting agreements mitigated the credit risk. Generally, revenues from the production of natural gas and oil properties in which the Group has an interest with other producers are recognized on the basis of the Group's working interest in those properties (the entitlement method). Differences between the production sold and the Group's share of production are not significant.

Foreign currency transactions

        Foreign currency transactions by Group companies are booked in the functional currency at the exchange rate ruling on the date of transaction, or at the forward rate if hedged by a forward exchange contract. Foreign currency monetary assets and liabilities are translated into the functional currency at

F - 11



rates of exchange ruling at the balance sheet date, or at the forward rate. Exchange differences are included in operating profit.

        Assets and liabilities of overseas subsidiary and associated undertakings and joint ventures, including related goodwill, are translated into US dollars at rates of exchange ruling at the balance sheet date. The results and cash flows of overseas subsidiary and associated undertakings and joint ventures are translated into US dollars using average rates of exchange. Exchange adjustments arising when the opening net assets and the profits for the year retained by overseas subsidiary and associated undertakings and joint ventures are translated into US dollars are taken directly to reserves and reported in the statement of total recognized gains and losses. Exchange gains and losses arising on long-term foreign currency borrowings used to finance the Group's foreign currency investments are also dealt with in reserves.

Derivative financial instruments

        The Group uses derivative financial instruments (derivatives) to manage certain exposures to fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates, and to manage some of its margin exposure from changes in oil, natural gas and power prices. Derivatives are also traded in conjunction with these risk management activities.

        The purpose for which a derivative contract is used is identified at inception. To qualify as a derivative for risk management, the contract must be in accordance with established guidelines which ensure that it is effective in achieving its objective. All contracts not identified at inception as being for the purpose of risk management are designated as being held for trading purposes and accounted for using the fair value method, as are all oil price derivatives.

        The Group accounts for derivatives using the following methods:

        Fair value method. Derivatives are carried on the balance sheet at fair value ('marked-to-market') with changes in that value recognized in earnings of the period. This method is used for all derivatives which are held for trading purposes. Interest rate contracts traded by the Group include futures, swaps, options and swaptions. Foreign exchange contracts traded include forwards and options. Oil, natural gas and power price contracts traded include swaps, options and futures.

        Accrual method. Amounts payable or receivable in respect of derivatives are recognized ratably in earnings over the period of the contracts. This method is used for derivatives held to manage interest rate risk. These are principally swap agreements used to manage the balance between fixed and floating interest rates on long-term finance debt. Other derivatives held for this purpose may include swaptions and futures contracts. Amounts payable or receivable in respect of these derivatives are recognized as adjustments to interest expense over the period of the contracts. Changes in the derivative's fair value are not recognized.

        Deferral method. Gains and losses from derivatives are deferred and recognized in earnings or as adjustments to carrying amounts, as appropriate, when the underlying debt matures or the hedged transaction occurs. This method is used for derivatives used to convert non-US dollar borrowings into US dollars, to hedge significant non-US dollar firm commitments or anticipated transactions, and to manage some of the Group's exposure to natural gas and power price fluctuations. Derivatives used to convert non-US dollar borrowings into US dollars include foreign currency swap agreements and

F - 12



forward contracts. Gains and losses on these derivatives are deferred and recognized on maturity of the underlying debt, together with the matching loss or gain on the debt. Derivatives used to hedge significant non-US dollar transactions include foreign currency forward contracts and options and to hedge natural gas and power price exposures include swaps, futures and options. Gains and losses on these contracts and option premia paid are also deferred and recognized in the income statement or as adjustments to carrying amounts, as appropriate, when the hedged transaction occurs.

        Where derivatives used to manage interest rate risk or to convert non-US dollar debt or to hedge other anticipated cash flows are terminated before the underlying debt matures or the hedged transaction occurs, the resulting gain or loss is recognized on a basis that matches the timing and accounting treatment of the underlying debt or hedged transaction. When an anticipated transaction is no longer likely to occur or finance debt is terminated before maturity, any deferred gain or loss that has arisen on the related derivative is recognized in the income statement, together with any gain or loss on the terminated item.

        The effect of these policies on the accounts is described as follows:

        Reporting in the income statement. Gains and losses on oil price contracts held for trading and for risk management purposes and natural gas and power price contracts held for trading purposes that are settled for difference in cash are reported in cost of sales in the income statement in the period in which the change in value occurs. Gains and losses on interest rate or foreign currency derivatives used for trading are reported in other income and cost of sales, respectively. Gains and losses in respect of derivatives used to manage interest rate exposures are recognized as adjustments to interest expense.

        Where derivatives are used to convert non-US dollar borrowings into US dollars, the gains and losses are deferred and recognized on maturity of the underlying debt, together with the matching loss or gain on the debt. The two amounts offset each other in the income statement.

        Gains and losses on derivatives identified as hedges of significant non-US dollar firm commitments or anticipated transactions are not recognized until the hedged transaction occurs. The treatment of the gain or loss arising on the designated derivative reflects the nature and accounting treatment of the hedged item. The gain or loss is recorded in cost of sales in the income statement or as an adjustment to carrying values in the balance sheet, as appropriate.

        Gains and losses arising from natural gas and power price derivatives held for risk management purposes are recognized in earnings when the hedged transaction occurs. The gains or losses are reported as components of the related transactions.

        Reporting in the balance sheet. The carrying amounts of foreign exchange contracts that hedge finance debt are included within finance debt in the balance sheet. The carrying amounts of other derivatives, including option premiums paid or received, are included in the balance sheet under debtors or creditors within current assets and current liabilities respectively, as appropriate.

        Cash flow effects. Interest rate swaps give rise, at specified intervals, to cash settlement of interest differentials. Under currency swaps the counterparties initially exchange a principal amount in two currencies, agreeing to re-exchange the currencies at a future date at the same exchange rate. The Group's currency swaps have terms of up to six years.

F - 13



        Interest rate futures require an initial margin payment and daily settlement of margin calls. Interest rate forwards require settlement of the interest rate differential on a specified future date. Currency forwards require purchase or sale of an agreed amount of foreign currency at a specified exchange rate at a specified future date, generally over periods of up to three years for the Group. Currency options involve the initial payment or receipt of a premium and will give rise to delivery of an agreed amount of currency at a specified future date if the option is exercised.

        For oil, natural gas and power price futures and options traded on regulated exchanges, gains and losses are settled on a daily basis, while exchange liquidity requirements are funded through letters of credit or cash deposits. For swaps and over-the-counter options, BP settles with the counterparty on conclusion of the pricing period.

        In the statement of cash flows the effect of interest rate derivatives used to manage interest rate exposures is reflected in interest paid. The effect of foreign currency derivatives used for hedging non-US dollar debt is included under financing. The cash flow effects of foreign currency derivatives used to hedge non-US dollar firm commitments and anticipated transactions are included in net cash inflow from operating activities for items relating to earnings or in capital expenditure or acquisitions, as appropriate, for items of a capital nature. The cash flow effects of all oil, natural gas and power price derivatives and all traded derivatives are included in net cash inflow from operating activities.

Maintenance expenditure

        Expenditure on major maintenance, refits or repairs is capitalized where it enhances the performance of an asset above its originally assessed standard of performance; replaces an asset or part of an asset which was separately depreciated and which is then written off; or restores the economic benefits of an asset which has been fully depreciated. All other maintenance expenditure is charged to income as incurred.

Oil and natural gas exploration and development expenditure

        Oil and natural gas exploration and development expenditure is accounted for using the successful efforts method of accounting.

        Licence and property acquisition costs. Exploration and property leasehold acquisition costs are capitalized within intangible fixed assets and amortized on a straight-line basis over the estimated period of exploration. Each property is reviewed on an annual basis to confirm that drilling activity is planned and it is not impaired. If no future activity is planned the remaining balance of the licence and property acquisition costs is written off. Upon determination of economically recoverable reserves ('proved reserves' or 'commercial reserves'), amortization ceases and the remaining costs are aggregated with exploration expenditure and held on a field-by-field basis as proved properties awaiting approval within intangible fixed assets. When development is approved internally, the relevant expenditure is transferred to tangible production assets.

        Exploration expenditure. Geological and geophysical exploration costs are charged against income as incurred. Costs directly associated with an exploration well are capitalized as an intangible asset until the drilling of the well is complete and the results have been evaluated. These costs include employee remuneration, materials and fuel used, rig costs, delay rentals and payments made to contractors. If hydrocarbons are not found, the exploration expenditure is written off as a dry hole. If

F - 14



hydrocarbons are found, and, subject to further appraisal activity which may include the drilling of further wells (exploration or exploratory-type stratigraphic test wells), are likely to be capable of commercial development, the costs continue to be carried as an asset. All such carried costs are subject to technical, commercial and management review at least once a year to confirm the continued intent to develop or otherwise extract value from the discovery. When this is no longer the case, the costs are written off. When proved reserves of oil and natural gas are determined and development is sanctioned, the relevant expenditure is transferred to tangible production assets.

        Development expenditure. Expenditure on the construction, installation or completion of infrastructure facilities such as platforms, pipelines and the drilling of development wells, including unsuccessful development or delineation wells, is capitalized within tangible production assets.

Decommissioning

        Provision for decommissioning is recognized in full on the installation of oil and natural gas production facilities. The amount recognized is the present value of the estimated future expenditure determined in accordance with local conditions and requirements. A corresponding tangible fixed asset of an amount equivalent to the provision is also created. This is subsequently depreciated as part of the capital costs of the production and transportation facilities.

        Any change in the present value of the estimated expenditure is reflected as an adjustment to the provision and the fixed asset.

Depreciation

        Oil and natural gas production assets are depreciated using a unit-of-production method. The cost of producing wells is amortized over proved developed reserves. Licence acquisition, decommissioning and field development costs are amortized over total proved reserves. The field development costs subject to amortization are expenditures incurred to date together with sanctioned future development expenditure.

        Other tangible and intangible assets are depreciated on the straight-line method over their estimated useful lives. The average estimated useful lives of refineries are 20 years, chemicals manufacturing plants 20 years and service stations 15 years. Other intangibles are amortized over a maximum period of 20 years.

        The Group undertakes a review for impairment of a fixed asset or goodwill if events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of the fixed asset or goodwill may not be recoverable. To the extent that the carrying amount exceeds the recoverable amount, that is, the higher of net realizable value and value in use, the fixed asset or goodwill is written down to its recoverable amount. The value in use is determined from estimated discounted future net cash flows.

Petroleum revenue tax

        The charge for petroleum revenue tax is calculated using a unit-of-production method.

F - 15


Note 1 — Accounting policies (continued)

Changes in unit-of-production factors

        Changes in factors which affect unit-of-production calculations are dealt with prospectively, not by immediate adjustment of prior years' amounts.

Environmental liabilities

        Environmental expenditures that relate to current or future revenues are expensed or capitalized as appropriate. Expenditures that relate to an existing condition caused by past operations and that do not contribute to current or future earnings are expensed.

        Liabilities for environmental costs are recognized when environmental assessments or clean-ups are probable and the associated costs can be reasonably estimated. Generally, the timing of these provisions coincides with the commitment to a formal plan of action or, if earlier, on divestment or on closure of inactive sites. The amount recognized is the best estimate of the expenditure required. Where the liability will not be settled for a number of years the amount recognized is the present value of the estimated future expenditure.

Leases

        Assets held under leases which result in Group companies receiving substantially all risks and rewards of ownership (capital leases) are capitalized as tangible fixed assets at the estimated present value of underlying lease payments. The corresponding capital lease obligation is included within finance debt. Rentals under operating leases are charged against income as incurred.

Research

        Expenditure on research is written off in the year in which it is incurred.

Interest

        Interest is capitalized gross of related tax relief during the period of construction where it relates either to the financing of major projects with long periods of development or to dedicated financing of other projects. All other interest is charged against income.

Pensions and other postretirement benefits

        For defined benefit pension and other postretirement benefit schemes, scheme assets are measured at fair value and scheme liabilities are measured on an actuarial basis using the projected unit method and discounted at an interest rate equivalent to the current rate of return on a high-quality corporate bond of equivalent currency and term to the scheme liabilities. Full actuarial valuations are obtained at least every three years and are updated at each balance sheet date. The resulting surplus or deficit, net of taxation thereon, is presented separately above the total for net assets on the face of the balance sheet.

        The service cost of providing pension and other postretirement benefits to employees for the year is charged to the income statement. The cost of making improvements to pension and other postretirement benefits is recognized in the income statement on a straight-line basis over the period

F - 16



during which the increase in benefits vests. To the extent that the improvements in benefits vest immediately, the cost is recognized immediately. These costs are recognized as an operating expense.

        A charge representing the unwinding of the discount on the scheme liabilities during the year is included within other finance expense. A credit representing the expected return on the scheme assets during the year is included within other finance expense. This credit is based on the market value of the scheme assets, and expected rates of return, at the beginning of the year.

        Actuarial gains and losses may result from: differences between the expected return and the actual return on scheme assets; differences between the actuarial assumptions underlying the scheme liabilities and actual experience during the year; or changes in the actuarial assumptions used in the valuation of the scheme liabilities. Actuarial gains and losses, and taxation thereon, are recognized in the statement of total recognized gains and losses. For defined contribution schemes, contributions payable for the year are charged to the income statement as an operating expense.

Deferred taxation

        Deferred tax is recognized in respect of all timing differences that have originated but not reversed at the balance sheet date where transactions or events have occurred at that date that will result in an obligation to pay more, or a right to pay less, tax in the future. In particular:

        Deferred tax assets are recognized only to the extent that it is considered more likely than not that there will be suitable taxable profits from which the underlying timing differences can be deducted. Deferred tax is measured on an undiscounted basis at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the periods in which timing differences reverse, based on tax rates and laws enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date.

Discounting

        The unwinding of the discount on provisions is included within other finance expense. Any change in the amount recognized for environmental and other provisions arising through changes in discount rates is included within other finance expense.

Use of estimates

        The preparation of accounts in conformity with generally accepted accounting practice requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and

F - 17



liabilities at the date of accounts and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual outcomes could differ from these estimates.

Comparative figures

        Information for 2003 and 2002 has been restated to reflect the transfer of natural gas liquids activities from Exploration and Production to Gas, Power and Renewables. In addition, certain prior year figures have been restated to conform with the 2004 presentation.

Note 2 — Turnover

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Sales and operating revenue   352,316   278,859   222,231
Customs duties and sales taxes   67,257   46,288   43,510
   
 
 
    285,059   232,571   178,721
   
 
 

Note 3 — Production taxes

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

UK petroleum revenue tax   335   300   309
Overseas production taxes   1,814   1,423   965
   
 
 
    2,149   1,723   1,274
   
 
 

Note 4 — Distribution and administration expenses

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Distribution   13,577   12,559   11,431
Administration   1,411   1,513   1,201
   
 
 
    14,988   14,072   12,632
   
 
 

F - 18


Note 5 — Other income

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Income from other fixed asset investments   76   157   139
Other interest and miscellaneous income   599   629   502
   
 
 
    675   786   641
   
 
 
Income from investments publicly traded included above   21   60   58
   
 
 

Note 6 — Auditors' remuneration

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  UK

  Total

  UK

  Total

  UK

  Total

 
  ($ million)

Audit fees — Ernst & Young                        
  Group audit   13   27   8   18   6   15
  Audit-related regulatory reporting   4   7   2   5   2   4
  Statutory audit of subsidiaries   4   16   3   13   2   10
   
 
 
 
 
 
    21   50   13   36   10   29
   
 
 
 
 
 
Fees for other services — Ernst & Young                        
  Further assurance services                        
    Acquisition and disposal due diligence   6   7   9   9   9   13
    Pension scheme audits     1     1     1
    Other further assurance services   6   9   5   9   5   8
  Tax services                        
    Compliance services   3   13   3   17   3   23
    Advisory services     1     2   2   4
  Other services           1   1
   
 
 
 
 
 
    15   31   17   38   20   50
   
 
 
 
 
 

        Group audit fees include $4 million (2003 $2 million and 2002 $2 million) in respect of the parent company. Audit fees are included in the income statement within distribution and administration expenses.

        The audit committee has established pre-approval policies and procedures for the engagement of Ernst & Young to render audit and certain assurance and tax services.

        The audit fees payable to Ernst & Young are reviewed by the audit committee in the context of other global companies for cost effectiveness.

        Ernst & Young performed further assurance and tax services which were not prohibited by regulatory or other professional requirements and were pre-approved by the committee. Ernst & Young is engaged for these services when their expertise and experience of BP are important. Most of this work is of an audit nature. Tax services were awarded either through a full competitive tender process

F - 19



or following an assessment of the expertise of Ernst & Young relative to that of other potential service providers. These services are for a fixed term.

        Fees paid to major firms of accountants other than Ernst & Young for other services amount to $82 million (2003 $44 million and 2002 $33 million).

Note 7 — Exceptional items

        Exceptional items comprise profit (loss) on sale of fixed assets and the sale of businesses or termination of operations, as follows:

 
   
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
   
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
   
  ($ million)

 
Profit on sale of businesses or termination of operations   — Group       195  
Loss on sale of businesses or termination of operations   — Group   (695 ) (28 ) (228 )
       
 
 
 
        (695 ) (28 ) (33 )
       
 
 
 
Profit on sale of fixed assets   — Group   1,829   1,894   2,736  
    — Associated undertakings       2  
Loss on sale of fixed assets   — Group   (319 ) (1,035 ) (1,537 )
       
 
 
 
        1,510   859   1,201  
       
 
 
 
Exceptional items   815   831   1,168  
Taxation credit (charge)                  
  Sale of businesses or termination of operations   238     45  
  Sale of fixed assets   23   (123 ) (170 )
       
 
 
 
Exceptional items (net of tax)   1,076   708   1,043  
       
 
 
 

Profit on sale of businesses or termination of operations

        Refining and Marketing nil (2003 nil and 2002 $130 million). The profit in 2002 relates mainly to the disposal of the Group's retail network in Cyprus.

        Gas, Power and Renewables nil (2003 nil and 2002 $65 million). The profit in 2002, arises principally from the sale of the Group's UK contract energy management business.

Loss on sale of businesses or termination of operations

        Refining and Marketing $132 million (2003 $28 million and 2002 $12 million). The closure of the lubricants operation of the Coryton refinery in the UK and of refining operations at the ATAS refinery in Mersin, Turkey. For 2003, the sale of the Group's European oil speciality products business.

        Gas, Power and Renewables nil (2003 nil and 2002 $69 million). For 2002, the withdrawal from solar thin film manufacturing.

F - 20



        Petrochemicals $563 million (2003 nil and 2002 $147 million). The sale of the speciality intermediate chemicals business; the sale of the Fabrics and Fibres business; the closure of two manufacturing plants at Hull, UK, which produced acids; and the closure of the linear alpha-olefins production facility at Pasadena, Texas. For 2002, the disposal of our plastic fabrications business; the sale of the former Burmah Castrol speciality chemicals business Fosroc Construction; and the provision for the loss on divestment of the former Burmah Castrol speciality chemicals businesses Sericol and Fosroc Mining.

Profit on sale of fixed assets

        Exploration and Production $379 million (2003 $1,591 million and 2002 $531 million). The Group divested interests in a number of oil and natural gas properties in all three years. For 2004, this included interests in oil and natural gas properties in Australia, Canada and the Gulf of Mexico, and the reversal of the provision for the loss on sale of $217 million for the Desarrollo Zuli Occidental (DZO) and Boqueron fields in Venezuela (see below). For 2003, the divestment of a further 20% interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC to Repsol; the sale of the Group's 96.14% interest in the Forties oil field in the UK North Sea; the sale of a package of UK Southern North Sea gas fields; and the divestment of our interest in the In Amenas gas condensate project in Algeria to Statoil. The significant element of the profit for 2002 is the gain on the redemption of certain preferred limited partnership interests BP retained following the Altura Energy common interest disposal in 2000 in exchange for BP loan notes held by the partnership.

        Refining and Marketing $107 million (2003 $89 million and 2002 $561 million). The sale of the Cushing and other pipeline interests in the US and the churn of retail assets. In 2003, the divestment of pipeline interests in the US. For 2002, the profit on the sale of the Group's interest in the Colonial pipeline in the US and the profit on the sale of a US downstream electronic payment system.

        Gas, Power and Renewables $56 million (2003 $11 million and 2002 $1,556 million). The divestment of BP's interest in two natural gas liquids plants in Canada. For 2003, the sale and leaseback of rail cars. The major part of the profit during 2002 arises from the divestment of the Group's shareholding in Ruhrgas.

        Petrochemicals nil (2003 $55 million and 2002 $27 million). For 2003, the sale of our interest in AG International Chemical Company, a purified isophthalic acid associated undertaking in Japan and other minor divestments. In 2002, the divestment of two-thirds of our interest in the European ethylene pipeline company, ARG.

        Other businesses and corporate $1,287 million (2003 $148 million and 2002 $63 million). The divestment of the Group's investments in PetroChina and Sinopec. In 2003, the Group sold its 50% interest in Kaltim Prima Coal, an Indonesian company, and certain other investments.

Loss on sale of fixed assets

        Exploration and Production $227 million (2003 $678 million and 2002 $1,257 million). The Group divested interests in a number of oil and natural gas properties in all three years. For 2004, this included interests in oil and natural gas properties in Indonesia and the Gulf of Mexico. In 2003, this included losses on exploration and production properties in China, Norway and the US and the

F - 21



provision for losses on sale in early 2004 of exploration and production properties in Canada and Venezuela. In respect of Venezuela, the sales agreement for our interests in the DZO and Boqueron fields lapsed in early 2004, and the fields have been retained. The provision for a loss on disposal of $217 million recognized in 2003 was reversed in 2004 and an impairment charge of $186 million was recognized. The major element of the loss on sale of fixed assets for 2002 relates to provisions for losses on the sale of oil and natural gas properties in the US announced in early 2003.

        Refining and Marketing $92 million (2003 $274 million and 2002 $67 million). The divestment of the Singapore refinery and retail churn. For 2003, retail churn and the sale of refinery and retail interests in Germany and Central Europe.

        Gas, Power and Renewables nil (2003 $17 million and 2002 nil).

        Petrochemicals nil (2003 $17 million and 2002 $136 million). For 2002, the closure of our polypropylene production facility at Cedar Bayou, Texas, a high density polyethylene unit at Deer Park, Texas, and one of four polypropylene units at Chocolate Bayou, Texas.

        Other businesses and corporate nil (2003 $49 million and 2002 $77 million). For 2003 and 2002 the divestment of a number of minor investments.

        Additional information on the sale of businesses and fixed assets is given in Note 20 — Disposals.

Note 8 — Interest expense

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Bank loans and overdrafts   34   38   134
Other loans (a)   573   628   852
Capital leases   37   34   40
   
 
 
    644   700   1,026
Capitalized at 3% (2003 3% and 2002 4%) (b)   208   190   100
   
 
 
Group   436   510   926
Joint ventures   158   89   58
Associated undertakings   48   45   83
   
 
 
Total charged against profit   642   644   1,067
   
 
 

(a)
Interest expense for 2003 includes a charge of $31 million (2002 $15 million) relating to early redemption of debt.

(b)
Tax relief on capitalized interest is $73 million (2003 $68 million and 2002 $36 million).

F - 22


 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Interest on pension and other postretirement benefit plan liabilities   2,012   1,840   1,671  
Expected return on pension and other postretirement benefit plan assets   (1,983 ) (1,500 ) (1,810 )
   
 
 
 
Interest net of expected return on plan assets   29   340   (139 )
Unwinding of discount on provisions   196   173   170  
Unwinding of discount on deferred consideration for acquisition of investment in TNK-BP   91   34    
Change in discount rate for provisions (a)   41     42  
   
 
 
 
Total charged against profit   357   547   73  
   
 
 
 

(a)
Revaluation of environmental and other provisions at a lower discount rate.

Note 10 — Depreciation and amounts provided

        Included in the income statement under the following headings:

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Depreciation and amortization of goodwill and other intangibles            
  Cost of sales   11,109   9,748   9,346
  Distribution   1,334   1,044   952
  Administration   128   148   90
   
 
 
    12,571   10,940   10,388
Amounts provided against fixed asset investments            
  Cost of sales   12     13
   
 
 
    12,583   10,940   10,401
   
 
 
Depreciation of capitalized leased assets included above   164   46   49
   
 
 

        The charge for depreciation and amortization of goodwill and other intangibles in 2004 includes asset write-downs and impairment charges of $1,743 million in total. Exploration and Production recognized a charge of $621 million for the impairment of certain assets. During the year, as a result of impairment triggers, reviews were conducted which have resulted in impairment charges of $83 million in respect of King's Peak in the Gulf of Mexico, $20 million in respect of two fields in the Gulf of Mexico Shelf Matagorda Island area and $184 million in respect of various US onshore fields. A charge of $88 million was reflected in respect of a gas processing plant in the US and a charge of $60 million following the blowout of the Temsah platform in Egypt. In addition, following the lapse of the sale agreement for DZO and Boqueron in Venezuela, an impairment charge of $186 million was reflected. In connection with the Solvay transactions, the Group has recognized impairment charges of $325 million

F - 23



for goodwill and $306 million for tangible fixed assets in BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe. As part of a restructuring of the North American Olefins and Derivatives businesses, decisions were taken to exit certain businesses and facilities resulting in impairments and write-downs of $291 million. With the formation of Olefins and Derivatives and its planned divestment, certain agreements and assets have been restructured to reflect the arm's-length relationship that will exist in the future. This has resulted in a $188 million impairment of the facilities at Hull, UK. Other businesses and corporate recognized an impairment charge of $12 million for certain investments.

        The 2003 charge for depreciation and amortization of goodwill and other intangibles includes asset write-downs and impairment charges on exploration and production properties of $738 million. This includes a charge of $296 million for four fields in the Gulf of Mexico following technical reassessment and re-evaluation of future investment options; charges of $133 million and $49 million respectively for the Miller and Viscount fields in the UK North Sea as a result of a decision not to proceed with waterflood and gas import options and a reserve write-down respectively; a charge of $105 million for the Yacheng field in China; a charge of $108 million for the Kepodang field in Indonesia; and $47 million for the Eugene Island/West Cameron fields in the US as a result of reserve write-downs following completion of our routine full technical reviews.

        The charge for depreciation and amortization of goodwill and other intangibles in 2002 includes asset write-downs and impairment charges of $1,390 million in total. Exploration and Production recognized a charge of $1,091 million for the impairment of Shearwater in the North Sea, Rhourde El Baguel in Algeria, LL652 and Boqueron in Venezuela, Pagerungan in Indonesia and Badami in Alaska, following full technical reassessments and evaluations of future investment opportunities. In addition, the business took a $94 million write-off in respect of its Gas-to-Liquids plant in Alaska. Petrochemicals wrote down the value of its Indonesian manufacturing assets by $140 million following a review of immediate prospects and opportunities for future growth in a highly competitive regional market. Gas, Power and Renewables incurred an impairment charge of $30 million in respect of a cogeneration power plant in the UK. Refining and Marketing recognized an impairment charge of $35 million for its retail business in Venezuela.

        In assessing the value in use of potentially impaired assets, a nominal discount rate of 9% before tax has been used. Asset values are determined by deriving the net present value of the future cash flows; the cash flows are adjusted for the risks specific to the asset.

Note 11 — Rental expense under operating leases

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Minimum rentals:              
  Tanker charters   747   440   397  
  Plant and machinery   428   457   621  
  Land and buildings   555   548   342  
   
 
 
 
    1,730   1,445   1,360  
Less: Rentals from sub-leases   (109 ) (128 ) (166 )
   
 
 
 
    1,621   1,317   1,194  
   
 
 
 

F - 24


Note 12 — Research

        Expenditure on research amounted to $439 million (2003 $349 million and 2002 $373 million).

Note 13 — Currency exchange gains and losses

        Accounted net foreign currency exchange gain included in the determination of profit for the year amounted to $41 million (2003 $171 million gain and 2002 $66 million gain).

Note 14 — Taxation

Tax on profit on ordinary activities

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Current tax:              
  UK corporation tax   8,917   11,435   1,304  
  Overseas tax relief   (7,078 ) (10,293 ) (301 )
   
 
 
 
    1,839   1,142   1,003  
  Overseas   5,070   3,525   1,883  
   
 
 
 
  Group   6,909   4,667   2,886  
  Joint ventures   880   158   75  
  Associated undertakings   119   94   187  
   
 
 
 
    7,908   4,919   3,148  
   
 
 
 
Deferred tax:              
  UK   (140 ) 289   390  
  Overseas   340   931   779  
   
 
 
 
  Group   200   1,220   1,169  
  Joint ventures   170   (14 )  
  Associated undertakings   4   (14 )  
   
 
 
 
    374   1,192   1,169  
   
 
 
 
Tax on profit on ordinary activities   8,282   6,111   4,317  
   
 
 
 

        Included in the charge for the year is a credit of $261 million (2003 $123 million charge and 2002 $125 million charge) relating to exceptional items.

F - 25



Tax included in statement of total recognized gains and losses

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Current tax:              
  UK   43     57  
  Overseas   (20 ) (11 ) (54 )
   
 
 
 
    23   (11 ) 3  
   
 
 
 
Deferred tax:              
  UK   165   64   (1,105 )
  Overseas   (76 )   (1,215 )
   
 
 
 
    89   64   (2,320 )
   
 
 
 
Tax included in statement of total recognized gains and losses   112   53   (2,317 )
   
 
 
 

Factors affecting current tax charge

        The following table provides a reconciliation of the UK statutory corporation tax rate to the effective current tax rate of the Group on profit before taxation.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Analysis of profit before taxation:              
  UK   7,671   4,990   2,678  
  Overseas   16,572   11,773   8,511  
   
 
 
 
    24,243   16,763   11,189  
   
 
 
 
Taxation   8,282   6,111   4,317  
   
 
 
 
Effective tax rate   34 % 36 % 39 %
   
 
 
 

 

 

(% of profit before tax)

 

UK statutory corporation tax rate

 

30

 

30

 

30

 
Increase (decrease) resulting from:              
  UK supplementary and overseas taxes at higher rates   8   10   9  
  Tax credits     (1 ) (3 )
  Restructuring benefits   (2 ) (2 )  
  Current year losses unrelieved (prior year losses utilized)   (2 ) (3 ) 1  
  No relief for inventory holding losses (inventory holding gains not taxed)   (2 ) (1 ) (2 )
  Acquisition amortization   3   4   7  
  Other   (1 ) (1 ) (3 )
   
 
 
 
Effective tax rate   34   36   39  
Current year timing differences   (1 ) (6 ) (11 )
   
 
 
 
Effective current tax rate   33   30   28  
   
 
 
 

F - 26


        Current year timing differences arise mainly from the excess of tax depreciation over book depreciation.

        From January 1, 2005, the Group has adopted International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS). As a consequence, there will be a change in the basis of providing deferred taxation in such areas as business combinations and the valuation of inventory, which will lead to changes to certain of the factors described below and may lead to a change in the Group's effective tax rate.

        The Group earns income in many different countries and, on average, pays taxes at rates higher than the UK statutory rate. The overall impact of these higher taxes, which include the supplementary charge of 10% on UK North Sea profits, is subject to changes in enacted tax rates and the country mix of the Group's income. However, it is not expected to increase or decrease substantially in the near term.

        The tax charge in 2002 reflected a benefit from US 'non-conventional fuel credits' which are no longer available after December 31, 2002. The effect of the loss of these credits on the overall tax charge was offset in 2003 by benefits from restructuring and planning initiatives.

        The Group has around $7.7 billion ($4.5 billion) of carry-forward tax losses in the UK and Germany, which would be available to offset against future taxable income. At the end of 2004, no tax assets were recognized on these losses (at the end of 2003, $285 million of assets were recognized). Tax assets are recognized only to the extent that it is considered more likely than not that suitable taxable income will arise. Carry-forward losses in other taxing jurisdictions have not been recognized as deferred tax assets, and are unlikely to have a significant effect on the Group's tax rate in future years.

        The Group's profit before taxation includes inventory holding gains or losses. These gains (or losses) are not taxed (or deductible) in certain jurisdictions in which the Group operates, and therefore give rise to decreases or increases in the effective tax rate. The impact of this item will be reduced under IFRS.

        The impact on the tax rate of acquisition amortization (non-deductible depreciation and amortization relating to the fixed asset revaluation adjustments and goodwill consequent upon the Atlantic Richfield and Burmah Castrol acquisitions) is likely to be eliminated when the Group reports its results under IFRS.

        The major component of timing differences in the current year is accelerated tax depreciation. Based on current capital investment plans, the Group expects to continue to be able to claim tax allowances in excess of depreciation in future years at a level similar to the current year.

F - 27



Deferred tax

 
  At December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Analysis of provision:          
  Depreciation   15,936   15,613  
  Other taxable timing differences   2,090   1,882  
  Petroleum revenue tax   (578 ) (601 )
  Decommissioning and other provisions   (2,142 ) (2,256 )
  Pensions and other postretirement benefits   (1,720 ) (1,652 )
  Tax credit and loss carry forward   (51 ) (105 )
  Other deductible timing differences   (205 ) (162 )
   
 
 
Deferred tax provision   13,330   12,719  
   
 
 
of which — UK   3,932   4,179  
               — Overseas   9,398   8,540  
   
 
 

Analysis of movements during the year:

 

 

 

 

 
  At January 1   12,719   10,894  
  Exchange adjustments   329   541  
  Charge for the year on ordinary activities   200   1,220  
  Charge for the year in the statement of total recognized gains and losses   89   64  
  Deletions/transfers   (7 )  
   
 
 
At December 31   13,330   12,719  
   
 
 
offset against — Pensions   147   172  
                       — Other postretirement benefits   1,573   1,480  
   
 
 
Disclosed as deferred taxation on the balance sheet   15,050   14,371  
   
 
 
 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
The charge for deferred tax on ordinary activities:              
  Origination and reversal of timing differences   200   1,220   814  
  Effect of the introduction of supplementary UK corporation tax of 10% on opening liability       355  
   
 
 
 
    200   1,220   1,169  
   
 
 
 
The charge (credit) for deferred tax in statement of total recognized gains and losses:              
  Origination and reversal of timing differences   89   64   (2,320 )
   
 
 
 

F - 28


Note 15 — Quarterly results of operations (unaudited)

 
  Group
turnover

  Profit before
interest and tax

  Profit
for the
period

  Profit
per
ordinary
share

 
  ($ million)

  (cents)

Year ended December 31, 2004                
First quarter   68,461   6,912   4,818   21.81
Second quarter   70,473   6,368   3,896   17.80
Third quarter   68,515   6,885   4,483   20.67
Fourth quarter   77,610   5,077   2,534   11.80
   
 
 
 
Total   285,059   25,242   15,731   72.08
   
 
 
 
Year ended December 31, 2003                
First quarter   62,031   6,332   4,219   18.90
Second quarter   54,426   3,665   1,585   7.19
Third quarter   58,250   4,113   2,344   10.62
Fourth quarter   57,864   3,844   2,334   10.56
   
 
 
 
Total   232,571   17,954   10,482   47.27
   
 
 
 
Year ended December 31, 2002                
First quarter   36,290   2,369   1,284   5.73
Second quarter   43,655   4,099   2,046   9.12
Third quarter   49,054   3,803   2,828   12.62
Fourth quarter   49,722   2,058   637   2.86
   
 
 
 
Total   178,721   12,329   6,795   30.33
   
 
 
 

Note 16 — Dividends per ordinary share

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

  2004

  2003

  2002

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (pence per share)

  (cents per share)

  ($ million)

First quarterly   3.807   3.947   4.051   6.75   6.25   5.75   1,483   1,386   1,290
Second quarterly   3.860   4.039   3.875   7.10   6.50   6.00   1,535   1,433   1,346
Third quarterly   3.910   3.857   3.897   7.10   6.50   6.00   1,530   1,438   1,340
Fourth quarterly   4.522   3.674   3.815   8.50   6.75   6.25   1,821   1,494   1,397
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    16.099   15.517   15.638   29.45   26.00   24.00   6,369   5,751   5,373
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

F - 29


Note 17 — Profit per ordinary share

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (cents per share)

Basic earnings per share   72.08   47.27   30.33
Diluted earnings per share   70.79   46.83   30.19

        The calculation of basic earnings per ordinary share is based on the profit attributable to ordinary shareholders, i.e., profit for the year less preference dividends, related to the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year. The profit attributable to ordinary shareholders is $15,729 million (2003 $10,480 million and 2002 $6,793 million). The average number of shares outstanding excludes the shares held by the Employee Share Ownership Plans.

        The calculation of diluted earnings per share is based on profit attributable to ordinary shareholders, adjusted for the unwinding of the discount on the deferred consideration for the acquisition of our interest in TNK-BP, of $15,793 million (2003 $10,504 million and 2002 $6,793 million). The number of shares outstanding is adjusted to show the potential dilution if employee share options are converted into ordinary shares, and for the ordinary shares issuable, in two further annual tranches, in respect of the TNK-BP joint venture. The number of ordinary shares outstanding for basic and diluted earnings per share may be reconciled as follows:

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (shares thousand)

Weighted average number of ordinary shares   21,820,535   22,170,741   22,397,126
Potential dilutive effect of ordinary shares issuable under employee share schemes   74,775   71,651   107,322
Potential dilutive effect of ordinary shares issuable as consideration for BP's interest in the TNK-BP joint venture   415,016   186,980  
   
 
 
    22,310,326   22,429,372   22,504,448
   
 
 

Note 18 — Operating lease commitments

        Annual commitments under operating leases were as follows:

 
  December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  Land and
buildings

  Other

  Land and
buildings

  Other

 
  ($ million)

Expiring within: 1 year   79   359   70   186
                           2 to 5 years   180   261   173   388
                           Thereafter   268   387   262   291
   
 
 
 
    527   1,007   505   865
   
 
 
 

F - 30


        The minimum future lease payments (after deducting related rental income from operating sub-leases of $496 million) were as follows:

 
  December 31, 2004

 
  ($ million)

2005   1,483
2006   1,106
2007   944
2008   858
2009   754
Thereafter   3,209
   
    8,354
   

Note 19 — Acquisitions

 
  Year ended December 31, 2004

 
 
  Book value on
acquisitions

  Fair value
adjustments

  Fair value

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Intangible fixed assets   15     15  
Tangible fixed assets   703   636   1,339  
Current assets (excluding cash)   721     721  
Cash at bank and in hand   36     36  
Other creditors   (329 )   (329 )
Pension liability   (3 )   (3 )
Net investment in equity-accounted entities transferred to full consolidation   (547 ) (94 ) (641 )
   
 
 
 
Net assets acquired   596   542   1,138  
   
 
     
Negative goodwill           (61 )
Goodwill           328  
           
 
Consideration           1,405  
           
 

Acquisitions in 2004

        On November 2, 2004, Solvay exercised its option to sell its interests in BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe and BP Solvay Polyethylene North America to BP. Solvay held 50% of BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe and 51% of BP Solvay Polyethylene North America. On completion, the two entities, which manufacture and market high-density polyethylene, became wholly owned subsidiaries of BP. The total consideration for the acquisition was $1,391 million. The consideration is subject to final closing adjustments. Other minor acquisitions were made for a total consideration of $14 million. All business combinations have been accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. The fair value of the

F - 31



tangible fixed assets has been estimated by determining the net present value of future cash flows. No significant adjustments were made to the other assets and liabilities acquired. The assets and liabilities acquired as part of the 2004 acquisitions are shown in aggregate in the table above.

        During the year, BP China and Sinopec announced the establishment of the BP-Sinopec (Zhejiang) Petroleum Co. Ltd, a retail joint venture between BP and Sinopec. Based on the existing service station network of Sinopec, the new joint venture will build, operate and manage a network of 500 service stations in Hangzhou, Ningbo and Shaoxing. Also during the year, BP China and PetroChina announced the establishment of BP-PetroChina Petroleum Company Limited. Located in Guangdong, one of the most developed provinces in China, the joint venture will acquire, build, operate and manage 500 service stations in the province. The initial investment in both joint ventures amounted to $106 million.

Acquisitions in 2003

        BP made a number of minor acquisitions in 2003 for a total consideration of $82 million. All these business combinations were accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. No significant fair value adjustments were made to the acquired assets and liabilities. Goodwill of $5 million arose on these acquisitions. In addition the Group redeemed the outstanding stock in CH-Twenty, Inc., a subsidiary undertaking, for $150 million.

TNK-BP

        On August 29, 2003 BP and the Alfa Group and Access-Renova (AAR) combined certain of their Russian and Ukranian oil and gas businesses to create TNK-BP, a new company owned and managed 50:50 by BP and AAR. TNK-BP is a joint venture and accounted for under the gross equity method. BP contributed its 29% interest in Sidanco, its 29% interest in Rusia Petroleum and its holding in the BP Moscow retail network. There was additional consideration from BP to AAR comprising an immediate $2,604 million in cash (which was subsequently reduced by receipt of pre-acquisition dividends net of other adjustments, of $298 million) together with annual tranches of $1,250 million in BP shares payable in 2004, 2005 and 2006. There were costs of $45 million in connection with the transaction. The first tranche was issued in September 2004. BP also agreed with AAR to incorporate AAR's 50% interest in Slavneft into TNK-BP in return for $1,418 million in cash (which was subsequently reduced by receipt of pre-acquisition dividends of $64 million to $1,354 million). This transaction was completed on January 16, 2004.

Acquisitions in 2002

        During the year BP acquired the whole of Veba Oil (Veba) from E.ON in two stages. Veba owns Aral, Germany's biggest fuels retailer. In February BP paid $1,072 million to subscribe for new shares issued by Veba and acquired $1,520 million of outstanding loans from E.ON to Veba in return for a 51% interest in and operational control of Veba. In addition, there were acquisition expenses of $30 million. Subsequently, on June 30, BP paid E.ON a further $2,386 million to acquire the remaining 49% of Veba. There were further acquisition expenses of $30 million. The total consideration of $5,038 million was subject to final closing adjustments. As well as a refining and marketing business, Veba also had an exploration and production business. With the exception of the Cerro Negro field in Venezuela, the

F - 32



whole of these activities was sold in May 2002, mainly to Petro-Canada. These activities represent the Businesses held for resale in the table set out below.

        Other transactions in 2002 included buying our co-venturers' 15% interest in the Atlantic Richfield polypropylene joint venture and acquiring the 51% BP did not own in certain Chinese LPG ventures. All these business combinations have been accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. The assets and liabilities acquired as part of the 2002 acquisitions are shown in aggregate in the table below. The identifiable assets and liabilities of Veba were not revalued on the acquisition of the 49% minority interest in June, as the difference between the fair values and the carrying amounts of the assets and liabilities was not material. Additional goodwill of $203 million was originally recognized on the acquisition of the minority interest in Veba. This has been reduced to $61 million following the revisions to the fair values described below.

        The fair values of the assets and liabilities of Veba included in the accounts for the year ended December 31, 2002 have been subject to further investigation and review during 2003, as permitted by Financial Reporting Standard No. 7 'Fair Values in Acquisition Accounting'. The revisions to the previously reported fair values are as set out below.

 
  Fair value
as previously
reported

  Revisions

  Final
fair value

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Intangible fixed assets        
Tangible fixed assets   4,945   (76 ) 4,869  
Fixed assets — Investments   122     122  
Businesses held for resale   1,369     1,369  
Current assets (excluding cash)   3,031     3,031  
Cash at bank and in hand   1,118     1,118  
Finance debt   (1,002 )   (1,002 )
Other creditors   (3,394 ) 365   (3,029 )
Deferred taxation   (6 )   (6 )
Other provisions   (1,107 )   (1,107 )
Net investment in equity-accounted entities transferred to full consolidation   (191 )   (191 )
   
 
 
 
Net assets acquired   4,885   289   5,174  
Minority interests   (2,201 ) (142 ) (2,343 )
Goodwill   342   (147 ) 195  
   
 
 
 
Consideration   3,026     3,026  
   
 
 
 

Note 20 — Disposals

        As part of the strategy to upgrade the quality of its asset portfolio, the Group has an active programme to dispose of non-strategic assets. In the normal course of business in any particular year, the Group may sell interests in exploration and production properties, service stations and pipeline

F - 33



interests as well as non-core businesses. Disposal proceeds also include monies received from the repayment of loans.

        Cash received during the year from disposals amounted to $5.0 billion (2003 $6.4 billion and 2002 $6.8 billion). The major transactions in 2004 which generated over $2.3 billion of proceeds were the sale of the Group's investments in PetroChina and Sinopec.

        For 2003, the major disposals representing over $3.0 billion of the proceeds were the divestment of a further 20% interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC; the sale of 50% of our interest in the In Amenas gas condensate project and 49% of our interest in the In Salah gas development in Algeria; and the sale of the UK North Sea Forties oil field, together with a package of 61 shallow-water assets in the Gulf of Mexico. The major asset transactions during 2002, generating proceeds of over $4.7 billion included the sale of the Group's shareholding in Ruhrgas, the sale of the Veba exploration and production operations and the divestment of certain US downstream assets. The principal transactions generating the proceeds for each segment are described below.

        Exploration and Production $921 million (2003 $4,867 million and 2002 $794 million). The Group divested interests in a number of oil and natural gas properties in all three years. During 2004, in the US we sold 45% of our interest in King's Peak in the deepwater Gulf of Mexico to Marubeni Oil & Gas; divested our interest in Swordfish; and additionally, we sold various properties including our interest in the South Pass 60 property in the Gulf of Mexico Shelf. In Canada, BP sold various assets in Alberta to Fairborne Energy. In Indonesia, we disposed of our interest in the Kangean Production Sharing Contract and our participating interest in the Muriah Production Sharing Contract. In 2003, the UK North Sea Forties oil field, together with a package of 61 shallow-water assets in the Gulf of Mexico, were sold to Apache. A 12.5% interest in the Tangguh liquefied natural gas project in Indonesia was sold to CNOOC. Interests in 14 UK Southern North Sea gas fields, together with associated pipelines and onshore processing facilities, including the Bacton terminal, were sold to Perenco. BP sold 50% of its interest in the In Amenas gas condensate project and 49% of its interest in the In Salah gas development in Algeria to Statoil. In January 2003, Repsol exercised its option to acquire a further 20% interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC. BP's interest in the company is now 70%. In February 2003, BP called its $420 million Exchangeable Bonds which were exchangeable for Lukoil American Depositary Shares (ADSs). Bondholders converted to ADSs before the redemption date. During 2002, the Group sold a number of minor oil and natural gas properties and completed the divestment of the Group's interest in the Kashagan discovery in Kazakhstan.

        Refining and Marketing $906 million (2003 $1,053 million and 2002 $1,580 million). The churn of retail assets represents a significant element of the total in all three years. In addition, for 2004, major asset transactions included the sale of the Singapore refinery, and the Cushing and other pipeline interests in the US. As a condition of the approval of the acquisition of Veba in 2002, BP was, amongst other things, required to divest approximately 4% of its retail market share in Germany and a significant portion of its Bayermoil refining interests. The sale of 494 retail sites in the northern and northeastern part of Germany to PKN Orlen and the sale of retail and refinery assets in Germany and Central Europe to OMV in 2003 completed the divestments required. In addition, for 2002, the major transactions were the sale of a US downstream electronic payment system, the Group's interest in the Colonial pipeline in the USA, the refinery at Yorktown, Virginia and the downstream retail business in Cyprus.

F - 34



        Petrochemicals $717 million (2003 $236 million and 2002 $207 million). In 2004, these related principally to the sale of the speciality intermediate chemicals and Fabrics and Fibres businesses. For 2003, the proceeds related mainly to the completion of the divestment of the former Burmah Castrol speciality chemicals business Sericol and Fosroc Mining. In 2002, the Group sold its plastic fabrication business. In addition BP sold two-thirds of its interest in the European ethylene pipeline company, ARG, in accordance with EU Commission requirements in relation to the Veba acquisition.

        Gas, Power and Renewables $144 million (2003 $67 million and 2002 $2,551 million). In 2004, the Group sold its interest in two Canadian natural gas liquids plants. In 2003, the Group entered into a sale and leaseback transaction for NGL railcars and received certain loan repayments. For 2002 in addition to the sale of the Group's interest in Ruhrgas, proceeds were received from the sale and leaseback of a solar manufacturing facility in Spain and an LNG tanker.

        Other businesses and corporate $2,360 million (2003 $209 million and 2002 $1,650 million). The disposal of the Group's investments in PetroChina and Sinopec were the major transactions in 2004. In 2003, the Group sold its 50% interest in PT Kaltim Prima Coal, an Indonesian company. For 2002, the principal transaction was the sale in May of the Veba exploration and production operations acquired earlier in the year.

F - 35



        Total proceeds received for disposals represent the following amounts shown in the cash flow statement:

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Proceeds from the sale of businesses   725   179   1,974
Proceeds from the sale of fixed assets   4,323   6,253   2,470
Proceeds from the sale of investment in Ruhrgas       2,338
   
 
 
    5,048   6,432   6,782
   
 
 
 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
The disposals comprise the following:

  ($ million)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Intangible assets   215   322   205  
Tangible assets (a)   2,549   6,212   2,545  
Fixed asset — Investments   1,197   890   1,769  
Net assets of businesses held for resale       1,369  
Finance debt     (420 ) (1,135 )
Current assets less current liabilities   417   (498 ) 533  
Other provisions   (105 ) (971 ) (109 )
   
 
 
 
    4,273   5,535   5,177  

Profit (loss) on sale of businesses or termination of operations

 

(695

)

(28

)

(33

)
Profit (loss) on sale of fixed assets   1,510   859   1,199  
   
 
 
 
Total consideration   5,088   6,366   6,343  
Decrease (increase) in amounts receivable from disposals   (40 ) 66   439  
   
 
 
 
Net cash inflow   5,048   6,432   6,782  
   
 
 
 

(a)
2003 includes provision for loss on disposal of $275 million (2002 $1,204 million).

F - 36


 
  Goodwill

  Negative goodwill

  Total goodwill

  Exploration
expenditure

  Other
intangibles

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Cost                          
At January 1, 2004   14,384     14,384   4,977   833   20,194  
Exchange adjustments   451     451   41   57   549  
Acquisitions   328   (61 ) 267     15   282  
Additions         754   246   1,000  
Transfers         (1,036 )   (1,036 )
Deletions   (96 )   (96 ) (425 )   (521 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31, 2004   15,067   (61 ) 15,006   4,311   1,151   20,468  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation                          
At January 1, 2004   5,215     5,215   741   596   6,552  
Exchange adjustments   194     194   1   40   235  
Charge for the year   1,761     1,761   274   72   2,107  
Transfers         (196 )   (196 )
Deletions   (36 )   (36 ) (270 )   (306 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31, 2004   7,134     7,134   550   708   8,392  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net book amount                          
At December 31, 2004   7,933   (61 ) 7,872   3,761   443   12,076  
At December 31, 2003   9,169     9,169   4,236   237   13,642  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 

F - 37


Note 22 — Tangible assets

        Property, plant and equipment:

 
  Land

  Buildings

  Oil and
gas
properties

  Plant,
machinery
and
equipment

  Fixtures
fittings and
office
equipment

  Transport-
ation

  Oil depots
storage
tanks and
service
stations

  Total

  Of which:
Assets
under
construction

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Cost                                      
At January 1, 2004   4,442   3,745   96,991   46,413   3,482   11,738   8,969   175,780   13,957  
Exchange adjustments   493   71   1,641   2,461   37   182   718   5,603   158  
Acquisitions   10       1,329         1,339    
Additions   308   121   8,048   2,201   513   852   861   12,904   10,084  
Transfers       1,036           1,036   (8,879 )
Deletions   (123 ) (415 ) (3,749 ) (2,770 ) (314 ) (365 ) (688 ) (8,424 ) (282 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31, 2004   5,130   3,522   103,967   49,634   3,718   12,407   9,860   188,238   15,038  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Depreciation

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
At January 1, 2004   702   1,351   50,028   19,590   1,793   6,324   4,081   83,869      
Exchange adjustments   90   9   948   1,064   3   83   365   2,562      
Charge for the year   50   116   5,871   3,182   334   278   907   10,738      
Transfers       196           196      
Deletions   (89 ) (285 ) (3,031 ) (1,539 ) (370 ) (202 ) (359 ) (5,875 )    
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
At December 31, 2004   753   1,191   54,012   22,297   1,760   6,483   4,994   91,490      
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     

Net book amount

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
At December 31, 2004   4,377   2,331   49,955   27,337   1,958   5,924   4,866   96,748   15,038  
At December 31, 2003   3,740   2,394   46,963   26,823   1,689   5,414   4,888   91,911   13,957  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

F - 38


Assets held under capital leases, capitalized interest, decommissioning assets and land at net book amount included above:

 
  Leased assets

  Capitalized interest

 
  Cost

  Depreciation

  Net

  Cost

  Depreciation

  Net

 
  ($ million)

  ($ million)

At December 31, 2004   2,831   1,127   1,704   3,881   2,547   1,334
At December 31, 2003   2,737   955   1,782   3,281   2,127   1,154
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Decommissioning asset

 
  Cost

  Depreciation

  Net

 
  ($ million)

At December 31, 2004   4,425   1,908   2,517
At December 31, 2003   3,686   1,606   2,080
   
 
 
 
   
  Leasehold land

 
  Freehold land

  Over 50 years
unexpired

  Other

 
  ($ million)

At December 31, 2004   4,177   116   84
At December 31, 2003   3,466   71   203
   
 
 

F - 39


Note 23 — Fixed assets — investments

 
  Joint ventures

  Associated
undertakings

   
   
   
   
 
 
  Net assets
(liabilities)

  Loans

  Net assets
(liabilities)

  Loans

  Other
Loans

  Listed
investments (a)

  Other (b)

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Cost                                  
At January 1, 2004   9,789   1,220   3,992   1,076   129   1,284   179   17,669  
Exchange adjustments   18     44   9   1   20   6   98  
Additions and net movements in joint ventures and associated undertakings   494   (155 ) 117   682         1,138  
Acquisitions   1,472               1,472  
Transfers   (387 )   20   (180 )       (547 )
Deletions       (73 ) (57 ) (55 ) (1,041 ) (28 ) (1,254 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31, 2004   11,386   1,065   4,100   1,530   75   263   157   18,576  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amounts provided                                  
At January 1, 2004       21   177   2     11   211  
Exchange adjustments       1         3   4  
Provided in the year               12   12  
Transfers                  
Deletions         (57 )       (57 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31, 2004       22   120   2     26   170  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net book amount                                  
At December 31, 2004   11,386   1,065   4,078   1,410   73   263   131   18,406  
At December 31, 2003   9,789   1,220   3,971   899   127   1,284   168   17,458  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

(a)
The market value of listed investments at December 31, 2004 was $543 million ($3,212 million at December 31, 2003).

(b)
Other investments are not publicly traded.

F - 40


 
  At December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  ($ million)

Petroleum   9,612   6,623
Chemicals   1,771   1,165
Other   474   961
   
 
    11,857   8,749
Stores   925   938
   
 
    12,782   9,687
Trading stocks   2,916   1,930
   
 
    15,698   11,617
   
 
Replacement cost   15,765   11,717
   
 

Note 25 — Receivables

 
  December 31, 2004

  December 31, 2003

 
  Within
1 year

  After
1 year (a)

  Within
1 year

  After
1 year (a)

 
  ($ million)

Trade receivables   31,223     23,487  
   
 
 
 
Other receivables:                
  Joint ventures   14     44  
  Associated undertakings   210   23   337   53
  Prepayments and accrued income   7,188   1,874   3,445   2,023
  Taxation recoverable   157   2   78   14
  Other   5,603   402   3,993   428
   
 
 
 
    13,172   2,301   7,897   2,518
   
 
 
 

        Provisions for doubtful debts deducted from Trade receivables amounted to $526 million ($441 million at December 31, 2003).


(a)
See Note 50 — US generally accepted accounting principles.

F - 41


Note 26 — Current assets — investments

 
  At December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  ($ million)

Publicly traded — UK   21   42
— Foreign   42   37
   
 
    63   79
Not publicly traded   265   106
   
 
    328   185
   
 
Stock exchange value of publicly traded investments   63   79
   
 

F - 42


Note 27 — Financial instruments

        Financial instruments comprise primary financial instruments (cash, fixed and current asset investments, receivables, payables, finance debt and provisions) and derivative financial instruments (interest rate contracts, foreign exchange contracts, oil price contracts and natural gas price contracts and power price contracts). Interest rate contracts include futures contracts, swap agreements and options. Foreign exchange contracts include forwards, futures contracts, swap agreements and options. Oil, natural gas and power price contracts are those that require settlement in cash and include futures contracts, swap agreements and options. Oil, natural gas and power price contracts that require physical delivery are not financial instruments. However, if it is normal market practice for a particular type of oil, natural gas and power contract, despite having contract terms that require settlement by delivery, to be extinguished other than by physical delivery (e.g., by cash payment) it is called a cash-settled commodity contract. Contracts of this type are included with derivatives in the disclosures in Notes 28 and 29.

        With the exception of the table of currency exposures shown on page F-46, short-term receivables and payables that arise directly from the Group's operations have been excluded from the disclosures contained in this note, as permitted by Financial Reporting Standard No. 13 'Derivatives and Other Financial Instruments: Disclosures'.

Concentrations of credit risk

        The primary activities of the Group are oil and natural gas exploration and production, gas and power marketing and trading, oil refining and marketing and the manufacture and marketing of chemicals. The Group's principal customers, suppliers and financial institutions with which it conducts business are located throughout the world. The credit ratings of interest rate and currency swap counterparties are all of at least investment grade. The credit quality is actively managed over the life of the swap.

Maturity profile of financial liabilities

        The profile of the maturity of the financial liabilities included in the Group's balance sheet is shown in the table below.

 
   
  December 31, 2004

  December 31, 2003

 
   
  Finance
debt

  Other
financial
liabilities

  Total

  Finance
debt

  Other
financial
liabilities

  Total

 
   
  ($ million)

Due within:   1 year   10,184     10,184   9,456     9,456
    1 to 2 years   3,046   2,049   5,095   2,702   2,087   4,789
    2 to 5 years   6,105   744   6,849   5,105   1,834   6,939
    Thereafter   3,756   1,577   5,333   5,062   1,990   7,052
       
 
 
 
 
 
        23,091   4,370   27,461   22,325   5,911   28,236
       
 
 
 
 
 

F - 43


Interest rate and currency of financial liabilities

        The interest rate and currency profile of the financial liabilities of the Group, at December 31, after taking into account the effect of interest rate swaps, currency swaps and forward contracts, is set out below.

 
  Fixed rate

  Floating rate

   
   
   
 
  Interest free

   
 
  Weighted
average
interest rate

   
   
  Weighted
average
interest rate

   
   
 
  Weighted
average time for which rate is fixed

  Amount

  Amount

  Weighted
average time until maturity

  Amount

  Total

 
  (%)

  (Years)

  ($ million)

  (%)

  ($ million)

  (Years)

  ($ million)

  ($ million)

At December 31, 2004                                
Finance debt                                
  US dollar   7   11   707   3   21,789       22,496
  Sterling         5   96       96
  Other currencies   9   15   167   4   332       499
           
     
     
 
            874       22,217         23,091
           
     
     
 
Other financial liabilities                                
  US dollar   3   2   1,522   5   573   5   1,847   3,942
  Sterling             4   193   193
  Other currencies   4   4   15   2   46   4   174   235
           
     
     
 
            1,537       619       2,214   4,370
           
     
     
 
Total           2,411       22,836       2,214   27,461
           
     
     
 
At December 31, 2003                                
Finance debt                                
  US dollar   8   14   578   2   20,991       21,569
  Sterling         4   107       107
  Other currencies   9   15   141   3   508       649
           
     
     
 
            719       21,606         22,325
           
     
     
 
Other financial liabilities                                
  US dollar   3   3   2,899   5   242   4   1,817   4,958
  Sterling             5   267   267
  Other currencies   5   4   303       6   383   686
           
     
     
 
            3,202       242       2,467   5,911
           
     
     
 
  Total           3,921       21,848       2,467   28,236
           
     
     
 

F - 44


 
  December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  ($ million)

Analysis of the above financial liabilities by balance sheet caption:        
Current liabilities — falling due within one year        
— Finance debt   10,184   9,456
Noncurrent liabilities        
— Finance debt   12,907   12,869
— Accounts payable and accrued liabilities   2,978   4,480
Provisions for liabilities and charges        
— Other   1,392   1,431
   
 
    27,461   28,236
   
 

        The other financial liabilities comprise various accruals, sundry creditors and provisions relating to the Group's normal commercial operations, with payment dates spread over a number of years.

        The proportion of floating rate debt at December 31, 2004 was 96% of total finance debt outstanding. Aside from debt issued in the US municipal bond markets, interest rates on floating rate debt denominated in US dollars are linked principally to London Inter-Bank Offer Rate (LIBOR), while rates on debt in other currencies are based on local market equivalents. The Group monitors interest rate risk using a process of sensitivity analysis. Assuming no changes to the finance debt and hedges described above, it is estimated that a change of 1% in the general level of interest rates on January 1, 2005 would change 2005 profit before tax by approximately $215 million.

        Interest rate swaps and futures are used by the Group to modify the interest characteristics of its long-term finance debt from a fixed to a floating rate basis or vice versa. The following table indicates the types of instruments used and their weighted average interest rates as at December 31.

 
  December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($ million except percentages)

 
Receive fixed rate swaps — notional amount   8,182   7,432  
Average receive fixed rate   3.1 % 3.1 %
Average pay floating rate   2.3 % 1.1 %

F - 45


Currency exchange rate risk

        The monetary assets and monetary liabilities of the Group in currencies other than in the functional currency of individual operating units are summarized below. These currency exposures arise from normal trading activities.

 
  Net foreign currency monetary assets (liabilities)

 
 
  US dollar

  Sterling

  Euro

  Other

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

 
At December 31, 2004                      
US dollar     374   2   (942 ) (566 )
Sterling   314     380   66   760  
Other   (269 ) (51 ) (25 ) (237 ) (582 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
    45   323   357   (1,113 ) (388 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31, 2003                      
US dollar     191   (24 ) 39   206  
Sterling   67     308   34   409  
Other   (1,148 ) (25 ) (27 ) (131 ) (1,331 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
    (1,081 ) 166   257   (58 ) (716 )
   
 
 
 
 
 

        In accordance with its policy for managing its foreign exchange rate risk, the Group enters into various types of foreign exchange contracts, such as currency swaps, forwards and options. The fair values and carrying amounts of these derivatives are shown in the fair value table in Note 29.

F - 46



Interest rate and currency of financial assets

        The following table shows the interest rate and currency profile of the Group's material financial assets.

 
  Fixed rate

  Floating rate

  Interest free

   
 
  Weighted
average
interest
rate

  Weighted
average
time
for which
rate is
fixed

  Amount

  Weighted
average
interest
rate

  Amount

  Weighted
average
time
until
maturity

  Amount

  Total

 
  (%)

  (Years)

  ($ million)

  (%)

  ($ million)

  (Years)

  ($ million)

  ($ million)

At December 31, 2004                                
US dollar   10   11   72   4   186   5   252   510
Sterling   8   2   101   2   292   3   242   635
Other currencies         2   510   1   695   1,205
           
     
     
 
            173       988       1,189   2,350
           
     
     
 
At December 31, 2003                                
US dollar         2   656   2   154   810
Sterling   8   2   91   3   907   2   257   1,255
Other currencies   3   2   19   1   189   1   1,866   2,074
           
     
     
 
            110       1,752       2,277   4,139
           
     
     
 
 
  December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  ($ million)

Analysis of the above financial assets by balance sheet caption:        
Fixed assets — Investments   464   1,579
Current assets        
— Receivables — amounts falling due after more than one year   402   428
— Investments   328   185
— Cash at bank and in hand   1,156   1,947
   
 
    2,350   4,139
   
 

        The floating rate financial assets earn interest at various rates set principally with respect to LIBOR or the local market equivalent.

        Fixed asset investments included in the table above are held for the long term and have no maturity period. They are excluded from the calculation of weighted average time until maturity.

F - 47



Note 28 — Derivative financial instruments

        In the normal course of business the Group is a party to derivative financial instruments (derivatives) with off balance sheet risk, primarily to manage its exposure to fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates, including management of the balance between floating rate and fixed rate debt. The Group also manages certain of its exposures to movements in oil, natural gas and power prices. In addition, the Group trades derivatives in conjunction with these risk management activities.

Risk management

        Gains and losses on derivatives used for risk management purposes are deferred and recognized in earnings or as adjustments to carrying amounts, as appropriate, when the underlying debt matures or the hedged transaction occurs. When an anticipated transaction is no longer likely to occur or finance debt is terminated before maturity, any deferred gain or loss that has arisen on the related derivative is recognized in the income statement, together with any gain or loss on the terminated item. Where such derivatives used for hedging purposes are terminated before the underlying debt matures or the hedged transaction occurs, the resulting gain or loss is recognized on a basis which matches the timing and accounting treatment of the underlying hedged item. The unrecognized and carried-forward gains and losses on derivatives used for hedging, and the movements therein, are shown in the following table.

 
  Not recognized
in the accounts

  Carried forward in the
balance sheet

 
  Gains

  Losses

  Total

  Gains

  Losses

  Total

 
  ($ million)

Gains and losses at January 1, 2004   331   (130 ) 201   1,003   (425 ) 578
  of which accounted for in income in 2004   98   (28 ) 70   438   (75 ) 363
Gains and losses at December 31, 2004   487   (408 ) 79   1,063   (364 ) 699
  of which expected to be recognized in income in 2005   259   (267 ) (8 ) 265   (77 ) 188

Gains and losses at January 1, 2003

 

526

 

(450

)

76

 

352

 

(28

)

324
  of which accounted for in income in 2003   96   (51 ) 45   200   (14 ) 186
Gains and losses at December 31, 2003   331   (130 ) 201   1,003   (425 ) 578
  of which expected to be recognized in income in 2004   98   (28 ) 70   438   (75 ) 363

Trading activities

        The Group maintains active trading positions in a variety of derivatives. This activity is undertaken in conjunction with risk management activities. Derivatives held for trading purposes are marked-to-market and any gain or loss recognized in the income statement. For traded derivatives, many positions have been neutralized, with trading initiatives being concluded by taking opposite positions to fix a gain or loss, thereby achieving a zero net market risk.

F - 48



        The following table shows the fair value at December 31, of derivatives and other financial instruments held for trading purposes. The fair values at the year end are not materially unrepresentative of the position throughout the year.

 
  December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  Fair value
asset

  Fair value
liability

  Fair value
asset

  Fair value
liability

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Interest rate contracts          
Foreign exchange contracts   36   (90 ) 30   (54 )
Oil price contracts   1,162   (1,177 ) 586   (667 )
Natural gas price contracts   802   (624 ) 858   (711 )
Power price contracts   82   (12 ) 548   (514 )
   
 
 
 
 
    2,082   (1,903 ) 2,022   (1,946 )
   
 
 
 
 

        The Group measures its market risk exposure, i.e. potential gain or loss in fair values, on its trading activity using value-at-risk techniques. These techniques are based on a variance/covariance model or a Monte Carlo simulation and make a statistical assessment of the market risk arising from possible future changes in market values over a 24-hour period. The calculation of the range of potential changes in fair value takes into account a snapshot of the end-of-day exposures, and the history of one-day price movements over the previous 12 months, together with the correlation of these price movements. The potential movement in fair values is expressed to three standard deviations which is equivalent to a 99.7% confidence level. This means that, in broad terms, one would expect to see an increase or a decrease in fair values greater than the value at risk on only one occasion per year if the portfolio were left unchanged.

        The Group calculates value at risk on all instruments that are held for trading purposes and that therefore give an exposure to market risk. The value-at-risk model takes account of derivative financial instruments such as interest rate forward and futures contracts, swap agreements, options and swaptions; foreign exchange forward and futures contracts, swap agreements and options; and oil, natural gas and power price futures, swap agreements and options. Financial assets and liabilities and physical crude oil and refined products that are treated as trading positions are also included in these calculations. The value-at-risk calculation for oil, natural gas and power price exposure also includes cash-settled commodity contracts such as forward contracts.

F - 49



        The following table shows values at risk for trading activities.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  High

  Low

  Average

  Year end

  High

  Low

  Average

  Year end

 
  ($ million)

Interest rate trading   1         1      
Foreign exchange trading   4   1   1   1   4     2   1
Oil price trading   55   18   29   45   34   17   26   27
Natural gas price trading   23   6   13   10   29   4   16   18
Power price trading   10   1   4   4   13     4   6

        The presentation of trading results shown in the table below includes certain activities of BP's trading units which involves the use of derivative financial instruments in conjunction with physical and paper trading of oil, natural gas and power. It is considered that a more comprehensive representation of the Group's oil, natural gas and power price trading activities is given by aggregating the gain or loss on such derivatives together with the gain or loss arising from the physical and paper trades to which they relate, representing the net result of the trading portfolio.

 
  Years ended
December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  Net gain
(loss)

  Net gain
(loss)

 
  ($ million)

Interest rate trading   4   9
Foreign exchange trading   136   118
Oil price trading   1,371   825
Natural gas price trading   461   341
Power price trading   160   119
   
 
    2,132   1,412
   
 

Note 29 — Fair values of financial assets and liabilities

        The estimated fair value of the Group's financial instruments is shown in the table below. The table also shows the 'net carrying amount' of the financial asset or liability. This amount represents the net book value, i.e. market value when acquired or later marked-to-market. Interest rate contracts include futures contracts, swap agreements and options. Foreign exchange contracts include forward and futures contracts, swap agreements and options. Oil, natural gas and power price contracts include futures contracts, swap agreements and options and cash-settled commodity contracts such as forward contracts.

        Short-term receivables and payables that arise directly from the Group's operations have been excluded from the disclosures contained in this note, as permitted by Financial Reporting Standard No. 13 'Derivatives and Other Financial Instruments: Disclosures'.

F - 50



        The fair value and carrying amounts of finance debt shown below exclude the effects of currency swaps, interest rate swaps and forward contracts (which are included for presentation in the balance sheet). Long-term borrowings in the table below include debt that matures in the year from December 31, 2004, whereas in the balance sheet long-term debt of current maturity is reported under amounts falling due within one year. Long-term borrowings also include US Industrial Revenue/Municipal Bonds classified on the balance sheet as repayable within one year.

 
   
  December 31,

 
 
   
  2004

  2003

 
 
   
  Net fair
value asset
(liability)

  Net carrying
amount asset
(liability)

  Net fair
value asset
(liability)

  Net carrying
amount asset
(liability)

 
 
   
  ($ million)

 
Primary financial instruments                  
Fixed assets — Investments   748   464   3,507   1,579  
Current assets                      
— Other receivables — amounts falling due after more than one year   402   402   428   428  
— Investments   328   328   185   185  
— Cash at bank and in hand   1,156   1,156   1,947   1,947  
Finance debt                      
— Short-term borrowings   (5,003 ) (5,003 ) (5,059 ) (5,059 )
— Long-term borrowings   (16,800 ) (16,344 ) (16,190 ) (15,559 )
— Net obligations under capital leases   (2,608 ) (2,579 ) (2,479 ) (2,452 )
Noncurrent liabilities                  
— Accounts payable and accrued liabilities   (2,978 ) (2,978 ) (4,480 ) (4,480 )
Provisions for liabilities and charges                  
— Other   (1,392 ) (1,392 ) (1,431 ) (1,431 )
Derivative financial or commodity instruments                  
Risk management   — interest rate contracts   (73 )   5    
    — foreign exchange contracts   1,084   835   941   745  
    — oil price contracts   7   7   (5 ) (5 )
    — natural gas price contracts.   35   35   (5 ) (5 )
    — power price contracts       (10 ) (10 )
Trading   — interest rate contracts          
    — foreign exchange contracts   (54 ) (54 ) (24 ) (24 )
    — oil price contracts   (15 ) (15 ) (81 ) (81 )
    — natural gas price contracts.   178   178   147   147  
    — power price contracts   70   70   34   34  

F - 51


        The following methods and assumptions were used by the Group in estimating its fair value disclosures for its financial instruments:

        Fixed assets — Investments. The carrying amount reported in the balance sheet for unlisted fixed asset investments approximates their fair value. The fair value of listed fixed asset investments has been determined by reference to market prices.

        Current assets — Other receivables — amounts falling due after more than one year. The fair value of other receivables due after one year is estimated not to be materially different from its carrying value.

        Current assets — Investments and Cash at bank and in hand. The carrying amount reported in the balance sheet for unlisted current asset investments and cash at bank and in hand approximates their fair value. The fair value of listed current asset investments has been determined by reference to market prices.

        Finance debt. The carrying amount of the Group's short-term borrowings, which mainly comprise commercial paper, bank loans and overdrafts, approximates their fair value. The fair value of the Group's long-term borrowings and capital lease obligations is estimated using quoted prices or, where these are not available, discounted cash flow analyses, based on the Group's current incremental borrowing rates for similar types and maturities of borrowing.

        Noncurrent liabilities — Accounts payable and accrued liabilities. Deferred consideration for the acquisition of our interest in TNK-BP is discounted to the present value of the future payments. The carrying value thus approximates the fair value. The remaining liabilities are predominantly interest-free. In view of the short maturities, the reported carrying amount is estimated to approximate the fair value.

        Provisions for liabilities and charges — Other provisions. Where the liability will not be settled for a number of years the amount recognized is the present value of the estimated future expenditure. The carrying amount of provisions thus approximates the fair value.

        Derivative financial instruments and cash-settled commodity contracts. The fair values of the Group's interest rate and foreign exchange contracts are based on pricing models which take into account relevant market data. The fair values of the Group's oil, natural gas and power price contracts (futures contracts, swap agreements, options and forward contracts) are based on market prices.

F - 52


Note 30 — Finance debt

 
  December 31, 2004

  December 31, 2003

 
  Within
1 year (a)

  After
1 year

  Total

  Within
1 year (a)

  After
1 year

  Total

 
  ($ million)

Bank loans   250   457   707   205   253   458
Other loans   9,819   10,167   19,986   9,161   10,524   19,685
   
 
 
 
 
 
Total borrowings   10,069   10,624   20,693   9,366   10,777   20,143
Net obligations under capital leases   115   2,283   2,398   90   2,092   2,182
   
 
 
 
 
 
    10,184   12,907   23,091   9,456   12,869   22,325
   
 
 
 
 
 

(a)
Amounts due within one year include current maturities of long-term debt.

        Where finance debt is swapped into another currency, the finance debt is accounted in the swap currency and not in the original currency of denomination. Total finance debt includes an asset of $835 million (an asset of $745 million at December 31, 2003) for the carrying value of currency swaps and forward contracts.

        Included within Other loans repayable within one year are US Industrial Revenue/Municipal Bonds of $2,487 million (December 31, 2003 $2,503 million) with maturity periods ranging up to 34 years. They are classified as repayable within one year, as required under UK GAAP, as the bondholders typically have the option to tender these bonds for repayment on interest reset dates. Any bonds that are tendered are usually remarketed and BP has not experienced any significant repurchases. BP considers these bonds to represent long-term funding when assessing the maturity profile of its finance debt.

        At December 31, 2004, the Group had substantial amounts of undrawn borrowing facilities available, including committed facilities of $4,500 million expiring in 2005 ($3,700 million expiring in 2004). These facilities are with a number of international banks and borrowings under them would be at pre-agreed rates. The Group expects to renew the facilities on an annual basis. Certain of these facilities support the Group's commercial paper programme.

F - 53


        At December 31, 2004, the Group's share of third party finance debt of joint ventures and associated undertakings was $2,821 million (December 31, 2003 $2,151 million) and $1,048 million (December 31, 2003 $922 million) respectively. These amounts are not reflected in the Group's debt on the balance sheet.

 
   
  December 31, 2004

  December 31, 2003

Analysis of borrowing by
year of repayment


  Bank
loans

  Other
loans

  Total

  Bank
loans

  Other
loans

  Total

 
   
  ($ million)

Due after   10 years   1   773   774     721   721
Due within   10 years   29   1   30     17   17
    9 years   20   5   25     337   337
    8 years   22   365   387     291   291
    7 years   28   286   314      
    6 years   36   99   135   7   1,700   1,707
    5 years   33   1,691   1,724   7   938   945
    4 years   29   1,510   1,539   8   1,291   1,299
    3 years   251   2,431   2,682   193   2,593   2,786
    2 years   8   3,006   3,014   38   2,636   2,674
       
 
 
 
 
 
        457   10,167   10,624   253   10,524   10,777
    1 year   250   9,819   10,069   205   9,161   9,366
       
 
 
 
 
 
        707   19,986   20,693   458   19,685   20,143
       
 
 
 
 
 

        Amounts included above repayable by instalments, part of which falls due after five years from December 31, are as follows:

 
  At December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  ($ million)

After five years   204   14
Within five years   76   82
   
 
    280   96
   
 

        Interest rates on borrowings repayable wholly or partly more than five years from December 31, 2004 range from 1% to 12% with a weighted average of 4%. The weighted average interest rate on finance debt is 3%.

F - 54



Obligations under capital leases

        The future minimum lease payments together with the present value of the net minimum lease payments were as follows:

 
  December 31, 2004

 
 
  ($ million)

 
2005   152  
2006   254  
2007   258  
2008   268  
2009   280  
Thereafter   3,540  
   
 
    4,752  
Less: amount representing lease interest   (2,354 )
   
 
Present value of net minimum capital lease payments   2,398  
   
 
of which — due within one year   117  
— due after one year   2,281  
   
 

        The following information is presented in compliance with the requirements of US GAAP.

Bank and other loans — long term





  Weighted average interest rate at December 31,

  December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2004

  2003

 
  (%)

  ($ million)

US dollar   3   3   10,374   10,427
Sterling   5   4   25   30
Other currencies   7   5   225   320
           
 
            10,624   10,777
           
 
Bank and other loans — short term



  December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  ($ million)

Current maturities of long-term debt   2,622   1,874
Commercial paper   4,180   4,243
Bank loans   250   205
Other   3,017   3,044
   
 
    10,069   9,366
   
 

F - 55


 
  Weighted average interest rate at December 31,


 

 

2004


 

2003

 
  (%)

Commercial paper   2   1
Bank loans and other borrowings   2   2
US Industrial Revenue/Municipal bonds   2   1

Note 31 — Accounts payable and accrued liabilities

 
  December 31, 2004

  December 31, 2003

 
  Within
1 year

  After
1 year

  Within
1 year

  After
1 year

 
  ($ million)

Trade payables   28,340     20,858  
   
 
 
 
Other accounts payable and accrued liabilities:                
  Joint ventures   137     126  
  Associated undertakings   364   5   322   4
  Production taxes   517   1,520   421   1,544
  Taxation on profits   4,131     3,441  
  Social security   122     96  
  Accruals and deferred income   9,569   1,000   6,411   1,321
  Dividends   1,822     1,495  
  Other   9,339   1,980   7,958   3,161
   
 
 
 
    26,001   4,505   20,270   6,030
   
 
 
 

Note 32 — Other provisions

 
  Decommissioning

  Environmental

  Other

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

 
At January 1, 2004   4,720   2,298   1,797   8,815  
Prior year adjustment — change in accounting policy       (216 ) (216 )
   
 
 
 
 
As restated   4,720   2,298   1,581   8,599  
Exchange adjustments   213   21   25   259  
New provisions   294   588   298   1,180  
Write-back of unused provisions     (151 ) (64 ) (215 )
Unwinding of discount   118   55   23   196  
Change in discount rate   434   40   1   475  
Utilized/deleted   (199 ) (393 ) (294 ) (886 )
   
 
 
 
 
At December 31, 2004   5,580   2,458   1,570   9,608  
   
 
 
 
 

F - 56


        The Group makes full provision for the future cost of decommissioning oil and natural gas production facilities and related pipelines on a discounted basis on the installation of those facilities. At December 31, 2004, the provision for the costs of decommissioning these production facilities and pipelines at the end of their economic lives was $5,580 million (2003 $4,720 million). The provision has been estimated using existing technology, at current prices and discounted using a real discount rate of 2.0% (2003 2.5%). These costs are expected to be incurred over the next 30 years. While the provision is based on the best estimate of future costs and the economic lives of the facilities and pipelines, there is uncertainty regarding both the amount and timing of incurring these costs. The estimated aggregate costs used in assessing the provision were $8,247 million.

        Provisions for environmental remediation are made when a clean-up is probable and the amount reasonably determinable. Generally, this coincides with commitment to a formal plan of action or, if earlier, on divestment or closure of inactive sites. The provision for environmental liabilities at December 31, 2004 was $2,458 million (2003 $2,298 million). The provision has been estimated using existing technology, at current prices and discounted using a real discount rate of 2.0% (2003 2.5%). The majority of these costs are expected to be incurred over the next 10 years. The extent and cost of future remediation programmes are inherently difficult to estimate. They depend on the scale of any possible contamination, the timing and extent of corrective actions, and also the Group's share of liability. The estimated aggregate costs used in assessing the provision were $2,620 million.

        The Group also holds provisions for expected rental shortfalls on surplus properties, litigation and sundry other liabilities. To the extent that these liabilities are not expected to be settled within the next three years, the provisions are discounted using either a nominal discount rate of 4.5% (2003 4.5%) or a real discount rate of 2.0% (2003 2.5%), as appropriate.

Note 33 — Pensions

        Most Group companies have pension plans, the forms and benefits of which vary with conditions and practices in the countries concerned. Pension benefits may be provided through defined contribution plans (money purchase schemes) or defined benefit plans (final salary, cash balance and other types of schemes with committed pension payments). For defined contribution plans, retirement benefits are determined by the value of funds arising from contributions paid in respect of each employee. For defined benefit plans, retirement benefits are based on the employees' pensionable salary and length of service. Defined benefit plans may be externally funded or unfunded. The assets of funded plans are generally held in separately administered trusts.

        Contributions to funded defined benefit plans are based on advice from independent actuaries using actuarial methods, the objective of which is to provide adequate funds to meet pension obligations as they fall due. The pension plans in the UK and US are reviewed annually by the independent actuaries and subject to a formal actuarial valuation at least every three years. The date of the latest actuarial valuation for the UK and US plans was January 1, 2003 and January 1, 2004 respectively. The date of the most recent actuarial reviews was December 31, 2004.

        During 2004, contributions of $249 million ($258 million) and $30 million ($2,189 million) were made to the UK plans and US plans respectively. In addition, contributions of $116 million ($86 million)

F - 57



were made to other funded defined benefit plans. The aggregate level of contributions in 2005 is expected to be approximately $600 million.

        The pension assumptions for the principal plans are set out below. The assumptions used to evaluate accrued pension benefits at December 31 in any year are used to determine pension expense for the following year, that is, the assumptions at December 31, 2004 are used to determine the pension liabilities at that date and the pension cost for 2005.

 
  At December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (%)

UK plans:            
  Discount rate for plan liabilities   5.25   5.5   5.75
  Rate of increase in salaries   4.0   4.0   4.0
  Rate of increase for pensions in payment   2.5   2.5   2.5
  Rate of increase in deferred pensions   2.5   2.5   2.5
  Inflation   2.5   2.5   2.5
US plans:            
  Discount rate for plan liabilities   5.75   6.0   6.75
  Rate of increase in salaries   4.0   4.0   4.0
  Rate of increase for pensions in payment   nil   nil   nil
  Rate of increase in deferred pensions   nil   nil   nil
  Inflation   2.5   2.5   2.5
Other plans:            
  Discount rate for plan liabilities   5.0   5.5   5.75
  Rate of increase in salaries   4.0   4.0   4.0
  Rate of increase for pensions in payment   2.5   2.5   2.5
  Rate of increase in deferred pensions   2.5   2.5   2.5
  Inflation   2.5   2.5   2.5

        The assumed rate of investment return and discount rate have a significant effect on the amounts reported. A one percentage point change in these assumptions for the Group's plans would have the following effects:

 
  1-Percentage
point increase

  1-Percentage
point decrease

 
  ($ million)

Investment return:        
  Effect on pension expense in 2005   (312 ) 314
Discount rate:        
  Effect on pension expense in 2005   (87 ) 88
  Effect on pension obligation at December 31, 2004   (4,508 ) 5,575

F - 58


        The expected long-term rates of return and market values of the various categories of asset held by the significant defined benefit plans at December 31, are set out below.

 
  At December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  Expected
long-term
rate of return

  Market
value

  Expected
long-term
rate of return

  Market
value

  Expected
long-term
rate of return

  Market
value

 
 
  (%)

  ($ million)

  (%)

  ($ million)

  (%)

  ($ million)

 
UK plans:                          
  Equities   7.5   17,329   7.5   14,642   7.5   10,815  
  Bonds   4.5   2,859   4.75   2,477   5.0   2,263  
  Property   6.5   1,660   6.5   1,336   6.5   1,352  
  Cash   4.0   459   4.0   769   4.0   708  
       
     
     
 
    7.0   22,307   7.0   19,224   7.0   15,138  
Present value of plan liabilities       20,399       17,766       14,822  
       
     
     
 
Surplus in the plans       1,908       1,458       316  
Deferred tax       (572 )     (437 )     (95 )
       
     
     
 
At December 31       1,336       1,021       221  
       
     
     
 
US plans:                          
  Equities   8.5   6,043   8.5   5,650   8.5   3,371  
  Bonds   4.75   1,057   4.75   1,018   5.5   720  
  Property   8.0   28   8.0   41   8.0   49  
  Cash   3.0   55   3.5   148   3.5   66  
       
     
     
 
    8.0   7,183   8.0   6,857   8.0   4,206  
Present value of plan liabilities       7,826       7,709       6,765  
       
     
     
 
Deficit in the plans       (643 )     (852 )     (2,559 )
Deferred tax       231       307       921  
       
     
     
 
At December 31       (412 )     (545 )     (1,638 )
       
     
     
 
Other plans:                          
  Equities   8.0   933   7.5   686   7.5   515  
  Bonds   4.25   857   4.75   737   5.0   672  
  Property   5.25   114   6.5   129   6.5   101  
  Cash   3.5   288   4.0   187   4.0   159  
       
     
     
 
    6.0   2,192   6.0   1,739   6.0   1,447  
Present value of plan liabilities       8,044       6,376       5,141  
       
     
     
 
Deficit in the plans       (5,852 )     (4,637 )     (3,694 )
Deferred tax       540       302       249  
       
     
     
 
At December 31       (5,312 )     (4,335 )     (3,445 )
       
     
     
 

F - 59


 
  At December 31, 2004

 
 
  Surplus

  Deficit

  Net

 
 
  ($ million)

 
UK plans   1,465   (129 ) 1,336  
US plans     (412 ) (412 )
Other plans   10   (5,322 ) (5,312 )
   
 
 
 
    1,475   (5,863 ) (4,388 )
   
 
 
 
 
  At December 31, 2003

 
 
  Surplus

  Deficit

  Net

 
 
  ($ million)

 
UK plans   1,093   (72 ) 1,021  
US plans     (545 ) (545 )
Other plans   53   (4,388 ) (4,335 )
   
 
 
 
    1,146   (5,005 ) (3,859 )
   
 
 
 
 
  At December 31, 2002

 
 
  Surplus

  Deficit

  Net

 
 
  ($ million)

 
UK plans   348   (127 ) 221  
US plans     (1,638 ) (1,638 )
Other plans   40   (3,485 ) (3,445 )
   
 
 
 
    388   (5,250 ) (4,862 )
   
 
 
 

F - 60


 
  Year ended December 31, 2004

 
 
  UK

  US

  Other

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Analysis of the amount charged to operating profit                  
Current service cost   363   215   118   696  
Past service cost   5     38   43  
Settlement, curtailment and special termination benefits   37     27   64  
Payments to defined contribution plans     150   12   162  
   
 
 
 
 
Total operating charge   405   365   195   965  
   
 
 
 
 
Analysis of the amount credited (charged) to other finance income                  
Expected return on pension plan assets   1,351   526   104   1,981  
Interest on pension plan liabilities   (981 ) (445 ) (346 ) (1,772 )
   
 
 
 
 
Other finance income (expense)   370   81   (242 ) 209  
   
 
 
 
 
Analysis of the amount recognized in the statement of total recognized gains and losses                  
Actual return less expected return on pension plan assets.   818   379   152   1,349  
Experience gains and losses arising on the plan liabilities   83   (22 ) (562 ) (501 )
Change in assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities   (795 ) (108 ) (366 ) (1,269 )
   
 
 
 
 
Actuarial gain (loss) recognized in statement of total recognized gains and losses   106   249   (776 ) (421 )
   
 
 
 
 
Movement in surplus (deficit) during the year                  
Surplus (deficit) in plans at January 1, 2004   1,458   (852 ) (4,637 ) (4,031 )
Movement in year:                  
  Current service cost   (363 ) (215 ) (118 ) (696 )
  Past service cost   (5 )   (38 ) (43 )
  Settlement, curtailment and special termination benefits   (37 )   (27 ) (64 )
  Acquisitions       (3 ) (3 )
  Disposals     32   59   91  
  Other finance income (expense)   370   81   (242 ) 209  
  Actuarial gain (loss)   106   249   (776 ) (421 )
  Employers' contributions   249   62   401   712  
  Exchange adjustments   130     (471 ) (341 )
   
 
 
 
 
Surplus (deficit) in plans at December 31, 2004   1,908   (643 ) (5,852 ) (4,587 )
   
 
 
 
 

F - 61


 
  Year ended December 31, 2003

 
 
  UK

  US

  Other

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Analysis of the amount charged to operating profit                  
Current service cost   290   177   116   583  
Past service cost     14     14  
Settlement, curtailment and special termination benefits     (11 ) 87   76  
Payments to defined contribution plans     134   36   170  
   
 
 
 
 
Total operating charge   290   314   239   843  
   
 
 
 
 
Analysis of the amount credited (charged) to other finance income                  
Expected return on pension plan assets   1,053   351   94   1,498  
Interest on pension plan liabilities   (848 ) (432 ) (301 ) (1,581 )
   
 
 
 
 
Other finance income (expense)   205   (81 ) (207 ) (83 )
   
 
 
 
 
Analysis of the amount recognized in the statement of total recognized gains and losses                  
Actual return less expected return on pension plan assets.   1,639   749   2   2,390  
Experience gains and losses arising on the plan liabilities   641   30   135   806  
Change in assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities   (1,437 ) (1,030 ) (279 ) (2,746 )
   
 
 
 
 
Actuarial gain (loss) recognized in statement of total recognized gains and losses   843   (251 ) (142 ) 450  
   
 
 
 
 
Movement in surplus (deficit) during the year                  
Surplus (deficit) in plans at January 1, 2003   316   (2,559 ) (3,694 ) (5,937 )
Movement in year:                  
  Current service cost   (290 ) (177 ) (116 ) (583 )
  Past service cost     (14 )   (14 )
  Settlement, curtailment and special termination benefits     11   (87 ) (76 )
  Acquisitions       1   1  
  Other finance income (expense)   205   (81 ) (207 ) (83 )
  Actuarial gain (loss)   843   (251 ) (142 ) 450  
  Employers' contributions   258   2,219   295   2,772  
  Exchange adjustments   126     (687 ) (561 )
   
 
 
 
 
Surplus (deficit) in plans at December 31, 2003   1,458   (852 ) (4,637 ) (4,031 )
   
 
 
 
 

F - 62


 
  Year ended December 31, 2002

 
 
  UK

  US

  Other

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Analysis of the amount charged to operating profit                  
Current service cost   278   150   81   509  
Past service cost     38   4   42  
Settlement, curtailment and special termination benefits     75   (84 ) (9 )
Payments to defined contribution plans     126   27   153  
   
 
 
 
 
Total operating charge   278   389   28   695  
   
 
 
 
 
Analysis of the amount credited (charged) to other finance income                  
Expected return on pension plan assets   1,204   530   72   1,806  
Interest on pension plan liabilities   (773 ) (421 ) (258 ) (1,452 )
   
 
 
 
 
Other finance income (expense)   431   109   (186 ) 354  
   
 
 
 
 
Analysis of the amount recognized in the statement of total recognized gains and losses                  
Actual return less expected return on pension plan assets   (3,874 ) (1,305 ) (137 ) (5,316 )
Experience gains and losses arising on the plan liabilities   212   (290 ) 90   12  
Change in assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities   (480 ) (343 ) (440 ) (1,263 )
   
 
 
 
 
Actuarial loss recognized in statement of total recognized gains and losses   (4,142 ) (1,938 ) (487 ) (6,567 )
   
 
 
 
 
Movement in surplus (deficit) during the year                  
Surplus (deficit) in plans at January 1, 2002   4,134   (521 ) (1,937 ) 1,676  
Movement in year:                  
  Current service cost   (278 ) (150 ) (81 ) (509 )
  Past service cost     (38 ) (4 ) (42 )
  Settlement, curtailment and special termination benefits     (75 ) 84   9  
  Acquisitions     (14 ) (1,036 ) (1,050 )
  Other finance income (expense)   431   109   (186 ) 354  
  Actuarial loss   (4,142 ) (1,938 ) (487 ) (6,567 )
  Employers' contributions   3   68   251   322  
  Exchange adjustments   168     (298 ) (130 )
   
 
 
 
 
Surplus (deficit) in plans at December 31, 2002   316   (2,559 ) (3,694 ) (5,937 )
   
 
 
 
 

F - 63


 
  At December 31, 2004

 
 
  UK

  US

  Other

  Total

 
History of experience gains and losses                  
Difference between the expected and actual return on plan assets:                  
  Amount ($ million)   818   379   152   1,349  
  Percentage of plan assets   4 % 5 % 7 % 4 %
Experience gains and losses on plan liabilities:                  
  Amount ($ million)   83   (22 ) (562 ) (501 )
  Percentage of the present value of the plan liabilities   0 % 0 % (7 )% (1 )%
Total amount recognized in statement of total recognized gains and losses:                  
  Amount ($ million)   106   249   (776 ) (421 )
  Percentage of the present value of the plan liabilities   1 % 3 % (10 )% (1 )%
   
 
 
 
 
 
  At December 31, 2003

 
 
  UK

  US

  Other

  Total

 
History of experience gains and losses                  
Difference between the expected and actual return on plan assets:                  
  Amount ($ million)   1,639   749   2   2,390  
  Percentage of plan assets   9 % 11 % 0 % 9 %
Experience gains and losses on plan liabilities:                  
  Amount ($ million)   641   30   135   806  
  Percentage of the present value of the plan liabilities   4 % 0 % 2 % 3 %
Total amount recognized in statement of total recognized gains and losses:                  
  Amount ($ million)   843   (251 ) (142 ) 450  
  Percentage of the present value of the plan liabilities   5 % (3 )% (2 )% 1 %
   
 
 
 
 
 
  At December 31, 2002

 
 
  UK

  US

  Other

  Total

 
History of experience gains and losses                  
Difference between the expected and actual return on plan assets:                  
  Amount ($ million)   (3,874 ) (1,305 ) (137 ) (5,316 )
  Percentage of plan assets   (26 )% (31 )% (9 )% (26 )%
Experience gains and losses on plan liabilities:                  
  Amount ($ million)   212   (290 ) 90   12  
  Percentage of the present value of the plan liabilities   1 % (4 )% 2 % 0 %
Total amount recognized in statement of total recognized gains and losses:                  
  Amount ($ million)   (4,142 ) (1,938 ) (487 ) (6,567 )
  Percentage of the present value of the plan liabilities   (28 )% (29 )% (9 )% (25 )%
   
 
 
 
 

F - 64


        Further information in respect of the Group's principal defined benefit pension plans required under FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 132 (R) — 'Employers' Disclosures about Pensions and Other Postretirement Benefits' is set out below.

        Pension plan assets are generally held in trusts. The primary objective of the trusts is to accumulate pools of assets sufficient to meet the obligation of the various plans. The assets of the trusts are invested in a manner consistent with fiduciary obligations and principles that reflect current practices in portfolio management.

        A significant proportion of the assets are held in equities owing to a higher expected level of return over the long term with an acceptable level of risk. In order to provide reasonable assurance that no single security or type of security has an unwarranted impact on the total portfolio, the investment portfolios are highly diversified. The long-term asset allocation policy for the major plans is as follows:

Asset category

  Policy range

 
  (%)

Total equity   55 - 85
Fixed income/cash   15 - 35
Property/real estate   0 - 10

        Some of the Group's pension funds use derivatives to manage their asset mix and the level of risk. Direct investment of trust assets in either securities or real property of the Company or any affiliate is generally prohibited.

        Return on asset assumptions reflect on the Company's expectations built up by asset class and by country. The Company's expectation is derived from a combination of historical returns over the long term and the forecasts of market professionals.

 
  At December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

  2001

 
  (%)

Main assumptions for the principal plans                
UK plans:                
  Discount rate   5.25   5.5   5.75   6.0
  Expected return on plan assets   7.0   7.0   7.0   6.0
  Rate of increase in salaries   4.0   4.0   4.0   4.5
US plans:                
  Discount rate   5.75   6.0   6.75   7.25
  Expected return on plan assets   8.0   8.0   8.0   10.0
  Rate of increase in salaries   4.0   4.0   4.0   4.0
Other plans:                
  Discount rate   5.0   5.5   5.75   6.25
  Expected return on plan assets   6.0   6.0   6.0   6.5
  Rate of increase in salaries   4.0   4.0   4.0   3.25

F - 65


 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Pension expense              
Principal plans:              
  Service cost — benefits earned during year   688   583   509  
  Interest cost on projected benefit obligation   1,776   1,581   1,452  
  Expected return on plan assets   (2,159 ) (1,882 ) (1,787 )
  Amortization of transition asset   9   (68 ) (64 )
  Recognized net actuarial gain   304   (8 ) (206 )
  Recognized prior service cost   134   87   77  
  Curtailment and settlement (gains) losses   (2 ) 4   (46 )
  Special termination benefits   60   92   76  
   
 
 
 
    810   389   11  
Defined contribution plans   162   170   153  
   
 
 
 
Total pension expense   972   559   164  
   
 
 
 

Estimated future benefit payments

        The expected benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, through 2014 are as follows:

 
  UK

  US

  Other

 
  ($ million)

2005   963   552   455
2006   994   568   451
2007   1,030   590   453
2008   1,071   606   450
2009   1,113   620   445
2010-2014   6,105   3,184   2,041

F - 66


 
  UK

  US

  Other

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2004

  2003

  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Benefit obligation at January 1   17,766   14,822   7,709   6,765   6,376   5,141  
Disposals       (97 )   (59 )  
Service cost   364   290   213   177   118   116  
Interest cost   981   848   446   432   346   301  
Plan amendments   5       14   38    
Settlement, curtailment and special termination benefits   37       (11 ) 27   87  
Actuarial (gain) loss   692   796   133   1,000   928   144  
Acquisitions           3   1  
Plan participants' contributions   33   33       4   2  
Benefit payments   (943 ) (761 ) (578 ) (668 ) (383 ) (325 )
Exchange adjustment   1,464   1,738       646   909  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Benefit obligation at December 31   20,399   17,766   7,826   7,709   8,044   6,376  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of plan assets at January 1   19,224   15,138   6,857   4,206   1,739   1,447  
Disposals       (62 )      
Actual return on plan assets   2,149   2,692   904   1,100   256   96  
Acquisitions             2  
Plan participants' contributions   33   33       4   2  
Employers' contributions   249   258   62   2,219   401   295  
Benefit payments   (943 ) (761 ) (578 ) (668 ) (383 ) (325 )
Exchange adjustment   1,595   1,864       175   222  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of plan assets at December 31   22,307   19,224   7,183   6,857   2,192   1,739  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Funded status   1,908   1,458   (643 ) (852 ) (5,852 ) (4,637 )
Unrecognized transition (asset) obligation           29   37  
Unrecognized net actuarial (gain) loss   1,681   1,532   3,442   3,918   1,358   634  
Unrecognized prior service cost   640   680   76   78   10   12  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net amount recognized   4,229   3,670   2,875   3,144   (4,455 ) (3,954 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prepaid benefit cost (accrued benefit liability)   3,714   3,670   2,699   2,937   (5,206 ) (4,225 )
Intangible asset       13   14   26   29  
Accumulated other comprehensive income   515     163   193   725   242  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    4,229   3,670   2,875   3,144   (4,455 ) (3,954 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 

F - 67


Note 34 — Other postretirement benefits

        Certain Group companies in the US provide postretirement healthcare and life insurance benefits to their retired employees and dependants. The entitlement to these benefits is usually based on the employee remaining in service until retirement age and completion of a minimum period of service. The plans are funded to a limited extent. The cost of providing postretirement benefits is assessed annually by independent actuaries using the projected unit credit method. The date of the latest actuarial valuation was January 1, 2004 and the date of the most recent actuarial review was December 31, 2004.

        At December 31, 2004 the independent actuaries have reassessed the obligation for postretirement benefits at $3,676 million ($4,143 million at December 31, 2003). The discount rate used to assess the obligation at December 31, 2004 of the plans was 5.75% (6.0% at December 31, 2003).

Assumed future healthcare cost trend rate

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2005

  2006

  2007

  2008

  2009
and
subsequent
years

Beneficiaries aged under 65   9 % 8 % 7 % 6 % 5%
Beneficiaries aged over 65   12 % 10 % 8 % 7 % 6%

        The assumed healthcare cost trend rate has a significant effect on the amounts reported. A one-percentage-point change in the assumed healthcare cost trend rate would have the following effects:

 
  1-Percentage
point increase

  1-Percentage
point decrease

 
  ($ million)

Effect on postretirement benefit expense in 2005   39   (31)
Effect on postretirement obligation at December 31, 2004   458   (373)

F - 68


        BP's postretirement medical plans in the US provide prescription drug coverage for Medicare-eligible retired employees. The Group's obligation for other postretirement benefits at December 31, 2004 reflects the effects of the recent US Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003 (Act). The provisions of the Act provide for a federal subsidy for plans that provide prescription drug benefits and meet certain qualifications, and alternatively would allow prescription drug plan sponsors to coordinate with the Medicare benefit. BP reflected the impact of the legislation by reducing its actuarially determined obligation for postretirement benefits at December 31, 2004 and will reduce the net cost for postretirement benefits in subsequent periods. The reduction in liability was reflected in the 2004 results as an actuarial gain (assumption change). The expected long-term rates of return and market values of the various categories of assets held by the plans at December 31, are set out below.

 
  At December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  Expected
long-term
rate of
return

  Market
value

  Expected
long-term
rate of
return

  Market
value

 
 
  (%)

  ($ million)

  (%)

  ($ million)

 
US plans                  
Equities   8.5   21   8.5   24  
Bonds   4.75   9   4.75   9  
       
     
 
    7.25   30   8.0   33  
Present value of plan liabilities       3,676       4,143  
       
     
 
Other postretirement benefit liability before deferred tax       (3,646 )     (4,110 )
Deferred tax       1,520       1,480  
       
     
 
        (2,126 )     (2,630 )
       
     
 
 
  At December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Analysis of the amount charged to operating profit              
Current service cost   61   54   37  
Past service cost   (4 ) 14    
Settlement, curtailment and special termination benefits     (669 ) (78 )
   
 
 
 
Total operating charge (income)   57   (601 ) (41 )
   
 
 
 
Analysis of the amount charged to other finance costs              
Expected return on plan assets   2   2   4  
Interest on plan liabilities   (240 ) (259 ) (219 )
   
 
 
 
Other finance expense   (238 ) (257 ) (215 )
   
 
 
 
               

F - 69


Analysis of the amount recognized in the statement of total recognized gains and losses              
Actual return less expected return on plan assets     2   (8 )
Experience gains and losses arising on the plan liabilities   33   67   (89 )
Change in assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities   495   (443 ) (1,165 )
   
 
 
 
Actuarial gain (loss) recognized in statement of total recognized gains and losses   528   (374 ) (1,262 )
   
 
 
 
Movement in deficit during the year              
Deficit in plans at January 1   (4,110 ) (4,293 ) (3,039 )
Movement in year:              
  Current service cost   (61 ) (54 ) (37 )
  Past service cost   4   (14 )  
  Settlement, curtailment and special termination benefits     669   78  
  Acquisitions and disposals   18     (36 )
  Other finance expense   (238 ) (257 ) (215 )
  Employers' contributions   213   213   218  
  Actuarial gain (loss)   528   (374 ) (1,262 )
   
 
 
 
Deficit in plans at December 31   (3,646 ) (4,110 ) (4,293 )
   
 
 
 
 
  At
December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
History of experience gains and losses          
Difference between the expected and actual return on plan assets:          
  Amount ($ million)     2  
  Percentage of plan assets   0 % 6 %
Experience gains and losses on plan liabilities:          
  Amount ($ million)   33   67  
  Percentage of the present value of the plan liabilities   1 % 2 %
Total amount recognized in statement of total recognized gains and losses:          
  Amount ($ million)   528   (374 )
  Percentage of the present value of the plan liabilities   14 % (9 )%
   
 
 

F - 70


        Further information presented in compliance with the requirements of FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 132 (R) — 'Employers' Disclosures about Pensions and Other Postretirement Benefits' is set out below.

 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Benefit obligation at January 1   4,143   4,326  
Disposals   (18 )  
Service cost   61   54  
Interest cost   240   259  
Plan amendments   (4 ) 14  
Settlement, curtailment and special termination benefits     (669 )
Actuarial (gain) loss   (528 ) 376  
Benefit payments   (218 ) (217 )
   
 
 
Benefit obligation at December 31   3,676   4,143  
   
 
 
Fair value of plan assets at January 1   33   33  
Actual return on plan assets   2   4  
Employers' contributions   213   213  
Benefit payments   (218 ) (217 )
   
 
 
Fair value of plan assets at December 31   30   33  
   
 
 
Funded status   (3,646 ) (4,110 )
Unrecognized net actuarial loss   1,149   1,834  
Unrecognized prior service cost   (579 ) (648 )
   
 
 
Provision for postretirement benefits   (3,076 ) (2,924 )
   
 
 

Estimated future benefit payments

        The expected benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, through 2014 are as follows:

 
  US

 
  ($ million)

2005   251
2006   235
2007   238
2008   237
2009   239
2010-2014   1,236

F - 71


Note 35 — Capital and reserves

 
  Share
capital

  Paid
in
surplus

  Merger
reserve

  Other
reserves

  Shares
held by
ESOP trusts

  Retained
earnings

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

 
At January 1, 2004   5,552   4,480   27,077   129     38,700   75,938  
Prior year adjustment — change in accounting policy           (96 ) (5,247 ) (5,343 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
As restated   5,552   4,480   27,077   129   (96 ) 33,453   70,595  
Currency translation differences (net of tax)           (7 ) 2,143   2,136  
Actuarial gain (net of tax)             203   203  
Unrealized gain on acquistion of further investment in equity-accounted investments             94   94  
Employee share schemes   16   311           327  
Atlantic Richfield   7   153   85   (85 )     160  
Issue of ordinary share capital for TNK-BP   35   1,215           1,250  
Purchase of shares by ESOP trusts           (147 )   (147 )
Charge for long-term performance plans and employee share schemes             226   226  
Release of shares by ESOP trusts           168   (168 )  
Repurchase of ordinary share capital   (207 ) 207         (7,548 ) (7,548 )
Profit for the year             15,731   15,731  
Dividends             (6,371 ) (6,371 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31, 2004   5,403   6,366   27,162   44   (82 ) 37,763   76,656  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

        The movements in the Group's share capital during the year are set out above. All movements are quantified in terms of the number of BP shares issued or repurchased.

        Employee share schemes. During the year 62,224,092 ordinary shares were issued under the BP, Amoco and Burmah Castrol employee share schemes.

        Atlantic Richfield. 29,288,178 ordinary shares were issued in respect of Atlantic Richfield employee share option schemes.

        Issue of ordinary share capital for TNK-BP. The Company issued 139,095,888 ordinary shares as the first tranche of deferred consideration for the acquisition of the investment in TNK-BP.

        Repurchase of ordinary share capital. The Company purchased for cancellation 827,240,360 ordinary shares for a total consideration of $7,548 million.

F - 72



Note 36 — Retained earnings

        Retained earnings of $37,763 million ($33,453 million at December 31, 2003) include the following amounts, the distribution of which is limited by statutory or other restrictions:

 
  December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  ($ million)

Parent company   25,026   24,107
Subsidiary undertakings   2,927   2,115
Joint ventures and associated undertakings   441   566
   
 
    28,394   26,788
   
 

        Cumulative net exchange gains (net of tax) of $4,529 million are included in retained earnings ($2,386 million gain at December 31, 2003).

        There were no unrealized currency translation differences for the year on long-term borrowings used to finance equity investments in foreign currencies (2003 nil and 2002 nil).

F - 73


Note 37 — Analysis of consolidated statement of cash flows

Reconciliation of profit before interest and tax to net cash inflow from operating activities

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Profit before interest and tax   25,242   17,954   12,329  
Depreciation and amounts provided   12,583   10,940   10,401  
Exploration expenditure written off   274   297   385  
Net operating charge for pensions and other postretirement benefits, less contributions   (67 ) (2,913 ) (39 )
Share of profits of joint ventures and associated undertakings   (3,574 ) (1,438 ) (966 )
Interest and other income   (325 ) (341 ) (358 )
(Profit) loss on sale of fixed assets and businesses or termination of operations   (815 ) (831 ) (1,166 )
Charge for provisions   671   782   645  
Utilization of provisions   (781 ) (716 ) (847 )
(Increase) decrease in inventories   (3,595 ) (841 ) (1,521 )
(Increase) decrease in receivables   (10,920 ) (3,042 ) (2,367 )
Increase (decrease) in payables   9,861   1,847   2,846  
   
 
 
 
Net cash inflow from operating activities   28,554   21,698   19,342  
   
 
 
 

Financing

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Long-term borrowing   (2,675 ) (4,322 ) (3,707 )
Repayments of long-term borrowing   2,204   3,560   2,369  
Short-term borrowing   (3,335 ) (4,706 ) (9,849 )
Repayments of short-term borrowing   3,375   4,708   10,451  
   
 
 
 
    (431 ) (760 ) (736 )
Issue of ordinary share capital for employee share schemes   (487 ) (173 ) (195 )
Purchase of shares by ESOP trusts   147   63   18  
Repurchase of ordinary share capital   7,548   1,999   750  
   
 
 
 
Net cash (inflow) outflow   6,777   1,129   (163 )
   
 
 
 

Management of liquid resources

        Liquid resources comprise current asset investments, which are principally commercial paper issued by other companies. The net cash outflow from the management of liquid resources was $132 million (2003 $41 million inflow and 2002 $220 million inflow).

F - 74



Commercial paper

        Net movements in commercial paper are included within short-term borrowings or repayment of short-term borrowings as appropriate.

Movement in net debt

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  Finance
debt

  Cash

  Current
asset
investments

  Net
debt

  Finance
debt

  Cash

  Current
asset
investments

  Net
debt

 
 
  ($ million)

 
At January 1   (22,325 ) 1,947   185   (20,193 ) (22,008 ) 1,520   215   (20,273 )
Exchange adjustments   (403 ) 80   11   (312 ) (199 ) 110   11   (78 )
Acquisitions           (15 )     (15 )
Net cash flow   (431 ) (871 ) 132   (1,170 ) (760 ) 317   (41 ) (484 )
Debt transferred to TNK-BP           93       93  
Exchange of Exchangeable Bonds for Lukoil American Depositary Shares           420       420  
Other movements   68       68   144       144  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31   (23,091 ) 1,156   328   (21,607 ) (22,325 ) 1,947   185   (20,193 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Note 38 — Employee share plans

Employee share options granted during the year (a)

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (options thousands)

Executive Directors' Incentive Plan   2,783   2,728   2,068
BP Share Option Plan   71,750   78,109   66,771
Savings-related schemes   5,861   23,922   9,719
   
 
 
    80,394   104,759   78,558
   
 
 

(a)
The exercise prices for BP options granted during the year were £4.22/$7.73 (weighted average price) for Executive Directors' Incentive Plan (2,783,333 options); £4.38/$8.01 (weighted average price) for 71,750,436 options granted under the BP Share Option Plan; and £3.86/$7.06 (5,860,991 options) for savings-related and similar plans.

        BP offers most of its employees the opportunity to acquire a shareholding in the Company through savings-related and/or matching share plan arrangements. Such arrangements are now in place in nearly 80 countries. BP also uses long-term performance plans (see Note 39) and the granting of share options as elements of remuneration for executive directors and senior employees.

F - 75



        During 2004, share options were granted to the executive directors under the Executive Directors' Incentive Plan (EDIP). For these options the option exercise price was the market value (as determined in accordance with the plan rules) on the grant date. The options granted to executive directors reflect BP's performance in terms of total shareholder return (TSR), that is, share price increase with all dividends reinvested, relative to the FTSE Global 100 group of companies over the three years preceding the grant as well as the underlying health of the business and the competitive market place. Options are not granted in any year unless the criteria for an award of shares under the share element of the EDIP (see Note 39) have been met. Options vest over three years (one-third each after one, two and three years respectively) and have a life of seven years after the grant.

        Share options were also granted in 2004 under the BP Share Option Plan to certain categories of employees. Subject to certain vesting requirements the options are exercisable between the third and tenth anniversaries of the date of grant. There are no performance conditions attaching to the options granted during the year.

        Under the BP ShareSave Plan (a savings-related share option plan) employees save on a monthly basis over a three- or five-year period towards the purchase of shares at a price fixed when the option is granted. The option price is usually set at a 20% discount to the market price at the time of grant. The option must be exercised within six months of maturity of the savings contract; otherwise it lapses. The plan is run in the UK and a small number of other countries.

        Under the BP ShareMatch Plan, BP matches employees' own contributions of shares, up to a predetermined limit. The shares are then held in trust for a defined minimum period. The plan is run in the UK and in over 70 other countries.

        The Group takes advantage of the exemption granted under Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract No. 17 (revised 2003) 'Employee Share Schemes', whereby no compensation expense need be recognized for the BP ShareSave Plan. BP does not recognize an expense in respect of share options granted to employees under the BP Share Option Plan. If the fair value of options granted in any particular year is estimated and this value amortized over the vesting period of the options, an indication of the cost of granting options to employees can be made. The fair value of each share option granted has been estimated using a Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following assumptions:

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
Risk-free interest rate   4.0 % 3.5 % 4.0 %
Expected volatility   22 % 30 % 26 %
Expected life in years   1 to 5   1 to 5   1 to 5  
Expected dividend yield   3.75 % 4.00 % 3.75 %
Weighted average fair value of options granted ($)   1.40   1.44   1.64  

F - 76


        The following table illustrates the effect on net income and earnings per share if the Company had applied the fair value recognition provisions of FASB Statement No. 123, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation, to share based employee compensation.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Profit for the year applicable to ordinary shares, as reported   15,729   10,480   6,793  
Deduct: Total stock-based employee compensation expense determined under fair value based method for all awards, net of related tax effects   (79 ) (79 ) (90 )
   
 
 
 
Pro forma net income   15,650   10,401   6,703  
   
 
 
 

 

 

(cents)

 
Earnings per share              
  Basic — as reported   72.08   47.27   30.33  
  Basic — pro forma   71.72   46.91   29.93  
 
Diluted — as reported

 

70.79

 

46.83

 

30.19

 
  Diluted — pro forma   70.43   46.48   29.79  

        The Company sponsors a number of savings plans covering most US employees. Under these plans, most employees may contribute up to 100% of their salary subject to certain regulatory limits. Most employees are eligible for a dollar-for-dollar Company-matched contribution for the first 7% of eligible pay contributed on a before-tax or after-tax basis, or a combination of both. The precise arrangement may vary in certain business units. Plan participants may invest contributions in more than 200 investment options, including a fund comprised primarily of BP ADSs. The Company's contributions generally vest over a period of three years (0% for years one and two and 100% after completion of three years). Company contributions to savings plans during the year were $138 million (2003 $130 million and 2002 $125 million).

        An Employee Share Ownership Plan (ESOP) was established in 1997 to acquire BP shares to satisfy future requirements of certain employee share plans, principally the BP ShareMatch Plan. The ESOP holds the shares for participants during the retention period of the plan. The Company provides funding to the ESOP. Until such time as the Company's own shares held by the ESOP trust vest unconditionally in employees, the amount paid for those shares is deducted in arriving at shareholders' interest (see Note 35 of Notes to Financial Statements). Other assets and liabilities of the ESOP are recognized as assets and liabilities of the Company. The ESOP has waived its rights to dividends.

        During 2004, the ESOP released 14,156,047 shares (2003 16,892,853 shares and 2002 15,332,235 shares) for the matching share plans. The cost of shares released for these plans has been charged in these accounts. At December 31, 2004, the ESOP held 2,682,860 shares (at December 31, 2003 7,811,544 shares).

        BP had established a Qualifying Employee Share Ownership Trust (QUEST) to support the UK ShareSave plan. During 2002, contributions of $21 million were made by the Company to QUEST which,

F - 77



together with option-holder contributions, were used by the QUEST to subscribe for new ordinary shares at market price. The Company transferred the cost of this contribution directly to retained earnings and the excess of the subscription price over the nominal value has increased the paid in surplus.

        At December 31, 2002, all the ordinary shares issued to the QUEST had been transferred to employees exercising options under the UK ShareSave plan. Under new legislation, the QUEST can no longer be used for ShareSave plans after December 31, 2002.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  (shares thousands)

Shares issued in respect of options exercised during the year:            
  Savings-related schemes   3,163   5,325   10,412
  BP, Amoco and Burmah Castrol executive share option plans   59,061   27,564   23,409
   
 
 
    62,224   32,889   33,821
   
 
 

 

 

2004


 

2003


 

2002

Options outstanding at December 31:            
  BP options (shares thousands)   470,264   461,886   410,986
  Exercise period   2005-2014   2004-2013   2003-2012
  Price   £2.04-£6.40   £1.86-£6.40   £1.50-£6.40
  Price   $3.95-$9.97   $3.47-$9.97   $3.47-$9.97

        The following table summarizes share option transactions under employee share plans.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  Number of
shares

  Weighted
average
exercise
price

  Number of
shares

  Weighted
average
exercise
price

  Number of
shares

  Weighted
average
exercise
price

 
   
  ($)

   
  ($)

   
  ($)

Outstanding at January 1   461,885,881   6.76   410,986,179   6.70   373,857,979   6.20
Reinstated   434,285   7.96   35,876   7.57   24,310   5.08
Granted   80,394,760   7.93   104,758,602   6.22   78,557,576   8.07
Exercised   (62,625,182 ) 5.18   (32,988,942 ) 4.11   (34,130,302 ) 4.20
Cancelled   (9,825,936 ) 7.30   (20,905,834 ) 7.05   (7,323,384 ) 7.59
   
     
     
   
Outstanding at December 31   470,263,808   7.16   461,885,881   6.76   410,986,179   6.70
   
     
     
   
Exercisable at December 31   224,627,758       229,198,494       239,241,597    
   
     
     
   
Available for grant at December 31   966,076,636       1,079,531,345       1,159,841,669    
   
     
     
   

        Options outstanding at December 31, 2004 will be exercisable between 2005 and 2014.

F - 78


For the share options outstanding and exercisable at December 31, 2004 the exercise price ranges and average remaining lives were:

 
  Options outstanding

  Options exercisable

 
  Number of
shares

  Weighted
average
remaining
life

  Weighted
average
exercise
price

  Number of
shares

  Weighted
average
exercise
price

 
   
  (years)

  ($)

   
  ($)

Range of exercise prices                    
$3.22 - $4.61   24,058,341   0.98   4.41   23,759,435   4.41
$5.02 - $6.49   162,768,929   5.28   5.94   66,597,119   5.58
$6.78 - $8.33   247,090,117   6.62   7.99   121,545,703   8.07
$8.57 - $10.10   36,346,421   6.61   8.82   12,725,501   9.11
   
 
 
 
 
    470,263,808   5.87   7.16   224,627,758   7.00
   
 
 
 
 

Note 39 — Long-term performance plans

        During 2004, the Company operated two long-term performance plans: the Executive Directors' Incentive Plan (EDIP) for executive directors and the Long Term Performance Plan (LTPP) for senior employees. Executive directors participated in the LTPP prior to 2002 or to their appointment as an executive director, whichever was the later. Both plans are incentive schemes under which the Company may award shares to participants or fund the purchase of shares for participants if long-term targets are met. Awards were made in 2004 in respect of the 2001-2003 LTPP. Further details of the plans are given in Item 6—Directors, Senior Management and Employees — Compensation on page 117.

        The costs of potential future awards for both the EDIP and LTPP are accrued over the three-year performance periods of each plan. The amount charged in 2004 was $89 million (2003 $94 million and 2002 $51 million). The value of awards under the 2001-2003 LTPP made in 2004 was $42 million (2000-2002 LTPP made in 2003 $35 million and 1999-2001 LTPP made in 2002 $125 million). Employees are able to defer the date of their potential award beyond the end of the performance period. The amount charged in respect of the increase in deferred awards after the expiry of the relevant performance periods was $23 million (2003 $17 million and 2002 $19 million).

        Employee Share Ownership Plans (ESOPs) have been established to acquire BP shares to satisfy any awards made to participants under the EDIP and LTPP and then to hold them for the participants during the retention period of the plan. In order to hedge the cost of potential future awards and deferred awards the ESOPs may, from time to time over the performance period of the plans, purchase BP shares in the open market. The Company provides funding to the ESOPs. The assets and liabilities of the ESOPs are recognized as assets and liabilities of the Company within these accounts. The ESOPs have waived their rights to dividends on shares held for future awards.

        At December 31, 2004 the ESOPs held 5,938,359 shares (at December 31, 2003, 4,118,835 shares) for potential future awards.

F - 79



Note 40 — Employee costs and numbers

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Employee costs            
Wages and salaries   7,922   7,142   6,519
Social security costs   667   622   490
Pension and other postretirement benefit costs   1,051   582   515
   
 
 
    9,640   8,346   7,524
   
 
 
 
  At December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

Number of employees            
Exploration and Production   15,650   15,150   16,600
Refining and Marketing (a)   67,250   66,150   72,300
Petrochemicals   12,400   15,950   18,950
Gas, Power and Renewables   4,050   3,750   4,600
Other businesses and corporate   3,550   2,700   2,800
   
 
 
    102,900   103,700   115,250
   
 
 

(a)
Includes 27,950 (2003 26,950 and 2002 30,250) service station staff.

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
World

  Total

Average number of employees                    

Year ended December 31, 2004

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Exploration and Production   2,900   650   4,900   6,950   15,400
Refining and Marketing   10,100   18,250   25,900   12,550   66,800
Petrochemicals   2,400   5,750   5,450   1,250   14,850
Gas, Power and Renewables   200   800   1,400   1,550   3,950
Other businesses and corporate   1,550     1,550   100   3,200
   
 
 
 
 
    17,150   25,450   39,200   22,400   104,200
   
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31, 2003                    
Exploration and Production   3,200   750   5,000   6,900   15,850
Refining and Marketing   9,900   19,600   26,950   12,300   68,750
Petrochemicals   2,650   5,950   6,250   1,800   16,650
Gas, Power and Renewables   250   950   1,450   1,550   4,200
Other businesses and corporate   1,250     1,350   100   2,700
   
 
 
 
 
    17,250   27,250   41,000   22,650   108,150
   
 
 
 
 

F - 80


 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
World

  Total

Year ended December 31, 2002                    
Exploration and Production   3,750   800   5,350   6,800   16,700
Refining and Marketing   10,200   20,650   28,650   11,550   71,050
Petrochemicals   3,200   6,300   6,650   5,150   21,300
Gas, Power and Renewables   500   850   1,600   1,550   4,500
Other businesses and corporate   1,250     1,400   100   2,750
   
 
 
 
 
    18,900   28,600   43,650   25,150   116,300
   
 
 
 
 

Note 41 — Directors' remuneration

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Total for all directors            
Emoluments   19   17   14
Ex gratia payment to executive director retiring in 2003     1  
Gains made on the exercise of share options   3   1  
Amounts awarded under incentive schemes   6   4   14
   
 
 

Emoluments

        These amounts comprise fees paid to the non-executive chairman and non-executive directors and, for executive directors, salary and benefits earned during the relevant financial year, plus bonuses awarded for the year.

Pension contributions

        Six executive directors participated in a non-contributory pension scheme established for UK staff by a separate trust fund to which contributions are made by BP based on actuarial advice. One US executive director participated in the US BP Retirement Accumulation Plan during 2004.

Office facilities for former chairmen and deputy chairmen

        It is customary for the Company to make available to former chairmen and deputy chairmen, who were previously employed executives, the use of office and basic secretarial facilities following their retirement. The cost involved in doing so is not significant.

F - 81


Note 42 — Joint ventures and associated undertakings

        The significant joint ventures and associated undertakings of the BP Group at December 31, 2004 are shown in Note 45.

        The principal joint venture is the TNK-BP joint venture. Summarized financial information for the Group's share of joint ventures is shown below.

 
  TNK-BP

  Other

  2004
Total

  TNK-BP

  Other

  2003
Total

  2002
Total

 
  ($ million)

Turnover   7,839   1,951   9,790   1,864   1,610   3,474   1,465
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit for the year before tax   2,320   455   2,775   475   360   835   288
Taxation   752   298   1,050   83   61   144   75
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit for the year after tax   1,568   157   1,725   392   299   691   213
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed assets   9,955   4,556   14,511   8,389   3,558   11,947   2,771
Current assets   2,565   1,168   3,733   1,950   1,368   3,318   803
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    12,520   5,724   18,244   10,339   4,926   15,265   3,574
Current liabilities   1,959   686   2,645   1,575   752   2,327   284
Non current liabilities   1,851   1,820   3,671   1,350   1,434   2,784   514
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    8,710   3,218   11,928   7,414   2,740   10,154   2,776
Minority shareholders' interest   542     542   365     365  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    8,168   3,218   11,386   7,049   2,740   9,789   2,776
   
 
 
 
 
 
 

        The joint venture TNK-BP was created on August 29, 2003. See Note 19 for further information. TNK-BP in which BP holds a 50% interest, is an integrated oil company operating; inter alia, in Russia.

        The preliminary fair values attributed to the assets and liabilities of TNK-BP in 2003 have been revised in 2004 as permitted by Financial Reporting Standard No. 7 'Fair Values in Acquisition Accounting'.

        The results for TNK-BP for 2004 have been estimated. Any difference between the estimated and actual results for this period will be included in the results for 2005. The adjustment included in 2004 in respect of 2003 was a charge of $36 million.

        BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe and BP Solvay Polyethylene North America became subsidiary undertakings with effect from November 2, 2004.

        Transactions between the significant joint ventures and associated undertakings and the Group are summarized below.

F - 82



Sales to joint ventures and associated undertakings

 
   
  2004


  2003


   
 
   
  2002

 
   
   
  Amount
receivable at
December 31

   
  Amount
receivable at
December 31

 
  Product

  Sales

  Sales

  Sales

 
   
  ($ million)

  ($ million)

  ($ million)

Joint ventures                        
BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe (a)   Chemicals feedstocks   230     259   33   308
Pan American Energy   Crude oil   118   4   171   5   124
Watson Cogeneration   Natural gas   214   10   73   6   118
Associated undertakings                        
BP Solvay Polyethylene North America (a)   Chemicals feedstocks   217     241   17   143
China American Petrochemical Co.   Chemicals feedstocks   385   81   240   67   117
Ruhrgas (b)   Natural gas           98
Samsung Petrochemical Co.   Chemicals feedstock   62   8   55   10   35

F - 83


Purchases from joint ventures and associated undertakings

 
   
  2004

  2003

   
 
   
  2002

 
   
   
  Amount
payable at
December 31

   
  Amount
payable at
December 31

 
  Product

  Purchases

  Purchases

  Purchases

 
   
  ($ million)

  ($ million)

  ($ million)

Joint ventures                        
BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe (a)   Chemicals feedstocks       18   14  
Pan American Energy   Crude oil   481   43   381   48   200
TNK-BP (c)   Crude oil and oil products   1,809   80   349   52  
Watson Cogeneration   Electricity and steam   149   14   248   12   94
Associated undertakings                        
Abu Dhabi Marine Areas   Crude oil   866   91   661   61   504
Abu Dhabi Petroleum Co.   Crude oil   1,547   145   1,122   118   759
BP Solvay Polyethylene North America (a)   Chemicals feedstocks   9     11   1   7
China American Petrochemical Co.   Petrochemicals   455   111   197   83   77
Ruhrgas (b)   Natural gas           5
Samsung Petrochemical Co.   Chemicals feedstocks   290   17   187   38   114

(a)
The BP Solvay Polyethylene Europe and BP Solvay Polyethylene North America sales and purchases shown above relate to the period to November 2, 2004.

(b)
The Ruhrgas sales and purchases shown above relate to the period prior to its disposal on July 31, 2002.

(c)
The TNK-BP purchases shown above relate to the period from August 29, 2003.

Note 43 — Contingent liabilities

        There were contingent liabilities at December 31, 2004 in respect of guarantees and indemnities entered into as part of the ordinary course of the Group's business. No material losses are likely to arise from such contingent liabilities.

        Approximately 200 lawsuits were filed in State and Federal Courts in Alaska seeking compensatory and punitive damages arising out of the Exxon Valdez oil spill in Prince William Sound in March 1989. Most of those suits named Exxon (now ExxonMobil), Alyeska Pipeline Service Company (Alyeska), which operates the oil terminal at Valdez, and the other oil companies which own Alyeska. Alyeska initially responded to the spill until the response was taken over by Exxon. BP owns a 47% interest (reduced

F - 84


during 2001 from 50% by a sale of 3% to Phillips) in Alyeska through a subsidiary of BP America Inc. and briefly indirectly owned a further 20% interest in Alyeska following BP's combination with Atlantic Richfield Company (Atlantic Richfield). Alyeska and its owners have settled all the claims against them under these lawsuits. Exxon has indicated that it may file a claim for contribution against Alyeska for a portion of the costs and damages which it has incurred. If any claims are asserted by Exxon which affect Alyeska and its owners, BP will defend the claims vigorously.

        Since 1987, Atlantic Richfield, a current subsidiary of BP, has been named as a co-defendant in numerous lawsuits brought in the US alleging injury to persons and property caused by lead pigment in paint. The majority of the lawsuits have been abandoned or dismissed as against Atlantic Richfield. Atlantic Richfield (and in one case two of its affiliates) is named in these lawsuits as alleged successor to International Smelting & Refining which, along with a predecessor company, manufactured lead pigment during the period 1920-1946. Plaintiffs include individuals and governmental entities. Several of the lawsuits purport to be class actions. The lawsuits (depending on plaintiff) seek various remedies including: compensation to lead-poisoned children; cost to find and remove lead paint from buildings; medical monitoring and screening programmes; public warning and education on lead hazards; reimbursement of government healthcare costs and special education for lead-poisoned citizens; and punitive damages. No lawsuit against Atlantic Richfield has been settled or tried to conclusion. The amounts claimed and, if such suits were successful, the costs of implementing the remedies sought in the various cases could be substantial. While it is not possible to predict the outcome of these legal actions, Atlantic Richfield believes that it has valid defences and it intends to defend such actions vigorously and thus the incurring of a liability by Atlantic Richfield is remote. Consequently, BP believes that the impact of these lawsuits on the Group's results of operations, financial position or liquidity will not be material.

        The Group is subject to numerous national and local environmental laws and regulations concerning its products, operations and other activities. These laws and regulations may require the Group to take future action to remediate the effects on the environment of prior disposal or release of chemicals or petroleum substances by the Group or other parties. Such contingencies may exist for various sites including refineries, chemical plants, oil fields, service stations, terminals and waste disposal sites. In addition, the Group may have obligations relating to prior asset sales or closed facilities. The ultimate requirement for remediation and its cost are inherently difficult to estimate. However, the estimated cost of known environmental obligations has been provided in these accounts in accordance with the Group's accounting policies. While the amounts of future costs could be significant and could be material to the Group's results of operations in the period in which they are recognized, BP does not expect these costs to have a material effect on the Group's financial position or liquidity.

        The Group generally restricts its purchase of insurance to situations where this is required for legal or contractual reasons. This is because external insurance is not considered an economic means of financing losses for the Group. Losses will therefore be borne as they arise rather than being spread over time through insurance premia with attendant transaction costs. The position is reviewed periodically.

        The parent company has issued guarantees under which amounts outstanding at December 31, 2004 were $21,106 million (at December 31, 2003 $20,903 million), including $21,050 million (at December 31, 2003 $20,847 million) in respect of borrowings by its subsidiary undertakings and

F - 85



$56 million (at December 31, 2003 $56 million) in respect of liabilities of other third parties. In addition, other Group companies have issued guarantees under which amounts outstanding at December 31, 2004 were $1,281 million (at December 31, 2003 $635 million) in respect of borrowings of joint ventures and associated undertakings and $650 million (at December 31, 2003 $304 million) in respect of liabilities of other third parties.

Note 44 — Capital commitments

        Authorized future capital expenditure by Group companies for which contracts had been placed at December 31, 2004 amounted to $6,765 million (at December 31, 2003 $6,420 million).

Note 45 — Summarized financial information on joint ventures and associated undertakings

        A summarized statement of income and assets and liabilities based on latest information available, with respect to the Group's equity accounted joint ventures and associated undertakings, is set out below. These figures represent 100% of the Income Statements and Balance Sheets of the joint ventures and associated undertakings, not BP's ownership interest.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Sales and other operating revenue   38,303   21,479   22,457
Gross profit   9,002   4,816   4,180
Profit for the year   5,413   2,597   2,049
   
 
 
 
  December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Fixed assets   44,695   37,095  
Current assets   13,649   11,972  
   
 
 
    58,344   49,067  
Current liabilities   (11,765 ) (10,761 )
Noncurrent liabilities   (12,552 ) (9,813 )
   
 
 
Net assets   34,027   28,493  
   
 
 

F - 86


        The more important joint ventures and associated undertakings of the Group at December 31, 2004 and the percentage of ordinary share capital owned or joint venture interest (to nearest whole number) are:

 
  %

  Country of
incorporation

  Principal activities

Associated undertakings            
Abu Dhabi            
Abu Dhabi Marine Areas   37   England   Crude oil production
Abu Dhabi Petroleum Co   24   England   Crude oil production
Azerbaijan            
The Baku-Tbilisi-Ceyhan Pipeline Co   30   Cayman Islands   Pipelines
Korea            
Samsung Petrochemical Co.   47   England   Petrochemicals
Taiwan            
China American Petrochemical Co.   61   Taiwan   Petrochemicals
 
  %

  Country of
incorporation
or registration

  Principal activities

Joint ventures            
CaTO Finance V Limited Partnership   50   England   Finance
Lukarco   46   Netherlands   Exploration and production, pipelines
Pan American Energy   60   USA   Exploration and Production
Shanghai Secco Petrochemical Co   50   China   Petrochemicals
TNK-BP   50   British Virgin Islands   Integrated oil operations
Unimar LLC   50   USA   Exploration and Production
Watson Cogeneration   51   USA   Power generation

F - 87


Note 46 — New accounting standards

        Comparative information for 2003 and 2002 has been restated to reflect the changes described below.

New accounting standard for pensions and other postretirement benefits

        With effect from January 1, 2004, BP has adopted Financial Reporting Standard No. 17 'Retirement Benefits' (FRS 17). FRS 17 requires that financial statements reflect at fair value the assets and liabilities arising from an employer's retirement benefit obligations and any related funding. The operating costs of providing retirement benefits are recognized in the period in which they are earned, together with any related finance costs and changes in the value of related assets and liabilities. This contrasts with Statement of Standard Accounting Practice No. 24 'Accounting for Pension Costs', which required the cost of providing pensions to be recognized on a systematic and rational basis over the period during which the employer benefited from the employee's services. The difference between the amount charged in the income statement and the amount paid as contributions into the pension fund was shown as a prepayment or provision on the balance sheet.

        This change in accounting policy has resulted in a prior year adjustment. Shareholders' interest at January 1, 2002 has been reduced by $132 million, the profit for the year ended December 31, 2002 decreased by $50 million and the profit for the year ended December 31, 2003 increased by $215 million. Profit for the current year has been increased by approximately $301 million as a result of the change in accounting policy.

Accounting for Employee Share Ownership Plans

        With effect from January 1, 2004, BP has adopted Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract No. 38 'Accounting for Employee Share Ownership Plan (ESOP) Trusts'. This abstract requires that BP shares held by the Group for the purposes of Employee Share Ownership Plans (ESOPs) are deducted from equity on the balance sheet. Such shares were previously classified as fixed asset investments. In addition, accruals for awards under the Long Term Performance Plan have also been included in reserves.

F - 88



        This change in accounting policy has resulted in a prior year adjustment. Shareholders' interest at January 1, 2002 has been decreased by $18 million. The impact of the change in accounting policy on profit for the years ended December 31, 2002, 2003 and 2004 is not significant.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2003

  2002

 
 
  Restated

  Reported

  Restated

  Reported

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Group income statement                  
Turnover   236,045   236,045   180,186   180,186  
Less: joint ventures   3,474   3,474   1,465   1,465  
   
 
 
 
 
Group turnover   232,571   232,571   178,721   178,721  
Cost of sales   201,335   202,029   154,615   154,401  
Production taxes   1,723   1,723   1,274   1,274  
   
 
 
 
 
Gross profit   29,513   28,819   22,832   23,046  
Distribution and administration expenses   14,072   14,072   12,632   12,632  
Exploration expense   542   542   644   644  
   
 
 
 
 
    14,899   14,205   9,556   9,770  
Other income   786   786   641   641  
   
 
 
 
 
Group operating profit   15,685   14,991   10,197   10,411  
Share of profits of joint ventures   924   924   347   347  
Share of profits of associated undertakings   514   514   617   617  
   
 
 
 
 
Total operating profit   17,123   16,429   11,161   11,375  
Profit (loss) on sale of businesses or termination of operations   (28 ) (28 ) (33 ) (33 )
Profit (loss) on sale of fixed assets   859   859   1,201   1,201  
   
 
 
 
 
Profit before interest and tax   17,954   17,260   12,329   12,543  
Interest expense   644   851   1,067   1,279  
Other finance expense   547     73    
   
 
 
 
 
Profit before taxation   16,763   16,409   11,189   11,264  
Taxation   6,111   5,972   4,317   4,342  
   
 
 
 
 
Profit after taxation   10,652   10,437   6,872   6,922  
Minority shareholders' interest   170   170   77   77  
   
 
 
 
 
Profit for the year   10,482   10,267   6,795   6,845  
Distribution to shareholders   5,753   5,753   5,375   5,375  
   
 
 
 
 
Retained profit for the year   4,729   4,514   1,420   1,470  
   
 
 
 
 
Earnings per ordinary share — cents                  
  Basic   47.27   46.30   30.33   30.55  
  Diluted   46.83   45.87   30.19   30.41  
   
 
 
 
 

F - 89


 
  Restated

  Reported

 
  ($ million)

Group balance sheet at December 31, 2003        
Fixed assets        
  Intangible assets   13,642   13,642
  Tangible assets   91,911   91,911
  Investments   17,458   17,554
   
 
    123,011   123,107
   
 
Current assets   47,651   54,465
Current liabilities — falling due within one year   50,584   50,584
   
 
Net current assets (liabilities)   (2,933 ) 3,881
   
 
Total assets less current liabilities   120,078   126,988
Noncurrent liabilities   18,899   18,959
Provisions for liabilities and charges        
  Deferred taxation   14,371   15,273
  Other   8,599   15,693
   
 
Net assets excluding pension and other postretirement benefit balances   78,209   77,063
Defined benefit pension plan surpluses   1,146  
Defined benefit pension plan deficits   (5,005 )
Other postretirement benefit plan deficit   (2,630 )
   
 
Net assets   71,720   77,063
Minority shareholders' interest — equity   1,125   1,125
   
 
BP shareholders' interest   70,595   75,938
   
 

F - 90


 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2003

  2002

 
 
  Restated

  Reported

  Restated

  Reported

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Statement of total recognized gains and losses                  
Profit for the year   10,482   10,267   6,795   6,845  
Currency translation differences (net of tax)   3,644   3,841   3,284   3,333  
Actuarial gain (loss) (net of tax)   60     (5,370 )  
   
 
 
 
 
Total recognized gains and losses   14,186   14,108   4,709   10,178  
   
 
 
 
 
Group cash flow statement                  
Net cash inflow from operating activities   21,698   21,698   19,342   19,342  
Dividends from joint ventures   131   131   198   198  
Dividends from associated undertakings   417   417   368   368  
Net cash outflow from servicing of finance and returns on investments   (711 ) (711 ) (911 ) (911 )
Tax paid   (4,804 ) (4,804 ) (3,094 ) (3,094 )
Net cash outflow for capital expenditure and financial investment   (6,124 ) (6,187 ) (9,628 ) (9,646 )
Net cash (outflow) inflow from acquisitions and disposals   (3,548 ) (3,548 ) (1,337 ) (1,337 )
Equity dividends paid   (5,654 ) (5,654 ) (5,264 ) (5,264 )
   
 
 
 
 
Net cash inflow (outflow) before financing   1,405   1,342   (326 ) (344 )
   
 
 
 
 
Financing   1,129   1,066   (163 ) (181 )
Management of liquid resources   (41 ) (41 ) (220 ) (220 )
Increase (decrease) in cash   317   317   57   57  
   
 
 
 
 
    1,405   1,342   (326 ) (344 )
   
 
 
 
 

F - 91


 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2003

  2002

 
 
  Restated

  Reported

  Restated

  Reported

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Reconciliation of profit before interest and tax to net cash inflow from operating activities                  
Profit before interest and tax   17,954   17,260   12,329   12,543  
Depreciation and amounts provided   10,940   10,940   10,401   10,401  
Exploration expenditure written off   297   297   385   385  
Net operating charge for pensions and other postretirement benefits, less contributions   (2,913 )   (39 )  
Share of profits of joint ventures and associated undertakings   (1,438 ) (1,438 ) (966 ) (966 )
Interest and other income   (341 ) (341 ) (358 ) (358 )
(Profit) loss on sale of fixed assets and businesses   (831 ) (831 ) (1,166 ) (1,166 )
Charge for provisions   782   1,734   645   1,277  
Utilization of provisions   (716 ) (1,204 ) (847 ) (1,427 )
(Increase) decrease in inventories   (841 ) (841 ) (1,521 ) (1,521 )
(Increase) decrease in receivables   (3,042 ) (5,628 ) (2,367 ) (2,672 )
Increase (decrease) in payables   1,847   1,750   2,846   2,846  
   
 
 
 
 
Net cash inflow from operating activities   21,698   21,698   19,342   19,342  
   
 
 
 
 

Note 47 — Transfer of natural gas liquids activities

        With effect from January 1, 2004, natural gas liquids activities were transferred from Exploration and Production to Gas, Power and Renewables. The adjustments between these two segments for 2003 and 2002 are set out below.

 
  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Group operating profit   106   68
Share of profits of joint ventures    
Share of profits of associated undertakings    
   
 
Total operating profit   106   68
Exceptional items    
   
 
Profit before interest and tax   106   68
   
 
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   82   40
Operating capital employed   389   322
Tangible fixed assets   289   289
   
 
Number of employees        
  Year end   200   200
  Average   200   200
   
 

F - 92


Note 48 — Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities (a)

Capitalized costs at December 31

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Others

  Total

 
  ($ million)

2004                                    
Gross capitalized costs:                                    
  Proved properties   27,540   4,691   43,518   10,450   2,892   10,401     3,834   103,326
  Unproved properties   271   154   1,265   411   1,121   476   107   96   3,901
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    27,811   4,845   44,783   10,861   4,013   10,877   107   3,930   107,227
Accumulated depreciation   17,637   2,787   19,783   5,532   1,347   5,559     1,011   53,656
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net capitalized costs   10,174   2,058   25,000   5,329   2,666   5,318   107   2,919   53,571
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

2003

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Gross capitalized costs:                                    
  Proved properties   25,212   4,506   43,480   10,404   3,905   9,751   1   3,260   100,519
  Unproved properties   266   211   1,127   661   1,642   506   37   54   4,504
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    25,478   4,717   44,607   11,065   5,547   10,257   38   3,314   105,023
Accumulated depreciation   15,346   2,912   19,807   5,067   1,890   5,516   32   1,218   51,788
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net capitalized costs   10,132   1,805   24,800   5,998   3,657   4,741   6   2,096   53,235
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Gross capitalized costs:                                    
  Proved properties   26,804   4,029   46,555   9,406   5,275   7,803     2,120   101,992
  Unproved properties   294   179   1,045   806   2,148   479     236   5,187
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    27,098   4,208   47,600   10,212   7,423   8,282     2,356   107,179
Accumulated depreciation   16,394   2,591   22,416   4,729   2,360   4,489     1,075   54,054
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net capitalized costs   10,704   1,617   25,184   5,483   5,063   3,793     1,281   53,125
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

F - 93


Costs incurred for the year ended December 31

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Others

  Total

 
  ($ million)

2004                                    
Acquisition of properties:                                    
  Proved                  
  Unproved   2     58   5     13       78
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    2     58   5     13       78
Exploration and appraisal costs (b)   51   17   422   199   85   142   113   9   1,038
Development costs   679   262   3,248   527   88   1,460     1,007   7,271
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total costs   732   279   3,728   731   173   1,615   113   1,016   8,387
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2003                                    
Acquisition of properties:                                    
  Proved                  
  Unproved                  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                   
Exploration and appraisal costs (b)   20   69   290   119   57   205   26   40   826
Development costs   740   236   3,474   512   42   1,614     917   7,535
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total costs   760   305   3,764   631   99   1,819   26   957   8,361
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2002                                    
Acquisition of properties:                                    
  Proved     4             59   63
  Unproved       29   7     1       37
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
      4   29   7     1     59   100
Exploration and appraisal costs (b)   28   68   441   179   161   160   17   54   1,108
Development costs   895   219   3,607   684   129   1,164     526   7,224
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total costs   923   291   4,077   870   290   1,325   17   639   8,432
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

F - 94


Results of operations for the year ended December 31

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Others

  Total

 
  ($ million)

2004                                    
Turnover (c):                                    
  Third parties   3,458   626   1,735   1,785   989   524   5   467   9,589
  Sales between businesses   2,423   609   11,603   2,547   519   1,407     2,847   21,955
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    5,881   1,235   13,338   4,332   1,508   1,931   5   3,314   31,544
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploration expense   26   25   361   141   14   45   17   8   637
Production costs   873   117   1,428   535   142   323     131   3,549
Production taxes   273   30   477   239   45       1,023   2,087
Other costs (income) (d)   (211 ) 38   1,884   458   96   122   (3 ) 1,380   3,764
Depreciation   1,524   172   2,673   797   174   347     121   5,808
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    2,485   382   6,823   2,170   471   837   14   2,663   15,845
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit before taxation (e)   3,396   853   6,515   2,162   1,037   1,094   (9 ) 651   15,699
Allocable taxes   1,288   534   2,290   870   104   441   2   151   5,680
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations   2,108   319   4,225   1,292   933   653   (11 ) 500   10,019
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

2003

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Turnover (c):                                    
  Third parties   2,257   441   1,491   1,222   421   444     777   7,053
  Sales between businesses   2,901   568   10,930   2,684   925   974     1,707   20,689
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    5,158   1,009   12,421   3,906   1,346   1,418     2,484   27,742
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploration expense   17   37   204   164   15   32   21   52   542
Production costs   800   113   1,262   463   166   241     135   3,180
Production taxes   233   14   439   189   40       742   1,657
Other costs (income) (d)   (151 ) 57   2,019   447   160   38   30   946   3,546
Depreciation   1,830   169   3,384   560   445   222     136   6,746
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    2,729   390   7,308   1,823   826   533   51   2,011   15,671
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit before taxation (e)   2,429   619   5,113   2,083   520   885   (51 ) 473   12,071
Allocable taxes   1,060   360   2,130   881   97   342   (12 ) 158   5,016
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations   1,369   259   2,983   1,202   423   543   (39 ) 315   7,055
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                                     

F - 95



2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Turnover (c):                                    
  Third parties   2,249   465   1,290   884   457   512     644   6,501
  Sales between businesses   3,169   594   7,776   1,754   905   1,015     1,278   16,491
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    5,418   1,059   9,066   2,638   1,362   1,527     1,922   22,992
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploration expense   27   47   258   167   67   50   17   11   644
Production costs   820   104   1,318   403   190   237     122   3,194
Production taxes   279   7   288   115   36       519   1,244
Other costs (income) (d)   315   36   1,556   341   110   331   42   670   3,401
Depreciation   1,875   154   3,118   633   407   364     140   6,691
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    3,316   348   6,538   1,659   810   982   59   1,462   15,174
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit before taxation (e)   2,102   711   2,528   979   552   545   (59 ) 460   7,818
Allocable taxes   1,327   412   889   480   291   (86 ) (18 ) 220   3,515
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations   775   299   1,639   499   261   631   (41 ) 240   4,303
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

        The Group's share of joint ventures' and associated undertakings' results of operations in 2004 was a profit of $1,908 million (2003 $851 million profit and 2002 $372 million profit) after deducting a tax charge of $1,078 million (2003 $171 million tax charge and 2002 $110 million tax charge).

        The Group's share of joint ventures' and associated undertakings' net capitalized costs at December 31, 2004 was $12,077 million (December 31, 2003 $10,232 million and December 31, 2002 $4,350 million).

        The Group's share of joint ventures' and associated undertakings' costs incurred in 2004 was $1,435 million (2003 $6,282 million and 2002 $850 million).

(a)
This note relates to the requirements contained within the UK Statement of Recommended Practice 'Accounting for Oil and Gas Exploration, Development, Production and Decommissioning Activities'. Midstream activities of natural gas gathering and distribution and the operation of the main pipelines and tankers are excluded. The main midstream activities are the Alaskan transportation facilities, the Forties Pipeline system and the Central Area Transmission System. The Group's share of joint ventures' and associated undertakings' activities is excluded from the tables and included in the footnotes, with the exception of the Abu Dhabi operations, which are included in the income and expenditure items above. Profits (losses) on sale of fixed assets and businesses or termination of operations relating to the oil and natural gas exploration and production activities, which have been accounted as exceptional items, are also excluded.

(b)
Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditure and licence acquisition costs which are capitalized within intangible fixed assets and geological and geophysical exploration costs which are charged to income as incurred.

F - 96


(c)
Turnover represents proceeds from the sale of production and other crude oil and gas including royalty oil sold on behalf of others where royalty is payable in cash.

(d)
Includes the value of royalty oil sold on behalf of others where royalty is payable in cash, property taxes and other government take.

(e)
The exploration and production total operating profit comprises:

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Others

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Year ended
December 31, 2004
                                     
Exploration and production activities                                      
— Group (as above)   3,396   853   6,515   2,162   1,037   1,094   (9 ) 651   15,699  
— Equity-accounted entities         401   75     2,510     2,986  
Midstream activities   9   (15 ) (442 ) 164   (82 ) (19 )   78   (307 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total operating profit   3,405   838   6,073   2,727   1,030   1,075   2,501   729   18,378  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Year ended
December 31, 2003

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Exploration and production activities                                      
— Group (as above)   2,429   619   5,113   2,083   520   885   (51 ) 473   12,071  
— Equity-accounted entities       1   199   64     610   148   1,022  
Midstream activities   233   (2 ) 219   211   1   1       663  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total operating profit   2,662   617   5,333   2,493   585   886   559   621   13,756  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Year ended
December 31, 2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Exploration and production activities                                      
— Group (as above)   2,102   711   2,528   979   552   545   (59 ) 460   7,818  
— Equity-accounted entities       16   163   70   1   115   117   482  
Midstream activities   224     296   138   56   (8 )     706  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total operating profit   2,326   711   2,840   1,280   678   538   56   577   9,006  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Suspended exploration well costs

        Included within the total exploration expenditure of $3,761 million (2003 $4,236 million) shown as part of intangible assets (see Note 21—Intangible assets) is an amount of $1,680 million (2003 $1,698 million) representing costs directly associated with exploration wells.

        The carried costs of exploration wells are subject to technical, commercial and management review at least once a year to confirm the continued intent to develop or otherwise extract value from the discovery. In evaluating whether costs incurred meet the criteria for initial and continued capitalization management uses two main criteria: a) that exploration drilling is still under way or firmly planned, or

F - 97


b) that it either has been determined, or work is underway to determine, that the discovery is economically viable, based on a range of technical and commercial considerations, and sufficient progress is being made on establishing development plans and timing.

        The following table provides an analysis of the amount of costs directly associated with exploration wells:

 
  At December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  ($ million)

  Number
of wells

  ($ million)

  Number
of wells

Exploration well-drilling costs                
Projects with recent or planned drilling activity   690   51   418   48
Projects with completed exploration activity   990   103   1,280   148
   
 
 
 
At December 31,   1,680   154   1,698   196
   
 
 
 

        The following table provides the year-end balances and movements for suspended exploration well costs:

 
  Years ended
December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Capitalized exploration well costs              
At January 1,   1,698   1,846   1,941  
Additions pending determination of proved reserves   391   295   341  
Exploration well costs written off in the period   (84 ) (90 ) (143 )
Costs of exploration wells divested in the period   (34 ) (76 ) (35 )
Reclassified to tangible assets following determination of proved reserves   (291 ) (277 ) (258 )
   
 
 
 
At December 31,   1,680   1,698   1,846  
   
 
 
 

        The following table provides an ageing profile of suspended exploration wells:

 
  At December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  Cost

  Wells

  Cost

  Wells

  Cost

  Wells

 
  ($ million)

   
  ($ million)

   
  ($ million)

   
Age                        
Less than 1 year   411   26   266   34   273   32
1 to 5 years   787   81   752   81   1,038   110
6 to 10   292   29   522   62   363   45
More than 10 years   190   18   158   19   172   20
   
 
 
 
 
 
Total   1,680   154   1,698   196   1,846   207
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 98


Note 49 — Business and geographical analysis

        BP has four reportable operating segments — Exploration and Production; Refining and Marketing; Petrochemicals and Gas, Power and Renewables. Exploration and Production's activities include oil and natural gas exploration and field development and production (upstream activities), together with pipeline transportation and natural gas processing (midstream activities). The activities of Refining and Marketing include oil supply and trading as well as refining and marketing (downstream activities). Petrochemicals activities include petrochemicals manufacturing and marketing. Gas, Power and Renewables activities include marketing and trading of natural gas, natural gas liquids, new market development, LNG and solar and renewables.

        The Group is managed on a unified basis. Reportable segments are differentiated by the activities that each undertakes and the products they manufacture and market.

        The accounting policies of operating segments are the same as those described in Note 1 — Accounting Policies.

        Sales between segments are made at prices that approximate market prices, taking into account the volumes involved.

F - 99



By business

 
  Exploration
and
Production

  Refining
and
Marketing

  Petro-
chemicals

  Gas,
Power
and
Renewables

  Other
businesses
and
corporate (a)

  Eliminations

  Total

 
  ($ million)

2004                            
Group turnover — third parties   10,158   173,048   20,429   80,878   546     285,059
— sales between businesses (b)   24,756   6,539   780   2,442     (34,517 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    34,914   179,587   21,209   83,320   546   (34,517 ) 285,059
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
Share of sales by joint ventures   8,734   594   462         9,790
                           
                            294,849
                           
Equity-accounted income (c)   3,183   164   215   15         3,577
   
 
 
 
 
     
Total operating profit (loss) (d)   18,378   6,084   12   926   (973 )     24,427
Exceptional items (e)   152   (117 ) (563 ) 56   1,287       815
   
 
 
 
 
     
Profit (loss) before interest and tax   18,530   5,967   (551 ) 982   314       25,242
   
 
 
 
 
     
Total assets (f)   83,048   66,289   18,877   17,069   7,930       193,213
Operating capital employed (g)   68,718   38,577   14,755   4,901   (8,559 )     118,392
Goodwill   3,151   4,712   (29 ) 38         7,872
Depreciation and amounts provided (h)   6,877   3,423   1,951   215   117       12,583
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   11,193   3,014   2,289   538   215       17,249

2003

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Group turnover — third parties   7,868   145,029   15,483   63,676   515     232,571
— sales between businesses (b)   22,885   4,448   592   1,963     (29,888 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    30,753   149,477   16,075   65,639   515   (29,888 ) 232,571
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
Share of sales by joint ventures   2,587   453   434         3,474
                           
                            236,045
                           
Equity-accounted income (c)   1,186   164   73   (3 ) 18       1,438
   
 
 
 
 
     
Total operating profit (loss) (d)   13,756   2,483   585   582   (283 )     17,123
Exceptional items (e)   913   (213 ) 38   (6 ) 99       831
   
 
 
 
 
     
Profit (loss) before interest and tax   14,669   2,270   623   576   (184 )     17,954
   
 
 
 
 
     
Total assets (f)   77,703   58,602   16,677   10,607   8,753       172,342
Operating capital employed (g)   63,618   35,111   13,484   4,292   (6,392 )     110,113
Goodwill   3,761   5,325   35   48         9,169
Depreciation and amounts provided (h)   6,928   2,958   751   163   140       10,940
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   15,370   3,080   775   441   346       20,012

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Group turnover — third parties   6,974   122,470   12,507   36,260   510     178,721
— sales between businesses (b)   18,109   3,366   557   1,320     (23,352 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
    25,083   125,836   13,064   37,580   510   (23,352 ) 178,721
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
Share of sales by joint ventures   539   415   511         1,465
                           
                            180,186
                           
Equity-accounted income (c)   611   204   (10 ) 107   52       964
   
 
 
 
 
     
Total operating profit (loss) (d)   9,006   1,969   447   469   (730 )     11,161
Exceptional items (e)   (726 ) 613   (256 ) 1,551   (14 )     1,168
   
 
 
 
 
     
Profit (loss) before interest and tax   8,280   2,582   191   2,020   (744 )     12,329
   
 
 
 
 
     
Total assets (f)   71,423   54,505   15,783   7,243   6,667       155,621
Operating capital employed (g)   61,460   33,484   12,536   2,979   (9,768 )     100,691
Goodwill   4,371   5,969   43   55         10,438
Depreciation and amounts provided (h)   6,786   2,658   749   130   78       10,401
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   9,659   7,753   823   448   410       19,093

F - 100


By geographical area

 
  UK (i)

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
World

  Eliminations

  Total

 
  ($ million)

2004                        
Group turnover — third parties (j)   52,671   47,494   127,049   57,845     285,059
— sales between areas   28,484   6,928   3,603   10,207   (49,222 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
    81,155   54,422   130,652   68,052   (49,222 ) 285,059
   
 
 
 
 
 
Share of sales by joint ventures   155   296   212   9,127     9,790
                       
                        294,849
                       
Equity-accounted income (c)   6   27   99   3,445       3,577
   
 
 
 
     
Total operating profit (d)   2,408   3,157   9,138   9,724       24,427
Exceptional items (e)   (343 ) (87 ) (205 ) 1,450       815
   
 
 
 
     
Profit before interest and tax   2,065   3,070   8,933   11,174       25,242
   
 
 
 
     
Total assets (f)   38,700   29,229   69,107   56,177       193,213
Operating capital employed (g)   21,342   13,109   43,507   40,434       118,392
Depreciation and amounts provided (h)   3,314   1,653   5,484   2,132       12,583
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   1,832   2,105   6,301   7,011       17,249

2003

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Group turnover — third parties (j)   39,696   41,910   106,741   44,224     232,571
— sales between areas   15,275   8,672   2,169   8,274   (34,390 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
    54,971   50,582   108,910   52,498   (34,390 ) 232,571
   
 
 
 
 
   
Share of sales by joint ventures   144   290   177   2,863     3,474
                       
                        236,045
                       
Equity-accounted income (c)   (5 ) 13   105   1,325       1,438
   
 
 
 
     
Total operating profit (d)   1,924   2,271   6,672   6,256       17,123
Exceptional items (e)   717   (151 ) (347 ) 612       831
   
 
 
 
     
Profit before interest and tax   2,641   2,120   6,325   6,868       17,954
   
 
 
 
     
Total assets (f)   34,199   26,842   63,283   48,018       172,342
Operating capital employed (g)   18,788   11,030   44,322   35,973       110,113
Depreciation and amounts provided (h)   2,963   1,028   5,187   1,762       10,940
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   1,556   1,277   6,291   10,888       20,012

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Group turnover — third parties (j)   34,075   38,538   78,282   27,826     178,721
— sales between areas   14,673   7,980   2,099   6,575   (31,327 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
    48,748   46,518   80,381   34,401   (31,327 ) 178,721
   
 
 
 
 
   
Share of sales by joint ventures   129   298   236   802     1,465
                       
                        180,186
                       
Equity-accounted income (c)   (4 ) 130   153   685       964
   
 
 
 
     
Total operating profit (d)   1,207   2,195   3,646   4,113       11,161
Exceptional items (e)   (88 ) 1,817   (242 ) (319 )     1,168
   
 
 
 
     
Profit before interest and tax   1,119   4,012   3,404   3,794       12,329
   
 
 
 
     
Total assets (f)   30,838   25,024   62,599   37,160       155,621
Operating capital employed (g)   18,305   11,175   42,695   28,516       100,691
Depreciation and amounts provided (h)   2,821   867   4,780   1,933       10,401
Capital expenditure and acquisitions   1,619   6,556   6,095   4,823       19,093

(a)
Other businesses and corporate comprises Finance, the Group's coal asset (divested in October 2003) and aluminium asset, its investments in PetroChina and Sinopec (both divested in early 2004), interest income and costs relating to corporate activities worldwide.

F - 101


(b)
Sales and transfers between businesses are made at prices that approximate market prices taking into account the volumes involved.

(c)
Equity-accounted income (loss) represents the Group's share of income (loss) before exceptional items, interest expense and taxes of joint ventures and associated undertakings.

(d)
Total operating profit is before interest expense and other finance expense, which is attributable to the corporate function. Transfers between Group companies are made at prices that approximate market prices taking into account the volumes involved.

(e)
Exceptional items comprise profit on the sale of fixed assets and sale of businesses or termination of operations of $815 million in 2004 (2003 $831 million profit and 2002 $1,168 million profit).

(f)
Total assets comprise fixed and current assets and pension surpluses and include investments in joint ventures and associated undertakings analyzed between activities as follows:

 
  Exploration
and
Production

  Refining
and
Marketing

  Petro-
chemicals

  Gas,
Power
and
Renewables

  Other
businesses
and
corporate (a)

  Total

 
  ($ million)

2004   14,336   1,522   1,493   573   15   17,939
   
 
 
 
 
 
2003   12,418   1,381   1,691   362   27   15,879
   
 
 
 
 
 
2002   5,687   1,452   1,252   210   56   8,657
   
 
 
 
 
 
(g)
Operating capital employed comprises net assets before deducting finance debt and liabilities for current and deferred taxation.

 
  At December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Operating capital employed   118,392   110,113   100,691  
Liabilities for current and deferred taxation   (17,302 ) (16,068 ) (14,211 )
   
 
 
 
Capital employed   101,090   94,045   86,480  
   
 
 
 
(h)
Depreciation consists of charges for depreciation, depletion and amortization of property, plant and equipment, amortization of goodwill and other intangibles and amounts provided against fixed asset investments.

(i)
United Kingdom area includes the UK-based international activities of Refining and Marketing.

(j)
Turnover to third parties is stated by origin which is not materially different from turnover by destination.

F - 102


 
  Year ended December 31, 2004

Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  As
reported

  Reclassification

  US GAAP
presentation

 
   
  ($million)

   
Consolidated statement of income            
Other income   675   2,198   2,873
Share of profits of JVs and associated undertakings   3,577   (3,577 )
Exceptional items before taxation   815     815
Interest expense   642   (206 ) 436
Taxation   8,282   (1,173 ) 7,109
Profit for the year   15,731     15,731

F - 103


 
  Year ended December 31, 2003

Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  As
reported

  Reclassification

  US GAAP
presentation

 
  ($million)

Consolidated statement of income            
Other income   786   1,080   1,866
Share of profits of JVs and associated undertakings   1,438   (1,438 )
Exceptional items before taxation   831     831
Interest expense   644   (134 ) 510
Taxation   6,111   (224 ) 5,887
Profit for the year   10,482     10,482
 
  Year ended December 31, 2002

Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  As
reported

  Reclassification

  US GAAP
presentation

 
  ($million)

Consolidated statement of income            
Other income   641   563   1,204
Share of profits of JVs and associated undertakings   964   (964 )
Exceptional items before taxation   1,168   (2 ) 1,166
Interest expense   1,067   (141 ) 926
Taxation   4,317   (262 ) 4,055
Profit for the year   6,795     6,795

(b)  Exceptional items

(c)  Deferred taxation/Business combinations

F - 104


 
  Years ended December 31,

 
Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($million)

 
Cost of sales   2,048   1,550   852  
Taxation   (1,457 ) (1,381 ) (249 )
Profit for the year   (591 ) (169 ) (603 )
   
 
 
 
 
  At December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Tangible assets   4,052   6,084  
Deferred taxation   5,585   7,022  
BP shareholders' interest   (1,533 ) (938 )
   
 
 
 
  December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($million)

 
Depreciation   (20,434 ) (22,705 )
Other taxable temporary differences   (3,711 ) (3,715 )
   
 
 
Total deferred tax liabilities   (24,145 ) (26,420 )
   
 
 
Petroleum revenue tax   578   601  
Decommissioning and other provisions   1,890   2,743  
Tax credit and loss carry forward   668   105  
Other deductible temporary differences   356   222  
   
 
 
Gross deferred tax assets   3,492   3,671  
Valuation allowance   (888 )  
   
 
 
Net deferred tax assets   2,604   3,671  
   
 
 
Net deferred tax liability*   (21,541 ) (22,749 )
   
 
 

         

F - 105


 
  Years ended December 31,

 
Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($million)

 
Cost of sales   382   188   334  
Other finance expense   (237 ) (173 ) (212 )
Taxation   (5 ) (64 ) (130 )
Profit for the year before cumulative effect of accounting changes   (140 ) 49   8  
Cumulative effect of accounting changes     1,002    
Profit for the year   (140 ) 1,051   8  
   
 
 
 

F - 106


 
  At December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($million)

 
Tangible assets   (1,667 ) (835 )
Provisions   (1,454 ) (636 )
Deferred taxation   (76 ) (71 )
BP shareholders' interest   (137 ) (128 )
   
 
 
 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($million)

 
At January 1, 2004   3,872   3,474  
Exchange adjustments   175   219  
New provisions/adjustment to provisions   (174 ) 855  
Unwinding of discount   208   187  
Utilized/deleted   (183 ) (863 )
   
 
 
    3,898   3,872  
   
 
 

F - 107


        The following pro forma data summarize the results of operations for the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002 assuming SFAS 143 was applied retroactively.

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
  2003 (a)

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Profit for the year applicable to ordinary shares as adjusted to accord with US GAAP        
  As reported   12,939   8,107
  Pro forma   11,937   8,117

Per ordinary share — cents

 

 

 

 
  Basic — as reported   58.36   36.20
  Basic — pro forma   53.84   36.24
 
Diluted — as reported

 

57.79

 

36.02
  Diluted — pro forma   53.33   36.07

Per American Depositary Share — cents

 

 

 

 
  Basic — as reported   350.16   217.20
  Basic — pro forma   323.04   217.44
 
Diluted — as reported

 

346.74

 

216.12
  Diluted — pro forma   319.98   216.42

       

F - 108


 
  Years ended December 31,

Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($million)

Cost of sales   (48 )  
Taxation   18    
Profit for the year   30    
   
 
 
 
  At December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  ($million)

Tangible assets   48  
Deferred taxation   18  
BP shareholders' interest   30  
   
 

F - 109


(f)  Revisions to fair market values

 
  Years ended December 31,

Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Cost of sales     (330 )
Taxation     41  
Profit for the year     289  
   
 
 

(g)  Sale and leaseback

F - 110


 
  Years ended December 31,

 
Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($million)

 
Cost of sales   10   (106 ) (40 )
Taxation   (4 ) 37   16  
Profit for the year   (6 ) 69   24  
   
 
 
 
 
  At December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($million)

 
Other accounts payable and accrued liabilities   21   24  
Provisions   45   32  
Deferred taxation   (23 ) (19 )
BP shareholders' interest   (43 ) (37 )
   
 
 

(h)  Goodwill and intangible assets

F - 111


 
  Years ended December 31,

 
Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($million)

 
Cost of sales   (1,436 ) (1,376 ) (1,302 )
Profit for the year   1,436   1,376   1,302  
   
 
 
 
 
  At December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  ($ million)

Intangible assets   3,207   1,669
BP shareholders' interest   3,207   1,669
   
 
 
  At December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

 
  ($ million)

Exploration licence acquisition cost included in fixed assets (net of accumulated amortization)        
Tangible fixed assets   1,100   1,300
Intangible fixed assets   595   600
   
 

F - 112


 
  Exploration
expenditure

  Goodwill

  Gain on
asset
exchange
(see (j))

  Additional
minimum
pension
liability
(see (k))

  Other
intangibles

  Total

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Net book amount                          
At January 1, 2003   4,944   10,354   167   150   184   15,799  
Amortization expense   (297 )   (19 )   (51 ) (367 )
Other movements   (411 ) 484     (107 ) 104   70  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
At January 1, 2004   4,236   10,838   148   43   237   15,502  
Amortization expense   (274 )   (19 )   (72 ) (365 )
Other movements   (201 ) 566   (83 ) (4 ) 278   556  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31, 2004   3,761   11,404   46   39   443   15,693  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 

(i)  Derivative financial instruments and hedging activities

F - 113


Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Cost of sales   231   (27 ) (842 )
Taxation   (56 ) 15   302  
Profit for the year before cumulative effect of accounting change   (175 ) 12   540  
Cumulative effect of accounting change, net of taxation     50    
Profit for the year   (175 ) 62   540  
   
 
 
 

F - 114


 
  At December 31,

 

 

 

2004


 

2003


 
 
  ($ million)

 
Inventories   100   (150 )
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities   423   (58 )
Deferred taxation   (73 ) (20 )
BP shareholders' interest   (250 ) (72 )
   
 
 

(j)    Gain arising on asset exchange

Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Cost of sales   105   25   27  
Taxation   (37 ) (8 ) (9 )
Profit for the year   (68 ) (17 ) (18 )
   
 
 
 
 
  At December 31,

 

 

 

2004


 

2003


 
 
  ($ million)

 
Intangible assets   46   148  
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities   (48 ) (51 )
Deferred taxation   33   70  
BP shareholders' interest   61   129  
   
 
 

(k)  Pensions and other postretirement benefits

F - 115


Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Cost of sales   330   694   (214 )
Other finance expense   (29 ) (340 ) 139  
Taxation   (254 ) (139 ) 25  
Profit for the year   (47 ) (215 ) 50  
   
 
 
 
 
  At December 31,

 

 

 

2004


 

2003


 
 
  ($ million)

 
Intangible assets   39   43  
Other receivables falling due after more than one year   7,104   6,814  
Provisions for liabilities and charges — other   8,973   7,356  
Defined benefit pension plan surpluses   (1,475 ) (1,146 )
Defined benefit pension plan deficits   5,863   5,005  
Other postretirement benefit plan deficit   2,126   2,630  
Deferred taxation   595   744  
BP shareholders' interest   4,089   5,246  
   
 
 

(l)    Impairments

F - 116


Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Cost of sales   (986 )  
Taxation   309    
Profit for the year   677    
   
 
 
 
  At December 31,


 

 

2004


 

2003

 
  ($ million)

Intangible assets   325  
Tangible assets   661  
Deferred taxation   309  
BP shareholders' interest   677  
   
 

(m) Provisions for severance and operating costs

F - 117


Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Cost of sales   (87 )  
Taxation   27    
Profit for the year   60    
   
 
 
 
  At December 31,


 

 

2004


 

2003

 
  ($ million)

Provisions   (87 )
Deferred taxation   27  
BP shareholders' interest   60  
   
 

(n)  Equity-accounted investments

Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  Years ended December 31,

 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
  ($ million)

Taxation   (226 )  
Profit for the year   226    
   
 
 
 
  At December 31,


 

 

2004


 

2003

 
  ($ million)

Fixed assets — Investments   (226 )
BP shareholders' interest   226  
   
 

F - 118


(o)  Dividends

 
  At December 31,

 
Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Other accounts payable and accrued liabilities   (1,822 ) (1,495 )
BP shareholders' interest   1,822   1,495  
   
 
 

(p)  Investments

 
  At December 31,

Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  2004

  2003

 
  ($ million)

Fixed assets — Investments   344   1,924
Deferred taxation   117   673
BP shareholders' interest   227   1,251
   
 

F - 119


(q)  Consolidation of variable interest entities

 
  At December 31,

 
Increase (decrease) in caption heading

  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Tangible assets   507   217  
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities   (507 ) (217 )
BP shareholders' interest      
   
 
 

(r)   Balance sheet

(s)   Statement of income

F - 120


F - 121


 
  Fair value of contracts at December 31, 2004

 
  Maturity
less than
1 year

  Maturity
1–3 years

  Maturity
4–5 years

  Maturity
over
5 years

  Total
fair
value

 
  ($ million)

Prices actively quoted   111   (89 )     22
Prices provided by other external sources   128   169   62     359
Prices based on models and other valuation methods   4   3   1   62   70
   
 
 
 
 
    243   83   63   62   451
   
 
 
 
 
 
  Fair value of contracts at December 31, 2003

 
 
  Maturity
less than
1 year

  Maturity
1–3 years

  Maturity
4–5 years

  Maturity
over
5 years

  Total
fair
value

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Prices actively quoted   (37 )       (37 )
Prices provided by other external sources   (14 ) 123   32     141  
Prices based on models and other valuation methods   30       37   67  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    (21 ) 123   32   37   171  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 122


 
  Fair value
oil price
contracts

  Fair value
natural gas
and NGL price
contracts

  Fair value
power
price
contracts

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Fair value of contracts at January 1, 2004   (154 ) 191   134  
Contracts realized or settled in the year   154   259   54  
Unrealized gains (losses) recognized at inception of contract   (33 ) 73   (3 )
Unrealized gains (losses) recognized as a result of changes in valuation techniques and assumptions        
Other unrealized gains (losses) recognized during the year   (107 ) (109 ) (8 )
   
 
 
 
Fair value of contracts at December 31, 2004   (140 ) 414   177  
   
 
 
 
Fair value of contracts at January 1, 2003   (66 ) 124   79  
Contracts realized or settled in the year   66   61   49  
Unrealized gains (losses) recognized at inception of contract   (20 ) (64 )  
Unrealized gains (losses) recognized as a result of changes in valuation techniques and assumptions        
Other unrealized gains (losses) recognized during the year   (134 ) 70   6  
   
 
 
 
Fair value of contracts at December 31, 2003   (154 ) 191   134  
   
 
 
 
Fair value of contracts at January 1, 2002   6   208   50  
Contracts realized or settled in the year   (6 ) (194 ) (4 )
Unrealized gains (losses) recognized at inception of contract   1   (162 ) (45 )
Unrealized gains (losses) recognized as a result of changes in valuation techniques and assumptions        
Other unrealized gains (losses) recognized during the year   (67 ) 272   78  
   
 
 
 
Fair value of contracts at December 31, 2002   (66 ) 124   79  
   
 
 
 

F - 123


 
  High

  Low

  Average

  December 31

 
   
  ($ million)

   
2004                
Oil price trading   55   18   29   45
Natural gas and NGL price trading   42   11   23   18
Power price trading   18   2   8   7

2003

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Oil price trading   34   17   26   27
Natural gas and NGL price trading   29   4   16   18
Power price trading   13     4   6

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Oil price trading   34   14   23   19
Natural gas and NGL price trading   18   1   6   9
Power price trading   9   1   4   3

F - 124


        The following is a summary of the adjustments to profit for the year and to BP shareholders' interest which would be required if generally accepted accounting principles in the United States (US GAAP) had been applied instead of those generally accepted in the United Kingdom (UK GAAP).

        These results are stated using the first-in first-out method of inventory valuation.

Profit for the year

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million except per share amounts)

 
Profit as reported in the consolidated statement of income   15,731   10,482   6,795  
Deferred taxation/business combinations (c)   (591 ) (169 ) (603 )
Provisions (d)   (140 ) 49   8  
Oil and natural gas reserve differences (e)   30      
Revisions to fair market values (f)     289    
Sale and leaseback (g)   (6 ) 69   24  
Goodwill and intangible assets (h)   1,436   1,376   1,302  
Derivative financial instruments (i)   (175 ) 12   540  
Gain arising on asset exchange (j)   (68 ) (17 ) (18 )
Pensions and other postretirement benefits (k)   (47 ) (215 ) 50  
Impairments (l)   677      
Provisions for severance and operating costs (m)   60      
Equity-accounted investments (n)   226      
Other   (43 ) 13   11  
   
 
 
 
Profit for the year before cumulative effect of accounting changes as adjusted to accord with US GAAP   17,090   11,889   8,109  
Cumulative effect of accounting changes:              
  Provisions (d)     1,002    
  Derivative financial instruments (i)     50    
   
 
 
 
Profit for the year as adjusted to accord with US GAAP   17,090   12,941   8,109  
Dividend requirements on preference shares   2   2   2  
   
 
 
 
Profit for the year applicable to ordinary shares as adjusted to accord with US GAAP   17,088   12,939   8,107  
   
 
 
 
Profit for the year as adjusted:              
Per ordinary share — cents              
  Basic — before cumulative effect of accounting changes   78.31   53.62   36.20  
  Cumulative effect of accounting changes     4.74    
   
 
 
 
    78.31   58.36   36.20  
   
 
 
 
  Diluted — before cumulative effect of accounting changes   76.88   53.10   36.02  
  Cumulative effect of accounting changes     4.69    
   
 
 
 
    76.88   57.79   36.02  
   
 
 
 
Per American Depositary Share — cents (2)              
  Basic — before cumulative effect of accounting changes   469.86   321.72   217.20  
  Cumulative effect of accounting changes     28.44    
   
 
 
 
    469.86   350.16   217.20  
   
 
 
 
  Diluted — before cumulative effect of accounting changes   461.28   318.60   216.12  
  Cumulative effect of accounting changes     28.14    
   
 
 
 
    461.28   346.74   216.12  
   
 
 
 

F - 125


BP shareholders' interest

 
  December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

 
 
  ($ million)

 
BP shareholders' interest as reported in the consolidated balance sheet   76,656   70,595  
Deferred taxation/business combinations (c)   (1,533 ) (938 )
Provisions (d)   (137 ) (128 )
Oil and natural gas reserve differences (e)   30    
Sale and leaseback (g)   (43 ) (37 )
Goodwill and intangible assets (h)   3,207   1,669  
Derivative financial instruments (i)   (250 ) (72 )
Gain arising on asset exchange (j)   61   129  
Pensions and other postretirement benefits (k)   4,089   5,246  
Impairments (l)   677    
Provisions for severance and operating costs (m)   60    
Equity-accounted investments (n)   226    
Dividends (o)   1,822   1,495  
Investments (p)   227   1,251  
Other     (43 )
   
 
 
BP shareholders' interest as adjusted to accord with US GAAP   85,092   79,167  
   
 
 

(1)
The profit as reported under UK GAAP for the years ended December 31, 2003 and December 31, 2002, and BP shareholders' interest at December 31, 2003, have been restated to reflect the adoption of FRS 17 and UITF 38. Consequently certain of the adjustments in the UK/US GAAP reconciliation have also been restated. Profit for the year and BP shareholders' interest, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, are unaffected by the adoption of FRS 17 and UITF 38.

(2)
One American Depositary Share is equivalent to six ordinary shares.

F - 126


Comprehensive income

        The components of comprehensive income, net of related tax are as follows:

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Profit for the period as adjusted to accord with US GAAP   17,090   12,941   8,109  
Currency translation differences   2,143   3,644   3,284  
Investments              
  Unrealized gains   141   1,316   84  
  Unrealized losses       (48 )
  Less: reclassification adjustment for gains included in net income   (1,165 ) (99 )  
Additional minimum pension liability   (838 ) 1,887   (1,222 )
   
 
 
 
Comprehensive income   17,371   19,689   10,207  
   
 
 
 

        Accumulated other comprehensive income at December 31, 2004 comprised currency translation gains of $4,361 million (gains of $2,218 million at December 31, 2003), pension liability adjustments of $1,115 million ($277 million at December 31, 2003) and net unrealized gains on investments of $227 million ($1,251 million gain at December 31, 2003).

Consolidated statement of cash flows

        The Group's financial statements include a consolidated statement of cash flows in accordance with the revised UK Financial Reporting Standard No. 1 (FRS 1). The statement prepared under FRS 1 presents substantially the same information as that required under FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 95 'Statement of Cash Flows' (SFAS 95).

        Under FRS 1 cash flows are presented for (i) operating activities; (ii) dividends from joint ventures; (iii) dividends from associated undertakings; (iv) servicing of finance and returns on investments; (v) taxation; (vi) capital expenditure and financial investment; (vii) acquisitions and disposals; (viii) dividends; (ix) financing; and (x) management of liquid resources. SFAS 95 only requires presentation of cash flows from operating, investing and financing activities.

        Cash flows under FRS 1 in respect of dividends from joint ventures and associated undertakings, taxation and servicing of finance and returns on investments are included within operating activities under SFAS 95. Interest paid includes payments in respect of capitalized interest, which under SFAS 95 are included in capital expenditure under investing activities. Cash flows under FRS 1 in respect of capital expenditure and acquisitions and disposals are included in investing activities under SFAS 95. Dividends paid are included within financing activities. All short-term investments are regarded as liquid resources for FRS 1. Under SFAS 95 short-term investments with original maturities of three months or less are classified as cash equivalents and aggregated with cash in the cash flow statement. Cash flows in respect of short-term investments with original maturities exceeding three months are included in operating activities.

F - 127



        The statement of consolidated cash flows presented in accordance with SFAS 95 is as follows:

 
  Years ended December 31,

 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Operating activities              
Profit after taxation   15,961   10,652   6,872  
Adjustments to reconcile profit after tax to net cash provided by operating activities              
  Depreciation and amounts provided   12,583   10,940   10,401  
  Exploration expenditure written off   274   297   385  
  Net charge for pensions and other postretirement benefits, less contributions   (39 ) (2,573 ) (178 )
  Share of profits of joint ventures and associated undertakings less dividends received   2   (532 ) 3  
  (Profit) loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets   (815 ) (831 ) (1,166 )
  Working capital movement (a)   (4,073 ) (2,270 ) (1,060 )
  Deferred taxation   200   1,192   1,169  
  Other   181   66   (383 )
   
 
 
 
Net cash provided by operating activities   24,274   16,941   16,043  
   
 
 
 
Investing activities              
Capital expenditures   (13,243 ) (12,567 ) (12,198 )
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired   (1,503 ) (211 ) (4,324 )
Acquisition of investment in TNK-BP joint venture   (1,250 ) (2,351 )  
Investment in associated undertakings   (942 ) (987 ) (971 )
Net investment in joint ventures   (272 ) (178 ) (354 )
Proceeds from disposal of assets   5,048   6,432   6,782  
   
 
 
 
Net cash used in investing activities   (12,162 ) (9,862 ) (11,065 )
   
 
 
 
Financing activities              
Proceeds from shares issued (repurchased)   (7,208 ) (1,889 ) (573 )
Proceeds from long-term financing   2,675   4,322   3,707  
Repayments of long-term financing   (2,204 ) (3,560 ) (2,369 )
Net (decrease) increase in short-term debt   (40 ) (2 ) (602 )
Dividends paid  — BP shareholders   (6,041 ) (5,654 ) (5,264 )
                            — Minority shareholders   (33 ) (20 ) (40 )
   
 
 
 
Net cash used in financing activities   (12,851 ) (6,803 ) (5,141 )
   
 
 
 
Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents   91   121   90  
   
 
 
 
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents   (648 ) 397   (73 )
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year   2,132   1,735   1,808  
   
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year   1,484   2,132   1,735  
   
 
 
 

             

F - 128


(a)  Working capital:              
       Inventories (increase) decrease   (3,595 ) (841 ) (1,521 )
       Receivables (increase) decrease   (10,770 ) (3,025 ) (2,445 )
       Current liabilities — excluding finance debt increase (decrease)   10,292   1,596   2,906  
   
 
 
 
    (4,073 ) (2,270 ) (1,060 )
   
 
 
 

Impact of new US accounting standards

        Other postretirement benefits: In May 2004, the FASB issued Staff Position No. 106-2 'Accounting and Disclosure Requirements Related to the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003' (the Medicare Act). The provisions of the Medicare Act provide for a federal subsidy for plans that provide prescription drug benefits and meet certain qualifications, and alternatively would allow prescription drug plan sponsors to co-ordinate with the Medicare benefit. The Group reflected the impact of the legislation by reducing its actuarially determined obligation for postretirement benefits at December 31, 2004 and will reduce the net cost for postretirement benefits in subsequent periods. The $577 million reduction in liability was reflected as an actuarial gain (assumption change).

        Inventory: In November 2004, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 151 'Inventory Costs an amendment of ARB No. 43, Chapter 4' (SFAS 151). SFAS 151 requires that items, such as idle facility expense, excessive spoilage, double freight and re-handling costs, be recognized as current-period charges. SFAS 151 also requires that the allocation of fixed production overheads to the costs of conversion be based on the normal capacity of the production facilities. SFAS 151 is effective for accounting periods beginning after June 15, 2005. The adoption of SFAS 151 is not expected to have a significant effect on profit, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, or BP shareholders' interest, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP.

        Discontinued operations: In November 2004, the EITF reached a consensus on Issue No. 03-13 'Applying the Conditions in Paragraph 42 of FASB Statement No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets, in Determining Whether to Report Discontinued Operations' (EITF 03-13). Under EITF 03-13, a disposed component of an enterprise is classified as a discontinued operation only where the ongoing entity has no continuing direct cash flows and does not retain an interest, contract or other arrangement sufficient to enable the entity to exert significant influence over the disposed component's operating and financial policies after disposal. EITF 03-13 is effective for a component of an enterprise that is either disposed of or classified as held for sale in accounting periods beginning after December 15, 2004.

        Revenue: In November 2004, the EITF began discussion of Issue No. 04-13 'Accounting for Purchases and Sales of Inventory with the Same Counterparty' (EITF 04-13). EITF 04-13 addresses accounting issues that arise when a company both sells inventory to and buys inventory from another entity in the same line of business. The purchase and sale transactions may be pursuant to a single

F - 129



contractual arrangement or separate contractual arrangements and the inventory purchased or sold may be in the form of raw material, work-in-process or finished goods. At issue is whether the revenue, inventory cost and cost of sales should be recorded at fair value or whether the transactions should be classified as nonmonetary transactions. The EITF, which did not reach a consensus on the issue, requested the FASB staff to further explore the alternative views.

        Practice within the oil and natural gas industry varies for buy/sell arrangements with common counterparties and physical exchanges. The Group accounts for buy/sell arrangements and physical exchanges on a net basis.

        Nonmonetary asset exchanges: In December 2004, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 153 'Exchanges of Nonmonetary Assets an amendment of APB Opinion No. 29' (SFAS 153). SFAS 153 eliminates the Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 29 exception for nonmonetary exchanges of similar productive assets and replaces it with an exception for exchanges of nonmonetary assets that do not have commercial substance. SFAS 153 is effective for nonmonetary asset exchanges occurring in accounting periods beginning after June 15, 2005. The Group adopted SFAS 153 with effect from January 1, 2005. The adoption of SFAS 153 did not have a significant effect on profit, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, or BP shareholders' interest, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP.

        Share options: In December 2004, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123 (revised 2004) 'Share-Based Payment' (SFAS 123R). SFAS 123R, which is a revision of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123 'Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation' (SFAS 123), supersedes APB Opinion No. 25 'Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees'. Under SFAS 123R, share-based payments to employees and others are required to be recognized in the income statement based on their fair value. Pro forma disclosure is no longer a permitted alternative. SFAS 123R must be adopted no later than July 1, 2005.

        The Group currently accounts for share-based employee compensation based on the intrinsic value method and, as such, generally recognizes no compensation cost for employee share options. Disclosure of the pro forma effect on net income and earnings per share if the Group had applied the fair value recognition provisions of SFAS 123 to share-based employee compensation in prior years is included in Note 38.

        Effective January 1, 2005, as part of the adoption of IFRS, the Group adopted International Financial Reporting Standard No. 2 'Share-based Payment' (IFRS 2). IFRS 2 requires the recognition of expense when goods or services are received from employees or others in consideration for equity instruments or amounts that are based on the value of an entity's equity instruments. The recognition and measurement provisions of IFRS 2 are similar to those of SFAS 123R.

        In adopting IFRS 2, the Group elected to restate prior years to recognize the expense associated with equity-settled share-based payment transactions that were not fully vested as of January 1, 2003 and the liability associated with cash-settled share-based payment transactions as of January 1, 2003.

        The Group adopted SFAS 123R with effect from January 1, 2005. Had the Group adopted SFAS 123R in prior years, the impact would have approximated the pro forma expense included in Note 38.

F - 130



        Taxation: In December 2004, the FASB issued Staff Position No. 109-1 'Application of FASB Statement No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes, to the Tax Deduction on Qualified Production Activities Provided by the American Jobs Creation Act of 2004' (FSP 109-1). FSP 109-1, effective upon issuance, requires that the manufacturers' deduction provided for under the American Jobs Creation Act of 2004 (the Jobs Creation Act) be accounted for as a special deduction in accordance with FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 109, 'Accounting for Income Taxes,' rather than a tax rate reduction. The manufacturers' deduction will be recognized by the Company in the year the benefit is earned.

        In December 2004, the FASB issued Staff Position No. 109-2 'Accounting and Disclosure Guidance for the Foreign Earnings Repatriation Provision within the American Jobs Creation Act of 2004' (FSP 109-2). The Jobs Creation Act provides a special one-time provision allowing earnings of certain non-US companies to be repatriated to a US parent company at a reduced tax rate. FSP 109-2, effective upon issuance, permits additional time beyond the financial reporting period of enactment in order to evaluate the effect of the Jobs Creation Act without undermining an entity's assertion that repatriation of non-US earnings to a US parent company is not expected within the foreseeable future. As provided by FSP 109-2, the Group has elected to defer a decision on potentially altering current plans regarding the permanent reinvestment in certain non-US subsidiaries and corporate joint ventures. The income tax effects associated with any repatriation of unremitted earnings as a result of the Jobs Creation Act cannot be reasonably estimated at this time.

        Provisions: In March 2005, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 47 'Accounting for Conditional Asset Retirement Obligations an interpretation of FASB Statement No. 143' (Interpretation 47). Under Interpretation 47, a conditional asset retirement obligation represents an unconditional obligation to perform an asset retirement activity where the timing or method of settlement are conditional on a future event that may or may not be within the control of the entity. Interpretation 47 clarifies that an entity is required to recognize a liability, when incurred, for the fair value of a conditional asset retirement obligation if the fair value of the liability can be reasonably estimated. Uncertainty about the timing or method of settlement of a conditional asset retirement obligation is factored into the measurement of the liability when sufficient information exists. SFAS 143 acknowledges that in some cases, sufficient information may not be available to reasonably estimate the fair value of an asset retirement obligation. Interpretation 47 also clarifies when an entity would have sufficient information to reasonably estimate the fair value of an asset retirement obligation. Interpretation 47 is effective for fiscal years ending after December 15, 2005. The Group has not yet completed its evaluation of the impact of adopting Interpretation 47 on the Group's profit, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, or BP shareholders' interest, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP.

        Fixed assets: FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 19 'Financial Accounting and Reporting by Oil and Gas Producing Companies' (SFAS 19) requires the cost of drilling an exploratory well (exploration or exploratory-type stratigraphic test wells) to be capitalized pending determination of whether the well has found proved reserves. If this determination cannot be made at the conclusion of drilling, SFAS 19 sets out additional requirements for continuing to carry the cost of the well as an asset. These requirements include firm plans for further drilling and a one-year time limitation on continued capitalization in certain situations. Subsequent to the issuance of SFAS 19, as a result of the

F - 131



increasing complexity of oil and gas projects due to drilling in remote and deepwater offshore locations, entities increasingly require more than one year to complete all of the activities that permit recognition of proved reserves. In addition, because of new technologies, in certain situations additional exploratory wells may no longer be required before a project can commence.

        In April 2005, the FASB issued Staff Position No. 19-1 'Accounting for Suspended Well Costs' (FSP 19-1). FSP 19-1 amends SFAS 19 to permit the continued capitalization of exploratory well costs beyond one year if (a) the well found a sufficient quantity of reserves to justify its completion as a producing well and (b) the entity is making sufficient progress assessing the reserves and the economic and operating viability of the project. If either condition is not met, or if an entity obtains information that raises substantial doubt about the economic or operational viability of the project, the exploratory well is assumed to be impaired, and its costs, net of any salvage value, is charged to expense. FSP 19-1 provides a number of indicators that would be considered in order to demonstrate that sufficient progress was being made in assessing the reserves and the economic viability of the project. FSP 19-1 is effective for accounting periods beginning after April 4, 2005. Early application of the guidance is permitted in periods for which financial statements have not yet been issued.

        BP's accounting policy is that costs directly associated with an exploration well are capitalized as an intangible asset until the drilling of the well is complete and the results have been evaluated. If hydrocarbons are found, and, subject to further appraisal activity which may include the drilling of further wells (exploration or exploratory-type stratigraphic test wells), are likely to be capable of commercial development, the costs continue to be carried as an asset. All such carried costs are subject to technical, commercial and management review at least once a year to confirm the continued intent to develop or otherwise extract value from the discovery. When this is no longer the case, the costs are written off. When proved reserves of oil and natural gas are determined and development is sanctioned, the relevant expenditure is transferred to tangible production assets. We have adopted the FSP with effect from January 1, 2004. No previously capitalized costs were expensed upon the adoption of the FSP.

        Accounting changes and error corrections: In May 2005, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 154 'Accounting Changes and Error Corrections, a replacement of APB Opinion No. 20 and FASB Statement No. 3' (SFAS 154). SFAS 154 applies to all voluntary changes in accounting principle and changes the requirements for the accounting for and reporting of a change in accounting principle. SFAS 154 requires retrospective application to prior period financial statements of a voluntary change in accounting principle unless it is impracticable. Previously, most voluntary changes in accounting principle were recognized by including in net income of the period of the change the cumulative effect of changing to the new accounting principle. SFAS 154 also requires that a change in the method of depreciation, amortization or depletion for long-lived nonfinancial assets be accounted for as a change in accounting estimate that is effected by a change in accounting principle. Previously, such changes were reported as a change in accounting principle. SFAS 154 is effective for accounting changes and corrections of errors made in accounting periods beginning after December 15, 2005. The adoption of SFAS 154 is not expected to have a significant effect on profit, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP, or BP shareholders' interest, as adjusted to accord with US GAAP.

F - 132



Impact of new UK Accounting Standards adopted in 2004

        In December 2000, the UK Accounting Standards Board issued Financial Reporting Standard No. 17 'Retirement Benefits' (FRS 17). This standard was to be fully effective for accounting periods ending on or after June 22, 2003 with certain of the disclosure requirements effective for periods prior to 2003. However, in November 2002, the UK Accounting Standards Board issued an amendment to FRS 17, which allows deferral of full adoption no later than January 1, 2005; although the disclosure requirements apply to periods prior to 2005. FRS 17 requires that financial statements reflect at fair value the assets and liabilities arising from an employer's retirement benefit obligations and any related funding. The operating costs of providing retirement benefits are recognized in the period in which they are earned together with any related finance costs and changes in the value of related assets and liabilities.

        With effect from January 1, 2004, BP has fully adopted FRS 17. This change in accounting policy results in a prior year adjustment. Upon adoption, shareholders' interest at January 1, 2002 has been reduced by $132 million, profit for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2003 have been (decreased) increased by $(50) million and $215 million, respectively, and total recognized gains and losses relating to the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2003 have been (decreased) increased by $(5,469) million and $78 million, respectively.

        In addition, with effect from January 1, 2004 BP has also changed its accounting policy for shares held in employee share ownership plans for the benefit of employee share schemes.

        Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract No. 38 'Accounting for Employee Share Ownership Plan (ESOP) trusts' (Abstract 38) changes the presentation of an entity's own shares held in an ESOP trust from requiring them to be recognized as assets to requiring them to be deducted in arriving at shareholders' funds. Transactions in an entity's own shares by an ESOP trust are similarly recorded as changes in shareholders' funds and do not give rise to gains or losses. This treatment is in line with the accounting for purchases and sales of own shares set out in Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract No. 37 'Purchases and Sales of Own Shares' (Abstract 37).

        Abstract 37 requires a holding of an entity's own shares to be accounted for as a deduction in arriving at shareholders' funds, rather than being recorded as assets. Transactions in an entity's own shares are similarly recorded as changes in shareholders' funds and do not give rise to gains or losses. Abstract 37 applies where a company purchases treasury shares under new legislation that came into effect in December 2003.

        Urgent Issues Task Force Abstract No. 17 'Employee share schemes' (Abstract 17) was amended by Abstract 38 to reflect the consequences for the profit and loss account of the changes in the presentation of an entity's own shares held by an ESOP trust. Amended Abstract 17 requires that the minimum expense should be the difference between the fair value of the shares at the date of award and the amount that an employee may be required to pay for the shares (i.e. the 'intrinsic value' of the award). The expense was previously determined either as the intrinsic value or, where purchases of shares had been made by an ESOP trust at fair value, by reference to the cost or book value of shares that were available for the award. The effect of adopting Abstract 17 is to reduce BP shareholders' interest at January 1, 2002 by $18 million; the impact on profit before taxation for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2003 is negligible.

F - 133



Impact of International Accounting Standards

        An 'International Accounting Standards Regulation' was adopted by the Council of the European Union (EU) in June 2002. This regulation requires all EU companies listed on an EU stock exchange to use 'endorsed' International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), published by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB), to report their consolidated results with effect from 1 January 2005. The IASB completed its development of IFRS to be adopted in 2005 during the first half of 2004, but has also published certain amendments and interpretations of IFRS which would be available for early adoption if endorsed by the EU.

        The process of endorsement of IFRS by the EU to allow adoption by companies in 2005 is well advanced but not yet complete.

        BP's project team includes a broadly based representation from across the Group designed to plan for and achieve a smooth transition to IFRS. The project team has examined all implementation aspects, including changes to accounting policies, the presentation of the Group's results, systems impacts and the wider business issues that may arise from such a fundamental change. The Group has reported its results from the first quarter of 2005 using IFRS. However, the implementation may still be affected by developments in the IASB's standard-setting process and the endorsement of standards and interpretations by the EU.

        The Group has decided that, for the purposes of the restatement of prior periods currently reported under UK GAAP, the date of transition to IFRS is January 1, 2003. However, in accordance with the provisions of IFRS 1, the date of adoption of International Accounting Standards Nos. 32 and 39, which deal with the recognition and presentation of financial instruments, is set at January 1, 2005, with no restatement of prior periods' results.

        The process of finalizing the restatements of the results and financial position for 2003 and 2004 under IFRS, was completed in March 2005. The major effects of changing from current accounting practice to IFRS are in the following areas: goodwill acquired in a business combination; deferred tax related to business combinations and in respect of the valuation of stocks; accounting for items falling within the scope of IAS Nos. 32 and 39, including embedded derivatives and hedge accounting; the treatment of major overhaul expenditure; exchanges of fixed assets; recognition of dividend liabilities; and share-based payments. Certain joint arrangements with third parties, where BP currently accounts for its share of individual assets, liabilities, income and expense, will be accounted for using the equity method, resulting in reclassifications within the income statement and balance sheet.

        The adoption of IFRS, subject to developments in the standard-setting process and the endorsement of standards and interpretations, resulted in a $1,344 million and $1,966 million increase in profit for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2003, respectively, and a $236 million increase in BP shareholders' interest at December 31, 2004.

F - 134


Note 51 — Condensed consolidating information on certain US Subsidiaries

        BP p.l.c. fully and unconditionally guarantees the payment obligations of its 100% owned subsidiary BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. under the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust. The following financial information for BP p.l.c., and BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. and all other subsidiaries on a condensed consolidating basis is intended to provide investors with meaningful and comparable financial information about BP p.l.c. and its subsidiary issuers of debt securities and is provided pursuant to Rule 3-10 of Regulation S-X in lieu of the separate financial statements of each subsidiary issuer of public debt securities. Investments include the investments in subsidiaries recorded under the equity method for the purposes of the condensed consolidating financial information. Equity income of subsidiaries is the Group's share of operating profit related to such investments. The eliminations and reclassifications column includes the necessary amounts to eliminate the intercompany balances and transactions between BP p.l.c., BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. and other subsidiaries.

F - 135



Income statement

 
  Issuer
  Guarantor
   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Year ended December 31, 2004                      
Turnover   3,811     294,849   (3,811 ) 294,849  
Less: Joint ventures       9,790     9,790  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Group turnover   3,811     285,059   (3,811 ) 285,059  
Cost of sales   1,439     249,601   (3,930 ) 247,110  
Production taxes   267     1,882     2,149  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Gross profit   2,105     33,576   119   35,800  
Distribution and administration expenses   3   1,302   13,683     14,988  
Exploration expense   4     633     637  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    2,098   (1,302 ) 19,260   119   20,175  
Other income   23   1,296   715   (1,359 ) 675  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Group operating profit   2,121   (6 ) 19,975   (1,240 ) 20,850  
Share of profits of joint ventures       2,943     2,943  
Share of profits of associated undertakings       634     634  
Equity-accounted income of subsidiaries   707   25,444     (26,151 )  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Total operating profit   2,828   25,438   23,552   (27,391 ) 24,427  
Profit (loss) on sale of businesses or termination of operations     (695 ) (695 ) 695   (695 )
Profit (loss) on sale of fixed assets     1,510   1,510   (1,510 ) 1,510  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit before interest and tax   2,828   26,253   24,367   (28,206 ) 25,242  
Interest expense   43   1,883   1,901   (3,185 ) 642  
Other finance expense   16   357   693   (709 ) 357  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit before taxation   2,769   24,013   21,773   (24,312 ) 24,243  
Taxation   937   8,282   7,683   (8,620 ) 8,282  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit after taxation   1,832   15,731   14,090   (15,692 ) 15,961  
Minority shareholders' interest       230     230  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit for the year   1,832   15,731   13,860   (15,692 ) 15,731  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 136


        The following is a summary of the adjustments to the profit for the period which would be required if generally accepted accounting principles in the United States (US GAAP) had been applied instead of those generally accepted in the United Kingdom.

 
  Issuer
  Guarantor
   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Year ended December 31, 2004                      
Profit as reported   1,832   15,731   13,860   (15,692 ) 15,731  
Adjustments:                      
  Deferred taxation/business combinations   (11 ) (591 ) (580 ) 591   (591 )
  Provisions   (1 ) (140 ) (138 ) 139   (140 )
  Oil and natural gas reserve differences     30   30   (30 ) 30  
  Sale and leaseback     (6 ) (6 ) 6   (6 )
  Goodwill and intangible assets     1,436   1,436   (1,436 ) 1,436  
  Derivative financial instruments     (175 ) (175 ) 175   (175 )
  Gain arising on asset exchange     (68 ) (68 ) 68   (68 )
  Pensions and other postretirement benefits     (47 ) (70 ) 70   (47 )
  Impairments     677   677   (677 ) 677  
  Provisions for severance and operating costs     60   60   (60 ) 60  
  Equity-accounted investments     226   226   (226 ) 226  
  Other     (43 ) (43 ) 43   (43 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit for the year as adjusted to accord with US GAAP   1,820   17,090   15,209   (17,029 ) 17,090  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 137


 
  Issuer
  Guarantor
   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Year ended December 31, 2003                      
Turnover   3,168     236,045   (3,168 ) 236,045  
Less: Joint ventures       3,474     3,474  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Group turnover   3,168     232,571   (3,168 ) 232,571  
Cost of sales   1,436     203,168   (3,269 ) 201,335  
Production taxes   242     1,481     1,723  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Gross profit   1,490     27,922   101   29,513  
Distribution and administration expenses   4   671   13,397     14,072  
Exploration expense   14     528     542  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    1,472   (671 ) 13,997   101   14,899  
Other income   21   1,413   291   (939 ) 786  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Group operating profit   1,493   742   14,288   (838 ) 15,685  
Share of profits of joint ventures       924     924  
Share of profits of associated undertakings.       514     514  
Equity-accounted income of subsidiaries   420   17,049     (17,469 )  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Total operating profit   1,913   17,791   15,726   (18,307 ) 17,123  
Profit (loss) on sale of businesses or termination of operations     (13 ) (28 ) 13   (28 )
Profit (loss) on sale of fixed assets   (1 ) 859   860   (859 ) 859  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit before interest and tax   1,912   18,637   16,558   (19,153 ) 17,954  
Interest expense   288   1,482   1,325   (2,451 ) 644  
Other finance expense   11   547   740   (751 ) 547  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit before taxation   1,613   16,608   14,493   (15,951 ) 16,763  
Taxation   741   6,111   5,449   (6,190 ) 6,111  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit after taxation   872   10,497   9,044   (9,761 ) 10,652  
Minority shareholders' interest       170     170  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit for the year   872   10,497   8,874   (9,761 ) 10,482  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 138


        The following is a summary of the adjustments to the profit for the period which would be required if generally accepted accounting principles in the United States (US GAAP) had been applied instead of those generally accepted in the United Kingdom.

 
  Issuer
  Guarantor
   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Year ended December 31, 2003                      
Profit as reported   872   10,497   8,874   (9,761 ) 10,482  
Adjustments:                      
  Deferred taxation/business combinations   (12 ) (169 ) (149 ) 161   (169 )
  Provisions   (5 ) 49   90   (85 ) 49  
  Revisions to fair market values     289   289   (289 ) 289  
  Sale and leaseback     69   69   (69 ) 69  
  Goodwill and intangible assets     1,376   1,376   (1,376 ) 1,376  
  Derivative financial instruments   (13 ) 12   12   1   12  
  Gain arising on asset exchange     (17 ) (17 ) 17   (17 )
  Pensions and other postretirement benefits     (215 ) (583 ) 583   (215 )
  Other     13   13   (13 ) 13  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit for the year before cumulative effect of accounting changes as adjusted to accord with US GAAP   842   11,904   9,974   (10,831 ) 11,889  
Cumulative effect of accounting changes:                      
  Provisions   221   1,002   788   (1,009 ) 1,002  
  Derivative financial instruments     50   50   (50 ) 50  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit for the year as adjusted to accord with US GAAP   1,063   12,956   10,812   (11,890 ) 12,941  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 139


 
  Issuer
  Guarantor
   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Year ended December 31, 2002                      
Turnover   2,356     180,122   (2,292 ) 180,186  
Less: Joint ventures       1,465     1,465  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Group turnover   2,356     178,657   (2,292 ) 178,721  
Cost of sales   1,450     155,603   (2,438 ) 154,615  
Production taxes   199     1,075     1,274  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Gross profit   707     21,979   146   22,832  
Distribution and administration expenses   12   1,025   11,595     12,632  
Exploration expense   34     610     644  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    661   (1,025 ) 9,774   146   9,556  
Other income   31   752   446   (588 ) 641  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Group operating profit   692   (273 ) 10,220   (442 ) 10,197  
Share of profits of joint ventures       347     347  
Share of profits of associated undertakings.       617     617  
Equity-accounted income of subsidiaries   299   11,790     (12,089 )  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Total operating profit   991   11,517   11,184   (12,531 ) 11,161  
Profit (loss) on sale of businesses or termination of operations     884   (33 ) (884 ) (33 )
Profit (loss) on sale of fixed assets   (4 ) 1,226   1,205   (1,226 ) 1,201  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit before interest and tax   987   13,627   12,356   (14,641 ) 12,329  
Interest expense   83   1,500   1,400   (1,916 ) 1,067  
Other finance expense   10   73   483   (493 ) 73  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit before taxation   894   12,054   10,473   (12,232 ) 11,189  
Taxation   344   4,317   4,040   (4,384 ) 4,317  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit after taxation   550   7,737   6,433   (7,848 ) 6,872  
Minority shareholders' interest       77     77  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit for the year   550   7,737   6,356   (7,848 ) 6,795  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 140


        The following is a summary of the adjustments to the profit for the period which would be required if generally accepted accounting principles in the United States (US GAAP) had been applied instead of those generally accepted in the United Kingdom.

 
  Issuer
  Guarantor
   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Year ended December 31, 2002                      
Profit as reported   550   7,737   6,356   (7,848 ) 6,795  
Adjustments:                      
  Deferred taxation/business combinations   (129 ) (603 ) (520 ) 649   (603 )
  Provisions   (1 ) 8   9   (8 ) 8  
  Sale and leaseback     24   24   (24 ) 24  
  Goodwill and intangible assets     1,302   1,302   (1,302 ) 1,302  
  Derivative financial instruments   (50 ) 540   540   (490 ) 540  
  Gain arising on asset exchange     (18 ) (18 ) 18   (18 )
  Pensions and other postretirement benefits     50   442   (442 ) 50  
  Other     11   11   (11 ) 11  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Profit for the year as adjusted to accord with US GAAP   370   9,051   8,146   (9,458 ) 8,109  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 141


Note 51 — Condensed consolidating information on certain US Subsidiaries (continued)

Balance sheet

 
  Issuer

  Guarantor

   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
At December 31, 2004                      
Fixed assets                      
Intangible assets   418     11,658     12,076  
Tangible assets   6,326     90,422     96,748  
Investments                      
  Subsidiaries — equity-accounted basis   3,069   108,670     (111,739 )  
  Other     2   18,404     18,406  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    3,069   108,672   18,404   (111,739 ) 18,406  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Total fixed assets   9,813   108,672   120,484   (111,739 ) 127,230  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Current assets                      
Inventories   107     15,591     15,698  
Receivables — amounts falling due:                      
  Within one year   7,644   791   51,095   (15,135 ) 44,395  
  After more than one year   5,244   1,451   5,151   (9,545 ) 2,301  
Investments       328     328  
Cash at bank and in hand   (1 ) 4   1,153     1,156  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    12,994   2,246   73,318   (24,680 ) 63,878  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Current liabilities — amounts falling due within one year                      
Finance debt   57     10,127     10,184  
Other payables   1,635   9,508   58,333   (15,135 ) 54,341  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Net current assets (liabilities)   11,302   (7,262 ) 4,858   (9,545 ) (647 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets less current liabilities   21,115   101,410   125,342   (121,284 ) 126,583  
Noncurrent liabilities                      
Finance debt       12,907     12,907  
Other payables   4,263   76   9,711   (9,545 ) 4,505  
Provisions for liabilities and charges                      
Deferred taxation   1,745     13,305     15,050  
Other   549     9,059     9,608  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Net assets excluding pension and other postretirement benefit balances   14,558   101,334   80,360   (111,739 ) 84,513  
Defined benefit pension plan surpluses     1,465   10     1,475  
Defined benefit pension plan deficits   81     5,782     5,863  
Other postretirement benefit plan deficit       2,126     2,126  
Net assets   14,477   102,799   72,462   (111,739 ) 77,999  
Minority shareholders' interest — equity       1,343     1,343  
   
 
 
 
 
 
BP Shareholders' interest   14,477   102,799   71,119   (111,739 ) 76,656  
   
 
 
 
 
 
                       

F - 142



At December 31, 2004

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Capital and reserves                      
Capital shares   3,353   5,403     (3,353 ) 5,403  
Paid in surplus   3,145   6,366     (3,145 ) 6,366  
Merger reserve     26,465   697     27,162  
Other reserves     44       44  
Shares held by ESOP trusts     (82 )     (82 )
Retained earnings   7,979   64,603   70,422   (105,241 ) 37,763  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    14,477   102,799   71,119   (111,739 ) 76,656  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 143


        The following is a summary of the adjustments to BP shareholders' interest which would be required if generally accepted accounting principles in the United States (US GAAP) had been applied instead of those generally accepted in the United Kingdom.

 
  Issuer

  Guarantor

   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
At December 31, 2004                      
BP Shareholders' interest as reported   14,477   102,799   71,119   (111,739 ) 76,656  
Adjustments:                      
  Deferred taxation/business combinations   51   (1,533 ) (1,584 ) 1,533   (1,533 )
  Provisions   26   (137 ) (162 ) 136   (137 )
  Oil and natural gas reserve differences     30   30   (30 ) 30  
  Sale and leaseback     (43 ) (43 ) 43   (43 )
  Goodwill and intangible assets     3,207   3,207   (3,207 ) 3,207  
  Derivative financial instruments   (63 ) (250 ) (250 ) 313   (250 )
  Gain arising on asset exchange     61   61   (61 ) 61  
  Pensions and other postretirement benefits   82   4,089   1,017   (1,099 ) 4,089  
  Impairments     677   677   (677 ) 677  
  Provisions for severance and operating costs     60   60   (60 ) 60  
  Equity-accounted investments     226   226   (226 ) 226  
  Dividends     1,822   1,822   (1,822 ) 1,822  
  Investments     227   227   (227 ) 227  
  Other            
   
 
 
 
 
 
BP Shareholders' interest as adjusted to accord with US GAAP   14,573   111,235   76,407   (117,123 ) 85,092  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 144


 
  Issuer

   
   
   
   
 
 
  Guarantor

   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

   
  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

   
 

 

 

BP p.l.c.


 

Other
subsidiaries


 

BP Group


 
 
  ($ million)

 
At December 31, 2003                      
Fixed assets                      
Intangible assets   424     13,218     13,642  
Tangible assets   6,432     85,479     91,911  
Investments                      
  Subsidiaries — equity-accounted basis   2,814   83,123     (85,937 )  
  Other     2   17,456     17,458  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    2,814   83,125   17,456   (85,937 ) 17,458  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Total fixed assets   9,670   83,125   116,153   (85,937 ) 123,011  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Current assets                      
Inventories   102     11,515     11,617  
Receivables — amounts falling due:                      
  Within one year   9,782   865   36,272   (15,535 ) 31,384  
  After more than one year   1,368   23,751   6,753   (29,354 ) 2,518  
Investments       185     185  
Cash at bank and in hand   (5 ) 3   1,949     1,947  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    11,247   24,619   56,674   (44,889 ) 47,651  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Current liabilities — amounts falling due within one year                      
Finance debt   55     9,401     9,456  
Other payables   1,541   6,802   48,320   (15,535 ) 41,128  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Net current assets (liabilities)   9,651   17,817   (1,047 ) (29,354 ) (2,933 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets less current liabilities   19,321   100,942   115,106   (115,291 ) 120,078  
Noncurrent liabilities                      
Finance debt       12,869     12,869  
Other payables   4,272   50   31,062   (29,354 ) 6,030  
Provisions for liabilities and charges                      
Deferred taxation   1,745     12,626     14,371  
Other   505     8,094     8,599  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Net assets excluding pension and other postretirement benefit balances   12,799   100,892   50,455   (85,937 ) 78,209  
Defined benefit pension plan surpluses     1,093   53     1,146  
Defined benefit pension plan deficits   82     4,923     5,005  
Other postretirement benefit plan deficit       2,630     2,630  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Net assets   12,717   101,985   42,955   (85,937 ) 71,720  
Minority shareholders' interest — equity       1,125     1,125  
   
 
 
 
 
 
BP Shareholders' interest   12,717   101,985   41,830   (85,937 ) 70,595  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 145


 
  Issuer

   
   
   
   
 
 
  Guarantor

   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

   
  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

   
 

 

 

BP p.l.c.


 

Other
subsidiaries


 

BP Group


 
 
  ($ million)

 

At December 31, 2003

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Capital and reserves                      
Capital shares   1,903   5,552     (1,903 ) 5,552  
Paid in surplus   3,145   4,480     (3,145 ) 4,480  
Merger reserve     26,380   697     27,077  
Other reserves     129       129  
Shares held by ESOP trusts     (96 )     (96 )
Retained earnings   7,669   65,540   41,133   (80,889 ) 33,453  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    12,717   101,985   41,830   (85,937 ) 70,595  
   
 
 
 
 
 

        The following is a summary of the adjustments to BP shareholders' interest which would be required if generally accepted accounting principles in the United States (US GAAP) had been applied instead of those generally accepted in the United Kingdom.

 
  Issuer

  Guarantor

   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
BP Shareholders' interest as reported   12,717   101,985   41,830   (85,937 ) 70,595  
Adjustments:                      
  Deferred taxation/business combinations   62   (938 ) (1,000 ) 938   (938 )
  Provisions   27   (128 ) (155 ) 128   (128 )
  Sale and leaseback     (37 ) (37 ) 37   (37 )
  Goodwill and intangible assets     1,669   1,669   (1,669 ) 1,669  
  Derivative financial instruments   (63 ) (72 ) (9 ) 72   (72 )
  Gain arising on asset exchange     129   129   (129 ) 129  
  Pension and other postretirement benefits   82   5,246   3,688   (3,770 ) 5,246  
  Dividends     1,495       1,495  
  Investments     1,251   1,251   (1,251 ) 1,251  
  Other     (43 ) (43 ) 43   (43 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
BP Shareholders' interest as adjusted to accord with US GAAP   12,825   110,557   47,323   (91,538 ) 79,167  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 146


Cash flow statement

 
  Issuer

  Guarantor

   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Year ended December 31, 2004                      
Net cash inflow (outflow) from operating activities   2,593   24,947   331   683   28,554  
Dividends from joint ventures       1,908     1,908  
Dividends from associated undertakings       291     291  
Dividends from subsidiaries   16   18,489     (18,505 )  
Net cash inflow (outflow) from servicing of finance and returns on investments   (61 ) 1,391   (989 ) (683 ) (342 )
Tax paid   (142 ) (60 ) (6,176 )   (6,378 )
Net cash inflow (outflow) for capital expenditure and financial investment   (364 ) (31,517 ) 23,169     (8,712 )
Net cash inflow (outflow) for acquisitions and disposals       (3,242 )   (3,242 )
Equity dividends paid     (6,041 ) (18,505 ) 18,505   (6,041 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
Net cash inflow (outflow)   2,042   7,209   (3,213 )   6,038  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Financing   2,038   7,208   (2,469 )   6,777  
Management of liquid resources       132     132  
Increase (decrease) in cash   4   1   (876 )   (871 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
    2,042   7,209   (3,213 )   6,038  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 147


        The consolidated statement of cash flows presented in accordance with SFAS 95 is as follows:

 
  Issuer

  Guarantor

   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities   2,467   44,767   (4,635 ) (18,325 ) 24,274  
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities   (364 ) (31,517 ) 19,927   (208 ) (12,162 )
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities   (2,099 ) (13,249 ) (16,036 ) 18,533   (12,851 )
Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents       91     91  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents   4   1   (653 )   (648 )
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year   (5 ) 3   2,134     2,132  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year   (1 ) 4   1,481     1,484  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 148


 
  Issuer

  Guarantor

   
   
   
 

 

 

BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc


 

BP p.l.c.


 

Other
subsidiaries


 

Eliminations
and
reclassifications


 

BP Group


 
 
  ($ million)

 
Year ended December 31, 2003                      
Net cash inflow (outflow) from operating activities   1,774   (16,970 ) 36,877   17   21,698  
Dividends from joint ventures       131     131  
Dividends from associated undertakings       417     417  
Dividends from subsidiaries   18   27,914     (27,932 )  
Net cash inflow (outflow) from servicing of finance and returns on investments   (58 ) 578   (1,231 )   (711 )
Tax paid   (104 ) (6 ) (4,694 )   (4,804 )
Net cash inflow (outflow) for capital expenditure and financial investment   (389 ) (4,051 ) (1,684 )   (6,124 )
Net cash outflow for acquisitions and disposals   8   17   (3,556 ) (17 ) (3,548 )
Equity dividends paid     (5,654 ) (27,932 ) 27,932   (5,654 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
Net cash inflow (outflow)   1,249   1,828   (1,672 )   1,405  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Financing   1,243   1,826   (1,940 )   1,129  
Management of liquid resources       (41 )   (41 )
Increase (decrease) in cash   6   2   309     317  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    1,249   1,828   (1,672 )   1,405  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 149


        The consolidated statement of cash flows presented in accordance with SFAS 95 is as follows:

 
  Issuer

  Guarantor

   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities   1,687   11,517   31,500   (27,763 ) 16,941  
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities   (381 ) (4,034 ) (5,240 ) (207 ) (9,862 )
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities   (1,300 ) (7,481 ) (25,992 ) 27,970   (6,803 )
Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents       121     121  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents   6   2   389     397  
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year   (11 ) 1   1,745     1,735  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year   (5 ) 3   2,134     2,132  
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 150


 
  Issuer

  Guarantor

   
   
   
 

 

 

BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc


 

BP p.l.c.


 

Other
subsidiaries


 

Eliminations
and
reclassifications


 

BP Group


 
 
  ($ million)

 
Year ended December 31, 2002                      
Net cash inflow (outflow) from operating activities   1,357   9,108   13,308   (4,431 ) 19,342  
Dividends from joint ventures       198     198  
Dividends from associated undertakings       368     368  
Dividends from subsidiaries   26   761     (787 )  
Net cash inflow (outflow) from servicing of finance and returns on investments   (28 ) 235   (1,118 )   (911 )
Tax paid   (75 ) (2 ) (3,017 )   (3,094 )
Net cash inflow (outflow) for capital expenditure and financial investment   (1,097 ) 169   (8,700 )   (9,628 )
Net cash outflow for acquisitions and disposals     (4,431 ) (1,337 ) 4,431   (1,337 )
Equity dividends paid     (5,264 ) (787 ) 787   (5,264 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
Net cash inflow (outflow)   183   576   (1,085 )   (326 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
Financing   165   578   (906 )   (163 )
Management of liquid resources       (220 )   (220 )
Increase (decrease) in cash   18   (2 ) 41     57  
   
 
 
 
 
 
    183   576   (1,085 )   (326 )
   
 
 
 
 
 

F - 151


        The consolidated statement of cash flows presented in accordance with SFAS 95 is as follows:

 
  Issuer

  Guarantor

   
   
   
 
 
  BP
Exploration
(Alaska) Inc

  BP p.l.c.

  Other
subsidiaries

  Eliminations
and
reclassifications

  BP Group

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities   1,307   10,102   9,753   (5,119 ) 16,043  
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities   (1,097 ) (4,261 ) (10,052 ) 4,345   (11,065 )
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities   (192 ) (5,843 ) 120   774   (5,141 )
Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents       90     90  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents   18   (2 ) (89 )   (73 )
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year   (29 ) 3   1,834     1,808  
   
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year   (11 ) 1   1,745     1,735  
   
 
 
 
 
 

Note 52 — Post balance sheet events

        In December 2005, BP sold Innovene, its olefins, derivatives and refining group, to INEOS. Gross proceeds received initially amounted to $8,477 million, which is subject to revision for closing adjustments. There were selling costs of $120 million. A loss before tax of $694 million was recognized on the remeasurement to fair value less costs to sell of the Innovene operations.

        BP announced in April 2006 the sale of its remaining Gulf of Mexico Shelf exploration and production interests for $1.3 billion. The transaction is expected to close later in 2006. The gain on the sale is expected to be about $0.5 billion.

F - 152


BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES

SUPPLEMENTARY OIL AND GAS INFORMATION

(Unaudited)

        The following tables show estimates of the Group's net proved reserves of crude oil and natural gas at December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002.

Movements in estimated net proved reserves of crude oil (a)(b)

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Other

  Total

 
 
  (millions of barrels)

 
2004                                      
Subsidiary undertakings                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed   697   236   1,902   385   82   190     73   3,565  
Undeveloped   245   127   1,499   354   81   632     711   3,649  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    942   363   3,401   739   163   822     784   7,214  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates   (133 ) 1   (44 ) (92 ) 2   19     (192 ) (439 )
Purchases of reserves-in-place                    
Extensions, discoveries and other additions   24     74   5   8   48     213   372  
Improved recovery   57   4   55   31     6     3   156  
Production   (121 ) (28 ) (217 ) (63 ) (17 ) (48 )   (21 ) (515 )
Sales of reserves-in-place       (17 ) (10 ) (6 )       (33 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    (173 ) (23 ) (149 ) (129 ) (13 ) 25     3   (459 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31 (c)                                      
Developed   559   231   2,041   311   65   204     62   3,473  
Undeveloped   210   109   1,211   299   85   643     725   3,282  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    769   340   3,252 (d) 610   150   847     787   6,755  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity-accounted entities                                      
(BP share)                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed         206   1     1,384   705   2,296  
Undeveloped         134       410   27   571  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          340   1     1,794   732   2,867  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates         (5 )     382   15   392  
Purchases of reserves-in-place               252     252  
Extensions, discoveries and other additions         2           2  
Improved recovery         17       37     54  
Production         (25 )     (304 ) (55 ) (384 )
Sales of reserves-in-place               (4 )   (4 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          (11 )     363   (40 ) 312  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31 (e)                                      
Developed         204   1     1,863   592   2,660  
Undeveloped         125       294   100   519  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          329   1     2,157   692   3,179  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

S - 1


 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Other

  Total

 
 
  (millions of barrels)

 
2003                                      
Subsidiary undertakings                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed   858   250   2,225   573   125   179     125   4,335  
Undeveloped   269   99   1,336   198   54   723     748   3,427  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    1,127   349   3,561   771   179   902     873   7,762  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates   53   42   (83 ) (33 ) 30   (253 )   (107 ) (351 )
Purchases of reserves-in-place         42           42  
Extensions, discoveries and other additions   6   16   240   1     361     36   660  
Improved recovery   38   5   84   42         3   172  
Production   (138 ) (30 ) (237 ) (71 ) (22 ) (43 )   (21 ) (562 )
Sales of reserves-in-place   (144 ) (19 ) (164 ) (13 ) (24 ) (145 )     (509 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    (185 ) 14   (160 ) (32 ) (16 ) (80 )   (89 ) (548 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31 (c)                                      
Developed   697   236   1,902   385   82   190     73   3,565  
Undeveloped   245   127   1,499   354   81   632     711   3,649  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    942   363   3,401 (d) 739   163   822     784   7,214  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity-accounted entities                                      
(BP share)                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed         173   1     252   752   1,178  
Undeveloped         139   6     49   31   225  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          312   7     301   783   1,403  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates         3         2   5  
Purchases of reserves-in-place               1,600     1,600  
Extensions, discoveries and other additions         6           6  
Improved recovery         42           42  
Production         (23 ) (1 )   (107 ) (53 ) (184 )
Sales of reserves-in-place           (5 )       (5 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          28   (6 )   1,493   (51 ) 1,464  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31 (e)                                      
Developed         206   1     1,384   705   2,296  
Undeveloped         134       410   27   571  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          340   1     1,794   732   2,867  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

S - 2


 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Other

  Total

 
 
  (millions of barrels)

 
2002                                      
Subsidiary undertakings                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed   1,008   269   2,195   401   113   200     122   4,308  
Undeveloped   317   112   1,394   195   52   458     381   2,909  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    1,325   381   3,589   596   165   658     503   7,217  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates   (58 )   (33 ) (28 ) 36   27     27   (29 )
Purchases of reserves-in-place   8   2     210         7   227  
Extensions, discoveries and other additions   9     199   39     263     347   857  
Improved recovery   19   4   60   20   5       24   132  
Production   (168 ) (38 ) (254 ) (65 ) (27 ) (46 )   (21 ) (619 )
Sales of reserves-in-place   (8 )     (1 )       (14 ) (23 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    (198 ) (32 ) (28 ) 175   14   244     370   545  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31 (c)                                      
Developed   858   250   2,225   573   125   179     125   4,335  
Undeveloped   269   99   1,336   198   54   723     748   3,427  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    1,127   349   3,561 (d) 771   179   902     873   7,762  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity-accounted entities                                      
(BP share)                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed   5       129   3     45   800   982  
Undeveloped         146   6       25   177  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    5       275   9     45   825   1,159  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates         (4 ) (1 )   80   1   76  
Purchases of reserves-in-place               203     203  
Extensions, discoveries and other additions         7           7  
Improved recovery         55           55  
Production         (21 ) (1 )   (27 ) (43 ) (92 )
Sales of reserves-in-place   (5 )               (5 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    (5 )     37   (2 )   256   (42 ) 244  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31                                      
Developed         173   1     252   752   1,178  
Undeveloped         139   6     49   31   225  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          312   7     301   783   1,403  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

S - 3



(a)
Crude oil includes natural gas liquids and condensate. Net proved reserves of crude oil exclude production royalties due to others, whether royalty is payable in cash or in kind.

(b)
Proved reserves estimates for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2003 reflect year-end prices and some adjustments which have been made vis-à-vis individual asset reserve estimates based on different applications of certain SEC interpretations of SEC regulations relating to the use of technology (mainly seismic) to estimate reserves in the reservoir away from wellbores and the reporting of fuel gas (i.e., gas used for fuel in operations on the lease) within proved reserves. Reserve estimates for the year ended December 31, 2002 have not been adjusted.

(c)
Includes 40 million barrels of crude oil (55 million barrels at December 31, 2003 and 17 million barrels at December 31, 2002) in respect of the 30% minority interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.

(d)
Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 77 million barrels (78 million barrels at December 31, 2003 and 86 million barrels at December 31, 2002) upon which a net profits royalty will be payable over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.

(e)
Includes 127 million barrels (97 million barrels at December 31, 2003) in respect of the 5.9% minority interest in TNK-BP.

S - 4


Movements in estimated net proved reserves of natural gas (a)(b)

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Other

  Total

 
 
  (billions of cubic feet)

 
2004                                      
Subsidiary undertakings                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed   2,996   262   11,482   4,212   1,976   640     255   21,823  
Undeveloped   1,095   1,255   3,337   11,531   3,026   2,188     900   23,332  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    4,091   1,517   14,819   15,743   5,002   2,828     1,155   45,155  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates   (210 ) 28   (438 ) (1,081 ) 106   16     558   (1,021 )
Purchases of reserves-in-place       3   2           5  
Extensions, discoveries and other additions   127     140   991   2,478   233     3   3,972  
Improved recovery   134   4   870   76     29     38   1,151  
Production (c)   (461 ) (47 ) (1,111 ) (875 ) (296 ) (102 )   (76 ) (2,968 )
Sales of reserves-in-place       (202 ) (92 ) (247 ) (103 )     (644 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    (410 ) (15 ) (738 ) (979 ) 2,041   73     523   495  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31 (d)                                      
Developed   2,498   248   10,811   4,101   1,624   1,015     282   20,579  
Undeveloped   1,183   1,254   3,270   10,663   5,419   1,886     1,396   25,071  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    3,681   1,502   14,081   14,764   7,043   2,901     1,678   45,650  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity-accounted entities                                      
(BP share)                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed         1,591   136     46   58   1,831  
Undeveloped         916   80     14   28   1,038  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          2,507   216     60   86   2,869  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates         (12 ) (17 )   341     312  
Purchases of reserves-in-place                    
Extensions, discoveries and other additions                    
Improved recovery         23           23  
Production (e)         (144 ) (23 )   (177 ) (3 ) (347 )
Sales of reserves-in-place                    
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          (133 ) (40 )   164   (3 ) (12 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31 (f)                                      
Developed         1,397   107     214   60   1,778  
Undeveloped         977   69     10   23   1,079  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          2,374   176     224   83   2,857  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

S - 5


 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Other

  Total

 
 
  (billions of cubic feet)

 
2003                                      
Subsidiary undertakings                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed   3,215   216   12,102   4,637   2,528   815     260   23,773  
Undeveloped   651   44   2,259   13,128   2,747   3,176     66   22,071  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    3,866   260   14,361   17,765   5,275   3,991     326   45,844  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates   537   119   205   (1,629 ) 10   158     111   (489 )
Purchases of reserves-in-place       1   85           86  
Extensions, discoveries and other additions   397   1,213   293   64         764   2,731  
Improved recovery   72   1   2,083   262         28   2,446  
Production (c)   (528 ) (43 ) (1,224 ) (792 ) (283 ) (92 )   (74 ) (3,036 )
Sales of reserves-in-place   (253 ) (33 ) (900 ) (12 )   (1,229 )     (2,427 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    225   1,257   458   (2,022 ) (273 ) (1,163 )   829   (689 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31 (d)                                      
Developed   2,996   262   11,482   4,212   1,976   640     255   21,823  
Undeveloped   1,095   1,255   3,337   11,531   3,026   2,188     900   23,332  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    4,091   1,517   14,819   15,743   5,002   2,828     1,155   45,155  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity-accounted entities                                      
(BP share)                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed         1,282   160       64   1,506  
Undeveloped         855   538       46   1,439  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          2,137   698       110   2,945  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates         437   26     107   (21 ) 549  
Purchases of reserves-in-place                    
Extensions, discoveries and other additions         12           12  
Improved recovery         35           35  
Production (e)         (114 ) (26 )   (47 ) (3 ) (190 )
Sales of reserves-in-place           (482 )       (482 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          370   (482 )   60   (24 ) (76 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31                                      
Developed         1,591   136     46   58   1,831  
Undeveloped         916   80     14   28   1,038  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          2,507   216     60   86   2,869  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

S - 6


 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Other

  Total

 
 
  (billions of cubic feet)

 
2002                                      
Subsidiary undertakings                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed   3,212   265   12,232   4,549   2,307   826     358   23,749  
Undeveloped   1,160   43   2,535   9,926   2,220   3,209     117   19,210  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    4,372   308   14,767   14,475   4,527   4,035     475   42,959  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates   (137 ) 3   (149 ) 30   1,061   38     46   892  
Purchases of reserves-in-place   77   3   1   4         52   137  
Extensions, discoveries and other additions   126     340   2,687     11     4   3,168  
Improved recovery   64     738   1,263           2,065  
Production (c)   (566 ) (54 ) (1,334 ) (655 ) (313 ) (93 )   (86 ) (3,101 )
Sales of reserves-in-place   (70 )   (2 ) (39 )       (165 ) (276 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    (506 ) (48 ) (406 ) 3,290   748   (44 )   (149 ) 2,885  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31 (d)                                      
Developed   3,215   216   12,102   4,637   2,528   815     260   23,773  
Undeveloped   651   44   2,259   13,128   2,747   3,176     66   22,071  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    3,866   260   14,361   17,765   5,275   3,991     326   45,844  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity-accounted entities                                      
(BP share)                                      
At January 1                                      
Developed   24       1,288   153       67   1,532  
Undeveloped         1,158   491       35   1,684  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    24       2,446   644       102   3,216  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes attributable to:                                      
Revisions of previous estimates         (251 ) 82       12   (157 )
Purchases of reserves-in-place         18       2     20  
Extensions, discoveries and other additions         27           27  
Improved recovery         1           1  
Production (e)   (2 )     (104 ) (28 )   (2 ) (4 ) (140 )
Sales of reserves-in-place   (22 )               (22 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    (24 )     (309 ) 54       8   (271 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31                                      
Developed         1,282   160       64   1,506  
Undeveloped         855   538       46   1,439  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          2,137   698       110   2,945  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

S - 7



(a)
Net proved reserves of natural gas exclude production royalties due to others, whether royalty is payable in cash or in kind.

(b)
Proved reserves estimates for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2003 reflect year-end prices and some adjustments which have been made vis-à-vis individual asset reserve estimates based on different applications of certain SEC interpretations of SEC regulations relating to the use of technology (mainly seismic) to estimate reserves in the reservoir away from wellbores and the reporting of fuel gas (i.e., gas used for fuel in operations on the lease) within proved reserves. Reserve estimates for the year ended December 31, 2002 have not been adjusted.

(c)
Includes 165 billion cubic feet of natural gas consumed in operations (2003, 69 billion cubic feet and 2002, 63 billion cubic feet).

(d)
Includes 4,064 billion cubic feet of natural gas (4,505 billion cubic feet at December 31, 2003 and 1.185 billion cubic feet at December 31, 2002) in respect of the 30% minority interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.

(e)
Includes 25 billion cubic feet of natural gas consumed in operations (2003, nil and 2002, nil).

(f)
Includes 13 billion cubic feet of natural gas at December 31, 2004 in respect of the 5.9% minority interest in TNK-BP.

S - 8


Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows and changes therein relating to proved oil and gas reserves

        The following tables set out the standardized measures of discounted future net cash flows, and changes therein, relating to crude oil and natural gas production from the Group's estimated proved reserves. This information is prepared in compliance with the requirements of FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 69 — 'Disclosures about Oil and Gas Producing Activities'.

        In 2004 and 2003, the reserves reported in the Supplementary Oil and Gas Information and those included in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows (SMOG) are the same, both based on year-end prices. In prior years, the reserves reported at planning prices were adjusted for the purposes of the SMOG calculation to reflect only the impacts of the year-end price on PSAs, resulting in a lower volume being included in SMOG when prices were higher than our planning prices.

        Future net cash flows have been prepared on the basis of certain assumptions which may or may not be realized. These include the timing of future production, the estimation of crude oil and natural gas reserves and the application of year-end crude oil and natural gas prices and exchange rates. Furthermore, both reserve estimates and production forecasts are subject to revision as further technical information becomes available and economic conditions change. BP cautions against relying on the information presented because of the highly arbitrary nature of assumptions on which it is based and its lack of comparability with the historical cost information presented in the financial statements.

S - 9


 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Others

  Total

 
  ($ million)

At December 31, 2004                                    
Future cash inflows (a)   47,400   21,700   169,500   52,600   27,200   35,000     34,200   387,600
Future production cost (b)   19,200   4,500   37,800   14,300   6,700   5,800     6,900   95,200
Future development cost (b)   2,200   1,900   10,800   4,400   3,500   4,700     5,100   32,600
Future taxation (c)   9,900   11,200   41,800   16,300   5,200   6,900     5,000   96,300
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future net cash flows   16,100   4,100   79,100   17,600   11,800   17,600     17,200   163,500
10% annual discount (d)   4,700   2,000   38,100   8,000   6,900   7,500     7,800   75,000
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows (e)   11,400   2,100   41,000   9,600   4,900   10,100     9,400   88,500
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31, 2003                                    
Future cash inflows (a)   44,900   17,000   155,500   56,300   17,900   31,000     25,800   348,400
Future production cost (b)   16,200   3,900   29,600   14,200   4,400   4,700     5,400   78,400
Future development cost (b)   2,300   1,800   9,800   4,300   1,400   5,100     3,100   27,800
Future taxation (c)   10,200   7,600   41,400   17,100   3,600   5,300     3,800   89,000
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future net cash flows   16,200   3,700   74,700   20,700   8,500   15,900     13,500   153,200
10% annual discount (d)   5,300   1,900   36,200   10,500   4,100   7,700     7,000   72,700
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows (e)   10,900   1,800   38,500   10,200   4,400   8,200     6,500   80,500
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At December 31, 2002                                    
Future cash inflows (a)   44,300   11,600   146,100   64,200   20,500   32,300     19,900   338,900
Future production cost (b)   16,100   3,100   29,700   15,100   5,000   5,000     4,000   78,000
Future development cost (b)   2,300   800   9,300   3,000   2,600   5,100     2,900   26,000
Future taxation (c)   9,800   5,300   38,500   22,700   4,000   4,500     3,200   88,000
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future net cash flows   16,100   2,400   68,600   23,400   8,900   17,700     9,800   146,900
10% annual discount (d)   4,800   800   33,100   12,400   4,800   9,600     4,900   70,400
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows (e)   11,300   1,600   35,500   11,000   4,100   8,100     4,900   76,500
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

S - 10


        The following are the principal sources of change in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows during the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002:

 
  Years ended December 31,
 
 
  2004

  2003

  2002

 
 
  ($ million)

 
Sales and transfers of oil and gas produced, net of production costs   (24,100 ) (22,200 ) (22,400 )
Development costs incurred during the year   6,300   6,300   7,200  
Extensions, discoveries and improved recovery, less related costs   3,100   8,700   9,700  
Net changes in prices and production cost (f)   27,600   7,300   51,600  
Revisions of previous reserve estimates   (10,700 ) (3,000 ) 2,500  
Net change in taxation   1,900   6,100   (16,700 )
Future development costs   (3,200 ) (1,600 ) (5,100 )
Net change in purchase and sales of reserves-in-place   (1,000 ) (5,300 ) 800  
Addition of 10% annual discount   8,100   7,700   4,400  
   
 
 
 
Total change in the standardized measure during the year   8,000   4,000   32,000  
   
 
 
 

(a)
The year-end marker prices used were Brent $40.24/bbl, Henry Hub $6.01/mmbtu (2003 Brent $30.10/bbl, Henry Hub $5.76/mmbtu; 2002 Brent $30.38/bbl, Henry Hub $4.13/mmbtu).

(b)
Production costs (which include petroleum revenue tax in the UK) and development costs relating to future production of proved reserves are based on year-end cost levels and assume continuation of existing economic conditions. Future decommissioning costs are included.

(c)
Taxation is computed using appropriate year-end statutory corporate income tax rates.

(d)
Future net cash flows from oil and natural gas production are discounted at 10% regardless of the Group assessment of the risk associated with its producing activities.

(e)
Minority interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC amounted to $1,600 million at December 31, 2004 ($1,700 million at December 31, 2003 and $700 million at December 31, 2002).

(f)
Net changes in prices and production costs includes the effect of exchange movements.

Equity-accounted entities

        In addition, at December 31, 2004 the Group's share of the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted entities amounted to $11,200 million ($12,000 million at December 31, 2003 and $4,300 million at December 31, 2002).

S - 11


Operational and statistical information

        The following tables present operational and statistical information related to production, drilling, productive wells and acreage.

Crude oil and natural gas production

        The following table shows crude oil and natural gas production for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2003 and 2002.

Production for the year (a)

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Others

  Total

 
  (thousand barrels per day)

Subsidiary undertakings                                    
Crude oil (b)                                    
2004   330   77   666   173   48   130     56   1,480
2003   377   84   726   194   59   117     58   1,615
2002   461   104   765   180   73   124     59   1,766

 

 

(million cubic feet per day)
Natural gas (c)                                    
2004   1,174   125   2,749   2,334   775   267     200   7,624
2003   1,446   119   3,128   2,168   775   253     203   8,092
2002   1,550   147   3,483   1,799   855   256     234   8,324

Equity-accounted entities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
(BP share)                                    
Crude oil (b)                                    
2004         68   2     831   150   1,051
2003         63   2     296   145   506
2002   1       57   2     73   119   252

Natural gas (c)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
2004         353   60     458   8   879
2003         312   73     129   7   521
2002   5       283   77     6   12   383

(a)
All volumes are net of royalty, whether payable in cash or in kind.

(b)
Crude oil includes natural gas liquids and condensate.

(c)
Natural gas production excludes gas consumed in operations.

S - 12


Productive oil and gas wells and acreage

        The following tables show the number of gross and net productive oil and natural gas wells and total gross and net developed and undeveloped oil and natural gas acreage in which the Group and its equity-accounted entities had interests as of December 31, 2004. A 'gross' well or acre is one in which a whole or fractional working interest is owned, while the number of 'net' wells or acres is the sum of the whole or fractional working interests in gross wells or acres. Productive wells are producing wells and wells capable of production. Developed acreage is the acreage within the boundary of a field, on which development wells have been drilled, which could produce the reserves; while undeveloped acres are those on which wells have not been drilled or completed to a point that would permit the production of commercial quantities, whether or not such acres contain proved reserves.

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Others

  Total

Number of productive wells at December 31, 2004                                    
Oil wells (a) — gross   381   79   8,493   3,291   329   611   21,895   1,395   36,474
— net   148.1   25.4   2,608.8   1,834.0   142.9   563.4   9,603.7   235.9   15,162.2

Gas wells (b) — gross

 

319

 

43

 

16,974

 

2,151

 

516

 

71

 

48

 

118

 

20,240
— net   148.8   15.3   11,003.6   1,334.4   188.9   33.9   23.5   49.4   12,797.8

(a)
Includes approximately 1,036 gross (308.9 net) multiple completion wells (more than one formation producing into the same well bore).

(b)
Includes approximately 1,891 gross (999.4 net) multiple completion wells. If one of the multiple completions in a well is an oil completion, the well is classified as an oil well.

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Others

  Total

 
  (thousands of acres)

Oil and natural gas acreage at December 31, 2004                                    
Developed                                    
— gross   507   138   7,211   2,410   671   231   4,151   1,590   16,909
— net   221.9   46.1   4,844.2   1,271.8   208.0   131.0   1,820.8   156.6   8,700.4
Undeveloped (a)                                    
— gross   2,484   2,972   7,524   23,506   9,615   10,203   13,810   14,822   84,936
— net   1,328.5   1,120.3   5,387.7   12,803.6   3,794.2   5,318.2   5,714.9   3,305.4   38,772.8

(a)
Undeveloped acreage includes leases and concessions.

S - 13


Net oil and gas wells completed or abandoned

        The following table shows the number of net productive and dry exploratory and development oil and natural gas wells completed or abandoned in the years indicated by the Group and its equity-accounted entities. Productive wells include wells in which hydrocarbons were encountered and the drilling or completion of which, in the case of exploratory wells, has been suspended pending further drilling or evaluation. A dry well is one found to be incapable of producing hydrocarbons in sufficient quantities to justify completion.

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Others

  Total

2004                                    
Exploratory                                    
— productive       2.1   1.3     6.6   11.0   1.3   22.3
— dry       3.2   1.5     2.0   5.2   1.1   13.0
Development                                    
— productive   10.0   0.3   513.3   138.2   8.6   12.9   166.8   16.0   866.1
— dry   0.1     3.0   1.8     2.0   8.7   2.4   18.0
2003                                    
Exploratory                                    
— productive   0.3   1.1   1.0   2.8     5.2   1.8   0.7   12.9
— dry     0.2   0.8   1.3   0.5   1.5   0.3   1.2   5.8
Development                                    
— productive   11.0   2.8   466.2   139.5   8.8   26.1   39.3   12.1   705.8
— dry   0.4   0.3   5.5   3.8   1.1   1.0   1.7   0.7   14.5
2002                                    
Exploratory                                    
— productive   0.8   0.4   2.1   6.8   4.3   5.0   0.8   0.4   20.6
— dry     0.5   1.0   16.5   0.3   2.3   0.5     21.1
Development                                    
— productive   17.3   1.5   384.2   139.9   22.7   24.5   14.0   11.8   615.9
— dry   2.8     19.7   25.5     1.0     1.8   50.8

S - 14


Drilling and production activities in progress

        The following table shows the number of exploratory and development oil and natural gas wells in the process of being drilled by the Group and its equity-accounted entities as of December 31, 2004. Suspended development wells and long-term suspended exploratory wells are also included in the table.

 
  UK

  Rest of
Europe

  USA

  Rest of
Americas

  Asia
Pacific

  Africa

  Russia

  Others

  Total

At December 31, 2004                                    
Exploratory                                    
— gross       30   5   5   3   3   1   47
— net       14.0   3.3   2.6   2.4   1.2   0.3   23.8
Development                                    
— gross   11   1   162   22   2   22   20   27   267
— net   3.4   0.3   100.2   18.2   0.8   6.4   8.7   6.8   144.8

S - 15


Exploration wells

        During 2004 BP continued activity on suspended wells, and following technical, commercial and management review, has determined that it is appropriate to continue to carry the suspended well costs as assets as sufficient progress is being made towards the final assessment of the economic viability of these discoveries.

        The table below provides information about the exploration wells whose costs have been carried for more than one year after the completion of drilling and are classified as intangible assets at December 31, 2004:

Country/Project

  Amounts
carried as
intangible
assets at
year end 2004

  Number
of
wells gross

  Years wells
drilled

  Anticipated
year of
proved reserve
booking

  Comment

 
  ($ millions)

   
   
   
   
Angola   99   19            

Clochas/Tchihumba

 

14

 

2

 

2003

 

2009

 

Initial assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; potential requirement for further appraisal identified; negotiations in progress with joint venture partners; development options identified and under evaluation; development awaiting capacity in existing infrastructure.

Bavuca/Kakocha Mbulumbumba

 

15

 

3

 

2000-2003

 

2011

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; negotiations in progress with joint venture partners; development options identified and under evaluation; development planned in two phases through tieback to existing infrastructure.
                     

S - 16



Lirio/Cravo

 

7

 

2

 

1998-1999

 

2009

 

Initial assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; potential requirement for further appraisal identified; Declaration of Commercial Discovery submitted; development options identified and under evaluation; planned subsea tieback to floating production system.

Mondo/Saxi/Batuque

 

31

 

7

 

2000-2003

 

2005-2008

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; Declaration of Commercial Discovery submitted; development option selected; planned subsea tieback to floating production system.

Orquidea, Violeta, Tulipa

 

9

 

3

 

1999-2001

 

2007-2011

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; assessment of economic and developmental aspects of project in progress; planned subsea tieback to floating production system; high-resolution 3-D seismic survey in 2004; submission of Declaration of Commercial Discovery anticipated in 2005.
                     

S - 17



Cesio/Chumbo

 

23

 

2

 

2003

 

2008

 

Initial assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; potential requirement for further appraisal identified; assessment of developmental aspects in progress; development planned with tieback to standalone floating production system as part of area development in 2008; alternative development plan for tieback via existing facilities.

Australia

 

24

 

6

 

 

 

 

 

 

WA267-P

 

24

 

6

 

1999-2001

 

2006

 

Initial assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development options identified and under evaluation.

Colombia

 

133

 

4

 

 

 

 

 

 

Floreña/Pauto

 

90

 

3

 

1997-1998

 

2005-2009

 

Initial assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; assessment of economic aspects of project in progress; development options identified and under evaluation; phased development scheme, production from earlier phases in 2002-2004; subsequent phase via expansion of existing infrastructure.
                     

S - 18



Volcanera

 

43

 

1

 

1993

 

2009

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; assessment of economic aspects of project in progress; development options identified and under evaluation; planned phased development linked to neighbouring field using existing infrastructure.

Egypt

 

36

 

12

 

 

 

 

 

 

Baltim Tersa

 

7

 

2

 

1995-1999

 

2005-2007

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development option selected; planned tieback to existing infrastructure; part of existing producing concession with gas sale agreement.

East Delta Deep Marine Thalab

 

7

 

2

 

2000-2002

 

2007

 

Initial assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; potential requirement for further appraisal identified; assessment of economic aspects of project in progress; planned subsea tieback to existing infrastructure.

Saqqara

 

7

 

1

 

2003

 

2004

 

Final investment decision made; costs to be transferred to development costs in 2005.
                     

S - 19



Temsah

 

15

 

7

 

1995-1997

 

2005-2010

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development options identified and under evaluation; planned subsea tieback to existing infrastructure; gas sale agreement in place.

Norway

 

77

 

9

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ellida

 

12

 

1

 

2003

 

Not applicable

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; assessment of economic aspects of project completed. BP disposed of its interest in January 2005.

Skarv/Snadd

 

65

 

8

 

1998-2002

 

2006-2007

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development options identified and under evaluation; assessment of export infrastructure alternatives and negotiations with partners on development plan are in progress.

Trinidad

 

113

 

6

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cashima

 

17

 

1

 

2001

 

2009

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development options identified and under evaluation; development awaiting capacity in existing infrastructure.
                     

S - 20



Corallita/Lantana

 

24

 

2

 

1996

 

2008

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development options identified and under evaluation; planned subsea tieback to existing infrastructure; fields dedicated to LNG gas contract delivery.

Manakin

 

18

 

1

 

2000

 

2010-2011

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; assessment of economic aspects of project in progress; development options identified and under evaluation; planned subsea tieback to existing LNG train; government discussions on unitization underway.

Red Mango

 

54

 

2

 

2000-2002

 

2007

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development option selected; planned subsea tieback to existing infrastructure.

United Kingdom

 

195

 

19

 

 

 

 

 

 

Andrew

 

14

 

1

 

1998

 

2007

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development options identified and under evaluation; development awaiting capacity in existing infrastructure.
                     

S - 21



Devenick

 

97

 

3

 

1983-2001

 

2005-2006

 

Initial assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; assessment of economic and developmental aspects of project in progress; integrated field model, subsurface and seismic studies under review.

Kessog

 

35

 

4

 

1986-1987

 

2007

 

Initial assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; potential requirement for further appraisal identified; active negotiation of agreements with venture partners.

Puffin

 

29

 

9

 

1982-1991

 

2007-2008

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; further assessment of economic and developmental aspects of project to be undertaken; development awaiting capacity in existing infrastructure.

Suilven

 

20

 

2

 

1996-1998

 

2010

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; assessment of economic and developmental aspects of project in progress; development awaiting capacity in existing infrastructure.
                     

S - 22



United States

 

216

 

12

 

 

 

 

 

 

Blind Faith

 

57

 

2

 

2001

 

Not applicable

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; assessment of economic and developmental aspects of project in progress. BP disposed of its interest in February 2005.

Deimos

 

13

 

1

 

2002-2003

 

2005

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development options identified and under evaluation; development in two phases; first phase sanctioned in 2004; second phase planned with subsea tieback.

Dorado

 

61

 

3

 

2002

 

2005

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development options identified and under evaluation; planned subsea tieback to existing infrastructure.

Entrada

 

33

 

2

 

2000

 

2005-2006

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development options identified and under evaluation; expected development as subsea tieback to existing/planned facilities.
                     

S - 23



Langley-Canada

 

5

 

1

 

2003

 

2009-2010

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; assessment of economic and developmental aspects of project completed; development dependent on construction of major pipeline expected to be operational by 2010.

Liberty

 

20

 

1

 

1997

 

2008

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development options identified and under evaluation. Planned tieback to existing infrastructure; Memorandums Of Understanding with key permitting agencies are being secured.

Point Thomson/Sourdough

 

27

 

2

 

1994-1996

 

2008

 

Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; development options identified and under evaluation. Annual Plan of Development work programme approved by state; initial engineering design for gas cycling option complete; also progressing alternative development options including tie in to proposed Alaska gas pipeline.

S - 24


Country/Project

  Amounts
carried as
intangible
assets at
year end 2004

  Number
of
wells gross

  Years wells
drilled

  Anticipated
year of
proved reserve
booking

  Comment

 
  ($ millions)

   
   
   
   
Vietnam   78   4            
Hai Thach   65   3   1995-2002   2007   Assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; assessment of economic aspects of project completed; development options identified and under evaluation.
Kim Cuong Tay   13   1   1995   2010-2019   Initial assessment of hydrocarbon quantities as potentially commercial completed; requirement for further appraisal identified.
Miscellaneous
small projects
  19   12   1993-2002   2005-2019    
TOTAL   990   103            

S - 25



SCHEDULE II


BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES

VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS

 
   
  Additions

   
   
 
  Balance at
January 1,

  Charged to
costs and
expenses

  Charged to
other
accounts (a)

  Deductions

  Balance
December 31,

 
  ($ million)

2004                    
Fixed assets — Investments (b)   211   12   4   (57 ) 170
   
 
 
 
 
Doubtful debts (b)   441   254   6   (175 ) 526
   
 
 
 
 
2003                    
Fixed assets — Investments (b)   678     4   (471 ) 211
   
 
 
 
 
Doubtful debts (b)   445   139   29   (172 ) 441
   
 
 
 
 
2002                    
Fixed assets — Investments (b)   632   13   37   (4 ) 678
   
 
 
 
 
Doubtful debts (b)   290   179   49   (73 ) 445
   
 
 
 
 

(a)
Principally currency transactions.

(b)
Deducted in the balance sheet from the assets to which they apply.

S - 26



BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES

SIGNATURES

        The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this Amendment No. 1 to this annual report on its behalf.

    BP p.l.c.
(Registrant)
     
    /s/ D. J. PEARL
D. J. Pearl
Deputy Company Secretary

Dated: June 13, 2006

S - 27




QuickLinks

EXPLANATORY NOTE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CERTAIN DEFINITIONS
PART I
SELECTED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
RISK FACTORS
FORWARD LOOKING STATEMENTS
STATEMENTS REGARDING COMPETITIVE POSITION
GENERAL
SEGMENTAL INFORMATION
EXPLORATION AND PRODUCTION
REFINING AND MARKETING
PETROCHEMICALS
GAS, POWER AND RENEWABLES
OTHER BUSINESSES AND CORPORATE
REGULATION OF THE GROUP'S BUSINESS
ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION
PROPERTY, PLANTS AND EQUIPMENT
ORGANIZATIONAL STRUCTURE
GROUP OPERATING RESULTS
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
OUTLOOK
CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND NEW ACCOUNTING STANDARDS
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
COMPENSATION
BOARD PRACTICES
EMPLOYEES
SHARE OWNERSHIP
MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS
RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS AND OTHER FINANCIAL INFORMATION
SIGNIFICANT CHANGES
MEMORANDUM AND ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION
MATERIAL CONTRACTS
EXCHANGE CONTROLS AND OTHER LIMITATIONS AFFECTING SECURITY HOLDERS
TAXATION
DOCUMENTS ON DISPLAY
PART II
PART III
BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF INCOME
BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES STATEMENT OF TOTAL RECOGNIZED GAINS AND LOSSES
BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN BP SHAREHOLDERS' INTEREST
BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY OIL AND GAS INFORMATION
BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
BP p.l.c. AND SUBSIDIARIES SIGNATURES